REJ09B0450-0050 M32C/8B Group 16/32 Hardware Manual RENESAS MCU M16C FAMILY / M32C/80 SERIES Preliminary All information contained in these materials, including products and product specifications, represents information on the product at the time of publication and is subject to change by Renesas Technology Corp. without notice. Please review the latest information published by Renesas Technology Corp. through various means, including the Renesas Technology Corp. website (http://www.renesas.com). Rev.0.50 Revision Date:Oct 31, 2008 www.renesas.com Notes regarding these materials 1. This document is provided for reference purposes only so that Renesas customers may select the appropriate Renesas products for their use. Renesas neither makes warranties or representations with respect to the accuracy or completeness of the information contained in this document nor grants any license to any intellectual property rights or any other rights of Renesas or any third party with respect to the information in this document. 2. Renesas shall have no liability for damages or infringement of any intellectual property or other rights arising out of the use of any information in this document, including, but not limited to, product data, diagrams, charts, programs, algorithms, and application circuit examples. 3. You should not use the products or the technology described in this document for the purpose of military applications such as the development of weapons of mass destruction or for the purpose of any other military use. When exporting the products or technology described herein, you should follow the applicable export control laws and regulations, and procedures required by such laws and regulations. 4. All information included in this document such as product data, diagrams, charts, programs, algorithms, and application circuit examples, is current as of the date this document is issued. Such information, however, is subject to change without any prior notice. Before purchasing or using any Renesas products listed in this document, please confirm the latest product information with a Renesas sales office. Also, please pay regular and careful attention to additional and different information to be disclosed by Renesas such as that disclosed through our website. (http://www.renesas.com ) 5. Renesas has used reasonable care in compiling the information included in this document, but Renesas assumes no liability whatsoever for any damages incurred as a result of errors or omissions in the information included in this document. 6. When using or otherwise relying on the information in this document, you should evaluate the information in light of the total system before deciding about the applicability of such information to the intended application. Renesas makes no representations, warranties or guaranties regarding the suitability of its products for any particular application and specifically disclaims any liability arising out of the application and use of the information in this document or Renesas products. 7. With the exception of products specified by Renesas as suitable for automobile applications, Renesas products are not designed, manufactured or tested for applications or otherwise in systems the failure or malfunction of which may cause a direct threat to human life or create a risk of human injury or which require especially high quality and reliability such as safety systems, or equipment or systems for transportation and traffic, healthcare, combustion control, aerospace and aeronautics, nuclear power, or undersea communication transmission. If you are considering the use of our products for such purposes, please contact a Renesas sales office beforehand. Renesas shall have no liability for damages arising out of the uses set forth above. 8. Notwithstanding the preceding paragraph, you should not use Renesas products for the purposes listed below: (1) artificial life support devices or systems (2) surgical implantations (3) healthcare intervention (e.g., excision, administration of medication, etc.) (4) any other purposes that pose a direct threat to human life Renesas shall have no liability for damages arising out of the uses set forth in the above and purchasers who elect to use Renesas products in any of the foregoing applications shall indemnify and hold harmless Renesas Technology Corp., its affiliated companies and their officers, directors, and employees against any and all damages arising out of such applications. 9. You should use the products described herein within the range specified by Renesas, especially with respect to the maximum rating, operating supply voltage range, movement power voltage range, heat radiation characteristics, installation and other product characteristics. Renesas shall have no liability for malfunctions or damages arising out of the use of Renesas products beyond such specified ranges. 10. Although Renesas endeavors to improve the quality and reliability of its products, IC products have specific characteristics such as the occurrence of failure at a certain rate and malfunctions under certain use conditions. Please be sure to implement safety measures to guard against the possibility of physical injury, and injury or damage caused by fire in the event of the failure of a Renesas product, such as safety design for hardware and software including but not limited to redundancy, fire control and malfunction prevention, appropriate treatment for aging degradation or any other applicable measures. Among others, since the evaluation of microcomputer software alone is very difficult, please evaluate the safety of the final products or system manufactured by you. 11. In case Renesas products listed in this document are detached from the products to which the Renesas products are attached or affixed, the risk of accident such as swallowing by infants and small children is very high. You should implement safety measures so that Renesas products may not be easily detached from your products. Renesas shall have no liability for damages arising out of such detachment. 12. This document may not be reproduced or duplicated, in any form, in whole or in part, without prior written approval from Renesas. 13. Please contact a Renesas sales office if you have any questions regarding the information contained in this document, Renesas semiconductor products, or if you have any other inquiries. General Precautions in the Handling of MPU/MCU Products The following usage notes are applicable to all MPU/MCU products from Renesas. For detailed usage notes on the products covered by this manual, refer to the relevant sections of the manual. If the descriptions under General Precautions in the Handling of MPU/MCU Products and in the body of the manual differ from each other, the description in the body of the manual takes precedence. 1. Handling of Unused Pins Handle unused pins in accord with the directions given under Handling of Unused Pins in the manual. The input pins of CMOS products are generally in the high-impedance state. In operation with an unused pin in the open-circuit state, extra electromagnetic noise is induced in the vicinity of LSI, an associated shoot-through current flows internally, and malfunctions occur due to the false recognition of the pin state as an input signal become possible. Unused pins should be handled as described under Handling of Unused Pins in the manual. 2. Processing at Power-on The state of the product is undefined at the moment when power is supplied. The states of internal circuits in the LSI are indeterminate and the states of register settings and pins are undefined at the moment when power is supplied. In a finished product where the reset signal is applied to the external reset pin, the states of pins are not guaranteed from the moment when power is supplied until the reset process is completed. In a similar way, the states of pins in a product that is reset by an on-chip power-on reset function are not guaranteed from the moment when power is supplied until the power reaches the level at which resetting has been specified. 3. Prohibition of Access to Reserved Addresses Access to reserved addresses is prohibited. The reserved addresses are provided for the possible future expansion of functions. Do not access these addresses; the correct operation of LSI is not guaranteed if they are accessed. 4. Clock Signals After applying a reset, only release the reset line after the operating clock signal has become stable. When switching the clock signal during program execution, wait until the target clock signal has stabilized. When the clock signal is generated with an external resonator (or from an external oscillator) during a reset, ensure that the reset line is only released after full stabilization of the clock signal. Moreover, when switching to a clock signal produced with an external resonator (or by an external oscillator) while program execution is in progress, wait until the target clock signal is stable. 5. Differences between Products Before changing from one product to another, i.e. to one with a different part number, confirm that the change will not lead to problems. The characteristics of MPU/MCU in the same group but having different part numbers may differ because of the differences in internal memory capacity and layout pattern. When changing to products of different part numbers, implement a system-evaluation test for each of the products. How to Use This Manual 1. Purpose and Target Readers This manual is designed to provide the user with an understanding of the hardware functions and electrical characteristics of the MCU. It is intended for users designing application systems incorporating the MCU. A basic knowledge of electric circuits, logical circuits, and MCUs is necessary in order to use this manual. The manual comprises an overview of the product; descriptions of the CPU, system control functions, peripheral functions, and electrical characteristics; and usage notes. Particular attention should be paid to the precautionary notes when using the manual. These notes occur within the body of the text, at the end of each section, and in the Usage Notes section. The revision history summarizes the locations of revisions and additions. It does not list all revisions. Refer to the text of the manual for details. The following documents apply to the M32C/8B Group. Make sure to refer to the latest versions of these documents. The newest versions of the documents listed may be obtained from the Renesas Technology Web site. Document Type Datasheet Description Document Title Document No. REJ03B0242Hardware overview and electrical characteristics M32C/8B Group Datasheet 0050 M32C/8B Group This hardware Hardware manual Hardware specifications (pin assignments, Hardware Manual manual memory maps, peripheral function specifications, electrical characteristics, timing charts) and operation description Note: Refer to the application notes for details on using peripheral functions. Software manual Description of CPU instruction set M32C/80 Series REJ09B0319Software Manual 0100 Available from Renesas Application note Information on using peripheral functions and Technology Web site. application examples Sample programs Information on writing programs in assembly language and C Renesas Product specifications, updates on documents, technical update etc. 2. Notation of Numbers and Symbols The notation conventions for register names, bit names, numbers, and symbols used in this manual are described below. (1) Register Names, Bit Names, and Pin Names Registers, bits, and pins are referred to in the text by symbols. The symbol is accompanied by the word “register,” “bit,” or “pin” to distinguish the three categories. Examples the PM03 bit in the PM0 register P3_5 pin, VCC pin (2) Notation of Numbers The indication “b” is appended to numeric values given in binary format. However, nothing is appended to the values of single bits. The indication “h” is appended to numeric values given in hexadecimal format. Nothing is appended to numeric values given in decimal format. Examples Binary: 11b Hexadecimal: EFA0h Decimal: 1234 3. Register Notation The symbols and terms used in register diagrams are described below. XXX Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 *1 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol XXX Address XXX Bit Symbol XXX0 After Reset 00h Bit Name XXX bits XXX1 Function RW 1 0: XXX 0 1: XXX 1 0: Do not set to this value 1 1: XXX RW RW (b2) Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. (b3) Reserved bit Set to 0 RW XXX bits Function varies depending on each operation mode RW XXX4 *3 XXX5 WO XXX6 RW XXX7 XXX bit *2 b1 b0 0: XXX 1: XXX *4 RO *1 Blank: Set to 0 or 1 according to the application. 0: Set to 0. 1: Set to 1. X: Unimplemented. *2 RW: Read and write. RO: Read only. WO: Write only. −: Unimplemented. *3 • Reserved bit Reserved bit. Set to specified value. *4 • Unimplemented Nothing is implemented to the bit. As the bit may be used for future functions, if necessary, set to 0. • Do not set to a value Operation is not guaranteed when a value is set. • Function varies according to the operating mode. The function of the bit varies with the peripheral function mode. Refer to the register diagram for information on the individual modes. 4. List of Abbreviations and Acronyms Abbreviation ACIA bps CRC DMA DMAC GSM Hi-Z IEBus I/O IrDA LSB MSB NC PLL PWM SFR SIM UART VCO Full Form Asynchronous Communication Interface Adapter bits per second Cyclic Redundancy Check Direct Memory Access Direct Memory Access Controller Global System for Mobile Communications High Impedance Inter Equipment bus Input/Output Infrared Data Association Least Significant Bit Most Significant Bit Non-Connection Phase Locked Loop Pulse Width Modulation Special Function Registers Subscriber Identity Module Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter Voltage Controlled Oscillator All trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. IEBus is a registered trademark of NEC Electronics Corporation. Table of Contents Special Function Register (SFR) Page Reference ............................................................................... B - 1 1. Overview ......................................................................................................................................... 1 1.1 1.1.1 1.1.2 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 2. Features ..................................................................................................................................................... 1 Applications .......................................................................................................................................... 1 Specifications ........................................................................................................................................ 1 Product List ............................................................................................................................................... 6 Block Diagram .......................................................................................................................................... 7 Pin Assignments ........................................................................................................................................ 8 Pin Functions ........................................................................................................................................... 15 Central Processing Unit (CPU) ..................................................................................................... 18 2.1 General Registers .................................................................................................................................... 2.1.1 Data Registers (R0, R1, R2, and R3) .................................................................................................. 2.1.2 Address Registers (A0 and A1) .......................................................................................................... 2.1.3 Static Base Register (SB) ................................................................................................................... 2.1.4 Frame Base Register (FB) .................................................................................................................. 2.1.5 User Stack Pointer (USP) and Interrupt Stack Pointer (ISP) .............................................................. 2.1.6 Interrupt Table Register (INTB) ......................................................................................................... 2.1.7 Program Counter (PC) ........................................................................................................................ 2.1.8 Flag Register (FLG) ............................................................................................................................ 2.2 High-Speed Interrupt Registers ............................................................................................................... 2.3 DMAC-Associated Registers .................................................................................................................. 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 20 20 3. Memory ......................................................................................................................................... 21 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) ............................................................................................... 22 5. Reset ............................................................................................................................................. 33 5.1 5.1.1 5.1.2 5.2 5.3 5.4 6. 33 33 33 35 35 36 Power Supply Voltage Monitor Function ....................................................................................... 37 6.1 7. Operation of Voltage Monitor Function ................................................................................................. 39 Processor Mode ............................................................................................................................ 40 7.1 7.2 8. Hardware Reset ....................................................................................................................................... Reset at a Stable Supply Voltage ........................................................................................................ Power-on Reset ................................................................................................................................... Software Reset ........................................................................................................................................ Watchdog Timer Reset ............................................................................................................................ Internal Registers .................................................................................................................................... Processor Mode ....................................................................................................................................... 40 Setting of Processor Mode ...................................................................................................................... 40 Bus ................................................................................................................................................ 44 8.1 Bus Settings ............................................................................................................................................. 8.1.1 Selecting External Address Bus ......................................................................................................... 8.1.2 Selecting External Data Bus ............................................................................................................... 8.1.3 Selecting Separate Bus/Multiplexed Bus ........................................................................................... 8.2 Bus Control ............................................................................................................................................. A-1 44 45 45 45 47 8.2.1 Address Bus and Data Bus ................................................................................................................. 8.2.2 Chip-Select Output ............................................................................................................................. 8.2.3 Read/Write Output Signals ................................................................................................................. 8.2.4 Bus Timing ......................................................................................................................................... 8.2.5 ALE Output ........................................................................................................................................ 8.2.6 RDY Input ............................................................................................................................................ 8.2.7 HOLD Input ........................................................................................................................................ 8.2.8 External Bus States when Accessing Internal Space .......................................................................... 8.2.9 BCLK Output ..................................................................................................................................... 8.3 Page Mode Control Function .................................................................................................................. 9. 47 47 49 50 58 58 59 60 60 61 Clock Generation Circuits ............................................................................................................. 65 9.1 9.1.1 9.1.2 9.1.3 9.1.4 9.2 9.3 9.3.1 9.3.2 9.3.3 9.4 9.5 9.5.1 9.5.2 9.5.3 9.6 Types of the Clock Generation Circuit ................................................................................................... Main Clock ......................................................................................................................................... Sub Clock ........................................................................................................................................... On-Chip Oscillator Clock ................................................................................................................... PLL Clock ........................................................................................................................................... CPU Clock and BCLK ............................................................................................................................ Peripheral Function Clock ....................................................................................................................... f1, f8, f32, and f2n .............................................................................................................................. fAD ..................................................................................................................................................... fC32 .................................................................................................................................................... Clock Output Function ............................................................................................................................ Power Consumption Control .................................................................................................................. CPU operating mode .......................................................................................................................... Wait Mode .......................................................................................................................................... Stop Mode ........................................................................................................................................... System Clock Protect Function ............................................................................................................... 65 75 76 77 79 81 81 81 81 81 82 83 83 87 90 93 10. Protection ...................................................................................................................................... 94 11. Interrupts ....................................................................................................................................... 95 11.1 11.2 11.2.1 11.2.2 11.2.3 11.2.4 11.2.5 11.3 11.3.1 11.3.2 11.4 11.5 11.5.1 11.5.2 11.6 11.6.1 11.6.2 11.6.3 Types of Interrupts .................................................................................................................................. 95 Software Interrupts .................................................................................................................................. 96 Undefined Instruction Interrupt .......................................................................................................... 96 Overflow Interrupt .............................................................................................................................. 96 BRK Interrupt ..................................................................................................................................... 96 BRK2 Interrupt ................................................................................................................................... 96 INT Instruction Interrupt .................................................................................................................... 96 Hardware Interrupts ................................................................................................................................ 97 Special Interrupts ................................................................................................................................ 97 Peripheral Function Interrupt .............................................................................................................. 97 High-Speed Interrupt ............................................................................................................................... 98 Interrupts and Interrupt Vectors .............................................................................................................. 99 Fixed Vector Table ............................................................................................................................. 99 Relocatable Vector Table ................................................................................................................... 99 Interrupt Request Acknowledgement .................................................................................................... 102 I Flag and IPL ................................................................................................................................... 102 Interrupt Control Registers and RLVL Register ............................................................................... 102 Interrupt Sequence ............................................................................................................................ 106 A-2 11.6.4 11.6.5 11.6.6 11.6.7 11.6.8 11.6.9 11.7 11.8 11.9 11.10 Interrupt Response Time .................................................................................................................. IPL Change when Interrupt Request is Acknowledged .................................................................... Saving a Register .............................................................................................................................. Returning from Interrupt Routine ..................................................................................................... Interrupt Priority ............................................................................................................................... Interrupt Priority Level Decision Circuit .......................................................................................... INT Interrupt ......................................................................................................................................... NMI Interrupt ........................................................................................................................................ Key Input Interrupt ................................................................................................................................ Address Match Interrupt ....................................................................................................................... 107 108 108 109 109 109 111 114 114 115 12. Watchdog Timer .......................................................................................................................... 116 13. DMAC ......................................................................................................................................... 120 13.1 Transfer Cycles ..................................................................................................................................... 130 13.1.1 Effect of Source and Destination Addresses .................................................................................... 130 13.1.2 Effect of the DS Register .................................................................................................................. 130 13.1.3 Effect of Software Wait State ........................................................................................................... 130 13.1.4 Effect of the RDY Signal .................................................................................................................. 130 13.2 DMA Transfer Time ............................................................................................................................. 131 13.3 Channel Priority and DMA Transfer Timing ........................................................................................ 131 14. DMACII ....................................................................................................................................... 133 14.1 14.1.1 14.1.2 14.1.3 14.1.4 14.2 14.3 14.3.1 14.3.2 14.3.3 14.4 14.4.1 14.4.2 14.4.3 14.5 14.6 14.7 15. DMACII Settings .................................................................................................................................. RLVL Register ................................................................................................................................. DMACII Index ................................................................................................................................. Interrupt Control Register for the Peripheral Function .................................................................... Relocatable Vector Table for the Peripheral Function ..................................................................... DMACII Performance ........................................................................................................................... Transfer Data ......................................................................................................................................... Memory-to-memory Transfer ........................................................................................................... Immediate Data Transfer .................................................................................................................. Calculation Transfer ......................................................................................................................... Transfer Modes ..................................................................................................................................... Single Transfer ................................................................................................................................. Burst Transfer ................................................................................................................................... Multiple Transfer .............................................................................................................................. Chain Transfer ....................................................................................................................................... End-of-Transfer Interrupt ...................................................................................................................... Execution Time ..................................................................................................................................... 133 133 135 137 137 137 137 137 138 138 138 138 138 138 139 139 140 Timers ......................................................................................................................................... 141 15.1 Timer A ................................................................................................................................................. 15.1.1 Timer Mode ...................................................................................................................................... 15.1.2 Event Counter Mode ......................................................................................................................... 15.1.3 One-Shot Timer Mode ...................................................................................................................... 15.1.4 Pulse Width Modulation Mode ......................................................................................................... 15.2 Timer B ................................................................................................................................................. 15.2.1 Timer Mode ...................................................................................................................................... A-3 143 155 156 161 163 166 173 15.2.2 15.2.3 16. Event Counter Mode ......................................................................................................................... 174 Pulse Period Measurement Mode, Pulse Width Measurement Mode .............................................. 175 Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function ............................................................................... 178 16.1 Triangular Wave Modulation Mode ...................................................................................................... 16.2 Sawtooth Wave Modulation Mode ....................................................................................................... 16.3 Short Circuit Prevention Features ......................................................................................................... 16.3.1 Prevention Against Upper/Lower Arm Short Circuit by Program Errors ........................................ 16.3.2 Arm Short Circuit Prevention Using Dead Time Timer ................................................................... 16.3.3 Forced-Cutoff Function by the NMI Input ....................................................................................... 17. Serial Interfaces .......................................................................................................................... 196 17.1 UART0 to UART4 ................................................................................................................................ 17.1.1 Clock Synchronous Mode ................................................................................................................ 17.1.2 Clock Asynchronous (UART) Mode ................................................................................................ 17.1.3 Special Mode 1 (I2C Mode) ............................................................................................................. 17.1.4 Special Mode 2 ................................................................................................................................. 17.1.5 Special Mode 3 (GCI Mode) ............................................................................................................ 17.1.6 Special Mode 4 (SIM Mode) ............................................................................................................ 18. 189 193 195 195 195 195 197 207 216 224 236 241 245 A/D Converter ............................................................................................................................. 251 18.1 18.1.1 18.1.2 18.1.3 18.1.4 18.1.5 18.1.6 18.1.7 18.2 18.2.1 18.2.2 18.2.3 18.2.4 18.2.5 18.2.6 18.2.7 18.3 18.4 Mode Descriptions ................................................................................................................................ One-Shot Mode ................................................................................................................................. Repeat Mode ..................................................................................................................................... Single Sweep Mode .......................................................................................................................... Repeat Sweep Mode 0 ...................................................................................................................... Repeat Sweep Mode 1 ...................................................................................................................... Multi-Port Single Sweep Mode ........................................................................................................ Multi-Port Repeat Sweep Mode 0 .................................................................................................... Functions ............................................................................................................................................... Resolution ......................................................................................................................................... Sample and Hold .............................................................................................................................. Trigger Select Function .................................................................................................................... DMAC Operating Mode ................................................................................................................... Extended Analog Input Pins ............................................................................................................. External Operating Amplifier (Op-Amp) Connection Mode ........................................................... Power Consumption Reduce Function ............................................................................................. Read from the AD0i Register (i = 0 to 7) .............................................................................................. Output Impedance of Sensor Equivalent Circuit under A/D Conversion ............................................. 258 259 260 261 262 263 265 266 267 267 267 267 267 267 268 268 269 269 19. D/A Converter ............................................................................................................................. 271 20. CRC Calculation ......................................................................................................................... 274 21. X/Y Conversion ........................................................................................................................... 276 22. Programmable I/O Ports ............................................................................................................. 279 22.1 22.2 22.3 Port Pi Direction Register (PDi Register, i = 0 to 15) ........................................................................... 279 Port Pi Register (Pi Register, i = 0 to 15) .............................................................................................. 279 Function Select Register A (PSj Register, j = 0 to 3) ............................................................................ 279 A-4 22.4 22.5 22.6 22.7 22.8 23. Function Select Register B (PSLk Register, k = 0 to 3) ........................................................................ Function Select Register C (PSC Register) ........................................................................................... Pull-up Control Register 0 to 4 (PUR0 to PUR4 Registers) ................................................................. Port Control Register (PCR Register) ................................................................................................... Analog Input and Other Peripheral Function Input ............................................................................... 279 279 280 280 280 Flash Memory ............................................................................................................................. 299 23.1 23.2 23.3 23.3.1 23.3.2 23.3.3 23.4 23.5 23.6 23.6.1 23.6.2 23.6.3 Memory Map ......................................................................................................................................... Registers ................................................................................................................................................ Protect Function .................................................................................................................................... Lock bit Protect Function ................................................................................................................. ROM Code Protect Function ............................................................................................................ ID Code Check Function .................................................................................................................. Flash Memory Stop Function ................................................................................................................ Boot Mode ............................................................................................................................................. Flash Memory Rewrite Mode ............................................................................................................... CPU Rewrite Mode .......................................................................................................................... Standard Serial I/O Mode ................................................................................................................. Parallel I/O Mode ............................................................................................................................. 300 301 304 304 304 305 306 307 307 308 321 325 24. Electrical Characteristics ............................................................................................................. 326 25. Usage Notes ............................................................................................................................... 360 25.1 25.1.1 25.1.2 25.1.3 25.2 25.2.1 25.2.2 25.3 25.4 25.4.1 25.5 25.5.1 25.5.2 25.5.3 25.5.4 25.6 25.7 25.7.1 25.7.2 25.7.3 25.7.4 25.7.5 25.8 25.9 25.9.1 25.9.2 25.9.3 Power Supply ........................................................................................................................................ Power-on ........................................................................................................................................... Power Supply Ripple ........................................................................................................................ Noise ................................................................................................................................................. Special Function Registers (SFRs) ........................................................................................................ 100 Pin-Package ............................................................................................................................... Register Settings ............................................................................................................................... Processor Mode ..................................................................................................................................... Bus ......................................................................................................................................................... HOLD Input ...................................................................................................................................... Clock Generation Circuits ..................................................................................................................... Main Clock ....................................................................................................................................... Sub Clock ......................................................................................................................................... Clock Dividing Ratio ........................................................................................................................ Power Consumption Control ............................................................................................................ Protection .............................................................................................................................................. Interrupts ............................................................................................................................................... ISP Setting ........................................................................................................................................ NMI Interrupt ................................................................................................................................... INT Interrupt ..................................................................................................................................... Changing Interrupt Control Register ................................................................................................ Changing RLVL Register ................................................................................................................. DMAC ................................................................................................................................................... Timers ................................................................................................................................................... Timer A, Timer B ............................................................................................................................. Timer A ............................................................................................................................................. Timer B ............................................................................................................................................. A-5 360 360 361 361 362 362 362 363 364 364 365 365 365 365 365 368 369 369 369 369 371 371 372 373 373 373 375 25.10 Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function ......................................................................................... 25.11 Serial Interfaces ..................................................................................................................................... 25.11.1 Changing UiBRG Register (i = 0 to 4) ............................................................................................. 25.11.2 Clock Synchronous Mode ................................................................................................................ 25.11.3 UART Mode ..................................................................................................................................... 25.11.4 Special Mode 1 (I2C Mode) ............................................................................................................. 25.12 A/D Converter ....................................................................................................................................... 25.13 Programmable I/O Ports ........................................................................................................................ 25.14 Flash Memory ....................................................................................................................................... 25.14.1 Operating Speed ............................................................................................................................... 25.14.2 Prohibited Instructions ...................................................................................................................... 25.14.3 Interrupts (EW0 Mode) .................................................................................................................... 25.14.4 Interrupts (EW1 Mode) .................................................................................................................... 25.14.5 How to Access .................................................................................................................................. 25.14.6 Rewriting User ROM Area (EW0 Mode) ......................................................................................... 25.14.7 Rewriting User ROM Area (EW1 Mode) ......................................................................................... 25.14.8 Boot Mode ........................................................................................................................................ 25.14.9 Writing Command and Data ............................................................................................................. 25.14.10 Block Erase ...................................................................................................................................... 25.14.11 Wait Mode ....................................................................................................................................... 25.14.12 Stop Mode ........................................................................................................................................ 25.14.13 Low-Power Consumption Mode and On-Chip Oscillator Low-Power Consumption Mode ........... 376 377 377 377 377 377 378 380 381 381 381 381 381 381 381 381 382 382 382 382 382 382 Appendix 1. Package Dimensions ........................................................................................................ 383 Index ..................................................................................................................................................... 384 A-6 Special Function Register (SFR) Page Reference Address 0000h 0001h 0002h 0003h 0004h 0005h 0006h 0007h 0008h 0009h 000Ah 000Bh 000Ch 000Dh 000Eh 000Fh 0010h 0011h 0012h 0013h 0014h 0015h 0016h 0017h 0018h 0019h 001Ah 001Bh 001Ch 001Dh 001Eh 001Fh 0020h 0021h 0022h 0023h 0024h 0025h 0026h 0027h 0028h 0029h 002Ah 002Bh 002Ch 002Dh 002Eh 002Fh 0030h 0031h 0032h 0033h 0034h 0035h 0036h 0037h 0038h 0039h 003Ah 003Bh 003Ch 003Dh 003Eh 003Fh Register Symbol Page Processor Mode Register 0 Processor Mode Register 1 System Clock Control Register 0 System Clock Control Register 1 PM0 PM1 CM0 CM1 41 42 67, 118 68 Address Match Interrupt Enable Register Protect Register External Data Bus Width Control Register Main Clock Division Register Oscillation Stop Detection Register Watchdog Timer Start Register Watchdog Timer Control Register AIER PRCR DS MCD CM2 WDTS WDC 115 94 44 69 70 119 119 Address Match Interrupt Register 0 RMAD0 115 Processor Mode Register 2 PM2 72 Address Match Interrupt Register 1 RMAD1 115 Reference Voltage Configuration Register DVCR 38 Address Match Interrupt Register 2 RMAD2 115 Voltage Monitor Register LVDC 37 Address Match Interrupt Register 3 RMAD3 115 Voltage Regulator Control Register VRCR 74 PLL Control Register 0 PLC0 71 Address Match Interrupt Register 4 RMAD4 115 Address Match Interrupt Register 5 RMAD5 115 Address 0040h 0041h 0042h 0043h 0044h 0045h 0046h 0047h 0048h 0049h 004Ah 004Bh 004Ch 004Dh 004Eh 004Fh 0050h 0051h 0052h 0053h 0054h 0055h 0056h 0057h 0058h 0059h 005Ah 005Bh 005Ch 005Dh 005Eh 005Fh 0060h 0061h 0062h 0063h 0064h 0065h 0066h 0067h 0068h 0069h 006Ah 006Bh 006Ch 006Dh 006Eh 006Fh 0070h 0071h 0072h 0073h Address Match Interrupt Register 6 Address Match Interrupt Register 7 Blank spaces are reserved. No access is allowed. RMAD6 RMAD7 115 115 0074h 0075h 0076h 0077h 0078h 0079h 007Ah 007Bh 007Ch 007Dh 007Eh 007Fh Register Page External Space Wait Control Register 0 External Space Wait Control Register 1 External Space Wait Control Register 2 External Space Wait Control Register 3 Page Mode Wait Control Register 0 Page Mode Wait Control Register 1 EWCR0 EWCR1 EWCR2 EWCR3 PWCR0 PWCR1 50 50 50 50 62 63 Flash Memory Cotrol Register 3 FMR3 302 Flash Memory Cotrol Register 2 FMR2 302 Flash Memory Cotrol Register 1 FMR1 303 Flash Memory Cotrol Register 0 FMR0 303 Flash Memory Cotrol Register 4 FMR4 74 DMA0 Control Register Timer B5 Interrupt Control Register DMA2 Control Register UART2 Receive/ACK Interrupt Control Register Timer A0 Interrupt Control Register UART3 Receive/ACK Interrupt Control Register Timer A2 Interrupt Control Register UART4 Receive/ACK Interrupt Control Register Timer A4 Interrupt Control Register UART0/UART3 Bus Conflict Detection Interrupt Control Register UART0 Receive/ACK Interrupt Control Register A/D0 Conversion Interrput Control Register UART1 Receive/ACK Interrupt Control Register DM0IC TB5IC DM2IC Timer B1 Interrupt Control Register TB1IC 103 Timer B3 Interrupt Control Register TB3IC 103 INT5 Interrupt Control Register INT5IC 104 INT3 Interrupt Control Register INT3IC 104 INT1 Interrupt Control Register INT1IC 104 Blank spaces are reserved. No access is allowed. B-1 Symbol S2RIC TA0IC S3RIC TA2IC S4RIC 103 TA4IC BCN0IC/ BCN3IC S0RIC AD0IC S1RIC Special Function Register (SFR) Page Reference Address 0080h 0081h 0082h 0083h 0084h 0085h 0086h 0087h 0088h 0089h 008Ah 008Bh 008Ch 008Dh 008Eh 008Fh 0090h 0091h 0092h 0093h 0094h 0095h 0096h 0097h 0098h 0099h 009Ah 009Bh 009Ch 009Dh 009Eh 009Fh 00A0h 00A1h 00A2h 00A3h 00A4h 00A5h 00A6h 00A7h 00A8h 00A9h 00AAh 00ABh 00ACh 00ADh 00AEh 00AFh 00B0h 00B1h 00B2h 00B3h 00B4h 00B5h 00B6h 00B7h 00B8h 00B9h 00BAh 00BBh 00BCh 00BDh 00BEh 00BFh to 02BFh Register Symbol Page DMA1 Interrupt Control Register UART2 Transmit/NACK Interrupt Control Register DMA3 Interrupt Control Register UART3 Transmit/NACK Interrupt Control Register Timer A1 Interrupt Control Register UART4 Transmit/NACK Interrupt Control Register Timer A3 Interrupt Control Register UART2 Bus Conflict Detection Interrupt Control Register UART0 Transmit/NACK Interrupt Control Register UART1/UART4 Bus Conflict Detection Interrupt Control Register UART1 Transmit Complete Interrupt Control Register Key Input Interrupt Control Register Timer B0 Interrupt Control Register KUPIC TB0IC Timer B2 Interrupt Control Register TB2IC 103 Timer B4 Interrupt Control Register TB4IC 103 INT4 Interrupt Control Register INT4IC 104 INT2 Interrupt Control Register INT2IC 104 INT0 Interrupt Control Register Exit Priority Register INT0IC Blank spaces are reserved. No access is allowed. DM1IC S2TIC DM3IC S3TIC TA1IC S4TIC TA3IC 103 BCN2IC S0TIC BCN1IC/ BCN4IC S1TIC RLVL 104 105, 134 Address 02C0h 02C1h 02C2h 02C3h 02C4h 02C5h 02C6h 02C7h 02C8h 02C9h 02CAh 02CBh 02CCh 02CDh 02CEh 02CFh 02D0h 02D1h 02D2h 02D3h 02D4h 02D5h 02D6h 02D7h 02D8h 02D9h 02DAh 02DBh 02DCh 02DDh 02DEh 02DFh 02E0h 02E1h 02E2h 02E3h 02E4h 02E5h 02E6h 02E7h 02E8h 02E9h 02EAh 02EBh 02ECh 02EDh 02EEh 02EFh 02F0h 02F1h 02F2h 02F3h 02F4h 02F5h 02F6h 02F7h 02F8h 02F9h 02FAh 02FBh 02FCh 02FDh 02FEh 02FFh 0300h 0301h 0302h 0303h 0304h 0305h 0306h 0307h 0308h 0309h 030Ah 030Bh 030Ch 030Dh Register X0R, Y0R X1 Register, Y1 Register X1R, Y1R X2 Register, Y2 Register X2R, Y2R X3 Register, Y3 Register X3R, Y3R X4 Register, Y4 Register X4R, Y4R X5 Register, Y5 Register X5R, Y5R X6 Register, Y6 Register X6R, Y6R X7 Register, Y7 Register X7R, Y7R X8 Register, Y8 Register X8R, Y8R X9 Register, Y9 Register X9R, Y9R Page 276 X/Y Control Register X10R, Y10R X11R, Y11R X12R, Y12R X13R, Y13R X14R, Y14R X15R, Y15R XYC 276 UART1 Special Mode Register 4 UART1 Special Mode Register 3 UART1 Special Mode Register 2 UART1 Special Mode Register UART1 Transmit/Receive Mode Register UART1 Baud Rate Register U1SMR4 U1SMR3 U1SMR2 U1SMR U1MR U1BRG 202 201 200 199 198 204 X10 Register, Y10 Register X11 Register, Y11 Register X12 Register, Y12 Register X13 Register, Y13 Register X14 Register, Y14 Register X15 Register, Y15 Register UART1 Transmit Buffer Register U1TB 206 UART1 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 UART1 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 U1C0 U1C1 203 204 UART1 Receive Buffer Register U1RB 206 UART4 Special Mode Register 4 UART4 Special Mode Register 3 UART4 Special Mode Register 2 UART4 Special Mode Register UART4 Transmit/Receive Mode Register UART4 Baud Rate Register U4SMR4 U4SMR3 U4SMR2 U4SMR U4MR U4BRG 202 201 200 199 198 204 UART4 Transmit Buffer Register U4TB 206 UART4 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 UART4 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 U4C0 U4C1 203 204 UART4 Receive Buffer Register U4RB 206 Timer B3, B4, B5 Count Start Flag TBSR 171 Timer A11 Register TA11 Timer A21 Register TA21 Timer A41 Register TA41 Three-Phase PWM Control Register 0 Three-Phase PWM Control Register 1 Three-Phase Output Buffer Register 0 Three-Phase Output Buffer Register 1 Dead Time Timer Timer B2 Interrupt Generation Frequency Set Counter INVC0 INVC1 IDB0 IDB1 DTT 180 181 187 187 186 ICTB2 185 030Eh 030Fh Blank spaces are reserved. No access is allowed. B-2 Symbol X0 Register, Y0 Register 187 Special Function Register (SFR) Page Reference Address 0310h 0311h 0312h 0313h 0314h 0315h 0316h 0317h 0318h 0319h 031Ah 031Bh 031Ch 031Dh 031Eh 031Fh 0320h 0321h 0322h 0323h 0324h 0325h 0326h 0327h 0328h 0329h 032Ah 032Bh 032Ch 032Dh 032Eh 032Fh 0330h 0331h 0332h 0333h 0334h 0335h 0336h 0337h 0338h 0339h 033Ah 033Bh 033Ch 033Dh 033Eh 033Fh 0340h 0341h 0342h 0343h 0344h 0345h 0346h 0347h 0348h 0349h 034Ah 034Bh 044Ch 034Dh 034Eh 034Fh 0350h 0351h 0352h 0353h 0354h 0355h 0356h 0357h 0358h 0359h 035Ah 035Bh 035Ch 035Dh 035Eh 035Fh Register Symbol Page Timer B3 Register TB3 Timer B4 Register TB4 Timer B5 Register TB5 Timer B3 Mode Register Timer B4 Mode Register Timer B5 Mode Register TB3MR TB4MR TB5MR 167, 168, 169 External Interrupt Source Select Register IFSR 113, 205 UART3 Special Mode Register 4 UART3 Special Mode Register 3 UART3 Special Mode Register 2 UART3 Special Mode Register UART3 Transmit/Receive Mode Register UART3 Baud Rate Register U3SMR4 U3SMR3 U3SMR2 U3SMR U3MR U3BRG 202 201 200 199 198 204 UART3 Transmit Buffer Register U3TB 206 UART3 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 UART3 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 U3C0 U3C1 203 204 UART3 Receive Buffer Register U3RB 170 206 UART2 Special Mode Register 4 UART2 Special Mode Register 3 UART2 Special Mode Register 2 UART2 Special Mode Register UART2 Transmit/Receive Mode Register UART2 Baud Rate Register U2SMR4 U2SMR3 U2SMR2 U2SMR U2MR U2BRG 202 201 200 199 198 204 UART2 Transmit Buffer Register U2TB 206 UART2 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 UART2 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 U2C0 U2C1 203 204 UART2 Receive Buffer Register U2RB 206 Count Start Register TABSR Clock Prescaler Reset Registe One-Shot Start Register Trigger Select Register Up/Down Flag CPSRF ONSF TRGSR UDF 152, 171, 188 73 153 151, 184 150 Timer A0 Register TA0 149 Timer A1 Register TA1 149, 187 Timer A2 Register TA2 149, 187 Timer A3 Register TA3 149 Timer A4 Register TA4 149, 187 Timer B0 Register TB0 170 Timer B1 Register TB1 170 Timer B2 Register TB2 170, 186 Timer A0 Mode Register Timer A1 Mode Register Timer A2 Mode Register Timer A3 Mode Register Timer A4 Mode Register Timer B0 Mode Register Timer B1 Mode Register Timer B2 Mode Register Timer B2 Special Mode Register Count Source Prescaler Register TA0MR TA1MR TA2MR TA3MR TA4MR TB0MR TB1MR TB2MR TB2SC TCSPR 145, 146, 147, 148 167, 168, 169 185 73, 144 Address 0360h 0361h 0362h 0363h 0364h 0365h 0366h 0367h 0368h 0369h 036Ah 036Bh 036Ch 036Dh 036Eh 036Fh 0370h 0371h 0372h 0373h 0374h 0375h 0376h 0377h 0378h 0379h 037Ah 037Bh 037Ch 037Dh 037Eh 037Fh 0380h 0381h 0382h 0383h 0384h 0385h 0386h 0387h 0388h 0389h 038Ah 038Bh 038Ch 038Dh 038Eh 038Fh 0390h 0391h 0392h 0393h 0394h 0395h 0396h 0397h 0398h 0399h 039Ah 039Bh 039Ch 039Dh 039Eh 039Fh 03A0h 03A1h 03A2h 03A3h 03A4h 03A5h 03A6h 03A7h 03A8h 03A9h 03AAh 03ABh 03ACh 03ADh 03AEh 03AFh Register UART0 Special Mode Register 4 UART0 Special Mode Register 3 UART0 Special Mode Register 2 UART0 Special Mode Register UART0 Transmit/Receive Mode Register UART0 Baud Rate Register B-3 U0SMR4 U0SMR3 U0SMR2 U0SMR U0MR U0BRG Page 202 201 200 199 198 204 UART0 Transmit Buffer Register U0TB 206 UART0 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 UART0 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 U0C0 U0C1 203 204 UART0 Receive Buffer Register U0RB 206 DMA0 Request Source Select Register DMA1 Request Source Select Register DMA2 Request Source Select Register DMA3 Request Source Select Register DM0SL DM1SL DM2SL DM3SL 122 CRC Data Register CRCD 274 CRC Input Register CRCIN 274 A/D0 Register 0 AD00 A/D0 Register 1 AD01 A/D0 Register 2 AD02 A/D0 Register 3 AD03 A/D0 Register 4 AD04 A/D0 Register 5 AD05 A/D0 Register 6 AD06 A/D0 Register 7 AD07 A/D0 Control Register 4 AD0CON4 257 A/D0 Control Register 2 A/D0 Control Register 3 A/D0 Control Register 0 A/D0 Control Register 1 D/A Register 0 AD0CON2 AD0CON3 AD0CON0 AD0CON1 DA0 255 256 253 254 272 D/A Register 1 DA1 272 D/A Control Register DACON 272 Function Select Register C PSC 290 257 Blank spaces are reserved. No access is allowed. Blank spaces are reserved. No access is allowed. Symbol Special Function Register (SFR) Page Reference Address 03B0h 03B1h 03B2h 03B3h 03B4h 03B5h 03B6h 03B7h 03B8h 03B9h 03BAh 03BBh 03BCh 03BDh 03BEh 03BFh 03C0h 03C1h 03C2h 03C3h 03C4h 03C5h 03C6h 03C7h 03C8h 03C9h 03CAh 03CBh 03CCh 03CDh 03CEh 03CFh 03D0h 03D1h 03D2h 03D3h 03D4h 03D5h 03D6h 03D7h 03D8h 03D9h 03DAh 03DBh 03DCh 03DDh 03DEh 03DFh 03E0h 03E1h 03E2h 03E3h 03E4h 03E5h 03E6h 03E7h 03E8h 03E9h 03EAh 03EBh 03ECh 03EDh 03EEh 03EFh 03F0h 03F1h 03F2h 03F3h 03F4h 03F5h 03F6h 03F7h 03F8h 03F9h 03FAh 03FBh 03FCh 03FDh 03FEh 03FFh Register Function Select Register A0 Function Select Register A1 Function Select Register B0 Function Select Register B1 Function Select Register A2 Function Select Register A3 Function Select Register B2 Function Select Register B3 Symbol PS0 PS1 PSL0 PSL1 PS2 PS3 PSL2 PSL3 Page 286 286 288 288 287 287 289 289 Port P6 Register Port P7 Register Port P6 Direction Register Port P7 Direction Register Port P8 Register Port P9 Register Port P8 Direction Register Port P9 Direction Register Port P10 Register Port P11 Register Port P10 Direction Register Port P11 Direction Register Port P12 Register Port P13 Register Port P12 Direction Register Port P13 Direction Register Port P14 Register Port P15 Register Port P14 Direction Register Port P15 Direction Register P6 P7 PD6 PD7 P8 P9 PD8 PD9 P10 P11 PD10 PD11 P12 P13 PD12 PD13 P14 P15 PD14 PD15 285 285 284 284 285 285 284 284 285 285 284 284 285 285 284 284 285 285 284 284 Pull-Up Control Register 2 Pull-Up Control Register 3 Pull-Up Control Register 4 PUR2 PUR3 PUR4 292 293 294 Port P0 Register Port P1 Register Port P0 Direction Register Port P1 Direction Register Port P2 Register Port P3 Register Port P2 Direction Register Port P3 Direction Register Port P4 Register Port P5 Register Port P4 Direction Register Port P5 Direction Register P0 P1 PD0 PD1 P2 P3 PD2 PD3 P4 P5 PD4 PD5 285 285 284 284 285 285 284 284 285 285 284 284 Pull-Up Control Register 0 Pull-Up Control Register 1 PUR0 PUR1 291 291 Port Control Register PCR 295 Blank spaces are reserved. No access is allowed. B-4 PRELIMINARY Notice: This is not a final specification. Some parametric limits are subject to change. M32C/8B Group RENESAS MCU 1. Overview 1.1 Features The M32C/8B Group is a single-chip control MCU, fabricated using high-performance silicon gate CMOS technology, embedding the M32C/80 Series CPU core. The M32C/8B Group is housed in 144-pin and 100-pin plastic molded LQFP packages. With a 16-Mbyte address space, this MCU combines advanced instruction manipulation capabilities to process complex instructions by less bytes and execute instructions at higher speed. The M32C/8B Group has a multiplier and DMAC adequate for office automation, communication devices and industrial equipment, and other high-speed processing applications. 1.1.1 Applications • Audio-Visual equipment (e.g. televisions, audio components) • Home Appliances (e.g. air conditioners, washing machines, sewing machines) • Industrial equipment (e.g. programmable logic controllers) • Computers and peripherals, cameras, etc. 1.1.2 Specifications Tables 1.1 to 1.4 list the specifications of the M32C/8B Group. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 1 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 1.1 Item CPU 1. Overview Specifications (144-Pin Package) (1/2) Function Central processing unit Specification M32C/80 core (multiplier: 16 bits × 16 bits → 32 bits, multiply-addition operation instructions: 16 × 16 + 48 → 48 bits) • Basic instructions: 108 • Minimum instruction execution time: 31.3 ns (f(CPU) = 32 MHz / VCC1 = 3.0 to 5.5 V) • Operating modes: Single-chip mode, memory expansion mode, and microprocessor mode Memory ROM / RAM Flash memory version: 256KB + 8KB/32 KB, 128KB + 8KB/32 KB ROMless version : − / 32KB Power Supply Voltage Detection Voltage monitor interrupt (optional)(1) External Bus / memory expansion • Address space: 16 Mbyte Bus function • External bus interface: 1 to 7 wait states can be inserted, Expansion 4 chip select outputs, 3 V and 5 V interfaces • Bus format: Switchable between separate bus and multiplexed bus formats, switchable data bus width (8-bit or 16-bit) Clock Clock generation circuits • 4 circuits: Main clock, sub clock, on-chip oscillator, PLL frequency synthesizer • Oscillation stop detection: Main clock oscillation stop detect function • Frequency divider circuit: Dividing ratio selectable among 1, 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16 • Low power consumption features: Wait mode, stop mode Interrupts • Interrupt vectors: 70 • External interrupt inputs: 11 (NMI, INT × 6, Key input × 4) Single-chip mode Memory expansion and microprocessor mode with 8-bit external bus 8 (NMI, INT × 3, Key input × 4) Memory expansion and microprocessor mode with 16-bit external bus • Interrupt priority levels: 7 Watchdog Timer 15-bit × 1 (with prescaler) DMA DMAC • 4 channels, cycle steal method • Trigger sources: 31 • Transfer modes: 2 (single transfer and repeat transfer) DMACII • Can be activated by all peripheral function interrupt sources • Transfer modes: 2 (single transfer and burst transfer) • Immediate transfer, calculation transfer, and chain transfer functions Timer Timer A 16-bit timer × 5 Timer mode, event counter mode, one-shot timer mode, pulse width modulation (PWM) mode Event counter 2-phase pulse signal processing (2-phase encoder input) × 3 Timer B 16-bit timer × 6 Timer mode, event counter mode, pulse period measurement mode, pulse width measurement mode Timer function for 3-phase inverter control × 1 (using timer A1, timer A2, timer A4, 3-phase motor control and timer B2) On-chip dead time timer NOTE: 1. Please contact a Renesas sales office to use optional features. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 2 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 1.2 Item Serial Interface 1. Overview Specifications (144-Pin Package) (2/2) Function UART0 to UART4 A/D Converter D/A Converter CRC Calculation Circuit Specification Clock synchronous / asynchronous × 5 I2C bus, special mode 2, GCI mode, SIM mode IEBus (optional)(1)(2) 10-bit resolution x 34 channels (in single-chip mode) 10-bit resolution x 18 channels (in memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode) including sample and hold function 8-bit resolution × 2 channels CRC-CCITT (X16 + X12 + X5 + 1) compliant X/Y Converter 16 bits x 16 bits I/O Ports Programmable I/O ports • Input only: 1 • CMOS I/O: 121 (in single-chip mode) 81 (in memory expansion and microprocessor mode with 8-bit external bus) 73 (in memory expansion and microprocessor mode with 16-bit external bus) with selectable pull-up resistor • N channel open drain ports: 2 Flash Memory • Erase and program voltage: VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.0 to 5.5 V • Erase and program endurance: 100 times (all areas) • Program security: ROM code protect and ID code check • Debug functions: On-chip debug and on-board flash reprogram Operating Frequency / 32 MHz / VCC1 = 3.0 to 5.5 V, VCC2 = 3.0 to VCC1 Supply Voltage Current Consumption 26 mA (32 MHz / VCC1 = VCC2 = 5 V) 23 mA (32 MHz / VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V) 110 μA (approx. 1 MHz / VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V, on-chip oscillator low-power consumption mode → wait mode) 8 μA (approx. 32 kHz / VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V, low-power consumption mode → wait mode) 4 μA (VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V, stop mode) Operating Ambient Temperature (°C) -20 to 85°C, -40 to 85°C (optional)(2) Package 144-pin LQFP (PLQP0144KA-A) NOTES: 1. IEBus is a registered trademark of NEC Electronics Corporation. 2. Please contact a Renesas sales office to use optional features. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 3 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 1.3 Item CPU 1. Overview Specifications (100-Pin Package) (1/2) Function Central processing unit Specification M32C/80 core (multiplier: 16 bits × 16 bits → 32 bits, multiply-addition operation instructions: 16 × 16 + 48 → 48 bits) • Basic instructions: 108 • Minimum instruction execution time: 31.3 ns (f(CPU) = 32 MHz / VCC1 = 3.0 to 5.5 V) • Operating modes: Single-chip mode, memory expansion mode, and microprocessor mode Memory ROM / RAM Flash memory version: 256KB + 8KB/32 KB, 128KB + 8KB/32 KB ROMless version : − / 32KB Power Supply Voltage Detection Voltage monitor interrupt (optional)(1) External Bus / memory expansion • Address space: 16 Mbyte Bus function • External bus interface: 1 to 7 wait states can be inserted, Expansion 4 chip select outputs, 3 V and 5 V interfaces • Bus format: Switchable between separate bus and multiplexed bus formats, switchable data bus width (8-bit or 16-bit) Clock Clock generation circuits • 4 circuits: Main clock, sub clock, on-chip oscillator, PLL frequency synthesizer • Oscillation stop detection: Main clock oscillation stop detect function • Frequency divider circuit: Dividing ratio selectable among 1, 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16 • Low power consumption features: Wait mode, stop mode Interrupts • Interrupt vectors: 70 • External interrupt inputs: 11 (NMI, INT × 6, Key input × 4) Single-chip mode Memory expansion and microprocessor mode with 8-bit external bus 8 (NMI, INT × 3, Key input × 4) Memory expansion and microprocessor mode with 16-bit external bus • Interrupt priority levels: 7 Watchdog Timer 15-bit × 1 (with prescaler) DMA DMAC • 4 channels, cycle steal method • Trigger sources: 31 • Transfer modes: 2 (single transfer and repeat transfer) DMACII • Can be activated by all peripheral function interrupt sources • Transfer modes: 2 (single transfer and burst transfer) • Immediate transfer, calculation transfer, and chain transfer functions Timer Timer A 16-bit timer × 5 Timer mode, event counter mode, one-shot timer mode, pulse width modulation (PWM) mode Event counter 2-phase pulse signal processing (2-phase encoder input) × 3 Timer B 16-bit timer × 6 Timer mode, event counter mode, pulse period measurement mode, pulse width measurement mode Timer function for 3-phase inverter control × 1 (using timer A1, timer A2, timer A4, 3-phase motor control and timer B2) On-chip dead time timer NOTE: 1. Please contact a Renesas sales office to use optional features. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 4 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 1.4 Item Serial Interface 1. Overview Specifications (100-Pin Package) (2/2) Function UART0 to UART4 A/D Converter D/A Converter CRC Calculation Circuit Specification Clock synchronous / asynchronous × 5 I2C bus, special mode 2, GCI mode, SIM mode IEBus (optional)(1)(2) 10-bit resolution x 26 channels (in single-chip mode) 10-bit resolution x 10 channels (in memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode) including sample and hold function 8-bit resolution × 2 channels CRC-CCITT (X16 + X12 + X5 + 1) compliant X/Y Converter 16 bits x 16 bits I/O Ports Programmable I/O ports • Input only: 1 • CMOS I/O: 85 (in single-chip mode) 45 (in memory expansion and microprocessor mode with 8-bit external bus) 37 (in memory expansion and microprocessor mode with 16-bit external bus) with selectable pull-up resistor • N channel open drain ports: 2 Flash Memory Version • Erase and program voltage: VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.0 to 5.5 V • Erase and program endurance: 100 times (all areas) • Program security: ROM code protect and ID code check • Debug functions: On-chip debug and on-board flash reprogram Operating Frequency / 32 MHz: VCC1 = 3.0 to 5.5 V, VCC2 = 3.0 to VCC1 Supply Voltage Current Consumption 26 mA (32 MHz / VCC1 = VCC2 = 5 V) 23 mA (32 MHz / VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V) 110 μA (approx. 1 MHz / VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V, on-chip oscillator low-power consumption mode → wait mode) 8 μA (approx. 32 kHz / VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V, low-power consumption mode → wait mode) 4 μA (VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V, stop mode) Operating Ambient Temperature (°C) -20 to 85°C, -40 to 85°C (optional)(2) Package 100-pin LQFP (PLQP0100KB-A) NOTES: 1. IEBus is a registered trademark of NEC Electronics Corporation. 2. Please contact a Renesas sales office to use optional features. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 5 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 1.2 1. Overview Product List Table 1.5 lists product information. Figure 1.1 shows product numbering system. Table 1.5 Product List (M32C/8B) Part No. M308B8FGGP M308B6FGGP M308B8FCGP M308B6FCGP M308B8SGP M308B6SGP Package code (D) (D) (P) (P) (D) (D) PLQP0144KA-A (144P6Q-A) PLQP0100KB-A (100P6Q-A) PLQP0144KA-A (144P6Q-A) PLQP0100KB-A (100P6Q-A) PLQP0144KA-A (144P6Q-A) PLQP0100KB-A (100P6Q-A) Current as of Oct. 2008 ROM Capacity 256 KB + 8KB(1) 128 KB + 8KB(1) RAM Capacity Remarks Flash memory 32 KB − ROMless (D): Under development, (P): Under planning NOTE: 1. Additional 8-Kbyte space is available for data flash memory. Part No. M30 8B x F G GP Package type option GP: PLQP0144KA-A (144P6Q-A) GP: PLQP0100KB-A (100P6Q-A) ROM capacity C: 128 Kbytes G: 256 Kbytes Memory Type F: Flash memory version S: ROMless version RAM capacity, pin count, etc. (The value itself has no specific meaning.) M32C/8B Group M16C Family Figure 1.1 Product Numbering System REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 6 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 1.3 1. Overview Block Diagram Figure 1.2 shows a block diagram of M32C/8B Group. 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 Port P0 Port P1 Port P2 Port P3 Port P4 Port P5 Port P6 Port P7 <VCC2> <VCC1> Internal peripheral functions 10-bit A/D converter: 1 circuit, 34 input (2) Timers (16-bit) Output (timer A): 5 Input (timer B): 6 Clock generation circuits: XIN-XOUT XCIN-XCOUT On-chip oscillator PLL frequency synthesizer 8-bit D/A converters: 2 circuits Three-phase motor control circuit DMAC: 4 channels DMACII Watchdog timer (15 bits) M32C/80 Series CPU core Serial Interface: 5 channels R0H R0L R1H R1L FLG ISP R3 USP A0 SVF FB SVP SB VCT <VCC2> (1) Port P13 8 (1) Port P12 8 ROM PC A1 X/Y converter: 16 bits × 16 bits RAM INTB R2 CRC calculation circuit X16 + X12 + X5 + 1 (CCITT) Memory Multiplier <VCC1> (1) Port P11 5 (1) Port P15 8 (1) Port P14 7 Port P10 8 Port P9 8 P8_5 Port P8 7 NOTES: 1. Ports P11 to P15 are provided in the 144-pin package only. 2. 34 channels are available in the 144-pin package. 26 channels are available in the 100-pin package. Figure 1.2 M32C/8B Group Block Diagram REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 7 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 1.4 1. Overview Pin Assignments Figures 1.3 and 1.4 show pin assignments (top view). 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 82 72 71 70 69 68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 <VCC2> M32C/8B Group PLQP0144KA-A (144P6Q-A) (top view) 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 <VCC1> P4_4 / CS3 / A20 P4_5 / CS2 / A21 P4_6 / CS1 / A22 P4_7 / CS0 / A23 P12_5 P12_6 P12_7 P5_0 / WRL / WR P5_1 / WRH / BHE P5_2 / RD P5_3 / CLKOUT / BCLK / ALE P13_0 P13_1 VCC2 P13_2 VSS P13_3 P5_4 / HLDA / ALE P5_5 / HOLD P5_6 / ALE P5_7 / RDY P13_4 P13_5 P13_6 P13_7 P6_0 / CTS0 / RTS0 / SS0 P6_1 / CLK0 P6_2 / RXD0 / SCL0 / STXD0 P6_3 / TXD0 / SDA0 / SRXD0 P6_4 / CTS1 / RTS1 / SS1 P6_5 / CLK1 VSS P6_6 / RXD1 / SCL1 / STXD1 VCC1 P6_7 / TXD1 / SDA1 / SRXD1 P7_0 / TA0OUT / TXD2 / SDA2 / SRXD2 (1) ANEX1 / TXD4 / SDA4 / SRXD4 ANEX0 / CLK4 DA1 / SS4 / RTS4 / CTS4 / TB4IN DA0 / SS3 / RTS3 / CTS3 / TB3IN SRXD3 / SDA3 / TXD3 / TB2IN STXD3 / SCL3 / RXD3 / TB1IN CLK3 / TB0IN / P9_6 / P9_5 / P9_4 / P9_3 / P9_2 / P9_1 / P9_0 P14_6 P14_5 P14_4 P14_3 P14_2 P14_1 P14_0 BYTE CNVSS XCIN / P8_7 XCOUT / P8_6 RESET XOUT VSS XIN VCC1 NMI / P8_5 INT2 / P8_4 INT1 / P8_3 INT0 / P8_2 U / TA4IN / P8_1 U / TA4OUT / P8_0 TA3IN / P7_7 TA3OUT / P7_6 W / TA2IN / P7_5 W / TA2OUT / P7_4 SS2 / RTS2 / CTS2 / V / TA1IN / P7_3 CLK2 / V / TA1OUT / P7_2 (1) STXD2 / SCL2 / RXD2 / TB5IN / TA0IN / P7_1 ( note 2 ) 97 98 99 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 109 110 111 112 113 114 115 116 117 118 119 120 121 122 123 124 125 126 127 128 129 130 131 132 133 134 135 136 137 138 139 140 141 142 143 144 1 D8 / P1_0 AN0_7 / P0_7 AN0_6 / P0_6 AN0_5 / P0_5 AN0_4 / P0_4 P11_4 P11_3 P11_2 P11_1 P11_0 D3 / AN0_3 / P0_3 D2 / AN0_2 / P0_2 D1 / AN0_1 / P0_1 D0 / AN0_0 / P0_0 AN15_7 / P15_7 AN15_6 / P15_6 AN15_5 / P15_5 AN15_4 / P15_4 AN15_3 / P15_3 AN15_2 / P15_2 AN15_1 / P15_1 VSS AN15_0 / P15_0 VCC1 AN_7 / KI3 / P10_7 AN_6 / KI2 / P10_6 AN_5 / KI1 / P10_5 AN_4 / KI0 / P10_4 AN_3 / P10_3 AN_2 / P10_2 AN_1 / P10_1 AVSS AN_0 / P10_0 VREF AVCC ADTRG / STXD4 / SCL4 / RXD4 / P9_7 D7 / D6 / D5 / D4 / 107 108 P1_1 / D9 P1_2 / D10 P1_3 / D11 P1_4 / D12 P1_5 / INT3 / D13 P1_6 / INT4 / D14 P1_7 / INT5 / D15 P2_0 / AN2_0 / A0 , [ A0 P2_1 / AN2_1 / A1 , [ A1 P2_2 / AN2_2 / A2 , [ A2 P2_3 / AN2_3 / A3 , [ A3 P2_4 / AN2_4 / A4 , [ A4 P2_5 / AN2_5 / A5 , [ A5 P2_6 / AN2_6 / A6 , [ A6 P2_7 / AN2_7 / A7 , [ A7 VSS P3_0 / A8 , [ A8 / D8 ] VCC2 P12_0 P12_1 P12_2 P12_3 P12_4 P3_1 / A9 , [ A9 / D9 ] P3_2 / A10 , [ A10 / D10 ] P3_3 / A11 , [ A11 / D11 ] P3_4 / A12 , [ A12 / D12 ] P3_5 / A13 , [ A13 / D13 ] P3_6 / A14 , [ A14 / D14 ] P3_7 / A15 , [ A15 / D15 ] P4_0 / A16 P4_1 / A17 VSS P4_2 / A18 VCC2 P4_3 / A19 / / / / / / / / D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 ] ] ] ] ] ] ] ] ( note 3 ) NOTES: 1. P7_0 and P7_1 are N-channel open drain output ports . 2. Refer to Package Dimensions for the pin1 position on the package. 3. Pin names in brackets [ ] represent a single functional signal. They should not be considered as two separate functional signals. Figure 1.3 Pin Assignment for 144-pin Package REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 8 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 1.6 Pin No. 1. Overview 144-Pin Package List of Pin Names (1/3) Control Pin Port Interrupt Pin Timer Pin UART Pin 1 2 3 P9_6 P9_5 P9_4 TB4IN CTS4/RTS4/SS4 4 P9_3 TB3IN 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 P9_2 P9_1 P9_0 P14_6 P14_5 P14_4 P14_3 P14_2 P14_1 P14_0 TB2IN TB1IN TB0IN CTS3/RTS3/SS3 TXD3/SDA3/SRXD3 RXD3/SCL3/STXD3 CLK3 20 21 22 23 24 BYTE CNVSS XCIN XCOUT TXD4/SDA4/SRXD4 CLK4 P8_7 P8_6 RESET XOUT VSS XIN VCC1 P8_5 NMI 25 P8_4 INT2 26 P8_3 INT1 27 P8_2 INT0 28 P8_1 TA4IN/U 29 P8_0 TA4OUT/U 30 P7_7 TA3IN 31 P7_6 TA3OUT 32 P7_5 TA2IN/W 33 P7_4 TA2OUT/W 34 P7_3 TA1IN/V 35 P7_2 TA1OUT/V TA0IN/TB5IN RXD2/SCL2/STXD2 TA0OUT TXD2/SDA2/SRXD2 CTS2/RTS2/SS2 CLK2 36 P7_1 37 P7_0 38 39 40 41 42 43 P6_7 TXD1/SDA1/SRXD1 P6_6 RXD1/SCL1/STXD1 P6_5 P6_4 CTS1/RTS1/SS1 44 P6_3 TXD0/SDA0/SRXD0 45 P6_2 RXD0/SCL0/STXD0 46 P6_1 CLK0 47 P6_0 CTS0/RTS0/SS0 48 49 50 P13_7 P13_6 P13_5 VCC1 VSS REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 9 of 385 CLK1 Analog Pin ANEX1 ANEX0 DA1 DA0 Bus Control Pin Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 1.7 Pin No. 1. Overview 144-Pin Package List of Pin Names (2/3) Control Pin Port Interrupt Pin Timer Pin UART Pin Analog Pin Bus Control Pin 51 52 P13_4 P5_7 RDY 53 P5_6 ALE 54 P5_5 HOLD 55 P5_4 HLDA/ALE 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 P13_3 VSS P13_2 VCC2 CLKOUT P13_1 P13_0 P5_3 P5_2 BCLK/ALE RD 64 P5_1 WRH/BHE 65 P5_0 WRL/WR 66 67 68 69 P12_7 P12_6 P12_5 P4_7 CS0/A23 70 P4_6 CS1/A22 71 P4_5 CS2/A21 72 P4_4 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 P4_3 CS3/A20 A19 P4_2 A18 P4_1 P4_0 P3_7 P3_6 P3_5 P3_4 P3_3 P3_2 P3_1 P12_4 P12_3 P12_2 P12_1 P12_0 A17 A16 A15,[A15/D15] A14,[A14/D14] A13,[A13/D13] A12,[A12/D12] A11,[A11/D11] A10,[A10/D10] A9,[A9/D9] P3_0 A8,[A8/D8] VCC2 VSS VCC2 VSS P2_7 P2_6 P2_5 P2_4 P2_3 P2_2 P2_1 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 10 of 385 AN2_7 AN2_6 AN2_5 AN2_4 AN2_3 AN2_2 AN2_1 A7,[A7/D7] A6,[A6/D6] A5,[A5/D5] A4,[A4/D4] A3,[A3/D3] A2,[A2/D2] A1,[A1/D1] Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 1.8 Pin No. 1. Overview 144-Pin Package List of Pin Names (3/3) Control Pin Port Interrupt Pin Timer Pin UART Pin Analog Pin AN2_0 Bus Control Pin 101 102 P2_0 P1_7 INT5 A0,[A0/D0] D15 103 P1_6 INT4 D14 104 P1_5 INT3 D13 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 113 114 115 116 117 118 119 120 121 122 123 124 125 126 127 128 129 130 VSS 131 132 VCC1 133 P1_4 P1_3 P1_2 P1_1 P1_0 P0_7 P0_6 P0_5 P0_4 P11_4 P11_3 P11_2 P11_1 P11_0 P0_3 P0_2 P0_1 P0_0 P15_7 P15_6 P15_5 P15_4 P15_3 P15_2 P15_1 AN0_3 AN0_2 AN0_1 AN0_0 AN15_7 AN15_6 AN15_5 AN15_4 AN15_3 AN15_2 AN15_1 P15_0 AN15_0 P10_7 KI3 AN_7 134 P10_6 KI2 AN_6 135 P10_5 KI1 AN_5 136 P10_4 KI0 137 138 139 140 AVSS 141 142 VREF 143 AVCC 144 P10_3 P10_2 P10_1 AN_3 AN_2 AN_1 P10_0 AN_0 AN0_7 AN0_6 AN0_5 AN0_4 P9_7 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 11 of 385 AN_4 RXD4/SCL4/STXD4 ADTRG D12 D11 D10 D9 D8 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 1. Overview D10 / P1_2 D9 / P1_1 D8 / P1_0 D7 / AN0_7 / P0_7 D6 / AN0_6 / P0_6 D5 / AN0_5 / P0_5 D4 / AN0_4 / P0_4 D3 / AN0_3 / P0_3 D2 / AN0_2 / P0_2 D1 / AN0_1 / P0_1 D0 / AN0_0 / P0_0 AN_7 / KI3 / P10_7 AN_6 / KI2 / P10_6 AN_5 / KI1 / P10_5 AN_4 / KI0 / P10_4 AN_3 / P10_3 AN_2 / P10_2 AN_1 / P10_1 AVSS AN_0 / P10_0 VREF AVCC ADTRG / STXD4 / SCL4 / RXD4 / P9_7 ANEX1 / TXD4 / SDA4 / SRXD4 / P9_6 ANEX0 / CLK4 / P9_5 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 P1_3 / D11 P1_4 / D12 P1_5 / INT3 / D13 P1_6 / INT4 / D14 P1_7 / INT5 / D15 P2_0 / AN2_0 / A0 , [ A0 / D0 ] P2_1 / AN2_1 / A1 , [ A1 / D1 ] P2_2 / AN2_2 / A2 , [ A2 / D2 ] P2_3 / AN2_3 / A3 , [ A3 / D3 ] P2_4 / AN2_4 / A4 , [ A4 / D4 ] P2_5 / AN2_5 / A5 , [ A5 / D5 ] P2_6 / AN2_6 / A6 , [ A6 / D6 ] P2_7 / AN2_7 / A7 , [ A7 / D7 ] VSS P3_0 / A8 , [ A8 / D8 ] VCC2 P3_1 / A9 , [ A9 / D9 ] P3_2 / A10 , [ A10 / D10 ] P3_3 / A11 , [ A11 / D11 ] P3_4 / A12 , [ A12 / D12 ] P3_5 / A13 , [ A13 / D13 ] P3_6 / A14 , [ A14 / D14 ] P3_7 / A15 , [ A15 / D15 ] P4_0 / A16 P4_1 / A17 ( note 3 ) 76 50 <VCC2> 77 49 78 48 79 47 80 46 81 45 82 44 83 43 M32C/8B Group 84 85 42 41 86 40 87 39 88 38 PLQP0100KB-A (100P6Q-A) (top view) 89 90 91 92 37 36 35 34 93 33 94 32 95 31 96 30 97 29 98 28 <VCC1> 99 27 100 26 P4_2 / A18 P4_3 / A19 P4_4 / CS3 / A20 P4_5 / CS2 / A21 P4_6 / CS1 / A22 P4_7 / CS0 / A23 P5_0 / WRL / WR P5_1 / WRH / BHE P5_2 / RD P5_3 / CLKOUT / BCLK / ALE P5_4 / HLDA / ALE P5_5 / HOLD P5_6 / ALE P5_7 / RDY P6_0 / CTS0 / RTS0 / SS0 P6_1 / CLK0 P6_2 / RXD0 / SCL0 / STXD0 P6_3 / TXD0 / SDA0 / SRXD0 P6_4 / CTS1 / RTS1 / SS1 P6_5 / CLK1 P6_6 / RXD1 / SCL1 / STXD1 P6_7 / TXD1 / SDA1 / SRXD1 P7_0 / TA0OUT / TXD2 / SDA2 / SRXD2 (1) P7_1 / TA0IN / TB5IN / RXD2 / SCL2 / STXD2 (1) P7_2 / TA1OUT / V / CLK2 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 NMI INT2 INT1 INT0 U / TA4IN U / TA4OUT TA3IN TA3OUT W / TA2IN W / TA2OUT SS2 / RTS2 / CTS2 / V / TA1IN 11 12 VSS XIN VCC1 / P8_5 / P8_4 / P8_3 / P8_2 / P8_1 / P8_0 / P7_7 / P7_6 / P7_5 / P7_4 / P7_3 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 DA1 / SS4 / RTS4 / CTS4 DA0 / SS3 / RTS3 / CTS3 SRXD3 / SDA3 / TXD3 STXD3 / SCL3 / RXD3 CLK3 / / / / / TB4IN TB3IN TB2IN TB1IN TB0IN / / / / / P9_4 P9_3 P9_2 P9_1 P9_0 BYTE CNVSS XCIN / P8_7 XCOUT / P8_6 RESET XOUT 1 ( note 2 ) NOTES: 1. P7_0 and P7_1 are N-channel open drain output ports. 2. Refer to Package Dimensions for the pin1 position on the package. 3. Pin names in brackets [ ] represent a single functional signal. They should not be considered as two separate functional signals. Figure 1.4 Pin Assignment for 100-pin Package REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 12 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 1.9 Pin No. 1. Overview 100-Pin Package List of Pin Names (1/2) Control Pin Port Interrupt Pin Timer Pin UART Pin Analog Pin 1 P9_4 TB4IN CTS4/RTS4/SS4 DA1 2 P9_3 TB3IN DA0 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 P9_2 P9_1 P9_0 TB2IN TB1IN TB0IN CTS3/RTS3/SS3 TXD3/SDA3/SRXD3 RXD3/SCL3/STXD3 CLK3 11 12 13 14 BYTE CNVSS XCIN XCOUT Bus Control Pin P8_7 P8_6 RESET XOUT VSS XIN VCC1 15 P8_5 NMI 16 P8_4 INT2 17 P8_3 INT1 18 P8_2 INT0 19 P8_1 TA4IN/U 20 P8_0 TA4OUT/U 21 P7_7 TA3IN 22 P7_6 TA3OUT 23 P7_5 TA2IN/W 24 P7_4 TA2OUT/W 25 P7_3 TA1IN/V CTS2/RTS2/SS2 26 P7_2 TA1OUT/V CLK2 27 P7_1 TA0IN/TB5IN RXD2/SCL2/STXD2 28 P7_0 TA0OUT TXD2/SDA2/SRXD2 29 P6_7 TXD1/SDA1/SRXD1 30 P6_6 RXD1/SCL1/STXD1 31 P6_5 CLK1 32 P6_4 CTS1/RTS1/SS1 33 P6_3 TXD0/SDA0/SRXD0 34 P6_2 RXD0/SCL0/STXD0 35 P6_1 CLK0 36 P6_0 CTS0/RTS0/SS0 37 P5_7 RDY 38 P5_6 ALE 39 P5_5 HOLD 40 P5_4 HLDA/ALE P5_3 BCLK/ALE 42 P5_2 RD 43 P5_1 WRH/BHE 44 P5_0 WRL/WR 45 P4_7 CS0/A23 46 P4_6 CS1/A22 47 P4_5 CS2/A21 48 P4_4 CS3/A20 49 P4_3 A19 50 P4_2 A18 41 CLKOUT REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 13 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 1.10 Pin No. 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 1. Overview 100-Pin Package List of Pin Names (2/2) Control Pin Port Interrupt Pin Timer Pin UART Pin Analog Pin Bus Control Pin P4_1 P4_0 P3_7 P3_6 P3_5 P3_4 P3_3 P3_2 P3_1 A17 A16 A15,[A15/D15] A14,[A14/D14] A13,[A13/D13] A12,[A12/D12] A11,[A11/D11] A10,[A10/D10] A9,[A9/D9] P3_0 A8,[A8/D8] VCC2 VSS P2_7 P2_6 P2_5 P2_4 P2_3 P2_2 P2_1 P2_0 P1_7 INT5 A7,[A7/D7] A6,[A6/D6] A5,[A5/D5] A4,[A4/D4] A3,[A3/D3] A2,[A2/D2] A1,[A1/D1] A0,[A0/D0] D15 72 P1_6 INT4 D14 73 P1_5 INT3 D13 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 P1_4 P1_3 P1_2 P1_1 P1_0 P0_7 P0_6 P0_5 P0_4 P0_3 P0_2 P0_1 P0_0 P10_7 KI3 AN0_7 AN0_6 AN0_5 AN0_4 AN0_3 AN0_2 AN0_1 AN0_0 AN_7 88 P10_6 KI2 AN_6 89 P10_5 KI1 AN_5 90 P10_4 KI0 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 P10_3 P10_2 P10_1 AN_3 AN_2 AN_1 P10_0 AN_0 99 100 AN2_7 AN2_6 AN2_5 AN2_4 AN2_3 AN2_2 AN2_1 AN2_0 AN_4 AVSS VREF AVCC P9_7 RXD4/SCL4/STXD4 P9_6 P9_5 TXD4/SDA4/SRXD4 CLK4 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 14 of 385 ADTRG ANEX1 ANEX0 D12 D11 D10 D9 D8 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 1.5 1. Overview Pin Functions Table 1.11 Item Power supply Analog power supply input Reset input Pin Functions (100-Pin and 144-Pin Packages) (1/3) Symbol VCC1,VCC2 VSS AVCC AVSS RESET CNVSS CNVSS External data bus width select input BYTE Bus control Pins D0 to D7 D8 to D15 A0 to A22 A23 A0/D0 to A7/D7 I/O Supply Description Type Voltage − − Apply 3.0 to 5.5 V to pins VCC1 and VCC2, and 0 V to the VSS pin. Meet the input condition of VCC1 ≥ VCC2. − VCC1 Power supply input pins to the A/D converter and D/A converter. Connect the AVCC pin to VCC1, and the AVSS pin to VSS. I VCC1 The MCU is placed in the reset state while applying an “L” signal to the RESET pin. I VCC1 This pin switches processor mode. Apply an “L” to the CNVSS pin to start up in single-chip mode, or an “H” to start up in microprocessor mode and boot mode. I VCC1 This pin switches data bus width in external memory space 3. A data bus is 16 bits wide when the BYTE pin is held “L” and 8 bits wide when it is held “H”. Fix to either “L” or “H”. Apply an “L” to the BYTE pin in single-chip mode. I/O VCC2 Data (D0 to D7) input/output pins while accessing an external memory space with separate bus. I/O VCC2 Data (D8 to D15) input/output pins while accessing an external memory space with 16-bit separate bus. O VCC2 Address bits (A0 to A22) output pins. O VCC2 Inverted address bit (A23) output pin. I/O VCC2 A8/D8 to A15/D15 I/O VCC2 CS0 to CS3 O VCC2 WRL/WR WRH/BHE RD O VCC2 ALE O VCC2 HOLD I VCC2 HLDA O VCC2 The HLDA pin outputs an “L” while the MCU is placed in the hold state. RDY I VCC2 Bus is placed in the wait state while an “L” signal is applied to the RDY pin. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 15 of 385 Data (D0 to D7) input/output and 8 low-order address bits (A0 to A7) output are performed by time-sharing these pins while accessing an external memory space with multiplexed bus. Data (D8 to D15) input/output and 8 middle-order address bits (A8 to A15) output are performed by time-sharing these pins while accessing an external memory space with 16-bit multiplexed bus. Chip-select signal output pins used to specify external devices. WRL, WRH, (WR, BHE) and RD signal output pins. WRL and WRH can be switched with WR and BHE by a program. • WRL, WRH and RD are selected: If external data bus is 16 bits wide, data is written to an even address in external memory space while an “L” is output from the WRL pin. Data is written to an odd address while an “L” is output from the WRH pin. Data is read while an “L” is output from the RD pin. • WR, BHE and RD are selected: Data is written while an “L” is output from the WR pin. Data is read while an “L” is output from the RD pin. Data in odd address is accessed while an “L” is output from the BHE pin. Select WR, BHE and RD when an external data bus is 8 bits wide. ALE signal is used for the external devices to latch address signals when the multiplexed bus is selected. The MCU is placed in the hold state while an “L” signal is applied to the HOLD pin. Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 1.12 Item Main clock input Main clock output Sub clock input Sub clock output BCLK output Clock output 1. Overview Pin Functions (100-Pin and 144-Pin Packages) (2/3) Symbol XIN XOUT I/O Supply Description Type Voltage I VCC1 Input/output pins for the main clock oscillation circuit. Connect a ceramic resonator or crystal oscillator between XIN and XOUT. To O VCC1 apply an external clock, apply it to XIN and leave XOUT open. XCIN I VCC1 XCOUT O VCC1 BCLK CLKOUT O O VCC2 VCC2 Bus clock output pin The CLKOUT pin outputs the clock having the same frequency as fC, f8, or f32 INT interrupt input INT0 to INT2 I VCC1 INT interrupt input pins NT3 to INT5 I VCC2 NMI interrupt input Timer A NMI I VCC1 TA0OUT to TA4OUT TA0IN to TA4IN TB0IN to TB5IN I/O VCC1 I VCC1 NMI interrupt input pin. Connect the NMI pin to VCC1 via a resistor when the NMI interrupt is not used. Timer A0 to A4 input/output pins (TA0OUT is N-channel open drain output) Timer A0 to A4 input pins I VCC1 Timer B0 to B5 input pins U, U, V, V, W, W O VCC1 Three-phase motor control timer output pins CTS0 to CTS4 I VCC1 Input pins to control data transmission RTS0 to RTS4 CLK0 to CLK4 RXD0 to RXD4 TXD0 to TXD4 SDA0 to SDA4 SCL0 to SCL4 O VCC1 Output pins to control data reception I/O I VCC1 VCC1 Serial clock input/output pins Serial data input pins O VCC1 I/O VCC1 I/O VCC1 O VCC1 I VCC1 Serial data output pins (TXD2 is N-channel open drain output) Serial data input/output pins (SDA2 is N-channel open drain output) Serial clock input/output pins (SCL2 is N-channel open drain output) Serial data output pins when slave mode is selected (STXD2 is N-channel open drain output) Serial data input pins when slave mode is selected I VCC1 Control input pins used in the serial interface special mode. Timer B Three-phase motor control timer output Serial interface I2C mode STXD0 to Serial STXD4 interface special function SRXD0 to SRXD4 SS0 to SS4 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 16 of 385 Input/output pins for the sub clock oscillation circuit. Connect a crystal oscillator between XCIN and XCOUT. To apply an external clock, apply it to XCIN and leave XCOUT open. Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 1.13 Item Reference voltage input A/D converter D/A converter I/O port Input port Key input interrupt input Table 1.14 Item A/D converter I/O port 1. Overview Pin Functions (100-Pin and 144-Pin Packages) (3/3) Symbol VREF I/O Supply Type Voltage I − Description AN_0 to AN_7 AN0_0 to AN0_7, AN2_0 to AN2_7 I I VCC1 VCC2 The VREF pin supplies the reference voltage to the A/D converter and D/A converter. Analog input pins for the A/D converter. Analog input pins for the A/D converter. ADTRG ANEX0 I VCC1 External trigger input pin for the A/D converter. I/O VCC1 I O I/O VCC1 VCC1 VCC2 Extended analog input pin for the A/D converter or output pin in external op-amp connection mode. Extended analog input pin for the A/D converter. Output pins for the D/A converter. 8-bit CMOS I/O ports. The Port Pi Direction Register (i = 0 to 15) determines if each pin is used as an input port or an output port. The Pull-up Control Registers determine if the input ports, divided into groups of four, are pulled up or not. I/O VCC1 ANEX1 DA0, DA1 P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7 P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7 P8_0 to P8_4 P8_6, P8_7 P8_5 KI0 to KI3 These 8-bit I/O ports are functionally equivalent to P0. (P7_0 and P7_1 are N-channel open drain output.) These I/O ports are functionally equivalent to P0. I VCC1 I VCC1 Shares the pin with NMI. Input port to read NMI pin level. Key input interrupt input pins Pin Functions (144-Pin Package Only) Symbol AN15_0 to AN15_7 P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7 P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7 I/O Supply Description Type Voltage I VCC1 Analog input pins for the A/D converter I/O VCC2 I/O VCC1 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 17 of 385 These I/O ports are functionally equivalent to P0. Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 2. 2. Central Processing Unit (CPU) Central Processing Unit (CPU) Figure 2.1 shows the CPU registers. The register bank is comprised of eight registers (R0, R1, R2, R3, A0, A1, SB, and FB) out of 28 CPU registers. There are two sets of register banks. b31 General registers b15 R2 R2 R3 R3 b0 R0H R0H R1H R1H R0L R0L R1L R1L Data registers(1) R2 R2 R3 R3 b23 A0 A0 A1 A1 SB SB FB FB Static base register(1) Frame base register(1) USP ISP INTB PC User stack pointer Interrupt stack pointer Interrupt table register Program counter Address registers(1) FLG b15 Flag register b8 b7 IPL b0 U I O B S Z D C Carry flag Debug flag Zero flag Sign flag Register bank select flag Overflow flag Interrupt enable flag Stack pointer select flag Reserved Processor interrupt priority level Reserved b15 High-speed interrupt registers b0 SVF b23 Flag save register PC save register Vector register SVP VCT b7 b0 DMD0 DMD1 DMAC-associated registers b15 DCT0 DCT1 DRC0 DRC1 b23 DMA0 DMA1 DRA0 DRA1 DSA0 DSA1 DMA mode registers DMA transfer count registers DMA transfer count reload registers DMA memory address registers DMA memory address reload registers DMA SFR address registers NOTE: 1. These registers comprise a register bank. There are two sets of register banks (register bank 0 and register bank 1). Figure 2.1 CPU Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 18 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 2.1 2. Central Processing Unit (CPU) General Registers 2.1.1 Data Registers (R0, R1, R2, and R3) R0, R1, R2, and R3 are 16-bit registers for transfer, arithmetic and logic operations. R0 and R1 can be split into high-order (R0H/R1H) and low-order bits (R0L/R1L) to be used separately as 8-bit data registers. R0 can be combined with R2 and used as a 32-bit data register (R2R0). The same applies to R3R1. 2.1.2 Address Registers (A0 and A1) A0 and A1 are 24-bit registers used for A0-/A1-indirect addressing, A0-/A1-relative addressing, transfer, arithmetic and logic operations. 2.1.3 Static Base Register (SB) SB is a 24-bit register used for SB-relative addressing. 2.1.4 Frame Base Register (FB) FB is a 24-bit register used for FB-relative addressing. 2.1.5 User Stack Pointer (USP) and Interrupt Stack Pointer (ISP) The stack pointers (SP), USP and ISP, are 24 bits wide each. The U flag is used to switch between USP and ISP. Refer to 2.1.8 Flag Register (FLG) for details on the U flag. Set USP and ISP to even addresses to execute an interrupt sequence efficiently. 2.1.6 Interrupt Table Register (INTB) INTB is a 24-bit register indicating the starting address of a relocatable interrupt vector table. 2.1.7 Program Counter (PC) PC is 24 bits wide and indicates the address of the next instruction to be executed. 2.1.8 Flag Register (FLG) FLG is a 16-bit register indicating the CPU state. 2.1.8.1 Carry Flag (C) The C flag indicates whether or not carry or borrow has been generated after executing an instruction. 2.1.8.2 Debug Flag (D) The D flag is for debugging only. Set it to 0. 2.1.8.3 Zero Flag (Z) The Z flag becomes 1 when an arithmetic operation results in 0; otherwise becomes 0. 2.1.8.4 Sign Flag (S) The S flag becomes 1 when an arithmetic operation results in a negative value; otherwise becomes 0. 2.1.8.5 Register Bank Select Flag (B) Register bank 0 is selected when the B flag is set to 0. Register bank 1 is selected when this flag is set to 1. 2.1.8.6 Overflow Flag (O) The O flag becomes 1 when an arithmetic operation results in an overflow; otherwise becomes 0. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 19 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 2.1.8.7 2. Central Processing Unit (CPU) Interrupt Enable Flag (I) The I flag enables maskable interrupts. Interrupts are disabled when the I flag is set to 0 and enabled when it is set to 1. The I flag becomes 0 when an interrupt request is acknowledged. 2.1.8.8 Stack Pointer Select Flag (U) ISP is selected when the U flag is set to 0. USP is selected when the U flag is set to 1. The U flag becomes 0 when a hardware interrupt request is acknowledged or the INT instruction specifying software interrupt numbers 0 to 31 is executed. 2.1.8.9 Processor Interrupt Priority Level (IPL) IPL is 3 bits wide and assigns processor interrupt priority levels from level 0 to level 7. If a requested interrupt has higher priority level than IPL, the interrupt is enabled. 2.1.8.10 Reserved Space Only write 0 to bits assigned to the reserved space. When read, the bits return undefined values. 2.2 High-Speed Interrupt Registers Registers associated with the high-speed interrupt are as follows: • Flag save register (SVF) • PC save register (SVP) • Vector register (VCT) Refer to 11.4 High-Speed Interrupt for details. 2.3 DMAC-Associated Registers Registers associated with the DMAC are as follows: • DMA mode register (DMD0, DMD1) • DMA transfer count register (DCT0, DCT1) • DMA transfer count reload register (DRC0, DRC1) • DMA memory address register (DMA0, DMA1) • DMA memory address reload register (DRA0, DRA1) • DMA SFR address register (DSA0, DSA1) Refer to 13. DMAC for details. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 20 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 3. 3. Memory Memory Figure 3.1 shows a memory map of the M32C/8B Group. The M32C/8B Group has 16-Mbyte address space from addresses 000000h to FFFFFFh. The internal ROM is allocated in lower addresses, beginning with address FFFFFFh. For example, a 256-Kbyte internal ROM area is allocated in addresses FC0000h to FFFFFFh. The fixed interrupt vectors are allocated in addresses FFFFDCh to FFFFFFh. They store the starting address of each interrupt routine. Refer to 11. Interrupts for details. The internal RAM is allocated higher addresses, beginning with address 000400h. For example, a 32-Kbyte internal RAM area is allocated in addresses 000400h to 0083FFh. The internal RAM is used not only for storing data but for the stacks when subroutines are called or when interrupt requests are acknowledged. SFRs are allocated in addresses 000000h to 0003FFh. The peripheral function control registers such as for I/O ports, A/D converters, serial interfaces, timers are allocated here. All blank spaces within SFRs are reserved and cannot be accessed by users. The special page vectors are allocated addresses FFFE00h to FFFFDBh. They are used for the JMPS instruction and JSRS instruction. Refer to the Renesas publication M32C/80 Series Software Manual for details. 000000h SFR 000400h Internal RAM Internal RAM Capacity 32 Kbytes XXXXXXh 0083FFh FFFE00h XXXXXXh Reserved 00E000h 00FFFFh Internal ROM(3) (Data space) FFFFDCh Special page vector table Undefined instruction Overflow BRK instruction External space(1) Address match Internal ROM Capacity YYYYYYh 128 Kbytes FE0000h 256 Kbytes FC0000h F00000h Watchdog timer Reserved(2) (5) YYYYYYh NMI Internal ROM(4) FFFFFFh FFFFFFh Reset NOTES: 1. The space is used as the external space in memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode. It is reserved in single-chip mode. 2. The space is reserved in single-chip mode and memory expansion mode. It is used as the external space in microprocessor mode. 3. Additional two blocks of 4-Kbyte space are provided in the flash memory version to store data. This space is used in single-chip mode and memory expansion mode. It is reserved in microprocessor mode. 4. This space is used as the internal ROM in single-chip mode and memory expansion mode. It is used as the external space in microprocessor mode. 5. The watchdog timer interrupt, oscillation stop detection interrupt, and voltage monitor interrupt share the same vector. Figure 3.1 Memory Map REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 21 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 4. 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) Special Function Registers (SFRs) Special Function Registers (SFRs) are the control registers of peripheral functions. Tables 4.1 to 4.11 list SFR address maps. Table 4.1 SFR Address Map (1/11) Address Register Symbol After Reset 0000h 0001h 0002h 0003h 0004h Processor Mode Register 0(1) PM0 1000 0000b(CNVSS=”L”) 0000 0011b(CNVSS=”H”) 0005h Processor Mode Register 1 PM1 00h 0006h System Clock Control Register 0 CM0 0000 1000b 0007h System Clock Control Register 1 CM1 0010 0000b 0009h Address Match Interrupt Enable Register AIER 00h 000Ah Protect Register PRCR XXXX 0000b DS XXXX 1000b(BYTE=”L”) XXXX 0000b(BYTE=”H”) 0008h 000Bh External Data Bus Width Control Register 000Ch Main Clock Division Register MCD XXX0 1000b 000Dh Oscillation Stop Detection Register CM2 00h 000Eh Watchdog Timer Start Register WDTS XXh 000Fh Watchdog Timer Control Register WDC 000X XXXXb Address Match Interrupt Register 0 RMAD0 000000h Processor Mode Register 2 PM2 00h Address Match Interrupt Register 1 RMAD1 000000h Reference Voltage Configuration Register DVCR 1000 1111b Address Match Interrupt Register 2 RMAD2 000000h Voltage Monitor Register LVDC 0000 1000h Address Match Interrupt Register 3 RMAD3 000000h Voltage Regulator Control Register VRCR 00h PLL Control Register 0 PLC0 0001 X010b Address Match Interrupt Register 4 RMAD4 000000h Address Match Interrupt Register 5 RMAD5 000000h 0010h 0011h 0012h 0013h 0014h 0015h 0016h 0017h 0018h 0019h 001Ah 001Bh 001Ch 001Dh 001Eh 001Fh 0020h 0021h 0022h 0023h 0024h 0025h 0026h 0027h 0028h 0029h 002Ah 002Bh 002Ch 002Dh 002Eh 002Fh X: Undefined Blank spaces are all reserved. No access is allowed. NOTE: 1. Bits PM01 and PM00 in the PM0 register maintain values set before reset, even after software reset or watchdog timer reset has been performed. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 22 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 4.2 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) SFR Address Map (2/11) Address Register Symbol After Reset 0030h 0031h 0032h 0033h 0034h 0035h 0036h 0037h 0038h 0039h Address Match Interrupt Register 6 RMAD6 000000h Address Match Interrupt Register 7 RMAD7 000000h 0048h External Space Wait Control Register 0 EWCR0 X0X0 0011b 0049h External Space Wait Control Register 1 EWCR1 X0X0 0011b 004Ah External Space Wait Control Register 2 EWCR2 X0X0 0011b 003Ah 003Bh 003Ch 003Dh 003Eh 003Fh 0040h 0041h 0042h 0043h 0044h 0045h 0046h 0047h 004Bh External Space Wait Control Register 3 EWCR3 X0X0 0011b 004Ch Page Mode Wait Control Register 0(1) PWCR0 0001 0001b 004Dh Page Mode Wait Control Register 1(1) PWCR1 0001 0001b Flash Memory Control Register 3(2) FMR 3 XX0X XX00b Flash Memory Control Register 2(2) FMR 2 XXXX XXX0b Flash Memory Control Register 1(2) FMR1 0000 XX0Xb Flash Memory Control Register 0(2) FMR0 0000 0001b Flash Memory Control Register 4(2) FMR4 00h 004Eh 004Fh 0050h 0051h 0052h 0053h 0054h 0055h 0056h 0057h 0058h 0059h 005Ah 005Bh 005Ch 005Dh 005Eh 005Fh X: Undefined Blank spaces are all reserved. No access is allowed. NOTES: 1. These registers can be used only in ROMless version. 2. These registers are not available in ROMless version. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 23 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 4.3 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) SFR Address Map (3/11) Address Register Symbol After Reset 0060h 0061h 0062h 0063h 0064h 0065h 0066h 0067h 0068h DMA0 Interrupt Control Register DM0IC XXXX X000b 0069h Timer B5 Interrupt Control Register TB5IC XXXX X000b 006Ah DMA2 Interrupt Control Register DM2IC XXXX X000b 006Bh UART2 Receive/ACK Interrupt Control Register S2RIC XXXX X000b 006Ch Timer A0 Interrupt Control Register TA0IC XXXX X000b 006Dh UART3 Receive/ACK Interrupt Control Register S3RIC XXXX X000b 006Eh Timer A2 Interrupt Control Register TA2IC XXXX X000b 006Fh UART4 Receive/ACK Interrupt Control Register S4RIC XXXX X000b 0070h Timer A4 Interrupt Control Register TA4IC XXXX X000b 0071h UART0/UART3 Bus Conflict Detection Interrupt Control Register BCN0IC/BCN3IC XXXX X000b 0072h UART0 Receive/ACK Interrupt Control Register S0RIC XXXX X000b 0073h A/D0 Conversion Interrupt Control Register AD0IC XXXX X000b 0074h UART1 Receive/ACK Interrupt Control Register S1RIC XXXX X000b Timer B1 Interrupt Control Register TB1IC XXXX X000b Timer B3 Interrupt Control Register TB3IC XXXX X000b INT5 Interrupt Control Register INT5IC XX00 X000b INT3 Interrupt Control Register INT3IC XX00 X000b INT1 Interrupt Control Register INT1IC XX00 X000b 0088h DMA1 Interrupt Control Register DM1IC XXXX X000b 0089h UART2 Transmit/NACK Interrupt Control Register S2TIC XXXX X000b 008Ah DMA3 Interrupt Control Register DM3IC XXXX X000b 008Bh UART3 Transmit/NACK Interrupt Control Register S3TIC XXXX X000b 008Ch Timer A1 Interrupt Control Register TA1IC XXXX X000b 0075h 0076h 0077h 0078h 0079h 007Ah 007Bh 007Ch 007Dh 007Eh 007Fh 0080h 0081h 0082h 0083h 0084h 0085h 0086h 0087h 008Dh UART4 Transmit/NACK Interrupt Control Register S4TIC XXXX X000b 008Eh Timer A3 Interrupt Control Register TA3IC XXXX X000b 008Fh UART2 Bus Conflict Detection Interrupt Control Register BCN2IC XXXX X000b X: Undefined Blank spaces are all reserved. No access is allowed. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 24 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 4.4 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) SFR Address Map (4/11) Address Register Symbol After Reset 0090h UART0 Transmit/NACK Interrupt Control Register S0TIC XXXX X000b 0091h UART1/UART4 Bus Conflict Detection Interrupt Control Register BCN1IC/BCN4IC XXXX X000b 0092h UART1 Transmit/NACK Interrupt Control Register S1TIC XXXX X000b 0093h Key Input Interrupt Control Register KUPIC XXXX X000b 0094h Timer B0 Interrupt Control Register TB0IC XXXX X000b Timer B2 Interrupt Control Register TB2IC XXXX X000b Timer B4 Interrupt Control Register TB4IC XXXX X000b INT4 Interrupt Control Register INT4IC XX00 X000b INT2 Interrupt Control Register INT2IC XX00 X000b 009Eh INT0 Interrupt Control Register INT0IC XX00 X000b 009Fh Exit Priority Register RLVL XXXX 0000b 0095h 0096h 0097h 0098h 0099h 009Ah 009Bh 009Ch 009Dh 00A0h to 02BFh X: Undefined Blank spaces are all reserved. No access is allowed. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 25 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 4.5 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) SFR Address Map (5/11) Address 02C0h Register Symbol After Reset X0 Register, Y0 Register X0R, Y0R XXXXh X1 Register, Y1 Register X1R, Y1R XXXXh X2 Register, Y2 Register X2R, Y2R XXXXh X3 Register, Y3 Register X3R, Y3R XXXXh X4 Register, Y4 Register X4R, Y4R XXXXh X5 Register, Y5 Register X5R, Y5R XXXXh X6 Register, Y6 Register X6R, Y6R XXXXh X7 Register, Y7 Register X7R, Y7R XXXXh X8 Register, Y8 Register X8R, Y8R XXXXh X9 Register, Y9 Register X9R, Y9R XXXXh X10 Register, Y10 Register X10R, Y10R XXXXh X11 Register, Y11 Register X11R, Y11R XXXXh X12 Register, Y12 Register X12R, Y12R XXXXh X13 Register, Y13 Register X13R, Y13R XXXXh X14 Register, Y14 Register X14R, Y14R XXXXh X15 Register, Y15 Register X15R, Y15R XXXXh X/Y Control Register XYC XXXX XX00b 02E4h UART1 Special Mode Register 4 U1SMR4 00h 02E5h UART1 Special Mode Register 3 U1SMR3 00h 02E6h UART1 Special Mode Register 2 U1SMR2 00h 02E7h UART1 Special Mode Register U1SMR 00h 02E8h UART1 Transmit/Receive Mode Register U1MR 00h 02E9h UART1 Baud Rate Register U1BRG XXh UART1 Transmit Buffer Register U1TB XXXXh 02ECh UART1 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 U1C0 0000 1000b 02EDh UART1 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 U1C1 0000 0010b UART1 Receive Buffer Register U1RB XXXXh 02C1h 02C2h 02C3h 02C4h 02C5h 02C6h 02C7h 02C8h 02C9h 02CAh 02CBh 02CCh 02CDh 02CEh 02CFh 02D0h 02D1h 02D2h 02D3h 02D4h 02D5h 02D6h 02D7h 02D8h 02D9h 02DAh 02DBh 02DCh 02DDh 02DEh 02DFh 02E0h 02E1h 02E2h 02E3h 02EAh 02EBh 02EEh 02EFh X: Undefined Blank spaces are all reserved. No access is allowed. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 26 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 4.6 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) SFR Address Map (6/11) Address Register Symbol After Reset 02F0h 02F1h 02F2h 02F3h 02F4h UART4 Special Mode Register 4 U4SMR4 00h 02F5h UART4 Special Mode Register 3 U4SMR3 00h 02F6h UART4 Special Mode Register 2 U4SMR2 00h 02F7h UART4 Special Mode Register U4SMR 00h 02F8h UART4 Transmit/Receive Mode Register U4MR 00h 02F9h UART4 Baud Rate Register U4BRG XXh UART4 Transmit Buffer Register U4TB XXXXh 02FCh UART4 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 U4C0 0000 1000b 02FDh UART4 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 U4C1 0000 0010b UART4 Receive Buffer Register U4RB XXXXh Timer B3, B4, B5 Count Start Register TBSR 000X XXXXb Timer A11 Register TA11 XXXXh Timer A21 Register TA21 XXXXh Timer A41 Register TA41 XXXXh 0308h Three-Phase PWM Control Register 0 INVC0 00h 0309h Three-Phase PWM Control Register 1 INVC1 00h 030Ah Three-Phase Output Buffer Register 0 IDB0 XX11 1111b 02FAh 02FBh 02FEh 02FFh 0300h 0301h 0302h 0303h 0304h 0305h 0306h 0307h 030Bh Three-Phase Output Buffer Register 1 IDB1 XX11 1111b 030Ch Dead Time Timer DTT XXh 030Dh Timer B2 Interrupt Generation Frequency Set Counter ICTB2 XXh Timer B3 Register TB3 XXXXh Timer B4 Register TB4 XXXXh Timer B5 Register TB5 XXXXh 030Eh 030Fh 0310h 0311h 0312h 0313h 0314h 0315h 0316h 0317h 0318h 0319h 031Ah 031Bh Timer B3 Mode Register TB3MR 00XX 0000b 031Ch Timer B4 Mode Register TB4MR 00XX 0000b 031Dh Timer B5 Mode Register TB5MR 00XX 0000b External Interrupt Source Select Register IFSR 00h 031Eh 031Fh X: Undefined Blank spaces are all reserved. No access is allowed. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 27 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 4.7 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) SFR Address Map (7/11) Address Register Symbol After Reset 0320h 0321h 0322h 0323h 0324h UART3 Special Mode Register 4 U3SMR4 00h 0325h UART3 Special Mode Register 3 U3SMR3 00h 0326h UART3 Special Mode Register 2 U3SMR2 00h 0327h UART3 Special Mode Register U3SMR 00h 0328h UART3 Transmit/Receive Mode Register U3MR 00h 0329h UART3 Baud Rate Register U3BRG XXh UART3 Transmit Buffer Register U3TB XXXXh 032Ch UART3 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 U3C0 0000 1000b 032Dh UART3 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 U3C1 0000 0010b UART3 Receive Buffer Register U3RB XXXXh 0334h UART2 Special Mode Register 4 U2SMR4 00h 0335h UART2 Special Mode Register 3 U2SMR3 00h 0336h UART2 Special Mode Register 2 U2SMR2 00h 0337h UART2 Special Mode Register U2SMR 00h 032Ah 032Bh 032Eh 032Fh 0330h 0331h 0332h 0333h 0338h UART2 Transmit/Receive Mode Register U2MR 00h 0339h UART2 Baud Rate Register U2BRG XXh UART2 Transmit Buffer Register U2TB XXXXh 033Ch UART2 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 U2C0 0000 1000b 033Dh UART2 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 U2C1 0000 0010b UART2 Receive Buffer Register U2RB XXXXh 0340h Count Start Register TABSR 00h 0341h Clock Prescaler Reset Register CPSRF 0XXX XXXXb 0342h One-Shot Start Register ONSF 00h 033Ah 033Bh 033Eh 033Fh 0343h Trigger Select Register TRGSR 00h 0344h Up/Down Select Register UDF 00h Timer A0 Register TA0 XXXXh Timer A1 Register TA1 XXXXh Timer A2 Register TA2 XXXXh Timer A3 Register TA3 XXXXh Timer A4 Register TA4 XXXXh 0345h 0346h 0347h 0348h 0349h 034Ah 034Bh 034Ch 034Dh 034Eh 034Fh X: Undefined Blank spaces are all reserved. No access is allowed. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 28 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 4.8 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) SFR Address Map (8/11) Address 0350h Register Symbol After Reset Timer B0 Register TB0 XXXXh Timer B1 Register TB1 XXXXh Timer B2 Register TB2 XXXXh 0356h Timer A0 Mode Register TA0MR 00h 0357h Timer A1 Mode Register TA1MR 00h 0358h Timer A2 Mode Register TA2MR 00h 0359h Timer A3 Mode Register TA3MR 00h 035Ah Timer A4 Mode Register TA4MR 00h 035Bh Timer B0 Mode Register TB0MR 00XX 0000b 035Ch Timer B1 Mode Register TB1MR 00XX 0000b 0351h 0352h 0353h 0354h 0355h 035Dh Timer B2 Mode Register TB2MR 00XX 0000b 035Eh Timer B2 Special Mode Register TB2SC XXXX XXX0b 035Fh Count Source Prescaler Register(1) TCSPR 0XXX 0000b 0364h UART0 Special Mode Register 4 U0SMR4 00h 0365h UART0 Special Mode Register 3 U0SMR3 00h 0366h UART0 Special Mode Register 2 U0SMR2 00h 0367h UART0 Special Mode Register U0SMR 00h 0360h 0361h 0362h 0363h 0368h UART0 Transmit/Receive Mode Register U0MR 00h 0369h UART0 Baud Rate Register U0BRG XXh UART0 Transmit Buffer Register U0TB XXXXh 036Ch UART0 Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 U0C0 0000 1000b 036Dh UART0 Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 U0C1 0000 0010b UART0 Receive Buffer Register U0RB XXXXh 0378h DMA0 Request Source Select Register DM0SL 0X00 0000b 0379h DMA1 Request Source Select Register DM1SL 0X00 0000b 037Ah DMA2 Request Source Select Register DM2SL 0X00 0000b 037Bh DMA3 Request Source Select Register DM3SL 0X00 0000b CRC Data Register CRCD XXXXh CRC Input Register CRCIN XXh 036Ah 036Bh 036Eh 036Fh 0370h 0371h 0372h 0373h 0374h 0375h 0376h 0377h 037Ch 037Dh 037Eh 037Fh X: Undefined Blank spaces are all reserved. No access is allowed. NOTE: 1. The TCSPR register maintains values set before reset, even after software reset or watchdog timer reset has been performed. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 29 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 4.9 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) SFR Address Map (9/11) Address 0380h 0381h 0382h 0383h 0384h 0385h 0386h 0387h 0388h 0389h 038Ah 038Bh 038Ch 038Dh 038Eh 038Fh Register Symbol After Reset A/D0 Register 0 AD00 00XXh A/D0 Register 1 AD01 00XXh A/D0 Register 2 AD02 00XXh A/D0 Register 3 AD03 00XXh A/D0 Register 4 AD04 00XXh A/D0 Register 5 AD05 00XXh A/D0 Register 6 AD06 00XXh A/D0 Register 7 AD07 00XXh A/D0 Control Register 4 AD0CON4 XXXX 00XXb 0390h 0391h 0392h 0393h 0394h A/D0 Control Register 2 AD0CON2 XX0X X000b 0395h A/D0 Control Register 3 AD0CON3 XXXX X000b 0396h A/D0 Control Register 0 AD0CON0 00h 0397h A/D0 Control Register 1 AD0CON1 00h 0398h D/A Register 0 DA0 XXh D/A Register 1 DA1 XXh D/A Control Register DACON XXXX XX00b 0399h 039Ah 039Bh 039Ch 039Dh 039Eh 039Fh X: Undefined Blank spaces are all reserved. No access is allowed. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 30 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 4.10 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) SFR Address Map (10/11) Address Register Symbol After Reset 03A0h 03A1h 03A2h 03A3h 03A4h 03A5h 03A6h 03A7h 03A8h 03A9h 03AAh 03ABh 03ACh 03ADh 03AEh 03AFh Function Select Register C PSC 00X0 0000b 03B0h Function Select Register A0 PS0 00h 03B1h Function Select Register A1 PS1 00h 03B2h Function Select Register B0 PSL0 00h 03B3h Function Select Register B1 PSL1 00h 03B4h Function Select Register A2 PS2 00X0 0000b 03B5h Function Select Register A3 PS3 00h 03B6h Function Select Register B2 PSL2 00X0 0000b 03B7h Function Select Register B3 PSL3 00h 03C0h Port P6 Register P6 XXh 03C1h Port P7 Register P7 XXh 03C2h Port P6 Direction Register PD6 00h 03C3h Port P7 Direction Register PD7 00h 03C4h Port P8 Register P8 XXh 03C5h Port P9 Register P9 XXh 03C6h Port P8 Direction Register PD8 00X0 0000b 03C7h Port P9 Direction Register PD9 00h 03C8h Port P10 Register P10 XXh 03C9h Port P11 Register(1) P11 XXh 03CAh Port P10 Direction Register PD10 00h 03CBh Port P11 Direction Register(1)(2) PD11 XXX0 0000b 03CCh Port P12 Register(1) P12 XXh 03CDh Port P13 Register(1) P13 XXh 03CEh Port P12 Direction Register(1)(2) PD12 00h 03CFh Port P13 Direction Register(1)(2) PD13 00h 03B8h 03B9h 03BAh 03BBh 03BCh 03BDh 03BEh 03BFh X: Undefined Blank spaces are all reserved. No access is allowed. NOTES: 1. These registers cannot be used in the 100-pin package. 2. Set to FFh in the 100-pin package. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 31 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 4.11 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) SFR Address Map (11/11) Address Register Symbol After Reset 03D0h Port P14 Register(1) P14 XXh 03D1h Port P15 Register(1) P15 XXh 03D2h Port P14 Direction Register(1)(2) PD14 X000 0000b 03D3h Port P15 Direction Register(1)(2) PD15 00h 03DAh Pull-Up Control Register 2 PUR2 00h 03DBh Pull-Up Control Register 3 PUR3 00h 03DCh Pull-Up Control Register 4(1)(3) PUR4 XXXX 0000b 03E0h Port P0 Register P0 XXh 03E1h Port P1 Register P1 XXh 03E2h Port P0 Direction Register PD0 00h 03E3h Port P1 Direction Register PD1 00h 03E4h Port P2 Register P2 XXh 03E5h Port P3 Register P3 XXh 03E6h Port P2 Direction Register PD2 00h 03E7h Port P3 Direction Register PD3 00h 03E8h Port P4 Register P4 XXh 03E9h Port P5 Register P5 XXh 03EAh Port P4 Direction Register PD4 00h 03EBh Port P5 Direction Register PD5 00h 03F0h Pull-Up Control Register 0 PUR0 00h 03F1h Pull-Up Control Register 1 PUR1 XXXX 0000b Port Control Register PCR XXXX X000b 03D4h 03D5h 03D6h 03D7h 03D8h 03D9h 03DDh 03DEh 03DFh 03ECh 03EDh 03EEh 03EFh 03F2h 03F3h 03F4h 03F5h 03F6h 03F7h 03F8h 03F9h 03FAh 03FBh 03FCh 03FDh 03FEh 03FFh X: Undefined Blank spaces are all reserved. No access is allowed. NOTES: 1. These registers cannot be used in the 100-pin package. 2. Set to FFh in the 100-pin package. 3. Set to 00h in the 100-pin package. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 32 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 5. 5. Reset Reset Hardware reset, software reset and watchdog timer reset are implemented to reset the MCU. 5.1 Hardware Reset Pins, CPU, and SFRs are reset by using the RESET pin. When a low-level (“L”) signal is applied to the RESET pin while the supply voltage meets the recommended operating conditions, ports and I/O pins for peripheral functions are reset. (Refer to Table 5.1 Pin states while RESET pin is held “L”.) Also, the oscillation circuit is reset and the main clock starts oscillating. CPU and SFRs are reset when the signal applied to the RESET pin changes from “L” to high-level (“H”) signal, and then the MCU executes a program beginning with the address indicated by the reset vector. The internal RAM is not reset by hardware reset. When an “L” signal is applied to the RESET pin while writing data to the internal RAM, the value written to the internal RAM becomes undefined. Figure 5.1 shows an example of the reset circuit. Figure 5.2 shows a reset sequence. Table 5.1 lists pin states while the RESET pin is held “L”. 5.1.1 Reset at a Stable Supply Voltage (1) Apply an “L” signal to the RESET pin. (2) Input 20 clock cycles or more into the XIN pin. (3) Apply an “H” signal to the RESET pin. 5.1.2 Power-on Reset (1) Apply an “L” signal to the RESET pin. (2) Increase the supply voltage until it meets the recommended operating condition. (3) Wait for td(P-R) (internal power supply stabilization time) or more to allow the internal power supply to stabilize. (4) Inputs 20 clock cycles or more into the XIN pin. (5) Apply an “H” signal to the RESET pin. Recommended operating voltage VCC1 VCC1 0V RESET RESET 0.2VCC1 or below 0.2VCC1 or below 0V Input td(P-R) + 20 clock cycles or more to the XIN pin NOTE: 1. If operating at VCC1 > VCC2, VCC2 voltage must be lower than VCC1 voltage when powering up and down. Figure 5.1 Example of Reset Circuit REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 33 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 5. Reset VCC1, VCC2 XIN Td(P-R) ms or more is required 20 or more clock cycles are required RESET 300 to 308 BCLK cycles BCLK Microprocessor mode BYTE = "H" Content of reset vector Address FFFFFCh A23 “H” “L” RD “H” “L” WR “H” “L” FFFFFDh Microprocessor mode BYTE = "L" FFFFFCh “H” “L” RD “H” “L” WR “H” “L” Single-chip mode FFFFFCh FFFFFEh NOTE: 1. Address data is not output from pins in single-chip mode. Reset Sequence REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 34 of 385 FFFFFEh Content of reset vector Address(1) Figure 5.2 FFFFFFh Content of reset vector Address A23 FFFFFEh Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 5.1 5. Reset Pin States while RESET Pin is Held “L”(2) Single-Chip Mode Pin Name CNVSS = “L” Microprocessor Mode CNVSS = “H”(4) BYTE = “L” BYTE = “H” P0 Input port (high-impedance) Data input (high-impedance) P1 Input port (high-impedance) Data input (high-impedance) P2 to P4 Input port (high-impedance) Address output (undefined) P5_0 Input port (high-impedance) WR signal output (“H”)(3) P5_1 Input port (high-impedance) BHE signal output (undefined) P5_2 Input port (high-impedance) RD signal output (“H”)(3) P5_3 Input port (high-impedance) BCLK output(3) P5_4 Input port (high-impedance) HLDA signal output (output level depends on an input level to the HOLD pin)(3) P5_5 Input port (high-impedance) HOLD signal input (high-impedance) P5_6 Input port (high-impedance) “H” signal output(3) P5_7 Input port (high-impedance) RDY signal input (high-impedance) P6 to P15(1) Input port (high-impedance) Input port (high-impedance) Input port (high-impedance) NOTES: 1. Ports P11 to P15 are provided in the 144-pin package only. 2. The availability of the pull-up resistors is undefined until the internal supply voltage stabilizes. 3. These pin states are defined after the power is turned on and the internal supply voltage stabilizes. Until then, the pin states are undefined. 4. EPM (P5_5) must be “H” in the flash memory version. 5.2 Software Reset When the PM03 bit in the PM0 register is set to 1 (MCU is reset), the MCU resets the CPU, SFRs, ports, and I/O pins for peripheral functions. And then the MCU executes a program in an address indicated by the reset vector. Set the PM03 bit to 1 while the main clock is selected as the clock source for the CPU clock and the main clock oscillation is stable. The software reset does not reset the following SFRs; bits PM01 and PM00 in the PM0 register, and the TCSPR register. Processor mode remains unchanged since bits PM01 and PM00 are not reset. 5.3 Watchdog Timer Reset When the CM06 bit in the CM0 register is set to 1 (reset) and the watchdog timer underflows, the MCU resets the CPU, SFRs, ports, and I/O pins for peripheral functions. And then the MCU executes a program in an address indicated by the reset vector. The watchdog timer reset does not reset the following SFRs; bits PM01 and PM00 in the PM0 register, and the TCSPR register. Processor mode remains unchanged since bits PM01 and PM00 are not reset. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 35 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 5.4 5. Reset Internal Registers Figure 5.3 shows CPU register states after reset. Refer to 4. Special Function Registers (SFRs) for SFR states after reset. 0: 0 after reset X: Undefined after reset General registers High-speed interrupt registers b15 b0 b15 Flag register (FLG) b15 b8 b7 b0 X 0 0 0 X X X X 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 U I O B S Z D C IPL b15 b0 XXXXh b23 Flag save register (SVF) XXXXXXh PC save register (SVP) XXXXXXh Vector register (VCT) DMAC-associated registers b0 00h R0H 00h R0L Data register (R0H/R0L) 00h R1H 00h R1L Data register (R1H/R1L) b7 b0 00h DMA mode register (DMD0) 00h DMA mode register (DMD1) 0000h R2 Data register (R2) 0000h R3 Data register (R3) XXXXh DMA transfer count register (DCT0) 000000h A0 Address register (A0) XXXXh DMA transfer count register (DCT1) 000000h A1 Address register (A1) XXXXh DMA transfer count reload register (DRC0) 000000h SB Static base register (SB) XXXXh DMA transfer count reload register (DRC1) b23 000000h FB Frame base register (FB) b15 b23 XXXXXXh DMA memory address register (DMA0) XXXXXXh DMA memory address register (DMA1) 000000h User stack pointer (USP) XXXXXXh DMA memory address reload register (DRA0) 000000h Interrupt stack pointer (ISP) XXXXXXh DMA memory address reload register (DRA1) Interrupt table register (INTB) XXXXXXh DMA SFR address register (DSA0) Program counter (PC) XXXXXXh DMA SFR address register (DSA1) 000000h Contents of addresses FFFFFEh to FFFFFCh Figure 5.3 CPU Register States after Reset REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 36 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 6. 6. Power Supply Voltage Monitor Function Power Supply Voltage Monitor Function The power supply voltage monitor function detects the changes in voltage and triggers the interrupts. Figure 6.1 shows a block diagram of the voltage monitor function. Figures 6.2 and 6.3 show registers associated with the function. VCC1 Voltage Monitor Function R1 VDEN bit + R2 LVDIEN bit Vdet detection signal(1) ≥ Vdet RVC3 to RVC0 Voltage monitor interrupt signal Edge generation circuit VMF flag LVDF flag Watchdog timer interrupt request Oscillation stop detection interrupt signal Watchdog timer interrupt signal VDEN bit, LVDIEN bit, LVDF flag, and VMF flag: Bits in the LVDC register RVC3 to RVC0: Bits in the DVCR register NOTE: 1. When the VDEN bit in the LVDC register is set to 0, (Voltage monitor function not used), Vdet detection signal becomes “H” and the VMF bit becomes 1. Figure 6.1 Power Supply Voltage Monitor Function Block Diagram Voltage Monitor Register(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 Symbol LVDC Address 001Bh After Reset 0000 1000b Bit Symbol Bit Name VDEN Voltage monitor function select bit(2) 0: Voltage monitor function not used 1: Voltage monitor function used RW Voltage monitor interrupt enable bit 0: Voltage monitor interrupt disabled 1: Voltage monitor interrupt enabled RW LVDF Voltage change detect flag(3)(4) 0: Not detected 1: Voltage crosses Vdet RW VMF Voltage change monitor flag (3) 0: VCC1 < Vdet (F) 1: VCC1 ≥ Vdet (R) RO Reserved bits Set to 0 RW LVDIEN − (b7-b4) Function NOTES: 1. Set the LVDC register after setting the PRC3 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). 2. Wait for td(E-A) to elapse after the VDEN bit is set to 1 to use the voltage monitor function. To set the LVDIEN bit to 1, wait for td(E-A) to elapse after the VDEN bit is set to 1. 3. Bits LVDF and VMF are enabled when the VDEN bit is 1. When the VDEN bit is 0, the LVDF bit becomes 0 and the VMF bit becomes 1. 4. The LVDF bit can be set to 0 by a program. Writing a 1 has no effect. Figure 6.2 LVDC Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 37 of 385 RW Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 6. Power Supply Voltage Monitor Function Reference Voltage Configuration Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 Symbol DVCR Address 0017h Bit Symbol After Reset 1000 1111b Bit Name Function b3 b2 b1 b0 RVC0 RVC1 Reference voltage select bits (2) RVC2 RVC3 − (b6-b4) − (b7) RW 0 0 0 0 : 3.80 V 0 0 0 1 : 3.65 V 0 0 1 0 : 3.50 V 0 0 1 1 : 3.35 V 0 1 0 0 : 3.20 V 1 0 1 1 : 4.55 V 1 1 0 0 : 4.40 V 1 1 0 1 : 4.25 V 1 1 1 0 : 4.10 V 1 1 1 1 : 3.95 V Do not set to the value other than the above. Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. Reserved bit RW RW RW RW − Set to 1 RW NOTES: 1. Set the DVCR register after setting the PRC3 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable) while the VDEN bit in the LVDC register is 0 (Voltage monitor function not used). 2. The detection voltage levels of Vdet(F) and Vdet(R) lists as below. Figure 6.3 Bits RVC3 to RVC0 Reference voltage Detection voltage level (Voltage drops) Vdet(F) Detection voltage level (Voltage rises) Vdet(R) 1011b 4.55V 4.55V 4.77V 1100b 4.40V 4.40V 4.62V 1101b 4.25V 4.25V 4.47V 1110b 4.10V 4.10V 4.32V 1111b 3.95V 3.95V 4.17V 0000b 3.80V 3.80V 4.02V 0001b 3.65V 3.65V 3.87V 0010b 3.50V 3.50V 3.72V 0011b 3.35V 3.35V 3.57V 0100b 3.20V 3.20V 3.42V DVCR Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 38 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 6.1 6. Power Supply Voltage Monitor Function Operation of Voltage Monitor Function When the VDEN bit in the LVDC register is set to 1 (voltage monitor function used), the voltage monitor function can be used after td(E-A) has elapsed. When the voltage applied to the VCC1 pin has dropped below Vdet(F), the VMF bit in the LVDC register becomes 0 (VCC1 < Vdet(F)) and the LVDF bit in the LVDC register becomes 1 (voltage crosses Vdet). When the voltage applied to the VCC1 pin has risen above Vdet(R), the VMF bit becomes 1 (VCC1 ≥ Vdet(R)) and the LVDF bit becomes 1. If the LVDIEN bit in the LVDC register is 1 (voltage monitor interrupt enabled), when the value of the VMF bit is changed, the LVDF bit becomes 1 and a voltage monitor interrupt request is generated. The LVDF bit does not automatically become 0 when an interrupt request is acknowledged. Set it to 0 by a program. Whether the voltage has dropped below Vdet(F) or risen above Vdet(R) can be determined by reading the VMF bit. The voltage monitor interrupt shares the same interrupt vector with watchdog timer interrupt and oscillation stop detection interrupt. When using the voltage monitor interrupt simultaneously with these interrupts, determine whether the voltage monitor interrupt is generated by reading the LVDF bit in the interrupt routine. Figure 6.4 shows a voltage monitor function operation example. Voltage applied to VCC1 (V) Vdet(R) Vdet(F) 3.0 Time RESET VDEN bit “H” “L” (Note 1) 1 0 td(E-A): Wait time to stablize circuit LVDIEN bit 1 0 VMF bit 1 0 LVDF bit 1 0 Set to 0 by a program Voltage monitor interrupt request “H” signal from LVDF bit “L” VDEN bit, LVDIEN bit, LVDF bit, and VMF bit: Bits in the LVDC register NOTE: 1. Apply an "L" to the RESET pin when the voltage input to the VCC1 pin drops to 3.0 V or below. After the voltage rises above 3.0 V, and the voltage of the main voltage regulator and the main clock oscillation stabilize, apply an "H" to the RESET pin. Figure 6.4 Voltage Monitor Function Operation Example REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 39 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 7. 7. Processor Mode Processor Mode 7.1 Processor Mode Single-chip mode, memory expansion mode, microprocessor mode, or boot mode can be selected as the processor mode. Table 7.1 lists the features of the processor mode. Table 7.1 Processor Mode Features Processor Mode Single-chip mode Accessible Space Pins assigned to I/O Port SFR, internal RAM, internal ROM (user ROM area) Used as I/O ports or I/O pins for peripheral functions Memory expansion mode(1) SFR, internal RAM, internal ROM (user ROM area), external space P0 to P5 become bus control pins Microprocessor mode(1) SFR, internal RAM, external space P0 to P5 become bus control pins SFR, internal RAM, internal ROM (boot ROM area) Used as I/O ports or I/O pins for peripheral functions Boot mode(2) NOTES: 1. Refer to 8. Bus for details. 2. Refer to 25. Flash Memory for details. 7.2 Setting of Processor Mode The CNVSS pin, EPM(P5_5) pin, and bits PM01 and PM00 in the PM0 register determine which processor mode to select. Table 7.2 lists processor mode after hardware reset. Table 7.3 lists the processor mode selected by bits PM01 and PM00. Table 7.2 Processor Mode after Hardware Reset Input to mode entry pins Chip Type Processor Mode CNVSS pin EPM(P5_5) L H or L Flash memory version Single-chip mode H H(1) Flash memory version, ROMless version Microprocessor mode H L Flash memory version Boot mode NOTE: 1. P5_5 functions as the HOLD pin after reset. Table 7.3 PM01 and PM00 Bits Setting and Processor Mode Bits PM01 and PM00 Processor Mode 00b Single-chip mode 01b Memory expansion mode 11b Microprocessor mode Rewriting bits PM01 and PM00 in the PM0 register places the MCU in the corresponding processor mode regardless of the CNVSS input level. When using memory expansion mode or microprocessor mode, first set bits PM02, PM05 and PM04, and PM07 in the PM0 register, and also set bits PM11 and PM10, PM15 and PM14 in the PM1 register. Then, set bits PM01 and PM00. Do not enter microprocessor mode while the CPU is executing the program in the internal ROM. Do not enter single-chip mode from microprocessor mode while the CPU is executing the program in an external space. The internal ROM cannot be accessed regardless of the PM01 and PM00 bits setting if the MCU starts up in microprocessor mode after reset. Figures 7.1 and 7.2 show the PM0 register and PM1 register. Figure 7.3 shows a memory map in each processor mode. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 40 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 7. Processor Mode Processor Mode Register 0(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol Address After Reset PM0 0004h 1000 0000b (CNVSS = “L”) 0000 0011b (CNVSS = “H”) Bit Symbol Bit Name Function b1 b0 PM00 Processor mode bits(2, 3) PM01 0 0: Single-chip mode 0 1: Memory expansion mode 1 0: Do not set to this value 1 1: Microprocessor mode RW RW RW PM02 R/W mode select bit 0: RD/BHE/WR 1: RD/WRH/WRL RW PM03 Software reset bit The MCU is reset when this bit is set to 1. Read as 0. RW b5 b4 PM04 Multiplexed bus space select bits(4) PM05 − (b6) PM07 0 0: Multiplexed bus is not used 0 1: Access the CS2 area using multiplexed bus 1 0: Access the CS1 area using multiplexed bus 1 1: Access all CS areas using multiplexed bus RW RW Reserved bit Set to 0 RW BCLK output function select bit 0: BCLK output (5) 1: No BCLK output RW NOTES: 1. Set the PM0 register after the PRC1 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). 2. Bits PM01 and PM00 maintain values set before reset, even after software reset or watchdog timer reset has performed. 3. When using memory expansion mode or microprocessor mode, first set bits PM02, PM05 and PM04, and PM07 in the PM0 register, and also set bits PM11 and PM10, PM15 and PM14 in the PM1 register. Then, set bits PM01 and PM00. 4. The PM05 and PM04 bits setting is enabled in memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode. Set these bits in the combination with bits PM11 and PM10 in the PM 1 register. Do not set bits PM05 and PM04 to 11b in microprocessor mode since the MCU starts up with the separate bus after reset. Refer to the Table “Multiplexed Bus Settings and Chip-Select Areas” in the Bus chapter. 5. No BCLK is output in single-chip mode even if the PM07 bit is set to 0. To output BCLK from P5_3 in memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode, set the PM07 bit to 0, bits CM01 and CM00 in the CM0 register to “00b” (I/O port P5_3), and bits PM15 and PM14 in the PM1 register to 00b, 10b, or 11b. Figure 7.1 PM0 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 41 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 7. Processor Mode Processor Mode Register 1(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 Symbol PM1 Address 0005h Bit Symbol Bit Name After Reset 00h Function RW 0 0: Mode 0 (A20 to A23 for P4_4 to P4_7) 0 1: Mode 1 (A20 for P4_4, CS2 to CS0 for P4_5 to P4_7) 1 0: Mode 2 (A20 and A21 for P4_4 and P4_5, CS1 and CS0 for P4_6 and P4_7) 1 1: Mode 3 (CS3 to CS0 for P4_4 to P4_7) RW b1 b0 PM10 External space mode bits PM11 (2) RW PM12 Internal memory wait bit 0: No wait state 1: 1 wait state RW PM13 SFR area wait bit 0: 1 wait state 1: 2 wait states RW b5 b4 RW PM14 ALE pin select PM15 − (b7-b6) Reserved bits bits(2) 0 0: No ALE 0 1: P5_3(3) 1 0: P5_6 1 1: P5_4 Set to 0 RW RW NOTES: 1. Set the PM1 register after the PRC1 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). 2. The PM11 and PM10 bits settings are enabled in memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode. Set bits PM01 and PM00 after setting bits PM15 and PM14, and bits PM11 and PM10. 3. To output ALE signal from P5_3, set bits PM15 and PM14 to 01b, and bits CM01 and CM00 in the CM0 register to 00b (I/O port P5_3). Figure 7.2 PM1 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 42 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 7. Processor Mode Single-chip mode 000000h 000400h 00E000h 00F000h Memory expansion mode Mode 0 Mode 1 Mode 2 SFR SFR SFR SFR SFR Internal RAM Internal RAM Internal RAM Internal RAM Internal RAM Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Block B(3) Block B(3) Block B(3) Block B(3) Block B(3) Block A(3) Block A(3) Block A(3) Block A(3) Block A(3) External space 0 CS1 2-Mbyte external space 0(1) Mode 3 010000h 100000h 200000h 300000h External space 1 CS2 2-Mbyte external space 1 External space 2 Not used External space 3 CS0 2-Mbyte external space 3 Not used CS1 4-Mbyte external space 0(2) CS1 1-Mbyte external space 0 CS2 1-Mbyte external space 1 400000h Not used Not used Not used C00000h D00000h E00000h CS3 1-Mbyte external space 2 CS0 3-Mbyte external space 3 CS0 1-Mbyte external space 3 Not used F00000h FFFFFFh Internal ROM Not used Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved Internal ROM Internal ROM Internal ROM Internal ROM Microprocessor mode Mode 0 000000h 000400h Mode 1 Mode 2 Mode 3 SFR SFR SFR SFR Internal RAM Internal RAM Internal RAM Internal RAM Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved External space 0 CS1 2-Mbyte external space 0(1) 010000h 100000h CS area controlled by the EWCRi register (i = 0 to 3): CS0 controlled by EWCR3 CS1 controlled by EWCR0 CS2 controlled by EWCR1 CS3 controlled by EWCR2 200000h 300000h External space 1 CS2 2-Mbyte external space 1 External space 2 Not used Not used CS1 4-Mbyte external space 0(2) CS1 1-Mbyte external space 0 CS2 1-Mbyte external space 1 400000h NOTES: 1. 200000h to 010000h = 1984 Kbytes. 64K bytes less than 2 Mbytes. 2. 400000h to 010000h = 4032 Kbytes. 64K bytes less than 4 Mbytes. 3. Additional two 4-Kbyte blocks are provided in the flash memory version to store data. Not used C00000h D00000h E00000h CS3 1-Mbyte external space 2 Not used External space 3 F00000h CS0 2-Mbyte external space 3 FFFFFFh Figure 7.3 Not used Memory Map in Each Processor Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 43 of 385 CS0 4-Mbyte external space 3 Not used CS0 1-Mbyte external space 3 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8. 8. Bus Bus In memory expansion mode or microprocessor mode, the following pins become bus control pins: D0 to D15, A0 to A22, A23, CS0 to CS3, WRL/WR, WRH/BHE, RD, CLKOUT/BCLK/ALE, HLDA/ALE, HOLD, ALE, and RDY. 8.1 Bus Settings Bus setting is determined by the BYTE pin, the DS register, bits PM05 and PM04 in the PM0 register, and bits PM11 and PM10 in the PM1 register. Table 8.1 lists bus settings. Figure 8.1 shows the DS register. Table 8.1 Bus Settings Bus Setting Pin & Registers Used for Setting Selecting external data bus width DS register Setting bus width after reset BYTE pin (for external space 3 only) Selecting separate bus or multiplexed bus Bits PM05 and PM04 in the PM0 register Number of chip-select pins Bits PM11 and PM10 in the PM1 register External Data Bus Width Control Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol DS Address 000Bh Bit Symbol Function RW DS0 External space 0 data bus width select bit 0: 8 bits wide 1: 16 bits wide RW DS1 External space 1 data bus width select bit 0: 8 bits wide 1: 16 bits wide RW DS2 External space 2 data bus width select bit 0: 8 bits wide 1: 16 bits wide RW DS3 External space 3 data bus width select bit 0: 8 bits wide 1: 16 bits wide RW − (b7-b4) Figure 8.1 Bit Name After Reset XXXX 1000b (BYTE pin = "L") XXXX 0000b (BYTE pin = "H") Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. DS Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 44 of 385 − Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8.1.1 8. Bus Selecting External Address Bus The number of external address bus pins, the number of chip-select pins, and chip-select-assigned address space (CS area) vary in each external space mode. Bits PM11 and PM10 in the PM1 register select external space mode. 8.1.2 Selecting External Data Bus The DS register selects either external 8-bit data bus or 16-bit data bus per each external space. The data bus in the external space 3 becomes 16 bits wide when a low-level (“L”) signal is applied to the BYTE pin after reset, and 8 bits wide when a high-level (“H”) signal is applied. Do not change the BYTE pin level while the MCU is operating. Internal bus is always 16 bits wide. 8.1.3 Selecting Separate Bus/Multiplexed Bus Bits PM05 and PM04 in the PM0 register select either the separate bus or multiplexed bus. The MCU starts up with the separate bus after reset. 8.1.3.1 Separate Bus With the separate bus format, the MCU performs data input/output and address output using individual buses. The DS register selects 8-bit or 16-bit external data bus for each external space. If all DSi bits in the DS register (i = 0 to 3) are set to 0 (8-bit data bus), port P0 functions as the data bus and port P1 as the programmable I/O port. If any of the DSi bits is set to 1 (16-bit data bus), ports P0 and P1 function as the data bus. Port P1 output is undefined when the MCU accesses the space where its DSi bit is set to 0. 8.1.3.2 Multiplexed Bus With the multiplexed bus format, the MCU performs data input/output and address output using the same bus by time-sharing. D0 to D7 are time-multiplexed with A0 to A7 in the space accessed by the 8-bit data bus. D0 to D15 are time-multiplexed with A0 to A15 in the space accessed by the 16-bit data bus. When bits PM05 and PM04 in the PM0 register are set to 11b (access all CS area using multiplexed bus), address bus has only 16 bits using A0 to A15. In this case, the accessible space is 64 Kbytes per each chip-select output. Refer to Table 8.3 Processor Mode and Pin Function for details. Table 8.2 lists multiplexed bus settings and chip-select areas. Table 8.2 Multiplexed Bus Settings and Chip-Select Areas PM11 and PM10 Bits Setting PM05 and PM04 bits setting 00b (external space mode 0 01b (external space mode 1) 00b (multiplexed bus not used) 11b (external space mode 3) Separate bus 01b (access the CS2 area using multiplexed bus) 10b (access the CS1 area using multiplexed bus) 10b (external space mode 2) CS2 Do not set to this value CS2 CS1 CS1 CS1 CS0 CS1 CS2 CS0 CS1 CS0 CS1 CS2 CS3 Do not set to these values 11b (access the all CS areas using multiplexed bus)(1) NOTE: 1. In microprocessor mode, do not set bits PM05 and PM04 in the PM0 register to 11b (access all CS areas using multiplexed bus). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 45 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 8.3 Processor Mode 8. Bus Processor Mode and Pin Function Single-chip Mode Memory Expansion Mode/Microprocessor Mode Memory Expansion Mode PM05 and PM04 bits setting(1) 00b (Multiplexed bus not used) 01b (Access CS2 area using multiplexed bus) 10b (Access CS1 area using multiplexed bus) 11b (Access all CS areas using multiplexed bus) Data bus width Access all external spaces with 8-bit data bus Access all external spaces with 8-bit data bus Access any external spaces with 16-bit data bus Access all external spaces with 8-bit data bus P0_0 to P0_7 Data bus (D0 to D7) I/O port Data bus (D8 to D15) I/O port P1_0 to P1_7 I/O port P2_0 to P2_7 P3_0 to P3_7 Access any external spaces with 16-bit data bus Data bus (D8 to D15) Address bus (A0 to A7) I/O port Address bus (A8 to A15) Address bus/data bus (A0/D0 to A7/D7)(2) Address bus/ Address bus (A8 to A15) data bus (A8/D8 to A15/D15)(2) P4_0 to P4_3 Address Bus (A16 to A19) P4_4 to P4_6 CS or address bus (A20 to A22) (Refer to 8.2 Bus Control for details)(6) P4_7 CS or address bus (A23) (Refer to 8.2 Bus Control for details)(6) P5_0 to P5_2 RD, WRL, WRH outputs or RD, BHE, WR outputs (Refer to 8.2 Bus Control for details)(4) P5_3 I/O port/ CLKOUT CLKOUT/BCLK/ALE(7) P5_4 I/O port HLDA/ALE(3) P5_5 HOLD P5_6 ALE(3)(5) P5_7 RDY Access any external spaces with 16-bit data bus Address bus/ data bus (A8/D8 to A15/D15)(2) I/O port NOTES: 1. Do not set bits PM05 and PM04 in the PM0 register to 11b (access all CS areas using multiplexed bus) in microprocessor mode since the MCU starts up with the separate bus after reset. When bits PM05 and PM04 are set to 11b in memory expansion mode, the accessible space is 64-Kbyte per each chip-select output. 2. These pins are used as address bus when selecting separate bus. 3. Bits PM15 and PM14 in the PM1 register determine which pin is used to output the ALE signal. 4. The PM02 bit in the PM0 register selects either combination, “RD, WRL, WRH” or “RD, BHE, WR”. 5. P5_6 outputs undefined value when bits PM15 and PM14 are set to 00b (no ALE). In this case, it cannot be used as an I/O port. 6. Bits PM11 and PM10 in the PM1 register determine whether these pins are used as chip-select outputs or address bus. 7. Use bits CM01 and CM00 in the CM0 register, bits PM15 and PM14 in the PM1 register, and the PM07 bit in the PM0 register to select among CLKOUT, BCLK, and ALE function. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 46 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8.2 8. Bus Bus Control Described below are the signals required to access external devices and the bus timing. The signals are available in memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode only. 8.2.1 Address Bus and Data Bus Address bus is the signals to access 16-Mbyte space, and consists of 24 control pins; A0 to A22 and A23. A23 is an inverse output signal of the highest-order address bit. Data bus is the signals for data input and output. The DS register selects either an 8-bit data bus width from D0 to D7 or a 16-bit data bus width from D0 to D15 for each external space. When a high-level (“H”) signal is applied to the BYTE pin, the data bus accessing the external space 3 is 8 bits wide after reset. When a low-level (“L”) signal is applied to the BYTE pin, the data bus accessing the external space 3 is 16 bits wide. When changing single-chip mode to memory expansion mode, the address bus value is undefined until the MCU accesses an external space. 8.2.2 Chip-Select Output Chip-select outputs share pins with address bus, A20 to A22 and A23. Bits PM11 and PM10 in the PM1 register determine the CS areas to be accessed and the number of chip-select outputs. Maximum of four chip-select outputs are provided. In microprocessor mode, no chip-select signal is output after reset. Only A23, however, can perform as a chipselect output. The CSi pin (i = 0 to 3) outputs an “L” signal while accessing its corresponding external space. An “H” signal is output while the MCU is accessing other external spaces. Figure 8.2 shows an example of address bus and chipselect outputs (separate bus). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 47 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8. Bus Example 1: After accessing the external space, both address bus and chip-select output change Example 2: After accessing an external space, the chip-select output changes but the address bus does not. When the MCU accesses the external space j specified by another chip-select output in the next cycle after having accessed the external space i, both address bus and chip-select output change. When the MCU accesses SFR or internal ROM/ RAM area in the next cycle after having accessed an external space, the chip-select signal changes but the address bus does not. Access Access another external external space j space i Data bus Data Address bus Address Access external space Data bus Data Address bus Chip-select: CSk Access SFR, internal ROM/ RAM Data Address Chip-select: CSk Chip-select: CSp Example 3: After accessing the external space, the address bus changes but the chip-select output does not. Example 4: After accessing an external space, neither address bus nor chip-select signal changes. When the MCU accesses the space i specified by the same chip-select output in the next cycle after having accessed the external space i, the address bus changes but the chip-select output does not. When the MCU does not access any spaces in the next cycle after having accessed an external space (no instruction prefetch is performed), neither address bus nor chip-select signal changes. Access Access the same external external space i space i Data bus Data Address bus Address Data bus Data Chip-select: CSk i = 0 to 3 j = 0 to 3, excluding i k = 0 to 3 p = 0 to 3, excluding k Access external space Address bus Data Address Chip-select: CSk NOTE: 1. The above examples show the address bus and chip-select output in two consecutive bus cycles. Depending on the combination, the chip-select signal can be more than two bus cycles. CS1 outputs an "L" signal while accessing the external space 0. CS2 outputs an "L" signal while accessing the external space 1. CS3 outputs an "L" signal while accessing the external space 2. CS0 outputs an "L" signal while accessing the external space 3. Figure 8.2 No accesss to external space Address Bus and Chip-Select Outputs (Separate Bus) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 48 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8.2.3 8. Bus Read/Write Output Signals When using a 16-bit data bus, the PM02 bit in the PM0 register selects either a combination of the “RD, WR, and BHE” outputs or the “RD, WRL, and WRH” outputs to determine the read/write output signals. When bits DS3 to DS0 in the DS register are set to 0 (8-bit external data bus width), set the PM02 bit to 0 (RD/WR/BHE). When any of bits DS3 to DS0 is set to 1 (16-bit external data bus width) to access an 8-bit space, the combination of “RD, WR, and BHE” is automatically selected regardless of the PM02 bit setting. Table 8.4 lists RD, WRL, and WRH outputs. Table 8.5 list RD, WR, and BHE outputs. The RD, WR, and BHE outputs are selected for the read/write output signals after reset. When changing to “RD, WRL, and WRH” outputs, set the PM02 bit first to write data to an external memory. Table 8.4 Data Bus Width 16 bits 8 bits RD, WRL, and WRH Outputs RD WRL WRH A0 CPU Processing on External Space L H H Not used Read data H L H Not used Write 1-byte data to even address H H L Not used Write 1-byte data to odd address H L L Not used Write data to both even and odd addresses H L(1) Not used H/L Write 1-byte data L H(1) Not used H/L Read 1-byte data NOTE: 1. These become WR output. Table 8.5 Data Bus Width 16 bits 8 bits RD, WR, and BHE Outputs RD WR BHE A0 H L L H Write 1-byte data to odd address L H L H Read 1-byte data from odd address H L H L Write 1-byte data to even address L H H L Read 1-byte data from even address H L L L Write data to both even and odd addresses L H L L Read data from both even and odd addresses H L Not used H/L Write 1-byte data L H Not used H/L Read 1-byte data REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 49 of 385 CPU Processing on External Space Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8.2.4 8. Bus Bus Timing Software wait states for the internal ROM and internal RAM can be set using the PM12 bit in the PM1 register, for the SFR area using the PM13 bit, and for external spaces using the EWCRi register (i = 0 to 3). Table 8.6 lists a software wait state and bus cycle. The basic bus cycle for the internal ROM, internal RAM, and SFR area is one bus clock (BCLK) cycle. A read from the internal ROM takes the basic bus cycle. A read or write to the internal RAM takes the basic bus cycle. When the PM12 bit in the PM1 register to 1 (1 wait state), an access to the internal ROM or internal RAM takes two BCLK cycles. A read or write to the SFR area takes two BCLK cycles (1 wait state). When the PM13 bit in the PM1 register is set to 1 (2 wait states), an access takes three BCLK cycles. The external bus cycle is divided into two phases: the number of BCLK cycles in the period from the beginning of the bus access until the read or write output signal becomes “L” (first φ), and the number of BCLK cycles in the period from the read or write output signal becomes “L” until the signal changes to “H” (second φ). The minimum read or write cycle for the external bus is two BCLK cycles (1 φ + 1 φ). The EWCRi register (i = 0 to 3) selects an external bus cycle from 12 types for the separate bus and seven types for the multiplexed bus. For example, when bits EWCRi4 to EWCRi0 in the EWCRi register are set to 00011b (1 φ + 3 φ), the external bus cycle is four BCLK cycles. Figure 8.3 shows the EWCRi register. Figures 8.4 to 8.8 show external bus timings. External Space Wait Control Register i (i = 0 to 3) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol EWCR0 to EWCR3 Bit Symbol Address 0048h, 0049h, 004Ah, 004Bh Bit Name Function b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 (1) EWCRi0 EWCRi1 EWCRi2 Bus cycle select bits (3) EWCRi3 EWCRi4 − (b5) EWCRi6 − (b7) After Reset X0X0 0011b (2) 0 0 0 0 1: 1 φ + 1 φ 0 0 0 1 0: 1 φ + 2 φ 0 0 0 1 1: 1 φ + 3 φ 0 0 1 0 0: 1 φ + 4 φ 0 0 1 0 1: 1 φ + 5 φ 0 0 1 1 0: 1 φ + 6 φ 0 1 0 1 0: 2 φ + 2 φ 0 1 0 1 1: 2 φ + 3 φ 0 1 1 0 0: 2 φ + 4 φ 0 1 1 0 1: 2 φ + 5 φ 1 0 0 1 1: 3 φ + 3 φ 1 0 1 0 0: 3 φ + 4 φ 1 0 1 0 1: 3 φ + 5 φ 1 0 1 1 0: 3 φ + 6 φ Do not set to values other than the above Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. Recovery cycle insert select bit Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. RW RW RW RW RW RW − 0: Insert no recovery cycle when accessing external space i 1: Insert a recovery cycle when accessing external space i RW − NOTES: 1. The number of BCLK cycles in the period from the beginning of the bus access until the read or write output signal becomes "L". 2. The number of BCLK cycles in the period from the read or write output signal becomes "L" until the signal changes to "H". Figure 8.3 EWCR0 to EWCR3 Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 50 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 8.6 8. Bus Software Wait State and Bus Cycle EWCRi Register (i=0 to 3) PM1 Register Space External Bus Status PM13 Bit SFR area − Internal ROM/ RAM − Separate bus 0 1 − − PM12 Bit Bits EWCRi4 to EWCRi0 − − 0 1 − External memory Multiplexed bus REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 51 of 385 − − − Bus Cycle 2 BCLK cycles 3 BCLK cycles 1 BCLK cycle 2 BCLK cycles 00001b 2 BCLK cycles 00010b 3 BCLK cycles 00011b 4 BCLK cycles 00100b 5 BCLK cycles 00101b 6 BCLK cycles 00110b 7 BCLK cycles 01010b 4 BCLK cycles 01011b 5 BCLK cycles 01100b 6 BCLK cycles 10011b 6 BCLK cycles 10100b 7 BCLK cycles 10110b 9 BCLK cycles 01010b 4 BCLK cycles 01011b 5 BCLK cycles 01101b 7 BCLK cycles 10011b 6 BCLK cycles 10100b 7 BCLK cycles 10101b 8 BCLK cycles 10110b 9 BCLK cycles Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8. Bus • Bus cycle 1 φ + 1 φ • Bus cycle 1 φ + 2 φ 1 bus cycle = 2 φ 1 bus cycle = 3 φ BCLK BCLK Address Address CSi (Note 1) CSi Read data Read data RD RD Write data Write data WR, WRL, WRH WR, WRL, WRH • Bus cycle 1 φ + 3 φ (Note 1) • Bus cycle 1 φ + 4 φ 1 bus cycle = 4 φ 1 bus cycle = 5 φ BCLK BCLK Address Address CSi CSi (Note 1) Read data Read data RD RD Write data Write data WR, WRL, WRH WR, WRL, WRH • Bus cycle 1 φ + 5 φ (Note 1) • Bus cycle 1 φ + 6 φ 1 bus cycle = 6 φ 1 bus cycle = 7 φ BCLK BCLK Address Address CSi (Note 1) CSi Read data Read data RD RD Write data Write data WR, WRL, WRH WR, WRL, WRH i = 0 to 3 NOTE: 1. When the MCU accesses the same CS area consecutively, the CSi pin keeps outputting "L". Figure 8.4 Bus Cycles when Separate Bus is Selected (1/3) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 52 of 385 (Note 1) Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8. Bus • Bus cycle 2 φ + 2 φ • Bus cycle 2 φ + 3 φ 1 bus cycle = 4 φ 1 bus cycle = 5 φ BCLK BCLK Address Address CSi CSi (Note 1) Read data Read data RD RD Write data Write data WR, WRL, WRH WR, WRL, WRH • Bus cycle 2 φ + 4 φ 1 bus cycle = 6 φ BCLK Address CSi (Note 1) Read data RD Write data WR, WRL, WRH i = 0 to 3 NOTE: 1. When the MCU accesses the same CS area consecutively, the CSi pin keeps outputting "L". Figure 8.5 Bus Cycles when Separate Bus is Selected (2/3) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 53 of 385 (Note 1) Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8. Bus • Bus cycle 3 φ + 3 φ 1 bus cycle = 6 φ BCLK Address (Note 1) CSi Read data RD Write data WR, WRL, WRH • Bus cycle 3 φ + 4 φ 1 bus cycle = 7 φ BCLK Address CSi (Note 1) Read data RD Write data WR, WRL, WRH • Bus cycle 3 φ + 6 φ 1 bus cycle = 9 φ BCLK Address CSi (Note 1) Read data RD Write data WR, WRL, WRH i = 0 to 3 NOTE: 1. When the MCU accesses the same CS area consecutively, the CSi pin keeps outputting "L". Figure 8.6 Bus Cycle with Separate Bus is Selected (3/3) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 54 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8. Bus • Bus cycle 2 φ + 2 φ • Bus cycle 2 φ + 3 φ 1 bus cycle = 4 φ 1 bus cycle = 5 φ BCLK BCLK CSi CSi (Note 1) LA Read data RD Read data RD LA RD RD LA Write data WD Write data WR (WRL) WR (WRL) ALE ALE • Bus cycle 2 φ + 5 φ 1 bus cycle = 7 φ BCLK (Note 1) CSi LA Read data RD RD LA Write data WD WR (WRL) ALE • Bus cycle 3 φ + 3 φ 1 bus cycle = 6 φ BCLK CSi (Note 1) LA Read data RD RD LA Write data WD WR (WRL) ALE LA: Latch address RD: Read data WD: Write data i=0 to 3 NOTE: 1. When the MCU accesses the same CS area consecutively, the CSi pin keeps outputting "L". Figure 8.7 (Note 1) Bus Cycles when Multiplexed Bus is Selected (1/2) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 55 of 385 LA WD Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8. Bus • Bus cycle 3 φ + 4 φ 1 bus cycle = 7 φ BCLK (Note 1) CSi Read data LA RD RD Write data LA WD WR (WRL) ALE • Bus cycle 3 φ + 5 φ 1 bus cycle = 8 φ BCLK (Note 1) CSi Read data LA RD RD Write data LA WD WR (WRL) ALE • Bus cycle 3 φ + 6 φ 1 bus cycle = 9 φ BCLK (Note 1) CSi Read data LA RD RD Write data LA WD WR (WRL) ALE LA: Latch address RD: Read data WD: Write data i = 0 to 3 NOTE: 1. When the MCU accesses the same CS area consecutively, the CSi pin keeps outputting "L". Figure 8.8 Bus Cycles when Multiplexed Bus is Selected (2/2) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 56 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8.2.4.1 8. Bus Bus Cycle with Recovery Cycle Inserted The EWCRi6 bit in the EWCRi register (i = 0 to 3) determines whether the recovery cycle is inserted or not. Address output or data output is held during the recovery cycle (only when using the separate bus). Devices, which require longer address hold time or data hold time, are connectable. - Recovery cycle when separate bus is selected (bus cycle is 1 φ + 2 φ) Recovery cycle BCLK A Address Address is held CSi (Note 1) Read data RD RD Write data WD Data is held WR, WRL, WRH - Recovery cycle when multiplexed bus is selected (bus cycle is 2 φ + 3 φ) Recovery cycle BCLK (Note 1) CSi LA Read data RD RD LA Write data WD Data is held WR (WRL) ALE A: address LA: Latch address RD: Read data WD: Write data i = 0 to 3 NOTE: 1. When the MCU accesses the same CS area consecutively, the CSi pin keeps outputting "L". Figure 8.9 Recovery Cycle REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 57 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8.2.5 8. Bus ALE Output The ALE output signal is provided for the external devices to latch the address when using the multiplexed bus. Latch the address at the falling edge of the ALE output. Bits PM15 and PM14 in the PM1 register determine to what pin the ALE output is assigned. The ALE signal is output even when accessing the internal space. (1) 8-bit data bus (2) 16-bit data bus ALE A0/D0 to A7/D7 ALE Address Data(1) A8 to A15 Address A16 to A19 Address(2) A20/CS3 A21/CS2 A22/CS1 A23/CS0 Address or CS A0/D0 to A15/D15 Address A16 to A19 A20/CS3 A21/CS2 A22/CS1 A23/CS0 Data(1) Address(2) Address or CS NOTES: 1. A0/D0 to A15/D15 are placed in high-impedance states when read. 2. When the multiplexed bus is selected for all CS areas, A16 to A19 become I/O ports. Figure 8.10 8.2.6 ALE Output and Address/Data Bus RDY Input The RDY signal facilitates access to external devices requiring longer access time. When RDY input is “L” at the falling edge of the last BCLK cycle, wait states are inserted into the bus cycle. Then, when an “H” signal is input to the RDY pin at the falling edge of BCLK, the MCU resumes executing the remaining bus clock. Table 8.7 lists MCU states when placed in wait state by RDY input. Figure 8.11 shows an example of the RD signal that is extended by the RDY signal. Table 8.7 MCU States while “L” is Input to the RDY Pin Item State Clock generation circuits Operating (oscillating) RD, WR, A0 to A22, A23, D0 to D15, CS0 to CS3, ALE, HLDA, programmable I/O ports Maintains the same state as when “L” is input to RDY pin. Internal peripheral circuits Operating REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 58 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8. Bus - Separate bus (bus cycle is 1 φ + 2 φ) - Multiplexed bus (bus cycle is 2 φ + 2 φ) BCLK BCLK CSi(1) CSi(1) RD RD RDY RDY tsu(RDY-BCLK) tsu(RDY-BCLK) Timing to input RDY signal Timing to input RDY signal i = 0 to 3 : Wait states inserted by RDY input tsu(RDY-BCLK): RDY input setup time NOTE: 1. Chip-select output (CSi) may be extended depending on the CPU state such as the instruction queue buffer. Figure 8.11 8.2.7 RD Output Signal Extended by RDY Input HOLD Input The HOLD input signal is used to transfer ownership of the bus from the CPU to external devices. When a lowlevel (“L”) signal is applied to the HOLD pin, the MCU enters a hold state after the bus access in progress is completed. While the HOLD pin is held “L”, the MCU remains in a hold state and the HLDA pin outputs an “L” signal. Table 8.8 lists the MCU states in hold state. Bus is used in the following priority order: HOLD, DMAC, CPU. Table 8.8 MCU States in Hold State Item State Clock generation circuits Operating (oscillating) CPU Stopped Internal peripheral circuits Operating (Watchdog timer is stopped)(1) RD, WR, A0 to A22, A23, D0 to D15, CS0 to CS3, BHE High-impedance HLDA Outputs “L” ALE Outputs “L” Programmable I/O ports Maintains the same state as when “L” is input to HOLD pin. NOTE: 1. When the PM22 bit in the PM2 register is set to 1 (selects the on-chip oscillator clock as count source for the watchdog timer), watchdog timer does not stop. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 59 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8.2.8 8. Bus External Bus States when Accessing Internal Space Table 8.9 lists external bus states when the internal space is accessed. Table 8.9 External Bus States when Accessing Internal Space Item State when Accessing SFR, Internal ROM, and Internal RAM A0 to A22, A23 Hold the last accessed address in the external space D0 to D15 High-impedance RD, WR, WRL, WRH Outputs “H” BHE Holds the output level at the time when the MCU accessed the external space or SFR area for the last time CS Outputs “H” ALE Outputs ALE signal 8.2.9 BCLK Output The bus clock can be output from the BCLK pin in memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode. To output the bus clock, set the PM07 bit in the PM0 register to 0 (BCLK output) and bits CM01 and CM00 in the CM0 register to 00b (I/O port P5_3). No BCLK is output in single-chip mode. Refer to 9. Clock Generation Circuits for details. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 60 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8.3 8. Bus Page Mode Control Function NOTE The page mode control function is available only in the ROMless version. The page mode control function allows high-speed read access to the external memory compatible with the page mode control. While the MCU accesses data within the eight-byte block of consecutive addresses which have the same 21 high-order bits, less cycles are taken for the subsequent bus read accesses to a maximum of seven-byte addresses than the first bus access. The EWCRi register (i = 0 to 3) determines how many wait states are inserted for the first bus access. Registers PWCR0 and PWCR1 determine how many wait states are inserted for the subsequent bus accesses. Use the following procedure to enable the page mode control. (1) Set bits EWCRi4 to EWCRi0 in the EWCRi register. (2) Set bits PWCRj02 to PWCRj00 and bits PWCRj06 to PWCRj04 in the PWCRj register (j = 0, 1). (3) Set bits PWCRj03 and PWCRj07 to 1 (page mode control enabled). When using the page mode control function, access all the external spaces using page mode control. It is not allowed to combine the page mode controlled access and the normal access to external spaces. Set bits PM05 and PM04 to 00b (multiplexed bus is not used). The page mode control function and multiplexed bus cannot be used at the same time. Figure 8.12 and 8.13 show registers PWCR0 and PWCR1. Figure 8.14 shows a diagram of external bus timing with page mode function. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 61 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8. Bus Page Mode Wait Control Register 0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset PWCR0 004Ch 0001 0001b Bit Symbol Bit Name PWCR000 PWCR001 External space 0 subsequent access wait select bits External space 0 page mode control enable bit PWCR004 PWCR005 0 1 1 0 1: 1 0: 1 1: 1 0: 1 φ+1φ φ+2φ φ+3φ φ+4φ External space 1 subsequent access wait select bits External space 1 page mode control enable bit RW 0: Page mode control disabled 1: Page mode control enabled(1) RW 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 0 1: 1 0: 1 1: 1 0: 1 RW φ+1φ φ+2φ φ+3φ φ+4φ PWCR0 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 62 of 385 RW Do not set to values other than the above. RW 0: Page mode control disabled 1: Page mode control enabled(1) RW NOTE: 1. When page mode control is enabled, set the EWCRi6 bit in the EWCRi register (i = 0 to 3) to 0 (add no recovery cycle when accessing external space i ). Figure 8.12 RW Do not set to values other than the above. b6 b5 b4 PWCR006 PWCR007 0 0 0 1 RW RW b2 b1 b0 PWCR002 PWCR003 Function Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8. Bus Page Mode Wait Control Register 1 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset PWCR1 004Dh 0001 0001b Bit Symbol Bit Name PWCR100 PWCR101 b2 b1 b0 External space 2 subsequent access wait select bits External space 2 page mode control enable bit PWCR104 PWCR105 External space 3 subsequent access wait select bits 0 1 1 0 1: 1 0: 1 1: 1 0: 1 External space 3 page mode control enable bit PWCR1 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 63 of 385 RW RW 0: Page mode control disabled 1: Page mode control enabled (1) RW b6 b5 b4 RW 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 0 1: 1 0: 1 1: 1 0: 1 φ+1φ φ+2φ φ+3φ φ+4φ 0: Page mode control disabled 1: Page mode control enabled (1) NOTE: 1. When page mode control is enabled, set the EWCRi6 bit in the EWCRi register (i = 0 to 3) to 0 (add no recovery cycle when accessing external space i ). Figure 8.13 RW RW φ+1φ φ+2φ φ+3φ φ+4φ Do not set to values other than the above. PWCR106 PWCR107 0 0 0 1 Do not set to values other than the above. PWCR102 PWCR103 Function RW RW RW Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 8. Bus 8-bit data bus width Set using bits EWCR34 to EWCR30 Set using bits PWCR106 to PWCR104 3φ+3φ 1φ+2φ FFF000h FFF001h FFF002h 1φ+2φ 1φ+2φ 3φ+3φ 1φ+2φ FFF007h FFF008h FFF009h BCLK Address Data CS0 (CE) RD (OE) The above applies under the following conditions: - Bits PM11 and PM10 in the PM1 register are set to 11b (mode 3). - The DS3 bit in the DS regiter is set to 0 (8 bits wide). - Bits EWCR34 to EWCR30 in the EWCR3 register are set to 10011b (3 φ + 3 φ). - The EWCR36 bit is set to 0 (add no recovery cycle when accessing external space 3). - Bits PWCR106 to PWCR104 are set to 010b (1 φ + 2 φ). - The PWCR107 bit is set to 1 (page mode control enabled). The maximum of seven bytes of consective addresses can be read in the page mode control (The total of eight bytes adding the first bus access). If the MCU accesses data in other than the eight-byte block of consecutive addresses, the page mode controlled access is started over from the first bus access. 16-bit data bus width Set using bits EWCR34 to EWCR30 Set using bits PWCR106 to PWCR104 3φ+3φ 1φ+2φ FFF000h FFF002h FFF004h FFF006h 1φ+2φ 1φ+2φ 3φ+3φ 1φ+2φ FFF008h FFF00Ah FFF00Ch 1φ+2φ BCLK Address Data CS0 (CE) RD (OE) The above applies under the following conditions: - Bits PM11 and PM10 in the PM1 register are set to 11b (mode 3). - The DS3 bit in the DS regiter is set to 1 (16 bits wide). - Bits EWCR34 to EWCR30 in the EWCR3 register are set to 10011b (3 φ + 3 φ). - The EWCR36 bit is set to 0 (add no recovery cycle when accessing external space 3). - Bits PWCR106 to PWCR104 are set to 010b (1 φ + 2 φ). - The PWCR107 bit is set to 1 (page mode control enabled). Figure 8.14 External Bus Timing with Page Mode Control Function REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 64 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9. 9. Clock Generation Circuits Clock Generation Circuits 9.1 Types of the Clock Generation Circuit The MCU has four on-chip clock generation circuits to generate system clock signals. • Main clock oscillation circuit • Sub clock oscillation circuit • On-chip oscillator • PLL frequency synthesizer Table 9.1 lists the specifications of the clock generation circuit. Figure 9.1 shows a block diagram of the clock generation circuit. Figures 9.2 to 9.8 show clock-associated registers. Table 9.1 Clock Generation Circuit Specifications Item Main Clock Oscillation Circuit Sub Clock Oscillation Circuit PLL Frequency Synthesizer On-chip Oscillator Applications • CPU clock source • Peripheral function clock source • CPU clock source • Count source for timer A and timer B • CPU clock source • Peripheral function clock source • CPU clock source • Peripheral function clock source Clock frequency Up to 16 MHz 32.768 kHz Approx. 1 MHz 10 MHz to 32 MHz (see Table 9.3) Connectable oscillator or resonator • Ceramic resonator • Crystal oscillator Crystal oscillator − − Oscillator or resonator connect pins XIN, XOUT XCIN, XCOUT − − Oscillation stop/ restart function Available Available Available Available Oscillator state after reset Oscillating Stopped Stopped Stopped Other Externally generated clock can be used. Externally generated clock can be used. Oscillation stop detect 20 MHz: function: Input 5 MHz or 10 When the main clock MHz to the main stops, the on-chip clock oscillator starts 32 MHz oscillating Input 8 MHz or 16 automatically and MHz to the main becomes the CPU clock and peripheral function clock source REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 65 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9. Clock Generation Circuits PM21 Request signal used to wake-up from wait mode/stop mode CM10 SQ Logic 1 write signal to CM10 bit Stop mode R Voltage monitor interrupt signal S NMI WAIT instruction RQ CM02 Clock stop signal in wait mode RESET Software reset Watchdog timer reset Main clock oscillation circuit XIN CM05 CM21 Stop mode XOUT fXIND CM05 Main clock Stop mode PM26 CM17 0 0 1 PLL frequency synthesizer fPLL Clock stop signal in wait mode PM22 On-chip oscillator PM26 PM27 Reset the divider (divideby-8 mode) Divider 0 (divide-by-m) CM21 fROC 1 Clock stop signal in wait mode 1 Peripheral function clock source: fPFC MCD register(2) CM07 fAD f1 CM21 f8 Enable oscillation Stop mode Clock stop signal in wait mode Sub clock oscillation circuit XCIN XCOUT VDEN 1/8 1/4 CST 00 01 fXIND fROC 10 PM27 and PM26 f32 1/2n 1/32 CPSR=1 fC CPU clock (bus clock) fCPU f2n(1) fC32 Reset the divider CM04 Oscillation stop detection circuit Main clock Clock edge detect/ charge and discharge circuit control Charge and discharge circuit Oscillation stop detection interrupt request generation circuit Watchdog timer interrupt request signal Voltage monitor interrupt signal Oscillation stop detection interrupt request (non-maskable interrupt requst) CM21 VDEN: bit in the LVDC register VC27: bit in the VCR2 register CM02, CM04, CM05, and CM07: bits in the CM0 register CM10 and CM17: bits in the CM1 register CM21: bit in the CM2 regsiter PM21, PM22, PM26, and PM27: bits in the PM2 register CST: bit in the TCSPR register CPSR: bit in the CPSRF register NOTES: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). 2. Bits MCD4 to MCD0 in the MCD register select the dividing ratio (divide-by-m mode: m = 1, 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16). Figure 9.1 Clock Generation Circuit REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 66 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9. Clock Generation Circuits System Clock Control Register 0(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol CM0 Address 0006h Bit Symbol Bit Name After Reset 0000 1000b Function b1 b0 CM00 Clock output function select bits (2) CM01 0 0: I/O port P5_3(2) 0 1: Outputs fC 1 0: Outputs f8 1 1: Outputs f32 RW RW RW CM02 Peripheral function clock stop in wait mode bit(9) 0: Peripheral clocks do not stop in wait mode 1: Peripheral clocks stop in wait mode (3) RW CM03 XCIN-XCOUT drive capability select bit(10) 0: Low 1: High RW CM04 Port XC switch bit 0: I/O port function 1: XCIN-XCOUT oscillation function (4) RW CM05 Main clock (XIN-XOUT) stop bit(5, 9) 0: Main clock oscillates 1: Main clock stops (6) RW CM06 Watchdog timer function select bit 0: Watchdog timer interrupt 1: Reset(7) RW CM07 CPU clock select bit 0 (8, 9) 0: Clock selected by the CM21 bit divided by the MCD register 1: Sub clock RW NOTES: 1. Set the CM0 register after the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). 2. The BCLK, ALE, or "L" signal is output from the P5_3 in memory expansion mode or microprocessor mode. Port P5_3 does not function as an I/O port. 3. fC32 does not stop running. 4. To set the CM04 bit to 1, set bits PD8_7 and PD8_6 in the PD8 register to 00b (ports P8_6 and P8_7 in input mode) and the PU25 bit in the PUR2 register to 0 (not pulled up). 5. The CM05 bit stops the main clock oscillation when entering low-power consumption mode or on-chip oscillator low-power consumption mode. The CM05 bit cannot be used to determine whether the main clock stops or not. To stop the main clock oscillation, set the PLC07 bit in the PLC0 register to 0 and the CM05 bit to 1 after setting the CM07 bit to 1 or setting the CM21 bit in the CM2 register to 1 (on-chip oscillator clock). When the CM05 bit is set to 1, the XOUT pin outputs "H". Since an on-chip feedback resistor remains ON, the XIN pin is pulled up to the XOUT pin via the feedback resistor. 6. When the CM05 bit is set to 1, bits MCD4 to MCD0 in the MCD register become 01000b (divide-by-8 mode). In on-chip oscillator mode, bits MCD4 to MCD0 do not become 01000b even if the CM05 bit is set to 1. 7. Once the CM06 bit is set to 1, it cannot be set to 0 by a program. 8. Change the CM07 bit setting from 0 to 1, after the CM04 bit is set to 1 and the sub clock oscillation stabilizes. Change the CM07 bit setting from 1 to 0, after the CM05 bit is set to 0 and the main clock oscillation stabilizes. Do not change the CM07 bit simultaneously with the CM04 or CM05 bit. 9. If the PM21 bit in the PM2 register is set to 1 (disables a clock change), a write to bits CM02, CM05, and CM07 has no effect. 10. When stop mode is entered, the CM03 bit becomes 1. Figure 9.2 CM0 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 67 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9. Clock Generation Circuits System Clock Control Register 1(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 1 0 0 0 0 Symbol CM1 After Reset 0010 0000b Address 0007h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW CM10 All clock stop control bit (2, 3, 5) 0: Clock oscillates 1: All clocks stop (stop mode) RW − (b4-b1) Reserved bits Set to 0 RW − (b5) Reserved bit Set to 1 RW − (b6) Reserved bit Set to 0 RW CPU clock select bit 1 (4, 5) 0: Main clock 1: PLL clock RW CM17 NOTES: 1. Set the CM1 register after the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). 2. When the CM10 bit is set to 1, the XOUT pin outputs "H" and the on-chip feedback resistor is disconnected. Pins XIN, XCIN, and XCOUT are placed in high-impedance states. 3. When the CM10 bit is set to 1, bits MCD4 to MCD0 in the MCD register become 01000b (divide-by-8 mode). Do not set the CM10 bit to 1, when the CM20 bit in the CM2 register is set to 1 (oscillation stop detect function used) or the CM21 bit in the CM2 register is set to 1 (on-chip oscillator clock). 4. Set the CM17 bit to 1 after the PLL clock oscillation stablilizes. 5. If the PM21 bit in the PM2 register is set to 1 (disables a clock change), writes to bits CM10 and CM17 have no effect. If the PM22 bit in the PM2 register is set to 1 (on-chip oscillator clock as count source for watchdog timer), a write to the CM10 bit has no effect. Figure 9.3 CM1 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 68 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9. Clock Generation Circuits Main Clock Division Register(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset MCD 000Ch XXX0 1000b Bit Symbol Bit Name MCD0 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 MCD1 MCD2 Main clock division rate select bits(2) MCD3 1 0 0 1 0: Divide-by-1 (no division) mode 0 0 0 1 0: Divide-by-2 mode 0 0 0 1 1: Divide-by-3 mode 0 0 1 0 0: Divide-by-4 mode 0 0 1 1 0: Divide-by-6 mode 0 1 0 0 0: Divide-by-8 mode 0 1 0 1 0: Divide-by-10 mode 0 1 1 0 0: Divide-by-12 mode 0 1 1 1 0: Divide-by-14 mode 0 0 0 0 0: Divide-by-16 mode Do not set to values other than the above MCD4 − (b7-b5) Function Reserved bits Read as undefined value RW RW RW RW RW RW − NOTES: 1. Set the MCD register after the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). 2. When stop mode or low-power consumption mode is entered, bits MCD4 to MCD0 become 01000b. Bits MCD4 to MCD0, however, do not become 01000b if the CM05 bit in the CM0 register is set to 1 (main clock stops) while the CM21 bit in the CM2 register is set to 1. Figure 9.4 MCD Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 69 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9. Clock Generation Circuits Oscillation Stop Detection Register(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 Symbol CM2 Address 000Dh Bit Symbol Bit Name After Reset 00h Function RW CM20 Oscillation stop detection enable bit(2) 0: Oscillation stop detect function not used 1: Oscillation stop detect function used RW CM21 CPU clock select bit 2 (3, 4) 0: Clock selected by the CM17 bit 1: On-chip oscillator clock RW CM22 Oscillation stop detection flag (5) 0: Loss of main clock not detected 1: Loss of main clock detected RW CM23 Main clock monitor flag(6) 0: Main clock oscillates 1: Main clock stops RO − (b7-b4) Reserved bits Set to 0 RW NOTES: 1. Set the CM2 register after the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). 2. If the PM21 bit in the PM2 register is set to 1 (disables a clock change), a write to the CM20 bit has no effect. 3. When a loss of the main clock is detected while the CM20 bit is set to 1, the CM21 bit becomes 1. Although the main clock restarts oscillating, the CM21 bit does not become 0. To use the main clock as the CPU clock source after the main clock restarts oscillating, set the CM21 bit to 0 by a program. 4. When both the CM20 and CM23 bits are set to 1, do not set the CM21 bit to 0. 5. When a loss of the main clock is detected, the CM22 bit becomes 1. The CM22 bit can only be set to 0, not 1, by a program. If the CM22 bit is set to 0 by a program while the main clock is stopped, the CM22 bit does not become 1 until another loss of the main clock is detected after the main clock restarts oscillating. 6. Determine the main clock state by reading the CM23 bit several times after the oscillation stop detection interrupt is generated. Figure 9.5 CM2 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 70 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9. Clock Generation Circuits PLL Control Register 0 (1)(2) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol Address PLC0 0026h Bit Symbol Bit Name After Reset 0001 X010b Function PLC00 RW RW b2 b1 b0 PLC01 PLL clock multiplication factor select bits(3)(5) 0 1 0: Multiply-by-4 1 0 0: Multiply-by-8 RW Do not set to values other than the above PLC02 − (b3) RW Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. − b5 b4 PLC04 Reference clock division rate select bits(3)(5) RW 0 0: No division 0 1: Divide-by-2 1 0: Divide-by-4 PLC05 RW Do not set to values other than the above − (b6) PLC07 Reserved bit Set to 0 RW Operation enable bit(4) 0: PLL stops 1: PLL runs RW NOTES: 1. Set the PLC0 register after the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). 2. If the PM21 bit in the PM2 register is set to 1 (disables a clock change), a write to the PLC0 register has no effect. 3. Set bits PLC02 to PLC00 while the PLC07 bit is 0. Bits PLC02 to PLC00 can be written only once. 4. Enter wait mode or stop mode after the CM17 bit is set to 0 (main clock as CPU clock source) and then the PLC07 bit to 0. 5. The frequency of PLL clock is calculated by the following equation. Set by bits PLC02 to PLC00. PLL clock frequency = Main clock frequency × 1 × PLL clock multiplication factor Reference clock division rate Set by bits PLC05 and PLC04. e.g.) Main clock frequency: 10 MHz Bits PLC02 to PLC00: 100b (multiply-by-8) Bits PLC05 and PLC04: 10b (divide-by-4) Figure 9.6 PLC0 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 71 of 385 PLL clock frequency = 10 MHz × 8 = 20 MHz 4 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9. Clock Generation Circuits Processor Mode Register 2(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 Symbol PM2 Bit Symbol − (b0) After Reset 00h Address 0013h Bit Name Function Reserved bit Set to 0 RW PM21 System clock protect bit (2, 3) 0: Protects a clock by the PRCR register 1: Disables a clock change RW PM22 WDT count source protect bit (2, 4) 0: CPU clock as count source for the watchdog timer 1: On-chip oscillator clock as count source for the watchdog timer RW Reserved bits Set to 0 RW b7 b6 RW − (b5-b3) PM26 f2n clock source select bits PM27 0 0: Clock selected by the CM21 bit 0 1: XIN clock (fXIND) 1 0: On-chip oscillator clock (fROC) 1 1: Do not set to this value NOTES: 1. Set the PM2 register after the PRC1 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). 2. Once bits PM22 and PM21 are set to 1, they cannot be set to 0 by a program. 3. When the PM21 bit is set to 1, • the CPU clock does not stop, even if the WAIT instruction is executed; • writes to the following bits have no effect. - the CM02 bit in the CM0 register - the CM05 bit in the CM0 register - the CM07 bit in the CM0 register (CPU clock source is not changed) - the CM10 bit in the CM1 register (the MCU does not enter stop mode) - the CM17 bit in the CM1 register (CPU clock source is not changed) - the CM20 bit in the CM2 register (oscillation stop detect function setting is not changed) - all bits in registers PLC0 and PLC1 (PLL frequency synthesizer setting is not changed) 4. When the PM22 bit is set to 1, • the on-chip oscillator starts oscillating and the on-chip oscillator clock becomes the count source for the watchdog timer; • write to the CM10 bit in the CM1 register is disabled (writing a 1 has no effect and the MCU does not enter stop mode); • the watchdog timer keeps operating when the MCU is in wait mode or in hold state. Figure 9.7 RW PM2 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 72 of 385 RW Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9. Clock Generation Circuits Count Source Prescaler Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol TCSPR After Reset(2) 0XXX 0000b Address 035Fh Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW CNT0 RW CNT1 If the setting value is n, f2n is the main clock, on-chip oscillator clock, or PLL clock divided by 2n. When n is set to 0, no division is selected Division rate select bits (1) CNT2 CNT3 − (b6-b4) CST RW RW RW Reserved bits Read as undefined value Operation enable bit 0: Divider stops 1: Divider operates − RW NOTES: 1. Set bits CNT3 to CNT0 after the CST bit is set to 0. 2. The TCSPR register maintains values set before reset, even after the software reset or watchdog timer reset has been performed. Clock Prescaler Reset Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Figure 9.8 Symbol CPSRF Address 0341h Bit Symbol Bit Name − (b6-b0) Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. CPSR Clock prescaler reset bit TCSPR Register, CPSRF Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 73 of 385 After Reset 0XXX XXXXb Function RW − When the CPSR bit is set to 1, a divider for fC32 is reset. Read as 0. RW Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9. Clock Generation Circuits Flash Memory Control Register 4(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol FMR4 Address 0059h Bit Symbol After Reset 00h Bit Symbol Function FMR40 Flash memory low-speed access 0: Normal-speed access enable bit 1: Low-speed access(2) − (b7-b1) Reserved bits Set to 0 RW RW RW NOTES: 1. Set the FMR4 register in 8-bit units. To set the FMR40 bit to 1, write a 1 to the FMR40 bit immediately after writing a 0 to the bit. Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two settings. 2. The FMR40 bit can be set to 1 only when the CPU clock frequency is 2 MHz or lower. Voltage Regulator Control Register(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol VRCR Address 001Fh Bit Symbol MRS − (b7-b1) Bit Symbol Main voltage regulator stop bit(3) Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. After Reset 00h Function 0 : Main voltage regulator operates 1 : Main voltage regulator stops (2) RW RW − NOTES: 1. Set the VRCR register after the PRC3 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). 2. The MRS bit can be set to 1 when all the conditions as follows are met; a. In low-power consumption mode b. The FMR40 bit is 1 c. On-chip oscillator stops (the CM21 bit in the CM2 register is 0, the PM22 bit in the PM2 register is 0, and bits PM27 and PM26 are 00b) 3. When the PLC07 bit in PLC0 register is 1 (PLL runs) or the CM05 bit in the CM0 register is 0 (Main clock oscillates), the MRS bit becomes 0. Figure 9.9 FMR4 Register, VRCR Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 74 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9.1.1 9. Clock Generation Circuits Main Clock Main clock oscillation circuit generates the main clock. The main clock is used as the clock source for the CPU clock and peripheral function clocks. The main clock oscillation circuit is configured by connecting an oscillator between the XIN and XOUT pins. The circuit has an on-chip feedback resistor. The feedback resistor is disconnected from the oscillation circuit in stop mode to reduce power consumption. The main clock oscillation circuit may also be configured by feeding an externally generated clock to the XIN pin. Figure 9.10 shows examples of main clock circuit connection. Circuit constants vary depending on each oscillator. Use the circuit constant recommended by each oscillator manufacturer. The main clock divided-by-eight becomes the CPU clock source after reset. To reduce power consumption, set the CM05 bit in the CM0 register to 1 (main clock stopped) after the sub clock or on-chip oscillator clock is selected as the CPU clock sources. In this case, the XOUT pin outputs an “H” signal. The XIN pin is pulled up to the XOUT pin via the feedback resistor which remains on. When an external clock is input to the XIN pin, do not set the CM05 bit to 1. All clocks, including the main clock, stop in stop mode. Refer to 9.5 Power Consumption Control for details. MCU (On-chip feedback resistor) CIN XIN MCU (On-chip feedback resistor) XIN Externally generated clock VCC Oscillator VSS XOUT Rd(1) COUT VSS XOUT Open NOTE: 1. Insert a damping resistor if required. Resistance values vary depending on the oscillator setting. Use the resistance values recommended by the oscillator manufacturer. If the oscillator manufacturer recommends that a feedback resistor be added to the chip externally, insert a feedback resistor between XIN and XOUT following the instructions. Figure 9.10 Main Clock Circuit Connection REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 75 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9.1.2 9. Clock Generation Circuits Sub Clock Sub clock oscillation circuit generates the sub clock. The sub clock is used as the clock source for the CPU clock and for timer A and timer B. fC, which has the same frequency as the sub clock can be output from the CLKOUT pin. The sub clock oscillation circuit is configured by connecting a crystal oscillator between the XCIN and XCOUT pins. The circuit has an on-chip feedback resistor. The feedback resistor is disconnected from the oscillation circuit in stop mode to reduce power consumption. The sub clock oscillation circuit may also be configured by feeding an externally generated clock to the XCIN pin. Figure 9.11 shows an example of sub clock circuit connection. Circuit constants vary depending on each oscillator. Use the circuit constant recommended by each oscillator manufacturer. The sub clock is stopped after reset, and the feedback resistor is disconnected from the oscillation circuit. To start oscillating the sub clock oscillation circuit, set both the PD8_7 and PD8_6 bits in the PD8 register to 0 (input mode), the PU25 bit in the PUR2 register to 0 (not pulled up), and then the CM04 bit in the CM0 register to 1 (XCIN-XCOUT oscillation function). To input the externally generated clock to the XCIN pin, set the PD8_7 bit to 0, the PU25 bit to 0, and then the CM04 bit to 1. A clock input to the XCIN pin becomes the clock source for the sub clock. When the CM07 bit in the CM0 register is set to 1 (sub clock) after the sub clock oscillation stabilizes, the sub clock becomes the CPU clock source. All clocks, including the sub clock, stop in stop mode. Refer to 9.5 Power Consumption Control for details. MCU (On-chip feedback resistor) CCIN XCIN MCU (On-chip feedback resistor) XCIN Externally generated clock VCC Oscillator VSS XCOUT RCd(1) CCOUT VSS XCOUT Open NOTE: 1. Insert a damping resistor if required. Resistance values vary depending on the oscillator setting. Use the resistance values recommended by the oscillator manufacturer. If the oscillator manufacturer recommends that a feedback resistor be added to the chip externally, insert a feedback resistor between XCIN and XCOUT following the instructions. Figure 9.11 Sub Clock Circuit Connection REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 76 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9.1.3 9. Clock Generation Circuits On-Chip Oscillator Clock On-chip oscillator generates the 1-MHz on-chip oscillator clock. The on-chip oscillator clock is used as the clock source for the CPU clock and peripheral function clocks. The on-chip oscillator clock is stopped after reset. When the CM21 bit in the CM2 register is set to 1 (on-chip oscillator clock), the on-chip oscillator starts oscillating and becomes the clock source for the CPU clock and peripheral function clocks in place of the main clock. Table 9.2 lists on-chip oscillator start conditions. Table 9.2 On-Chip Oscillator Start Condition CM2 Register PM2 Register Applications CM21 PM22 PM27, PM26 1 0 00b Clock source for the CPU clock and peripheral function clock 0 1 00b Count source for the watchdog timer 0 0 10b Clock source for f2n 9.1.3.1 Oscillation Stop Detect Function When the main clock is terminated running by an external factor, the on-chip oscillator automatically starts oscillating to provide the clock. When the CM 20 bit in the CM2 register is set to 1 (oscillation stop detect function used), an oscillation stop detection interrupt request is generated as soon as the main clock is lost. Simultaneously, the on-chip oscillator starts oscillating. The on-chip oscillator clock takes the place of the main clock as the clock source for the CPU clock and peripheral function clocks. Associated bits in the CM2 register are changed as follows: • CM21 bit becomes 1 (on-chip oscillator clock becomes the CPU clock) • CM22 bit becomes 1 (loss of main clock stop is detected) • CM23 bit becomes 1 (main clock stops) The oscillation stop detection interrupt shares the vector with the watchdog timer interrupt and the voltage monitor interrupt. When these interrupts are used simultaneously, verify the CM22 bit in the interrupt routine to determine if an oscillation stop detection interrupt request has been generated. When the main clock resumes its operation after a loss of the main clock is detected, the main clock can be selected as the clock source for the CPU clock and peripheral function clocks by a program. Figure 9.12 shows the procedure to switch the clock source from the on-chip oscillator clock to the main clock. In low-speed mode, when the main clock is lost while the CM20 bit is set to 1, an oscillation stop detection interrupt request is generated, and the on-chip oscillator starts oscillating. The sub clock remains as the source for the CPU clock. The on-chip oscillator clock becomes the source for the peripheral function clocks. When the peripheral function clocks are stopped, the oscillation stop detect function cannot be used. To enter wait mode while using the oscillation stop detect function, set the CM02 bit in the CM0 register to 0 (peripheral clocks do not stop in wait mode). The oscillation stop detect function is a precaution against the unintended termination of the main clock by an external factor. Set the CM20 bit to 0 (oscillation stop detect function not used) when the main clock is stopped by a program, i.e., entering stop mode or setting the CM05 bit in the CM0 register to 1 (main clock stops). When the main clock frequency is 2 MHz or lower, the oscillation stop detect function is not available. In this case, set the CM20 bit to 0. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 77 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9. Clock Generation Circuits Start Read the CM23 bit in the CM2 register 1 (Main clock stops) 0 (Main clock oscillates) Verified several times? NO YES PRCR register: PRC0 bit = 1 Enable writing to registers associated with clocks MCD register: bits MCD4 to MCD0 = 01000b Divide-by-8 mode CM2 register: CM22 bit = 0 Loss of the main clock is not detected CM2 register: CM21 bit = 0 Select the main clock as the CPU clock source PRC0 bit = 0 Disable writing to registers associated with clocks End Figure 9.12 Procedure to Switch from On-chip Oscillator Clock to Main Clock REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 78 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9.1.4 9. Clock Generation Circuits PLL Clock The PLL frequency synthesizer generates the PLL clock by multiplying the main clock. The PLL clock can be used as the clock source for the CPU clock and peripheral function clocks. Figure 9.13 shows the block diagram of PLL frequency synthesizer. VCO clock (fVCO) VCO clock divider A Phase comparator Main clock Loop filter Reference clock divider Voltage controlled oscillator (VCO) VCO clock divider B PLL clock (fPLL)(2) (Note 1) NOTES: 1. The frequency after the main clock is divided by the reference clock divider is set to be from 2 MHz to 4 MHz. 2. Set the PLL clock frequency as follows: 10 MHz ≤ the PLL clock frequency ≤ 32 MHz Figure 9.13 PLL Frequency Synthesizer Block Diagram The PLL clock frequency is calculated by the following equation. Table 9.3 lists the PLL clock frequency settings examples. Division rate of VCO clock divider A PLL clock frequency = Main clock frequency × × Division rate of the reference clock divider Set by bits PLC05 and PLC04 1 Division rate of VCO clock divider B Set by bits PLC02 to PLC00 PLC05, PLC04, and PLC02 to PLC00: Bits in the PLC0 register Table 9.3 The PLL Clock Frequency Settings Examples PLC0 Register Main Clock (fXIN) Bits PLC05 and PLC04 Bits PLC02 to PLC00 PLL Clock (fPLL) 5 MHz 01b (Divide-by-2) 100b (Multiply-by-8) fPLL = fXIN × 1/2 × 8 = 20 MHz 10 MHz 10b (Divide-by-4) 100b (Multiply-by-8) fPLL = fXIN × 1/4 × 8 = 20 MHz 8 MHz 01b (Divide-by-2) 100b (Multiply-by-8) fPLL = fXIN × 1/2 × 8 = 32 MHz 16 MHz 10b (Divide-by-4) 100b (Multiply-by-8) fPLL = fXIN × 1/4 × 8 = 32 MHz The PLL frequency synthesizer is stopped after reset. When the PLC07 bit in the PLC0 register is set to 1 (PLL runs), the PLL frequency synthesizer starts operating. Waiting time, tsu(PLL), is required before the PLL clock is stabilized. Prior to entering wait mode or stop mode, set the CM17 bit in the CM1 register to 0 (main clock as CPU clock source), and then set the PLC07 bit to 0 (PLL stops). Figure 9.14 shows the procedure to use the PLL clock as the CPU clock source. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 79 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9. Clock Generation Circuits Start PRCR register: PRC0 bit = 1 Enable writing to registers associated with clocks CM2 register: CM21 bit = 0 CM0 register: CM07 bit = 0 Select the main clock as the CPU clock source (Set after a main clock oscillation stabilizes) PLC0 register: bits PLC05 and PLC04 PLC0 register: bits PLC02 to PLC00 Select the reference clock division rate for the PLL clock Select the PLL clock multiplication factor PLC0 register: PLC07 bit = 1 PLL runs Wait for tsu(PLL) Wait for PLL frequency synthesizer to stabilize CM1 register : CM17 bit = 1 Select the PLL clock as the clock source for the CPU clock and peripheral function clock PRC0 bit = 0 Disable writing to registers associated with clocks End Figure 9.14 Procedure to Use PLL Clock as CPU Clock Source REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 80 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9.2 9. Clock Generation Circuits CPU Clock and BCLK The CPU clock is used to operate the CPU and also used as the count source for the watchdog timer. After reset, the CPU clock is the main clock divided by eight. The bus clock (BCLK) has the same frequency as the CPU clock and can be output from the BCLK pin in memory expansion mode or microprocessor mode. Refer to 9.4 Clock Output Function for details. The main clock, sub clock, on-chip oscillator clock, or PLL clock can be selected as the clock source for the CPU clock. When the main clock, on-chip oscillator clock, or PLL clock is selected as the clock source for the CPU clock, the selected clock source divided by 1 (no division), 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, or 16 becomes the CPU clock. Bits MCD4 to MCD0 in the MCD register select the clock division. When the MCU enters stop mode or low-power consumption mode, bits MCD4 to MCD0 are set to 01000b (divide-by-8 mode). Therefore, when the CPU clock source is switched to the main clock next time, the CPU clock is the main clock divided by eight. Refer to 9.5 Power Consumption Control for details. 9.3 Peripheral Function Clock The peripheral function clocks are used to operate the peripheral functions excluding the watchdog timer. The clock selected by the CM17 bit in the CM1 register and the CM21 bit in the CM2 register (any of the main clock, PLL clock, or on-chip oscillator clock) becomes the peripheral function clock source (fPFC). 9.3.1 f1, f8, f32, and f2n f1, f8 and f32 are fPFC divided by 1, 8, or 32. Bits PM27 and PM 26 in the PM2 register select the f2n clock source from fPFC, XIN clock (fXIND), and the on-chip oscillator clock (fROC). Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select the f2n division. (n = 1 to 15. No division when n = 0.) When wait mode is entered while the CM02 bit in the CM0 register is set to 1 (peripheral clocks stop in wait mode) or when the CM05 bit is set to 1 using the main clock as the peripheral function clock source, fPFC stops. When bits PM27 and PM26 in the PM2 register are set to 10b (on-chip oscillator clock is selected for the f2n clock source), f2n does not stop in wait mode. f1, f8, and f2n are used to operate the serial interface and also is used as the count source for timer A and timer B. The CLKOUT pin outputs f8 and f32. Refer to 9.4 Clock Output Function for details. 9.3.2 fAD fAD is used to operate the A/D converter and has the same frequency as fPFC. When wait mode is entered while the CM02 bit in the CM0 register is set to 1 (peripheral clocks stop in wait mode) or when the CM05 bit is set to 1 using the main clock as the peripheral function clock source, fAD stops. 9.3.3 fC32 fC32 is the sub clock divided by 32. fC32 is used as the count source for timer A and timer B. fC32 is available if the sub clock is running. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 81 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9.4 9. Clock Generation Circuits Clock Output Function The CLKOUT pin outputs fC, f8, or f32. The BCLK clock, which has the same frequency as the CPU clock, can be output from the BCLK pin in memory expansion mode or microprocessor mode. Table 9.4 lists CLKOUT pin function in single-chip mode. Table 9.5 lists CLKOUT pin function in memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode. Table 9.4 CLKOUT Pin Function in Single-Chip Mode CM0 Register(1) Bits CM01 and CM00 P5_3/CLKOUT Pin Function 00b I/O port P5_3 01b Outputs fC 10b Outputs f8 11b Outputs f32 NOTE: 1. Rewrite the CM0 register after setting the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (write enable). Table 9.5 CLKOUT Pin Function in Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode CM0 Register(1) PM1 Register(2) Bits CM01 and CM00 Bits PM15 and PM14 PM0 Register(2) PM07 bit CLKOUT/BCLK/ALE Pin Function 00b 10b 11b 0 Outputs BCLK 1 Outputs “L” (does not function as P5_3) 01b 0 or 1 Outputs ALE 01b 0 or 1 0 or 1 Outputs fC 10b 0 or 1 0 or 1 Outputs f8 11b 0 or 1 0 or 1 Outputs f32 00b NOTES: 1. Change the CM0 register after setting the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (write enable). 2. Change registers PM0 and PM1 after setting the PRC1 bit in the PRCR register to 1 (write enable). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 82 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9.5 9. Clock Generation Circuits Power Consumption Control The power consumption control is enabled by controlling a CPU clock frequency. The higher the CPU clock frequency is, the more the processing power is available. The lower the CPU clock frequency is, the less power is consumed. When unnecessary oscillation circuits are stopped, power consumption is further reduced. CPU operating mode, wait mode, and stop mode are provided as the power consumption control. CPU operating mode is further separated into the following modes; main clock mode, PLL mode, low-speed mode, low-power consumption mode, on-chip oscillator mode, and on-chip oscillator low-power consumption mode. Figure 9.15 shows a mode transition diagram. Reset PLL clock (note 1) Stop mode CM10 = 1 PLL mode Main clock mode Interrupt T A I ion W uct rt s in pt ru er t In Wait mode On-chip oscillator mode Low-speed mode W in s t A I T ru c t io n Inte r ru p Sub clock t On-chip oscillator clock On-chip oscillator low-power consumption mode Low-power consumption mode WAIT instruction Interrupt CM10: bit in the CM1 register NOTE: 1. Bits MCD4 to MCD0 in the MCD register become 01000b (divide-by-8 mode) after reset. Figure 9.15 9.5.1 Mode Transition CPU operating mode The CPU clock can be selected from the main clock, sub clock, on-chip oscillator clock, or PLL clock. When switching the CPU clock source, wait until the new CPU clock source stabilizes. To change the CPU clock source from the sub clock, on-chip oscillator clock, or PLL clock, set it to the main clock once and then switch it to another clock. To switch the CPU clock source from the on-chip oscillator clock to the main clock, set bits MCD4 to MCD0 in the MCD register to 01000b (divided-by-8 mode) in on-chip oscillator mode. Table 9.6 lists bit setting and operation mode associated with clocks. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 83 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9.5.1.1 9. Clock Generation Circuits Main Clock Mode The main clock divided by 1 (no division), 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, or 16 is used as the source for the CPU clock. The main clock is also used as the source for fPFC. When the sub clock is running, fC32 can be used as the count source for timer A and timer B. 9.5.1.2 PLL Mode The PLL clock divided by 1 (no division), 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, or 16 is used as the source for the CPU clock. The PLL clock is also used as the source for fPFC. When the sub clock is running, fC32 can be used as the count source for timer A and timer B. 9.5.1.3 Low-Speed Mode The sub clock is used as the source for the CPU clock. The main clock, PLL clock, or on-chip oscillator clock can be selected as the source for fPFC by setting bits CM17 and CM21 after the CPU clock is switched to the sub clock using the CM07 bit. In low-speed mode, fC32 can be used as the count source for timer A and timer B. Out of CPU operating modes, only main clock mode and low-power consumption mode can be entered from low-speed mode. Enter main clock mode first prior to entering different CPU operating modes other than the low-power consumption mode. 9.5.1.4 Low-Power Consumption Mode The MCU enters low-power consumption mode when the main clock stops in low-speed mode. The sub clock is used as the source for the CPU clock. The on-chip oscillator clock can be selected as the source for fPFC by setting the CM21 bit after entering low-power consumption mode. fC32 can be used as the count source for timer A and timer B. When low-power consumption mode is entered, bits MCD4 to MCD0 in the MCD register become 01000b (divide-by-8 mode). Therefore, when next time the CPU clock source is switched to the main clock, the CPU clock is the main clock divided by eight. However, bits MCD4 to MCD0 do not become 01000b if the main clock is stopped by setting the CM05 bit to 1 while the on-ship oscillator clock is selected as the source for fPFC in low-speed mode. In this case, set bits MCD4 to MCD0 to 01000b by a program and then switch the CPU clock source to the main clock.Figure 9.16 shows the procedure to enter low-power consumption mode from main clock mode. 9.5.1.5 On-Chip Oscillator Mode The on-chip oscillator clock divided by 1 (no division), 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, or 16 is used as the source for the CPU clock. The on-chip oscillator clock is also used as the source for fPFC. When the sub clock is running, fC32 can be used as the count source for timer A and timer B. 9.5.1.6 On-Chip Oscillator Low-Power Consumption Mode The MCU enters on-chip oscillator low-power consumption mode when the main clock stops in on-chip oscillator mode. The on-chip oscillator clock divided by 1 (no division), 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, or 16 is used as the source for the CPU clock. The on-chip oscillator clock is also used as the source for fPFC. When the sub clock is running, fC32 can be used as the count source for timer A and timer B. 9.5.1.7 Flash Memory Low-Speed Access When the CPU clock frequency is 2 MHz or lower, power consumption can be reduced by setting the FMR40 bit in the FMR4 register to 1 (low-speed access). To configure low-speed access, set the FMR40 bit to 1 after setting the CPU clock frequency to 2 MHz or lower. To set the CPU clock frequency to higher than 2 MHz, change the frequency after setting the FMR40 bit to 0 (normal-speed access). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 84 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9.5.1.8 9. Clock Generation Circuits Main Voltage Regulator Stops Power consumption can be reduced by stopping the main voltage regulator in low-power consumption mode. To stop the main voltage regulator, set the MRS bit in the VRCR register to 1 (main voltage regulator stops) after all the following conditions are met. (1) Low-power consumption mode (2) On-chip oscillator stops •The CM21 bit in the CM2 register is set to 0 •The PM22 bit in the PM2 register is set to 0 •Bits PM27 and PM26 in the PM2 register are set to 00b (3) The FMR40 bit in the FMR4 register is set to 1 (flash memory low-speed access) Set the MRS bit to 0 (main voltage regulator operates) and wait for 50 μs or more before performing any of the following settings: changing CPU operating mode to other than low-power consumption mode, starting the onchip oscillator, or setting the FMR40 bit 0 (flash memory normal-speed access). Table 9.6 Operation Mode Setting Oscillation Control CPU Clock Source Operating Mode CM0 Register Selector PLC0 Register CM2 Register CM1 Register CM0 Register CM05 CM04 PLC07 CM21(1) CM17 CM07 0 or 1 0 0 0 Main clock Main clock mode 0 0 or 1 PLL clock PLL mode 0 0 or 1 1 0 1 0 Low-speed mode 0 1 0 or 1 0 0 1 Low power consumption mode 1 1 0 0 0 1 Sub clock On-chip oscillator clock On-chip oscillator mode 0 0 or 1 0 or 1 1 0 0 On-chip oscillator lowpower consumption mode 1 0 or 1 0 1 0 0 NOTE: 1. The CM21 bit in the CM2 register has both the oscillation control and selector functions. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 85 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9. Clock Generation Circuits Start PRCR register PRC0 bit = 1 Enable writing to registers associated with clocks PD8 register PD8 register PD8_7 bit = 0 PD8_6 bit = 0 Set ports P8_7 and P8_6 to input mode PUR2 register PU25 bit = 0 Not pulled up CM0 register CM0 register CM03 bit = 1 CM04 bit = 1 Sub clock oscillates Configuration to oscillate sub clock Wait for sub clock oscillation to stablize CM2 register CM21 bit = 0 Select the main clock as the CPU clock source CM0 register CM07 bit = 1 Select the sub clock as the CPU clock source CM2 register CM20 bit = 0 Oscillation stop detect function not used PLC register PLC07 bit = 0 PLL stops CM0 register CM05 bit = 1 Main clock stops PM2 register PM2 register PM22 bit = 0 Bits PM27 and PM26 = 00b On-chip oscillator stops PRCR register PRC0 bit = 0 Disable writing to registers associated with clocks I flag = 0 Entering from main clock mode to low-power consumption mode Interrupt disabled FMR4 register = 00h Flash memory low-speed access FMR4 register = 01h I flag = 1 To further reduce power consumption in low-power consumption mode Interrupt enabled PRCR register PRC3 bit = 1 Enable writing to the VRCR register VRCR register MRS bit = 1 Main voltage regulator stops PRCR register PRC3 bit = 0 Disable writing to the VRCR register Processing in low-power consumption mode PRCR register PRC3 bit = 1 Enable writing to the VRCR register VRCR register MRS bit = 0 Main voltage regulator operates PRCR register PRC3 bit = 0 Disable writing to the VRCR register Wait for 50µs or more FMR4 register = 00h Entering from low-power consumption mode to the other modes Wait for main voltage regulator to stablize Flash memory normal-speed access End Figure 9.16 Procedure to Enter Low-Power Consumption Mode From Main Clock Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 86 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9.5.2 9. Clock Generation Circuits Wait Mode In wait mode, the CPU and watchdog timer stop operating. If the PM22 bit in the PM2 register is set to 1 (onchip oscillator clock as watchdog timer count source), the watchdog timer continues operating. Since the main clock, sub clock, and on-chip oscillator clock continue running, peripheral functions using these clocks as their clock source also continue to operate. 9.5.2.1 Peripheral Function Clock Stop Function If the CM02 bit in the CM0 register is set to 1 (peripheral clocks stop in wait mode), fAD, f1, f8, and f32 stop in wait mode. f2n, which uses the clock selected by the CM21 bit in the CM2 register as its clock source, also stops in wait mode. Power consumption can be reduced by stopping these peripheral clocks. f2n, which uses the XIN clock (fXIND) or on-chip oscillator clock as its clock source, and fC32 do not stop even in wait mode. 9.5.2.2 Entering Wait Mode Figure 9.17 shows a procedure to enter wait mode. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 87 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9. Clock Generation Circuits Start (1) Initial setting RLVL register: bits RLVL2 to RLVL0 = 7 Set the wait/stop mode exit interrupt priority level to 7. Set an interrupt priority level of each interrupt (2) Before entering wait mode I flag = 0 Interrupt disabled Set the interrupt priority level (ILVL2 to ILVL0) of the interrupt used to exit wait mode (ILVL2 to ILVL0) > IPL* = (RLVL2 to RLVL0)* Set the interrupt priority level of the interrupts, which are not used to exit wait mode, to 0 FLG register: set IPL Set the processor interrupt priority level (IPL)* Bits RLVL2 to RLVL0 = the same level as IPL Set the exit interrupt priority level (RLVL2 to RLVL0)* Select the operating mode from the following: -main clock mode -low-speed mode -low-power consumption mode -on-chip oscillator mode -on-chip oscillator low-power consumption mode To further reduce power consumption, use the following procedure in low-power consumption mode before entering wait mode -Stops all clock oscillations except sub clock -Set the flash memory to low-speed access -Stops main voltage regulator (Refer to Figure Procedure to Enter Low-Power Consumption Mode From Main Clock Mode) I flag = 1 Interrupt enabled Execute the WAIT instruction (Note 1) Wait mode (3) After exiting wait mode RLVL register: bits RLVL2 to RLVL0 = 7 End NOTE: 1. Insert at least 4 NOP's after WAIT instruction. Figure 9.17 Procedure to Enter Wait Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 88 of 385 Set the exit priority level as soon as exiting wait mode Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9.5.2.3 9. Clock Generation Circuits Pin States in Wait Mode Table 9.7 lists pin states in wait mode. Table 9.7 Pin States in Wait Mode Pin Memory Expansion Mode Microprocessor Mode Address bus, data bus, CS0 to CS3, BHE Maintain the state immediately before entering wait mode RD, WR, WRL, WRH “H” Single-Chip Mode HLDA, BCLK “H” ALE “L” Ports Maintain the state immediately before entering wait mode CLKOUT When fC is selected Continue to output the clock When f8, f32 are selected • When the CM02 bit in the CM0 register is 0 (peripheral clocks do not stop in wait mode): Continue to output the clock • When the CM02 bit is 1 (peripheral clock stops in wait mode): The clock is stopped and holds the level immediately before entering wait mode 9.5.2.4 Exiting Wait Mode Wait mode is exited by the hardware reset, NMI interrupt, voltage monitor interrupt, or peripheral function interrupts. As for a peripheral function interrupt that is not used to exit wait mode, set bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 in the corresponding Interrupt Control Register to 000b (interrupt disabled) before executing the WAIT instruction. The CM02 bit setting in the CM0 register affects the use of the peripheral function interrupts to exit wait mode. When the CM02 bit is set to 0 (peripheral clocks do not stop in wait mode), any peripheral function interrupts can be used to exit wait mode. When the CM02 bit is set to 1 (peripheral clocks stop in wait mode), the peripheral functions clocked by the peripheral function clocks stop, and therefore, the peripheral function interrupts cannot be used to exit wait mode. However, the peripheral functions clocked by the external clock and fC32 do not stop regardless of the CM02 bit setting. Also, f2n, which uses the XIN clock (fXIND) or onchip oscillator clock as its clock source does not stop. The interrupts generated by the peripheral functions which operate using these clocks can be used to exit wait mode. When the MCU exits wait mode by the peripheral function interrupts or NMI interrupt, the CPU clock does not change before and after the WAIT instruction is executed. Table 9.8 lists interrupts to be used to exit wait mode and usage conditions. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 89 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 9.8 9. Clock Generation Circuits Interrupts to Exit Wait Mode and Usage Conditions Interrupt When CM02 = 0 When CM02 = 1 NMI interrupt Available Available Voltage monitor interrupt Available Available Serial interface interrupt Available when the source clock is the internal clock or external clock. Available when the source clock is the external clock or f2n (when fXIND or onchip oscillator clock is selected). Key input interrupt Available Available A/D conversion interrupt Available in one-shot mode or singlesweep mode Not available Timer A interrupt Timer B interrupt Available in all modes Available in event counter mode or when the count source is fC32 or f2n (when fXIND or on-chip oscillator clock is selected) INT interrupt Available Available 9.5.3 Stop Mode In stop mode, all clocks are stopped. Since the CPU clock and peripheral function clocks are stopped, the CPU and the peripheral functions which are operated by these clocks stop their operation. The least power is required to operate the MCU in stop mode. Enter stop mode from main clock mode. 9.5.3.1 Entering Stop Mode Stop mode is entered by setting the CM10 bit in the CM1 register to 1 (all clocks stop) while the NMI pin is held “H”. Also, bits MCD4 to MCD0 in the MCD register become 01000b (divide-by-8 mode) by setting the CM10 bit to 1. To enter stop mode, the MRS bit in the VRCR register is set to 0 (main voltage regulator operates). Figure 9.18 shows a procedure to enter stop mode. When entering stop mode, the instructions following CM10 = 1 instruction are stored into the instruction queue, and the program stops. When stop mode is exited, the instruction lined in the queue is executed before the exit interrupt routine is handled. Insert the jmp.b instruction as follows after the instruction to set the CM10 bit to 1. fset I bset 0, cm1 jmp.b LABEL_001 LABEL_001: nop nop nop nop mov.b #0, prcr . . . ; I flag is set to 1 ; all clocks stopped (stop mode) ; jmp.b instruction executed (no instruction between jmp.b and LABEL.) ; nop(1) ; nop(2) ; nop(3) ; nop(4) ; protection set REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 90 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9. Clock Generation Circuits Start (1) Initial setting RLVL register: bits RLVL2 to RLVL0 = 7 Set the wait/stop mode exit interrupt priority level to 7. Set an interrupt priority level of each interrupt (2) Before entering stop mode I flag = 0 Interrupt disabled Set the interrupt priority level (ILVL2 to ILVL0) of the interrupt used to exit stop mode (ILVL2 to ILVL0) > IPL* = (RLVL2 to RLVL0)* Set the interrupt priority level of the interrupts, which is not used to exit stop mode, to 0 FLG register: set IPL Set the processor interrupt priority level (IPL)* Bits RLVL2 to RLVL0 = the same level as IPL Set the exit interrupt priority level (RLVL2 to RLVL0)* PRCR register: PRC0 bit = 1 PRCR register: PRC1 bit = 1 Enable writing to registers associated with clocks CM1 register: CM17 bit = 0 CM2 register: CM21 bit = 0 CM0 register: CM07 bit = 0 Select the main clock as the CPU clock source (Set after a main clock oscillation is stabilized) CM2 register: CM20 bit = 0 (Note 1) MCD register: bits MCD4 to MCD0 = 00000b Disable oscillation stop detect function Divide-by-16 mode FMR4 register = 00h Flash memory low-speed access FMR4 register = 01h I flag = 1 Interrupt enabled CM1 register: CM10 bit = 1 (Note 2) All clocks stop Stop mode (3) After exiting wait mode RLVL register: bits RLVL2 to RLVL0 = 7 Set the exit priority level as soon as exiting wait mode FMR4 register = 00h Flash memory normal-speed access End NOTES: 1. This setting is required when the oscillation stop detect function is used. 2. Insert the jmp.b instruction as follows after the instruction to set the CM10 bit to 1. bset 0, cm1 jmp.b LABEL_001 LABEL_001: nop nop nop nop mov.b #0, prcr . . . Figure 9.18 ; all clocks stopped (stop mode) ; jmp.b instruction executed (no instruction ; between jmp.b and LABEL.) ; nop(1) ; nop(2) ; nop(3) ; nop(4) ; protection set Procedure to Enter Stop Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 91 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9.5.3.2 9. Clock Generation Circuits Pin States in Stop Mode Table 9.9 lists pin states in stop mode. Table 9.9 Pin States in Stop Mode Pin Memory Expansion Mode Microprocessor Mode Single-Chip Mode Address Bus, Data Bus, CS0 to CS3, BHE Maintain the state immediately before entering stop mode RD, WR, WRL, WRH “H” HLDA, BCLK “H” ALE “H” Ports Maintain the state immediately before entering stop mode CLKOUT When fC is selected “H” When f8, f32 are selected The clock is stopped and holds the level immediately before entering stop mode XIN Placed in a high-impedance state XOUT “H” XCIN, XCOUT Placed in a high-impedance state 9.5.3.3 Exiting Stop Mode Stop mode is exited by the hardware reset, NMI interrupt, voltage monitor interrupt, or peripheral function interrupts. The following are the peripheral function interrupts that can be used to exit stop mode. • Key input interrupt • INT interrupt • Timer A and timer B interrupts (Available when the timer counts external pulse having 100-Hz frequency or lower in event counter mode) When only the hardware reset, NMI interrupt, or voltage monitor interrupt is used to exit stop mode, set bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 in the Interrupt Control Registers for all the peripheral function interrupts to 000b (interrupt disabled) before setting the CM10 bit in the CM1 register to 1 (all clocks stop). If the voltage applied to pins VCC1 and VCC2 drops below 3.0 V in stop mode, exit stop mode by the hardware reset after the voltage has satisfied the recommended operating conditions. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 92 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 9.6 9. Clock Generation Circuits System Clock Protect Function The system clock protect function prohibits the clock setting from being rewritten in order to prevent the CPU clock source from being changed when a program goes out of control. When the PM21 bit in the PM2 register is set to 1 (disables a clock change), the following bits cannot be written: • Bits CM02, CM05, and CM07 in the CM0 register • Bits CM10 and CM17 in the CM1 register • The CM20 bit in the CM2 register • All bits in the PLC0 register The CPU clock continues running when the WAIT instruction is executed. Figure 9.19 shows a procedure to use the system clock protect function. Follow the procedure while the CM05 bit in the CM0 register is set to 0 (main clock oscillates) and the CM07 bit to 0 (main clock as CPU clock source). Start PRCR register: PRC1 bit = 1 PM2 register: PM21 bit = 1 PRCR register: PRC1 bit = 0 Enable writing to registers associated with clocks (Note 1) Disable a clock change Disable writing to registers associated with clocks End NOTE: 1. When entering wait mode, execute the WAIT instruction while the PM21 bit in the PM2 register is set to 0. Figure 9.19 Procedure to Use System Clock Protect Function REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 93 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 10. Protection 10. Protection The function protects important registers from being inadvertently overwritten in case of a program crash. Figure 10.1 shows the PRCR register. The PRC2 bit in the PRCR register becomes 0 (write disable) by a write to the SFR area after the PRC2 bit is set to 1 (write enable). Set the PD9 or PS3 register immediately after the PRC2 bit is set to 1. Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two instructions. Bits PRC0, PRC1, and PRC3 do not become 0 automatically even after a write to the SFR area. Set bits PRC0, PRC1, and PRC3 to 0 by a program. Protect Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol PRCR Address 000Ah Bit Symbol Bit Name After Reset XXXX 0000b Function RW PRC0 Protect bit 0(1) Writing to registers CM0, CM1, CM2, MCD, and PLC0 is enabled 0: Write disable 1: Write enable RW PRC1 Protect bit 1(1) Writing to registers PM0, PM1, PM2, INVC0, and INVC1 is enabled 0: Write disable 1: Write enable RW PRC2 Protect bit 2(2) Writing to registers PD9 and PS3 is enabled 0: Write disable 1: Write enable RW PRC3 Protect bit 3(1) Writing to registers DVCR, LVDC, and VRCR is enabled 0: Write disable 1: Write enable RW − (b7-b4) Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. − NOTES: 1. Bits PRC0, PRC1, and PRC3 do not become 0 automatically even after a write to the SFR area. Set bits PRC0, PRC1, and PRC3 to 0 by a program. 2. The PRC2 bit becomes 0 by a write to the SFR area after the PRC2 bit is set to 1. Figure 10.1 PRCR Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 94 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 11. Interrupts 11. Interrupts 11.1 Types of Interrupts Figure 11.1 shows the types of interrupts. Software (Non-maskable interrupts) Undefined instruction (UND instruction) Overflow (INTO instruction) BRK instruction BRK2 instruction(2) INT instruction NMI Interrupts Special (Non-maskable interrupts) Hardware Peripheral function(1) (Maskable interrupts) Watchdog timer Oscillation stop detection Voltage monitor Single step(2) Address match DMACII transfer complete NOTES: 1. Peripheral function interrupts are generated by the on-chip peripheral functions in the MCU. 2. Do not use these interrupts. They are for use with development tool only. Figure 11.1 Interrupts • Maskable interrupts The I flag and IPL can enable and disable these interrupts. The interrupt priority order can be changed by using interrupt priority level settings. • Non-maskable interrupt These interrupts cannot be disabled regardless of the I flag and IPL settings. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 95 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 11.2 11. Interrupts Software Interrupts Software interrupts occur when particular instructions are executed. Software interrupts are non-maskable. 11.2.1 Undefined Instruction Interrupt The undefined instruction interrupt occurs when the UND instruction is executed. 11.2.2 Overflow Interrupt The overflow interrupt occurs when the INTO instruction is executed while the O flag in the FLG register is 1 (arithmetic operation overflow). Instructions that can set the O flag are: ABS, ADC, ADCF, ADD, ADDX, CMP, CMPX, DIV, DIVU, DIVX, NEG, RMPA, SBB, SCMPU, SHA, SUB, SUBX 11.2.3 BRK Interrupt The BRK interrupt occurs when the BRK instruction is executed. 11.2.4 BRK2 Interrupt The BRK2 interrupt occurs when the BRK2 instruction is executed. Do not use this interrupt. This is for use with development support tool only. 11.2.5 INT Instruction Interrupt The INT instruction interrupt occurs when the INT instruction is executed. The INT instruction can specify software interrupt numbers 0 to 63. Software interrupt numbers 8 to 43 are assigned to the vector table used for the peripheral function interrupt. This means that the MCU is able to execute the peripheral function interrupt routine by executing the INT instruction. When the INT instruction is executed, values in the FLG register and PC are saved to the stack. The relocatable vector of the specified software interrupt number is stored in PC. The stack, where the data is saved, varies depending on a software interrupt number. ISP is selected for software interrupt numbers 0 to 31. (The U flag in the FLG register becomes 0.) For software interrupt numbers 32 to 63, SP which is selected immediately before executing the INT instruction is used. (The U flag does not change.) For the peripheral function interrupt, the FLG register value is saved and the U flag becomes 0 (ISP selected) when an interrupt request is acknowledged. Therefore, for software interrupt numbers 32 to 43, SP to be used can differ depending on whether an interrupt is generated by a peripheral function or by the INT instruction. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 96 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 11.3 11. Interrupts Hardware Interrupts Special interrupts and peripheral function interrupts are available as hardware interrupts. 11.3.1 Special Interrupts Special interrupts are non-maskable. 11.3.1.1 NMI Interrupt The NMI interrupt occurs when a signal applied to the NMI pin changes from high level (“H”) to low level (“L”). Refer to 11.8 NMI Interrupt for details. 11.3.1.2 Watchdog Timer Interrupt The watchdog timer interrupt occurs when the watchdog timer counter underflows. Refer to 12. Watchdog Timer for details. 11.3.1.3 Oscillation Stop Detection Interrupt The oscillation stop detection interrupt occurs when the MCU detects a loss of the main clock. Refer to 9. Clock Generation Circuits for details. 11.3.1.4 Voltage Monitor Interrupt The voltage monitor interrupt occurs when voltage monitor function detects the changes in voltage. Refer to 6. Power Supply Voltage Monitor Function for details. 11.3.1.5 Single-Step Interrupt Do not use the single-step interrupt. This is for use with development support tool only. 11.3.1.6 Address Match Interrupt When the AIERi bit in the AIER register is set to 1 (address match interrupt enabled), the address match interrupt occurs immediately before executing the instruction stored in the address indicated by the RMADi register (i = 0 to 7). Set the starting address of the instruction in the RMADi register. The address match interrupt does not occur if a table data or any address other than the starting address of the instruction is set. Refer to 11.10 Address Match Interrupt for details. 11.3.1.7 DMACII End-of-Transfer Complete Interrupt The DMACII transfer complete interrupt is generated by the DMACII function. Refer to 14. DMACII for details. 11.3.2 Peripheral Function Interrupt The peripheral function interrupt is generated by the on-chip peripheral functions. The peripheral function interrupts and software interrupt numbers 8 to 43 for the INT instruction use the same interrupt vector table. The peripheral function interrupt is maskable. See Tables 11.2 and 11.3 for the peripheral function interrupt sources. Refer to the descriptions of individual peripheral functions for details. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 97 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 11.4 11. Interrupts High-Speed Interrupt The high-speed interrupt executes an interrupt sequence in five cycles and returns from the interrupt routine in three cycles. When the FSIT bit in the RLVL register is set to 1 (interrupt priority level 7 is used for the highspeed interrupt), the interrupt that bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 in the Interrupt Control Register are set to 111b (level 7) becomes the high-speed interrupt. Only one interrupt can be set as the high-speed interrupt. To use the high-speed interrupt, do not set multiple interrupts to interrupt priority level 7. Set the DMAII bit in the RLVL register to 0 (interrupt priority level 7 is used for interrupt) to use the high-speed interrupt. Set the starting address of a high-speed interrupt routine in the VCT register. When the high-speed interrupt is acknowledged, the FLG register value is saved into the SVF register and the PC value is saved into the SVP register. A program is executed from an address indicated by the VCT register. Use the FREIT instruction to return from a high-speed interrupt routine. Values saved into registers SVF and SVP are restored to the FLG register and PC by executing the FREIT instruction. The high-speed interrupt, and DMA2 and DMA3 share some of the registers. When using the high-speed interrupt, neither DMA2 nor DMA3 is available. DMA0 and DMA1 can still be used. Figure 11.2 shows a procedure to use high-speed interrupt. Start I flag = 0 Interrupt disabled RLVL register: FSIT bit = 1 DMAII bit = 0 Interrupt priority level 7 is used for the high-speed interrupt Interrupt priority level 7 is used for interrupt VCT regsiter: Set the starting address of the high-speed interrupt routine Set the peripheral function used for the high-speed interrupt source Interrupt Control Register: Bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 = 111b (level 7) Set the interrupt priority level in the Interrupt Control Register for the peripheral function used for the high-speed interrupt source. I flag = 1 Interrupt enabled Operate peripheral functions End Figure 11.2 Procedure to Use High-Speed Interrupt REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 98 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 11.5 11. Interrupts Interrupts and Interrupt Vectors There are four bytes in each interrupt vector. Set the starting address of an interrupt routine in each interrupt vector. When an interrupt request is acknowledged, an interrupt routine is executed from the address set in its interrupt vector. Figure 11.3 shows an interrupt vector. MSB Figure 11.3 11.5.1 LSB Vector address+0 8 Low-order bits of address Vector address+1 8 Middle-order bits of address Vector address+2 8 High-order bits of address Vector address+3 00h Interrupt Vector Fixed Vector Table The fixed vector table is allocated in addresses FFFFDCh to FFFFFFh. Table 11.1 lists the fixed vector table. The ID code which is used for the ID code check function of the flash memory is stored to the part of the fixed vector table. Refer to 23.3.3 ID Code Check Function for details. Table 11.1 Fixed Vector Table Interrupt Source Vector Addresses Address (L) to Address (H) Remarks Reference Undefined instruction FFFFDCh to FFFFDFh Overflow FFFFE0h to FFFFE3h BRK instruction FFFFE4h to FFFFE7h Address match FFFFE8h to FFFFEBh − FFFFECh to FFFFEFh Reserved space Watchdog timer FFFFF0h to FFFFF3h These addresses are used for Voltage monitor function, Clock generation circuit, the watchdog timer interrupt, Watchdog timer oscillation stop detection interrupt, and voltage monitor interrupt. − FFFFF4h to FFFFF7h Reserved space NMI FFFFF8h to FFFFFBh Reset FFFFFCh to FFFFFFh 11.5.2 M32C/80 series software manual If the content of the address FFFFE7h is FFh, the CPU executes from the address stored in the software interrupt number 0 in the relocatable vector table. Reset Relocatable Vector Table The relocatable vector table occupies 256 bytes beginning from the address set in the INTB register. Tables 11.2 and 11.3 list the relocatable vector table. Set an even address to the starting address of the vector set in the INTB register to increase the interrupt sequence execution rate. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 99 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 11.2 11. Interrupts Relocatable Vector Tables (1/2) Interrupt Source Vector Table Address Address (L) to Address (H)(1) Software Interrupt Number Reference BRK instruction(2) +0 to +3 (0000h to 0003h) 0 Reserved space +4 to +31 (0004h to 001Fh) 1 to 7 M32C/80 Series Software Manual DMAC DMA0 +32 to +35 (0020h to 0023h) 8 DMA1 +36 to +39 (0024h to 0027h) 9 DMA2 +40 to +43 (0028h to 002Bh) 10 DMA3 +44 to +47 (002Ch to 002Fh) 11 Timer A0 +48 to +51 (0030h to 0033h) 12 Timer A1 +52 to +55 (0034h to 0037h) 13 Timer A2 +56 to +59 (0038h to 003Bh) 14 Timer A3 +60 to +63 (003Ch to 003Fh) 15 Timer A4 +64 to +67 (0040h to 0043h) 16 UART0 transmission, NACK(3) +68 to +71 (0044h to 0047h) 17 +72 to +75 (0048h to 004Bh) 18 +76 to +79 (004Ch to 004Fh) 19 UART0 reception, ACK(3) UART1 transmission, NACK(3) ACK(3) +80 to +83 (0050h to 0053h) 20 Timer B0 +84 to +87 (0054h to 0057h) 21 Timer B1 +88 to +91 (0058h to 005Bh) 22 Timer B2 +92 to +95 (005Ch to 005Fh) 23 UART1 reception, Timer A Serial interfaces Timer B Timer B3 +96 to +99 (0060h to 0063h) 24 Timer B4 +100 to +103 (0064h to 0067h) 25 INT5 +104 to +107 (0068h to 006Bh) 26 INT4 +108 to +111 (006Ch to 006Fh) 27 INT3 +112 to +115 (0070h to 0073h) 28 INT2 +116 to +119 (0074h to 0077h) 29 INT1 +120 to +123 (0078h to 007Bh) 30 INT0 +124 to +127 (007Ch to 007Fh) 31 Timer B5 +128 to +131 (0080h to 0083h) 32 Timer B UART2 transmission, NACK(3) +132 to +135 (0084h to 0087h) 33 Serial interfaces +136 to +139 (0088h to 008Bh) 34 +140 to +143 (008Ch to 008Fh) 35 +144 to +147 (0090h to 0093h) 36 +148 to +151 (0094h to 0097h) 37 +152 to +155 (0098h to 009Bh) 38 UART2 reception, ACK(3) UART3 transmission, UART3 reception, NACK(3) ACK(3) UART4 transmission, NACK(3) UART4 reception, ACK(3) NOTES: 1. These are the addresses offset from the base address set in the INTB register. 2. The I flag can not disable this interrupt. 3. In I2C mode, NACK, ACK, or start/stop condition detection can be the interrupt sources. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 100 of 385 Interrupts Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 11.3 11. Interrupts Relocatable Vector Tables (2/2) Interrupt Source Vector Table Address Address (L) to Address (H)(1) Software Interrupt Number Reference Bus conflict detection, Start condition detection/ Stop condition detection (UART2)(3) +156 to +159 (009Ch to 009Fh) 39 Serial interfaces Bus conflict detection, Start condition detection/ Stop condition detection (UART3 or UART0)(4) +160 to +163 (00A0h to 00A3h) 40 Bus conflict detection, Start condition detection/ Stop condition detection (UART4 or UART1)(4) +164 to +167 (00A4h to 00A7h) 41 A/D0 +168 to +171 (00A8h to 00ABh) 42 A/D converter Key input +172 to +175 (00ACh to 00AFh) 43 Interrupts Reserved space +176 to +255 (00B0h to 00FFh) 44 to 63 − INT instruction(2) +0 to +3 (0000h to 0003h) to +252 to +255 (00FCh to 00FFh) 0 to 63 Interrupts NOTES: 1. These are the addresses offset from the base address set in the INTB register. 2. The I flag can not disable this interrupt. 3. In I2C mode, NACK, ACK, or start/stop condition detection can be the interrupt sources. 4. The IFSR6 bit in the IFSR register selects either UART0 or UART3. The IFSR7 bit selects either UART1 or UART4. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 101 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 11.6 11. Interrupts Interrupt Request Acknowledgement Software interrupts occur when their corresponding instructions are executed. The INTO instruction, however, requires the O flag in the FLG register to be 1. Special interrupts occur when their corresponding interrupt requests are generated. For the peripheral function interrupts to be acknowledged, the following conditions must be met: • I flag = 1 • IR bit = 1 • Bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 > IPL The I flag, IPL, IR bit, and bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 are independent of each other. The I flag and IPL are in the FLG register. The IR bit and bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 are in the Interrupt Control Register. 11.6.1 I Flag and IPL The I flag enables and disables maskable interrupts. When the I flag is set to 1 (enable), all maskable interrupts are enabled; when the I flag is set to 0 (disable), they are disabled. The I flag automatically becomes 0 after reset. IPL is 3 bits wide and indicates the Interrupt Priority Level (IPL) from level 0 to level 7. If a requested interrupt has higher priority level than IPL, the interrupt is acknowledged. Table 11.4 lists interrupt priority levels associated with IPL. Table 11.4 Interrupt Priority Levels IPL2 to IPL0 11.6.2 Required Interrupt Priority Levels to Be Acknowledged for Maskable Interrupts 0 Level 1 and above 1 Level 2 and above 2 Level 3 and above 3 Level 4 and above 4 Level 5 and above 5 Level 6 and above 6 Level 7 and above 7 All maskable interrupts are disabled Interrupt Control Registers and RLVL Register The Interrupt Control Registers are used to control the peripheral function interrupts. Figures 11.4 and 11.5 show the Interrupt Control Registers. Figure 11.6 shows the RLVL register. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 102 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 11. Interrupts Interrupt Control Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset TA0IC to TA4IC TB0IC to TB5IC S0TIC to S4TIC S0RIC to S4RIC BCN0IC to BCN4IC DM0IC to DM3IC AD0IC KUPIC 006Ch, 008Ch, 006Eh, 008Eh, 0070h 0094h, 0076h, 0096h, 0078h, 0098h, 0069h 0090h, 0092h, 0089h, 008Bh, 008Dh 0072h, 0074h, 006Bh, 006Dh, 006Fh 0071h, 0091h, 008Fh, 0071h(1), 0091h(2) 0068h, 0088h, 006Ah, 008Ah 0073h 0093h XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX XXXX Bit Symbol Bit Name b2 b1 b0 ILVL0 ILVL1 Interrupt priority level select bits ILVL2 IR − (b7-b4) Interrupt request bit(3) Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. NOTES: 1. The BCN0IC register shares the address with the BCN3IC register. 2. The BCN1IC register shares the address with the BCN4IC register. 3. The IR bit can be set to 0 only. Do not set to 1. Figure 11.4 Function Interrupt Control Register (1/2) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 103 of 385 0 0 0: Level 0 (interrupt disabled) 0 0 1: Level 1 0 1 0: Level 2 0 1 1: Level 3 1 0 0: Level 4 1 0 1: Level 5 1 1 0: Level 6 1 1 1: Level 7 0: Interrupt not requested 1: Interrupt requested X000b X000b X000b X000b X000b X000b X000b X000b RW RW RW RW RW − Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 11. Interrupts Interrupt Control Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset INT0IC to INT2IC INT3IC to INT5IC(1) 009Eh, 007Eh, 009Ch 007Ch, 009Ah, 007Ah XX00 X000b XX00 X000b Bit Symbol Bit Name b2 b1 b0 ILVL0 ILVL1 Function Interrupt priority level select bits ILVL2 0 0 0: Level 0 (interrupt disabled) 0 0 1: Level 1 0 1 0: Level 2 0 1 1: Level 3 1 0 0: Level 4 1 0 1: Level 5 1 1 0: Level 6 1 1 1: Level 7 RW RW RW RW Interrupt request bit(2) 0: Interrupt not requested 1: Interrupt requested RW POL Polarity switch bit(3) 0: Falling edge / "L" level selected 1: Rising edge / "H" level selected RW LVS Level sensitive/ edge sensitive switch bit (4) 0 : Edge sensitive 1 : Level sensitive RW IR − (b7-b6) Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. − NOTES: 1. When a 16-bit data bus is used in microprocessor mode and memory expansion mode, pins INT3 to INT5 are used as data bus. In this case, set bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 in registers INT3IC to INT5IC to 000b. 2. The IR bit can be set to 0 only. Do not set to 1. 3. Set the POL bit to 0 when its corresponding bit in the IFSR register is set to 1 (both edges). 4. When the LVS bit is set to 1, set its corresponding bit in the IFSR register to 0 (one edge). Figure 11.5 11.6.2.1 Interrupt Control Register (2/2) Bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 Bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 determine an interrupt priority level. The higher the interrupt priority level is, the higher priority the interrupt has. When an interrupt request is generated, its interrupt priority level is compared to IPL. This interrupt is enabled only when its interrupt priority level is higher than IPL. When bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 are set to 000b (level 0), the interrupt is disabled. 11.6.2.2 IR Bit The IR bit is automatically set to 1 (interrupt requested) by hardware when an interrupt request is generated. After an interrupt request is acknowledged and an interrupt sequence in the corresponding interrupt vector is executed, the IR bit is automatically set to 0 (interrupt not requested) by hardware. The IR bit can be set to 0 by a program. Do not set it to 1. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 104 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 11. Interrupts Exit Priority Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset RLVL 009Fh XXXX 0000b Bit Symbol Bit Name b2 b1 b0 RLVL0 RLVL1 Function Exit wait mode/stop mode interrupt priority level control bits(1) RLVL2 FSIT High-speed interrupt select bit − (b4) Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. DMAII DMACII select bit (4) − (b7-b6) Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. 0 0 0: Level 0 0 0 1: Level 1 0 1 0: Level 2 0 1 1: Level 3 1 0 0: Level 4 1 0 1: Level 5 1 1 0: Level 6 1 1 1: Level 7 0: Interrupt priority level 7 is used for normal interrupt 1: Interrupt priority level 7 is used for high-speed interrupt(2)(3) RW RW RW RW RW − 0: Interrupt priority level 7 is used for interrupt 1: Interrupt priority level 7 is used for DMACII transfer (2) RW − NOTES: 1. The MCU exits stop or wait mode when an interrupt priority level of a requested interrupt is higher than a level set using bits RLVL2 to RLVL0. Set bits RLVL2 to RLVL0 to the same value as IPL in the FLG register. 2. Do not set both the FSIT and DMAII bits to 1. Set either the FSIT bit or the DMAII bit to 1 before setting bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 in the Interrupt Control Register to 111b. 3. Only one interrupt can have the interrupt priority level 7 when selecting the high-speed interrupt. 4. The DMAII bit is undefined after reset. To use interrupt priority level 7 for an interrupt, set it to 0 before setting the Interrupt Control Register. Figure 11.6 11.6.2.3 RLVL Register Bits RLVL2 to RLVL0 When using an interrupt to exit wait mode or stop mode, refer to 9.5.2 Wait Mode and 9.5.3 Stop Mode for details. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 105 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 11.6.3 11. Interrupts Interrupt Sequence The interrupt sequence is performed between an interrupt request acknowledgment and interrupt routine execution. When an interrupt request is generated while an instruction is being executed, the CPU determines its interrupt priority after the instruction in progress is completed. Then, the CPU starts the interrupt sequence from the following cycle. However, for the SCMPU, SIN, SMOVB, SMOVF, SMOVU, SSTR, SOUT, and RMPA instructions, if an interrupt request is generated while one of these instructions is being executed, the MCU suspends the instruction execution to start the interrupt sequence. The interrupt sequence is performed as indicated below: (1) The CPU obtains the interrupt number by reading the address 000000h (address 000002h for the highspeed interrupt). Then, the corresponding IR bit to the interrupt becomes 0 (interrupt not requested). (2) The FLG register value, immediately before the interrupt sequence, is saved to a temporary register(1) in the CPU. (3) Each bit in the FLG register becomes as follows: The I flag becomes 0 (interrupt disabled) The D flag becomes 0 (single-step interrupt disabled) The U flag becomes 0 (ISP selected) (4) The internal register value (the FLG register value saved in (2)) in the CPU is saved to the stack; or to the SVF register for the high-speed interrupt. (5) The PC value is saved to the stack; or to the SVP register for the high-speed interrupt. (6) The interrupt priority level of the acknowledged interrupt becomes the IPL level. (7) An interrupt vector corresponding to the acknowledged interrupt is stored into PC. After the interrupt sequence is completed, the CPU executes the instruction from the starting address of the interrupt routine. NOTE: 1. Temporary register cannot be accessed by users. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 106 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 11.6.4 11. Interrupts Interrupt Response Time Figure 11.7 shows the interrupt response time. Interrupt response time is the period between an interrupt request generation and the end of an interrupt sequence. Interrupt response time is divided into two phases: the period between an interrupt request generation and the end of the ongoing instruction execution ((a) in Figure 11.7), and the period required to perform the interrupt sequence ((b) in Figure 11.7). Interrupt request is generated Interrupt request is acknowledged Time Instruction Interrupt sequence (a) Instruction in interrupt routine (b) Interrupt response time (a) Period between an interrupt request generation and the end of instruction execution. (b) Period required to perform an interrupt sequence. Figure 11.7 Interrupt Response Time Time (a) varies depending on an instruction being executed. The DIV, DIVX, and DIVU instructions require the longest time (a), which is at the maximum of 42 cycles. Table 11.5 lists time (b). Table 11.5 Interrupt Sequence Execution Time(1) Interrupts Execution Time (in terms of CPU clock) Peripheral function 14 cycles INT instruction 12 cycles NMI Watchdog timer Undefined instruction Address match 13 cycles Overflow 14 cycles BRK instruction (relocatable vector table) 17 cycles BRK instruction (fixed vector table) 19 cycles High-speed interrupt 5 cycles NOTE: 1. The values when interrupt vectors are allocated in even addresses in the internal ROM, except for the highspeed interrupt. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 107 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 11.6.5 11. Interrupts IPL Change when Interrupt Request is Acknowledged When a peripheral function interrupt request is acknowledged, the priority level for the acknowledged interrupt becomes the IPL level in the flag register. Software interrupts and special interrupts have no interrupt priority level. If an interrupt that has no interrupt priority level occurs, the value shown in Table 11.6 becomes the IPL level. Table 11.6 Interrupts without Interrupt Priority Levels and IPL Interrupt Source IPL level Watchdog timer, NMI, oscillation stop detection, voltage monitor, DMACII end-of-transfer interrupt 7 Software, address match 11.6.6 Not changed Saving a Register In the interrupt sequence, values of the FLG register and PC are saved to the stack. Figure 11.8 shows the stack states before and after an interrupt request is acknowledged. The other necessary registers are saved by a program at the beginning of the interrupt routine. The PUSHM instruction can save multiple registers(1) in the register bank currently used. Refer to 11.4 High-Speed Interrupt for the high-speed interrupt. NOTE: 1. Selectable from registers R0, R1, R2, R3, A0, A1, SB, and FB. Address Address MSB Stack LSB MSB Stack m-6 m-6 PCL m-5 m-5 PCM m-4 m-4 PCH m-3 m-3 00h m-2 m-2 FLGL m-1 FLGH m-1 m Previous stack contents m+1 Previous stack contents [SP] SP value before an interrupt is generated Stack state before an interrupt request is acknowledged Figure 11.8 m Previous stack contents m+1 Previous stack contents LSB [SP] New SP value PCL: 8 low-order bits of PC PCM: 8 middle-order bits of PC PCH: 8 high-order bits of PC FLGL: 8 low-order bits of FLG FLGH: 8 high-order bits of FLG Stack state after an interrupt request is acknowledged Stack States Before and After Acknowledgement of Interrupt Request REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 108 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 11.6.7 11. Interrupts Returning from Interrupt Routine When the REIT instruction is executed at the end of an interrupt routine, the values of the FLG register and PC, which have been saved to the stack before the interrupt sequence is performed, are automatically restored. And then, the program that was running before an interrupt request was acknowledged, resumes its process. The high-speed interrupt uses the FREIT instruction instead. Refer to 11.4 High-Speed Interrupt for details. Before executing the REIT or FREIT instruction, use the POPM instruction or the like to restore registers saved by a program in the interrupt routine. By executing the REIT or FREIT instruction, register bank is switched back to the bank used immediately before the interrupt sequence. 11.6.8 Interrupt Priority If two or more interrupt requests are detected at the same sampling points (a timing to check whether any interrupt request is generated or not), the interrupt with the highest priority is acknowledged. Set bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 in the Interrupt Control Register to select the given priority level for maskable interrupts (peripheral function interrupts). Priority levels of special interrupts, such as NMI and watchdog timer interrupt are fixed by hardware. Figure 11.9 shows the priority of hardware interrupts. The interrupt priority does not affect software interrupts. Executing an instruction for a software interrupt causes the MCU to execute an interrupt routine. NMI H Watchdog timer Oscillation stop detection Voltage monitor Peripheral function Address match Figure 11.9 11.6.9 L Interrupt Priority of Hardware Interrupts Interrupt Priority Level Decision Circuit The interrupt priority level decision circuit selects the highest priority interrupt when two or more interrupt requests are generated at the same sampling point. Figure 11.10 shows the interrupt priority level decision circuit. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 109 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group High 11. Interrupts Interrupt priority level Level 0 (initial value) DMA0 DMA1 DMA2 DMA3 Timer A0 Timer A1 Timer A2 Timer A3 Timer A4 UART0 transmission/NACK UART0 reception/ACK UART1 transmission/NACK UART1 reception/ACK Timer B0 Timer B1 Timer B2 Interrupt priority level Timer B3 Timer B4 INT5 Bus conflict/ start or stop condition detection (UART0, UART3) INT4 Bus conflict/ start or stop condition detection (UART1, UART4) INT3 A/D0 INT2 Key input interrupt INT1 INT0 Timer B5 Bits RLVL2 to RLVL0 Request signal used to wake-up from wait mode/stop mode (to the clock generation circuit) UART2 transmission/NACK UART2 reception/ACK IPL UART3 transmission/NACK UART3 reception/ACK I flag UART4 transmission/NACK UART4 reception/ACK Low Bus conflict/ start or stop condition detection (UART2) Peripheral function interrupt priority (if priority levels are the same) Figure 11.10 Address match Watchdog timer, oscillation stop detection, voltage monitor NMI DMACII Interrupt Priority Level Decision Circuit REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 110 of 385 Interrupt request acknowledged (to CPU) Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 11.7 11. Interrupts INT Interrupt External input to pins INT0 to INT5 generates the INT0 to INT5 interrupt. INT0 to INT5 interrupts can select either edge sensitive, which the rising/falling edge triggers an interrupt request, or level sensitive, which an input signal level to the INTi pin (i = 0 to 5) triggers an interrupt request. To use INT0 to INT5 interrupts with edge sensitive, set the LVS bit in the INTiIC register to 0 (edge sensitive), and select a rising edge, falling edge, or both edges using the POL bit in the INTiIC register and the IFSRi bit in the IFSR register. When the IFSRi bit is set to 1 (both edges), set the corresponding POL bit to 0 (falling edge). When the selected edge is detected at the INTi pin, the corresponding IR bit becomes 1. To use INT0 to INT5 interrupts with level sensitive, set the LVS bit to 1 (level sensitive) and select either “L” level or “H” level using the POL bit. Also, set the IFSRi bit to 0 (one edge). While the selected level is detected at the INTi pin, the IR bit becomes 1 and remains 1. Therefore, the interrupt requests are generated repeatedly as long as the selected level is detected at the INTi pin. When the input signal is changed to the inactive level, the IR bit becomes 0 by the interrupt request acknowledgement or writing a 0 by a program. Interrupts can be enabled or disabled using bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 in the INTiIC register. Figure 11.11 shows INTi interrupt setting procedures (i = 0 to 5). Figure 11.12 shows the IFSR register. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 111 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 11. Interrupts < Procedure for Edge Sensitive > Start INTiIC register: bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 = 000b Interrupt disabled IFSR register: IFSRi bit Select either one edge or both edges INTiIC register: POL bit LVS bit = 0 Select polarity (Set to 0 when both edges are selected) Select edge sensitive INTiIC register: IR bit = 0 Clear the interrupt request bit INTiIC register: bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 Interrupt enabled End < Procedure for Level Sensitive > Start INTiIC register: bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 = 000b Interrupt disabled IFSR register: IFSRi bit = 0 Select one edge INTiIC register: POL bit LVS bit = 1 Select polarity Select level sensitive INTiIC register: IR bit = 0 Clear the interrupt request bit INTiIC register: bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 Interrupt enabled End Figure 11.11 INTi Interrupt Setting Procedures (i = 0 to 5) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 112 of 385 i = 0 to 5 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 11. Interrupts External Interrupt Source Select Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol IFSR Address 031Fh Bit Symbol Bit Name After Reset 00h Function IFSR0 INT0 interrupt polarity select bit(1) 0: One edge 1: Both edges RW IFSR1 INT1 interrupt polarity select bit(1) 0: One edge 1: Both edges RW IFSR2 INT2 interrupt polarity select bit(1) 0: One edge 1: Both edges RW IFSR3 INT3 interrupt polarity select bit(1) 0: One edge 1: Both edges RW IFSR4 INT4 interrupt polarity select bit(1) 0: One edge 1: Both edges RW IFSR5 INT5 interrupt polarity select bit(1) 0: One edge 1: Both edges RW IFSR6 UART0, UART3 interrupt source select bit 0: UART3 bus conflict, start condition detection, stop condition detection 1: UART0 bus conflict, start condition detection, stop condition detection RW IFSR7 UART1, UART4 interrupt source select bit 0: UART4 bus conflict, start condition detection, stop condition detection 1: UART1 bus conflict, start condition detection, stop condition detection RW NOTE: 1. Set the IFSRi bit (i = 0 to 5) to 0 to select a level-sensitive triggering. When selecting both edges, set the POL bit in the corresponding INTilC register to 0 (falling edge). Figure 11.12 RW IFSR Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 113 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 11.8 11. Interrupts NMI Interrupt The NMI interrupt is non-maskable. The NMI interrupt occurs when a signal applied to the P8_5/NMI pin changes from “H” level to “L” level. A read from the P8_5 bit in the P8 register returns the input level of the NMI pin. When the NMI interrupt is not used, connect the NMI pin to VCC1 via a resistor (pull-up). Each “H” or “L” width of the signal applied to the NMI pin must be 2 CPU clock cycles + 300 ns or more. 11.9 Key Input Interrupt The IR bit in the KUPIC register becomes 1 when an falling edge is detected at any of the pins P10_4 to P10_7 set to input mode. The key input interrupt can also be used as key-on wake-up function to exit wait mode or stop mode. To use the key input interrupt, do not use pins P10_4 to P10_7 as A/D input. Figure 11.13 shows a block diagram of the key input interrupt. When an “L” signal is applied to one of the pins P10_4 to P10_7 in input mode, a falling edge detected at the other pins is not recognized as an interrupt request signal. When the PSC_7 bit in the PSC register is set to 1 (AN_4 to AN_7), the input buffer for the port and the key input interrupt is disconnected. Therefore, the pin level cannot be obtained by reading the Port P10 register in input mode. Also, the IR bit in the KUPIC register does not become 1 even if a falling edge is detected at pins KI0 to KI3. PU31 bit Pull-up transistor PD10_7 bit PSC_7 bit PD10_7 bit P10_7/KI3 Pull-up transistor PD10_6 bit Key input interrupt request P10_6/KI2 Pull-up transistor PD10_5 bit Pull-up transistor PD10_4 bit P10_5/KI1 PD10_4 to PD10_7: Bits in the PD10 register PSC_7: Bit in the PSC register PU31: Bit in the PUR3 register P10_4/KI0 Figure 11.13 Key Input Interrupt Block Diagram REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 114 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 11. Interrupts 11.10 Address Match Interrupt The address match interrupt is non-maskable. This interrupt occurs immediately before executing the instruction stored in the address specified by the RMADi register (i = 0 to 7). Eight addresses can be set for the address match interrupt. The AIERi bit in the AIER register determines whether the interrupt is enabled or disabled. Figure 11.14 shows registers associated with the address match interrupt. Set the starting address of the instruction in the RMADi register. The address match interrupt does not occur if a table data or any address other than the starting address of the instruction is set. Address Match Interrupt Register i (i = 0 to 7) b23 b16 b15 b8 b7 b0 Symbol Address RMAD0 RMAD1 RMAD2 RMAD3 RMAD4 RMAD5 RMAD6 RMAD7 0012h to 0010h 0016h to 0014h 001Ah to 0018h 001Eh to 001Ch 002Ah to 0028h 002Eh to 002Ch 003Ah to 0038h 003Eh to 003Ch After Reset 000000h 000000h 000000h 000000h 000000h 000000h 000000h 000000h Function Address register for the address match interrupt Setting Range RW 000000h to FFFFFFh RW Address Match Interrupt Enable Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset AIER 0009h 00h Bit Symbol Figure 11.14 Bit Name Function RW AIER0 Address match interrupt 0 enable bit 0: interrupt disabled 1: interrupt enabled RW AIER1 Address match interrupt 1 enable bit 0: interrupt disabled 1: interrupt enabled RW AIER2 Address match interrupt 2 enable bit 0: interrupt disabled 1: interrupt enabled RW AIER3 Address match interrupt 3 enable bit 0: interrupt disabled 1: interrupt enabled RW AIER4 Address match interrupt 4 enable bit 0: interrupt disabled 1: interrupt enabled RW AIER5 Address match interrupt 5 enable bit 0: interrupt disabled 1: interrupt enabled RW AIER6 Address match interrupt 6 enable bit 0: interrupt disabled 1: interrupt enabled RW AIER7 Address match interrupt 7 enable bit 0: interrupt disabled 1: interrupt enabled RW RMAD0 to RMAD7 Registers, AIER Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 115 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 12. Watchdog Timer 12. Watchdog Timer The watchdog timer is used to detect the program running improperly. The watchdog timer contains a 15-bit freerunning counter. If a write to the WDTS register is not performed due to a program running out of control, the freerunning counter underflows, which results in the watchdog timer interrupt generation or the MCU reset. When operating the watchdog timer, write to the WDTS register in a shorter cycle than the watchdog timer cycle in such as the main routine. Tables 12.1 and 12.2 list specifications of the watchdog timer. Figure 12.1 shows a block diagram of the watchdog timer. Figures 12.2 and 12.3 show registers associated with the watchdog timer. Table 12.1 Watchdog Timer Specifications (1/2) Item Specification Count operation The free-running counter decrements Count start condition Writing to the WDTS register: A write to the WDTS register initializes a free-running counter and the counter decrements from 7FFFh When underflows One of the following occurs (selectable using the CM06 bit in the CM0 register): • Watchdog timer interrupt generation(1) • MCU reset After underflows The counter continues decrementing (when the watchdog timer interrupt is selected) Read from watchdog timer A read from bit 4 to bit 0 in the WDC register returns bit 14 to bit 10 of the free-running counter NOTE: 1. The watchdog timer shares the same vector with the oscillation stop detection interrupt and voltage monitor interrupt. Table 12.2 Watchdog Timer Specifications (2/2) Item Bit Setting and Specification register(1) 0 0 0 1 CM07 bit in CM0 register 0 0 1 0 or 1 WDC7 bit in WDC register 0 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 PM22 bit in PM2 Clock source CPU clock Clock divided by MCD register Prescaler Sub clock On-chip oscillator Divide-by-16 Divide-by-128 Divide-by-2 not available 1 × 16 fCPU 1 fCPU × 128 1 ×2 fCPU 1 fROC Time-out period (formula)(2) 1 × 524288 fCPU 1 fCPU × 4194304 1 × 65536 fCPU 1 fROC × 32768 Time-out period (reference) Approx. 16.4 ms fCPU = 32 MHz Approx. 131.1 ms fCPU = 32 MHz Approx. 2 s fCPU = 32 kHz Approx. 32.8 ms fROC = 1 MHz Count source for counter Operation in wait mode, stop mode, and hold state Stops Operates(3) fCPU: CPU clock frequency fROC: On-chip oscillator clock frequency NOTES: 1. Once the PM22 bit is set to 1, it cannot be set to 0 by a program. 2. Difference between the calculation result and actual period can be one count source cycle of the counter. 3. A write to the CM10 bit in the CM1 register is disabled. Writing a 1 has no effect and the MCU does not enter stop mode. The watchdog timer interrupt cannot be used to exit wait mode. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 116 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 12. Watchdog Timer Prescaler 1/16 CPU clock Wait mode signal HOLD 1/128 1/2 CM07=0 WDC7=0 CM07=0 WDC7=1 CM07=1 PM22 CM06 0 1 Write signal to the WDTS register Internal reset signal CM06, CM07: bits in the CM0 register WDC7: bit in the WDC register PM22: bit in the PM2 register Figure 12.1 Watchdog Timer Block Diagram REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 117 of 385 Watchdog timer interrupt signal Watchdog timer 1 Set to 7FFFh On-chip oscillator clock 0 Reset Voltage monitor interrupt signal Oscillation stop detection interrupt signal Watchdog timer interrupt request (non-maskable) Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 12. Watchdog Timer System Clock Control Register 0(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol CM0 After Reset 0000 1000b Address 0006h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function b1 b0 CM00 Clock output function select bits (2) CM01 0 0: I/O port P5_3(2) 0 1: Outputs fC 1 0: Outputs f8 1 1: Outputs f32 RW RW RW CM02 Peripheral function clock stop in wait mode bit(9) 0: Peripheral clocks do not stop in wait mode 1: Peripheral clocks stop in wait mode (3) RW CM03 XCIN-XCOUT drive capability select bit(10) 0: Low 1: High RW CM04 Port XC switch bit 0: I/O port function 1: XCIN-XCOUT oscillation function (4) RW CM05 Main clock (XIN-XOUT) stop bit(5, 9) 0: Main clock oscillates 1: Main clock stops (6) RW CM06 Watchdog timer function select bit 0: Watchdog timer interrupt 1: Reset(7) RW CM07 CPU clock select bit 0 (8, 9) 0: Clock selected by the CM21 bit divided by the MCD register 1: Sub clock RW NOTES: 1. Set the CM0 register after the PRC0 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). 2. The BCLK, ALE, or "L" signal is output from the P5_3 in memory expansion mode or microprocessor mode. Port P5_3 does not function as an I/O port. 3. fC32 does not stop running. 4. To set the CM04 bit to 1, set bits PD8_7 and PD8_6 in the PD8 register to 00b (ports P8_6 and P8_7 in input mode) and the PU25 bit in the PUR2 register to 0 (not pulled up). 5. The CM05 bit stops the main clock oscillation when entering low-power consumption mode or on-chip oscillator low-power consumption mode. The CM05 bit cannot be used to determine whether the main clock stops or not. To stop the main clock oscillation, set the PLC07 bit in the PLC0 register to 0 and the CM05 bit to 1 after setting the CM07 bit to 1 or setting the CM21 bit in the CM2 register to 1 (on-chip oscillator clock). When the CM05 bit is set to 1, the XOUT pin outputs "H". Since an on-chip feedback resistor remains ON, the XIN pin is pulled up to the XOUT pin via the feedback resistor. 6. When the CM05 bit is set to 1, bits MCD4 to MCD0 in the MCD register become 01000b (divide-by-8 mode). In on-chip oscillator mode, bits MCD4 to MCD0 do not become 01000b even if the CM05 bit is set to 1. 7. Once the CM06 bit is set to 1, it cannot be set to 0 by a program. 8. Change the CM07 bit setting from 0 to 1, after the CM04 bit is set to 1 and the sub clock oscillation stabilizes. Change the CM07 bit setting from 1 to 0, after the CM05 bit is set to 0 and the main clock oscillation stabilizes. Do not change the CM07 bit simultaneously with the CM04 or CM05 bit. 9. If the PM21 bit in the PM2 register is set to 1 (disables a clock change), a write to bits CM02, CM05, and CM07 has no effect. 10. When stop mode is entered, the CM03 bit becomes 1. Figure 12.2 CM0 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 118 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 12. Watchdog Timer Watchdog Timer Control Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 Symbol WDC Address 000Fh After Reset 000X XXXXb Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW − (b4-b0) High-order bits of watchdog timer − (b6-b5) Reserved bits Set to 0 RW WDC7 Prescaler select bit 0: Divide-by-16 1: Divide-by-128 RW RO Watchdog Timer Start Register b7 b0 Symbol WDTS Address 000Eh Address Undefined Function The counter is initialized and starts decrementing by a write instruction to the WDTS register. 7FFFh is the default value after initialization no matter what value is written. Figure 12.3 WDC Register, WDTS Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 119 of 385 RW WO Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 13. DMAC 13. DMAC DMAC allows data to be sent to and from memory without involving the CPU. The M32C/8B Group has four DMAC channels. DMAC transfers an 8- or 16-bit data from a source address to a destination address for each transfer request. DMA0 and DMA1 must be prioritized when using DMAC. DMA2 and DMA3 share the registers with the high-speed interrupts. The high-speed interrupts cannot be used when three or more DMAC channels are used. The CPU and DMAC use the same data bus, but DMAC has a higher bus access privilege than the CPU. DMAC employing the cycle-steal method enables a high-speed operation from a transfer request to a completion of 16-bit (word) or 8-bit (byte) data transfer. Figure 13.1 shows a mapping of DMAC-associated registers. Table 13.1 lists specifications of DMAC. Figures 13.2 to 13.6 show DMAC-associated registers. Figures 13.7 and 13.8 show register settings. Because the registers shown in Figure 13.1 are allocated in the CPU, use the LDC instruction to set the registers. To set registers DCT2, DCT3, DRC2, DRC3, DMA2, and DMA3, set the B flag to 1 (register bank 1) and write to registers R0 to R3, A0, and A1 with the MOV instruction. To set registers DSA2 and DSA3, set the B flag to 1 and write to registers SB and FB with the LDC instruction. To set registers DRA2 and DRA3, write to registers SVP and VCT with the LDC instruction. DMAC-Associated Registers DMD0 DMA mode register 0 DMD1 DMA mode register 1 DCT0 DMA0 transfer count register DCT1 DMA1 transfer count register DRC0 DMA0 transfer count reload register (1) DRC1 DMA1 transfer count reload register (1) DMA0 DMA0 memory address register DMA1 DMA1 memory address register DSA0 DMA0 SFR Address register DSA1 DMA1 SFR Address register DRA0 DMA0 memory address reload register (1) DRA1 DMA1 memory address reload register (1) When three or more DMAC channels are used, the high-speed interrupt registers are employed as DMAC registers. When three or more DMAC channels are used, the register bank 1 is employed as DMAC registers. DCT2(R0) DMA2 transfer count register SVF DCT3(R1) DMA3 transfer count register DRA2(SVP) DMA2 memory address reload register (1) DRC2(R2) DMA2 transfer count reload register (1) DRA3(VCT) DMA3 memory address reload register (1) DRC3(R3) (1) DMA3 transfer count reload register DMA2(A0) DMA2 memory address register DMA3(A1) DMA3 memory address register DSA2(SB) DMA2 SFR Address register DSA3(FB) DMA3 SFR Address register NOTE: 1. These registers are used for repeat transfer, not for single transfer. Figure 13.1 Register Mapping for DMAC REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 120 of 385 Flag save register When using DMA2 and DMA3, use the CPU registers shown in parentheses ( ). Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 13. DMAC A software trigger or an interrupt request generated by individual peripheral functions can be the DMA transfer request source. Bits DSEL 4 to DSEL0 in the DMiSL register determine which source is selected. When a software trigger is selected, a DMA transfer is started by setting the DSR bit in the DMiSL register to 1. When a peripheral function interrupt request is selected, a DMA transfer is started by an interrupt request generation. The DMA transfer is performed even if interrupts are disabled by the I flag, IPL, or Interrupt Control Register, since DMAC is free from these affects. When an interrupt request (DMA request) is generated, the IR bit in the Interrupt Control Register becomes 1. The IR bit, however, does not become 0 even if the DMA transfer is performed. Table 13.1 DMAC Specifications Item Specification Number of Channels 4 channels (cycle-steal method) Transfer memory space • From a given address in a 16-Mbyte space to a fixed address in a 16-Mbyte space • From a fixed address in a 16-Mbyte space to a given address in a 16-Mbyte space Maximum bytes transferred 128 Kbytes (when a 16-bit data is transferred) 64 Kbytes (when an 8-bit data is transferred) DMA request source • Falling edge or both edges of signals applied to pins INT0 to INT3 • Timer A0 to A4 interrupt requests • Timer B0 to B5 interrupt requests • UART0 to UART4 transmit/receive interrupt requests • A/D0 interrupt request • Software trigger Channel priority DMA0 > DMA1 > DMA2 > DMA3 (DMA0 has the highest priority) Transfer unit 8 bits, 16 bits Transfer address Fixed address: one specified address Incremented address: address which is incremented by a transfer unit on each successive access. (Source address and destination address cannot be both fixed nor both incremented.) Transfer mode Single transfer Transfer is completed when the DCTi register (i = 0 to 3) becomes 0000h Repeat transfer When the DCTi register becomes 0000h, values of the DRCi register are reloaded into the DCTi register and the DMA transfer continues. DMA interrupt request generation timing When the DCTi register becomes from 0001h to 0000h, a DMA interrupt request is generated. DMA start Single transfer DMAC starts a data transfer when a DMA request is generated after bits MDi1 and MDi0 in the DMDj register (j = 0 to 1) are set to 01b (single transfer), while the DCTi register is set to 0001h or higher value. Repeat transfer DMAC starts a data transfer when a DMA request is generated after bits MDi1 and MDi0 are set to 11b (repeat transfer), while the DCTi register is set to 0001h or higher value. Single transfer • When bits MDi1 and MDi0 are set to 00b (DMA disabled) • When the DCTi register becomes 0000h (no DMA transfer) at completion of DMA transfer, or is set to 0000h by a program. Repeat transfer • When bits MDi1 and MDi0 are set to 00b (DMA disabled) • When the DCTi register becomes 0000h (no DMA transfer) at completion of DMA transfer, or is set to 0000h by a program while the DRCi register is 0000h. DMA stop Reload timing to registers DCTi Values are reloaded when the DCTi register becomes from 0001h to 0000h in repeat and DMAi transfer mode. DMA transfer time Between SFR area and internal RAM transfer: minimum 3 bus clock cycles REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 121 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 13. DMAC DMAi Request Source Select Register (i=0 to 3) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol DM0SL to DM3SL Bit Symbol Address 0378h, 0379h, 037Ah, 037Bh Bit Name After Reset 0X00 0000b Function RW DSEL0 RW DSEL1 RW See Table "DMiSL register function (i = 0 to 3)" DSEL2 DMA request source select bits(1) Do not set to values other than specified in the Table. DSEL3 RW DSEL4 RW DSR Software DMA request bit (2) When a software trigger is selected, a DMA request is generated by setting this bit to 1 (Read as 0) − (b6) Reserved bit Read as undefined value DRQ DMA request bit(2, 3) 0: Not requested 1: Requested NOTES: 1. Change settings of bits DSEL4 to DSEL0 while bits MDi1 and MDi0 in the DMD0 or DMD1 register are set to 00b (DMA disabled). Also, when bits DSEL4 to DSEL0 are changed, set the DRQ bit to 1 at the same time. e.g., MOV.B #083h, DMiSL ; Select timer A0 2. When the DSR bit is set to 1, set the DRQ bit to 1 at the same time. e.g., OR.B #0A0h, DMiSL 3. Do not write a 0 to the DRQ bit. Figure 13.2 RW DM0SL to DM3SL Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 122 of 385 RW − RW Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 13.2 13. DMAC DMiSL Register (i = 0 to 3) Function Setting Value DMA Request Source b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 DMA0 DMA1 DMA2 DMA3 0 0 0 0 0 Software trigger 0 0 0 0 1 Falling edge of INT0 Falling edge of INT1 Falling edge of INT2 Falling edge of INT3(1) (Note 2) 0 0 0 1 0 Both edges of INT0 Both edges of INT1 Both edges of INT2 Both edges of INT3(1) (Note 2) 0 0 0 1 1 Timer A0 interrupt request 0 0 1 0 0 Timer A1 interrupt request 0 0 1 0 1 Timer A2 interrupt request 0 0 1 1 0 Timer A3 interrupt request 0 0 1 1 1 Timer A4 interrupt request 0 1 0 0 0 Timer B0 interrupt request 0 1 0 0 1 Timer B1 interrupt request 0 1 0 1 0 Timer B2 interrupt request 0 1 0 1 1 Timer B3 interrupt request 0 1 1 0 0 Timer B4 interrupt request 0 1 1 0 1 Timer B5 interrupt request 0 1 1 1 0 UART0 transmit interrupt request 0 1 1 1 1 UART0 receive interrupt or ACK interrupt request(3) 1 0 0 0 0 UART1 transmit interrupt request 1 0 0 0 1 UART1 receive interrupt or ACK interrupt request(3) 1 0 0 1 0 UART2 transmit interrupt request 1 0 0 1 1 UART2 receive interrupt or ACK interrupt request(3) 1 0 1 0 0 UART3 transmit interrupt request 1 0 1 0 1 UART3 receive interrupt or ACK interrupt request(3) 1 0 1 1 0 UART4 transmit interrupt request 1 0 1 1 1 UART4 receive interrupt or ACK interrupt request(3) 1 1 0 0 0 A/D0 interrupt request NOTES: 1. When the INT3 pin is used for data bus in memory expansion mode or microprocessor mode, a DMA3 interrupt request cannot be generated by an input signal to the INT3 pin. 2. The falling edge or both edges of input signal to the INTi pin can be a DMA request source. It is not affected by the INT interrupts (bits POL and LVS in the INTiIC register, the IFSR register) and vice versa. 3. To switch between the UARTj receive interrupt and ACK interrupt (j = 0 to 4), use the IICM bit in the UiSMR register and IICM2 bit on the UiSMR2 register. To use the ACK interrupt, set the IICM bit to 1 (I2C mode) and the IICM2 bit to 0 (NACK/ACK interrupt). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 123 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 13. DMAC DMAi Memory Address Register (i = 0 to 3) b23 b16 b15 b8 b7 b0 Symbol (2) DMA0 DMA1(2) DMA2 (bank1:A0)(3) DMA3 (bank1:A1)(4) Address After Reset (CPU internal register) (CPU internal register) (CPU internal register) (CPU internal register) XXXXXXh XXXXXXh 000000h 000000h Function Set an incremented source address or incremented destination address(1) Setting Range RW 000000h to FFFFFFh (16 Mbytes) RW NOTES: 1. When the RWk bit (k = 0 to 3) in the DMDj register (j = 0, 1) is set to 0 (fixed address to incremented address), a destination address is selected. When the RWk bit is set to 1 (incremented address to fixed address), a source address is selected. 2. Use the LDC instruction to set registers DMA0 and DMA1. 3. To set the DMA2 register, set the B flag in the FLG register to 1 (register bank 1) and write to the A0 register. 4. To set the DMA3 register, set the B flag to 1 and write to the A1 register. DMAi SFR Address Register (i = 0 to 3) b23 b16 b15 b8 b7 b0 Symbol Address After Reset DSA0(2) DSA1(2) DSA2 (bank1:SB)(3) DSA3 (bank1:FB)(4) (CPU internal register) (CPU internal register) (CPU internal register) (CPU internal register) XXXXXXh XXXXXXh 000000h 000000h Function Set a fixed source address or fixed destination address (1) Setting Range RW 000000h to FFFFFFh (16 Mbytes) RW NOTES: 1. When the RWk bit (k = 0 to 3) in the DMDj register (j = 0, 1) is set to 0 (fixed address to incremented address), a source address is selected. When the RWk bit is set to 1 (incremented address to fixed address), a destination address is selected. 2. Use the LDC instruction to set registers DSA0 and DSA1. 3. To set the DSA2 register, set the B flag in the FLG register to 1 (register bank 1) and write to the SB register using the LDC instruction. 4. To set the DSA3 register, set the B flag to 1 and write to the FB register using the LDC instruction. Figure 13.3 DMA0 to DMA3 Registers, DSA0 to DSA3 Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 124 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 13. DMAC DMAi Memory Address Reload Register(1) (i = 0 to 3) b23 b16 b15 b8 b7 b0 Symbol Address After Reset DRA0 DRA1 DRA2 (SVP)(2) DRA3 (VCT)(3) (CPU internal register) (CPU internal register) (CPU internal register) (CPU internal register) XXXXXXh XXXXXXh XXXXXXh XXXXXXh Function Set an incremented source address or incremented destination address Setting Range RW 000000h to FFFFFFh (16 Mbytes) RW NOTES: 1. Use the LDC instruction to set registers DRA0 to DRA3. 2. To set the DRA2 register, write to the SVP register. 3. To set the DRA3 register, write to the VCT register. DMAi Transfer Count Register (i = 0 to 3) b15 b8 b7 b0 Symbol Address After Reset DCT0(2) (CPU internal register) (CPU internal register) (CPU internal register) (CPU internal register) XXXXh XXXXh 0000h 0000h DCT1(2) DCT2 (bank1:R0)(3) DCT3 (bank1:R1)(4) Function Set the number of transfers Setting Range RW 0000h to FFFFh(1) RW NOTES: 1. When the DCTi register is set to 0000h, no data transfer occurs regardless of a DMA request generation. 2. Use the LDC instruction to set registers DCT0 and DCT1. 3. To set the DCT2 register, set the B flag in the FLG register to 1 (register bank 1) and write to the R0 register. 4. To set the DCT3 register, set the B flag to 1 and write to the R1 register. DMAi Transfer Count Reload Register (i = 0 to 3) b15 b8 b7 b0 Symbol Address After Reset DRC0(1) DRC1(1) DRC2 (bank1:R2)(2) DRC3 (bank1:R3)(3) (CPU internal register) (CPU internal register) (CPU internal register) (CPU internal register) XXXXh XXXXh 0000h 0000h Function Set the number of transfers Setting Range RW 0000h to FFFFh RW NOTES: 1. Use the LDC instruction to set registers DRC0 and DRC1. 2. To set the DRC2 register, set the B flag in the FLG register to 1 (register bank 1) and write to the R2 register. 3. To set the DRC3 register, set the B flag to 1 and write to the R3 register. Figure 13.4 DRA0 to DRA3 Registers, DCT0 to DCT3 Registers, DRC0 to DRC3 Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 125 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 13. DMAC DMA Mode Register 0(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol DMD0 Bit Symbol Bit Name Function b1 b0 MD00 Channel 0 transfer mode select bits MD01 0 0: DMA disabled 0 1: Single transfer 1 0: Do not set to this value 1 1: Repeat transfer RW RW RW BW0 Channel 0 transfer unit select bit 0: 8 bits 1: 16 bits RW RW0 Channel 0 transfer direction select bit 0: Fixed address to incremented address 1: Incremented address to fixed address RW b5 b4 MD10 Channel 1 transfer mode select bits MD11 0 0: DMA disabled 0 1: Single transfer 1 0: Do not set to this value 1 1: Repeat transfer RW RW BW1 Channel 1 transfer unit select bit 0: 8 bits 1: 16 bits RW RW1 Channel 1 transfer direction select bit 0: Fixed address to incremented address 1: Incremented address to fixed address RW NOTE: 1. Use the LDC instruction to set the DMD0 register. Figure 13.5 After Reset 00h Address (CPU internal register) DMD0 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 126 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 13. DMAC DMA Mode Register 1(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset DMD1 (CPU internal register) 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name b1 b0 MD20 Channel 2 transfer mode select bits MD21 0 0: DMA disabled 0 1: Single transfer 1 0: Do not set to this value 1 1: Repeat transfer RW RW RW BW2 Channel 2 transfer unit select bit 0: 8 bits 1: 16 bits RW RW2 Channel 2 transfer direction select bit 0: Fixed address to incremented address 1: Incremented address to fixed address RW b5 b4 MD30 Channel 3 transfer mode select bits MD31 0 0: DMA disabled 0 1: Single transfer 1 0: Do not set to this value 1 1: Repeat transfer RW RW BW3 Channel 3 transfer unit select bit 0: 8 bits 1: 16 bits RW RW3 Channel 3 transfer direction select bit 0: Fixed address to incremented address 1: Incremented address to fixed address RW NOTE: 1. Use the LDC instruction to set the DMD1 register. Figure 13.6 Function DMD1 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 127 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 13. DMAC Start Set the peripheral function used as DMAi request source Set the control registers of the peripheral function, but do not yet start. DMD0 register: bits MD01 and MD00 = 00b bits MD11 and MD10 = 00b DMA disabled for channel 0 DMA disabled for channel 1 DMiSL register: bits DSEL4 to DSEL0 DSR bit = 0 DRQ bit = 1 DMA request source select bits Write with LDC instruction (note 1) DMA requested DMAi register Set an incremented source address or incremented destination address DSAi register Set a fixed source address or fixed destination address Write with LDC instruction <When using repeat transfer> DRAi register Set an incremented source address or incremented destination address Write with LDC instruction DCTi register Set the number of transfers (2) Write with LDC instruction DRCi register Set the number of transfers, which is to be reloaded Write with LDC instruction DMD0 register: bits MD01 and MD00 BW0 bit RW0 bit bits MD11 and MD10 BW1 bit RW1 bit Transfer mode select bits for channel 0 Transfer unit select bit for channel 0 Transfer direction select bit for channel 0 Transfer mode select bits for channel 1 Transfer unit select bit for channel 1 Transfer direction select bit for channel 1 <When using repeat transfer> Start the peripheral function used as DMAi request source Write with LDC instruction (note 3) (note 4) End i = 0, 1 NOTES: 1. When setting the DMiSL register, write a 1 to the DRQ bit. 2. When the INT interrupts are selected as a DMA request source, do not write a 1 to the DCTi register. If the DCTi register is 1, do not generate a DMA request when writing 01b or 11b to bits MDi1 and MDi0. 3. Wait six CPU clock cycles or more by a program to set bits MDi1 and MDi0 to 01b or 11b after setting the DMiSL register. 4. When a DMA transfer is started by the software trigger, set both the DSR and DRQ bit in the DMiSL register to 1 at the same time. Figure 13.7 Register Settings When Using DMA0 or DMA1 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 128 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 13. DMAC Start Set the peripheral function used as DMAi request source Set the control registers of the peripheral function, but do not yet start. DMD1 register: bits MD21 and MD20 = 00b bits MD31 and MD30 = 00b DMA disabled for channel 2 DMA disabled for channel 3 DMiSL register: bits DSEL4 to DSEL0 DSR bit = 0 DRQ bit = 1 DMA request source select bits B flag = 1 Select register bank 1 (2) DMA2 (A0) register or DMA3 (A1) register Set an incremented source address or incremented destination address Write with MOV instruction DSA2 (SB) register or DSA3 (FB) register Set a fixed source address or fixed destination address Write with LDC instruction DRA2 (SVP) register or DRA3 (VCT) register Set an incremented source address or incremented destination address Write with LDC instruction DCT2 (R0) register or DCT3 (R1) register Set the number of transfer (3) Write with MOV instruction DRC2 (R2) register or DRC3 (R3) register Set the number of transfer, which is to be reloaded Write with MOV instruction B flag = 0 Select register bank 0 (2) DMD1 register: bits MD21 and MD20 BW2 bit RW2 bit bits MD31 and MD30 BW3 bit RW3 bit Transfer mode select bits for channel 2 Transfer unit select bit for channel 2 Transfer direction select bit for channel 2 Transfer mode select bits for channel 3 Transfer unit select bit for channel 3 Transfer direction select bit for channel 3 Write with LDC instruction (note 1) DMA requested <When using repeat transfer> <When using repeat transfer> Start the peripheral function used as DMAi request source Write with LDC instruction (note 4) (note 5) End i = 2, 3 NOTES: 1. When setting the DMiSL register, write a 1 to the DRQ bit. 2. The register bank 1 and high-speed interrupt cannot be used when using DMA2 and DMA3. 3. When the INT interrupts are selected as a DMA request source, do not write a 1 to the DCTi register. If the DCTi register is 1, do not generate a DMA request when writing 01b or 11b to bits MDi1 and MDi0. 4. Wait six CPU clock cycles or more by a program to set bits MDi1 and MDi0 to 01b or 11b after setting the DMiSL register. 5. When a DMA transfer is started by the software trigger, set both the DSR and DRQ bit in the DMiSL register to 1 at the same time. Figure 13.8 Register Settings When Using DMA2 or DMA3 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 129 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 13.1 13. DMAC Transfer Cycles The transfer cycle is composed of bus cycles to read data from source address (source read) and bus cycles to write data to destination address (destination write). The number of read and write bus cycles depends on the locations of source and destination addresses. In memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode, the number of read and write bus cycles also depends on DS register setting. Software wait state insertion and the RDY signal can extend the number of the bus cycles. 13.1.1 Effect of Source and Destination Addresses When a 16-bit data is transferred with a 16-bit data bus and a source address starts with an odd address, the source-read cycle is added by one bus cycle, compared to a source address starting with an even address. When a 16-bit data is transferred with a 16-bit data bus and a destination address starts with an odd address, the destination-write cycle is added by one bus cycle, compared to a destination address starting with an even address. 13.1.2 Effect of the DS Register In an external space in memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode, the transfer cycle varies depending on the data bus width of the source and destination addresses. See Figure 8.1 for details about the DS register. • When a 16-bit data is transferred accessing both source address and destination address with an 8-bit data bus (the DSi bit in the DS register is set to 0 (i = 0 to 3)), an 8-bit data will be transferred twice. Therefore, two bus cycles are required for reading and another two bus cycles for writing. • When a 16-bit data is transferred accessing a source address with an 8-bit data bus (the DSi bit is set to 0) and a destination address with a 16-bit data bus, an 8-bit data will be read twice but be written once as 16bit data. Therefore, two bus cycles are required for reading and one bus cycle for writing. • When a 16-bit data is transferred accessing a source address with a 16-bit data bus (the DSi bit is set to 1) and a destination address with an 8-bit data bus, a 16-bit data will be read once and an 8-bit data will be written twice. Therefore, one bus cycle is required for reading and two bus cycles for writing. 13.1.3 Effect of Software Wait State When accessing the SFR area or memory space that requires wait states, the number of bus clocks (BCLK) is increased by software wait states. 13.1.4 Effect of the RDY Signal In memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode, the RDY signal affects the number of the bus cycles if a source address or destination address is in an external space. Refer to 8.2.6 RDY Signal for details. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 130 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 13.2 13. DMAC DMA Transfer Time The DMA transfer time can be calculated as follows. (in terms of bus clock) Table 13.3 lists the number of the source read cycle and destination write cycle. Table 13.4 lists coefficient j, k (the number of bus clock). Transfer time = source read bus cycle × j + destination write bus cycle × k Table 13.3 Source Read Cycle and Destination Write Cycle Transfer Unit 8-bit transfer (BWi bit in the DMDp register = 0) 16-bit transfer (BWi bit = 1) Accessing Internal Space Accessing External Space Read Cycle Write Cycle Read Cycle Write Cycle Even 1 1 1 1 Odd 1 1 1 1 Even − − 1 1 Odd − − 1 1 Even 1 1 1 1 Odd 2 2 2 2 Even − − 2 2 Odd − − 2 2 Access Address Bus Width 16 bits 8 bits 16 bits 8 bits i=0 to 3, p=0 and 1 Table 13.4 Coefficient j, k Internal Space External Space Internal ROM or internal RAM Internal ROM or internal RAM SFR area with no wait state j=1 k=1 with wait state j=2 k=2 j=2 k=2 13.3 j and k BCLK cycles shown in Table 8.6 (j, k = 2 to 9). Add one cycle to j or k cycles when inserting a recovery cycle Channel Priority and DMA Transfer Timing When multiple DMA requests are generated in the same sampling period (between a falling edge of the BCLK and the next falling edge), the corresponding DRQ bits in the DMiSL register (i = 0 to 3) are set to 1 (requested) simultaneously. Channel priority in this case is: DMA0 > DMA1 > DMA2 > DMA3. Leave the following period between each DMA transfer request generation on the same channel. DMA request interval ≥ (number of channels set for DMA transfer - 1) × 5 BCLK cycles Described in the following is the operation when DMA0 and DMA1 requests are generated in the same sampling period. Figure 13.9 shows an example of DMA transfers triggered by the INT interrupts. In Figure 13.9, DMA0 and DMA1 requests are generated simultaneously. A DMA0 request having higher priority is acknowledged first to start a transfer. After one DMA0 transfer is completed, the DMAC returns ownership of the bus to the CPU. When the CPU has completed one bus access, a DMA1 transfer starts. After one DMA1 transfer is completed, bus ownership is again returned to the CPU. DMA requests cannot be counted up since each channel has one DRQ bit. Even if multiple DMA1 requests are generated before receiving bus ownership as shown in Figure 13.9, the DRQ bit is set to 0 as soon as bus ownership is acquired. Bus ownership is returned to the CPU after one transfer is completed. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 131 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 13. DMAC Example when DMA transfer requests for DMA0 and DMA1 are generated simultaneously and DMA transfers (SFR to RAM) are performed in minimum time. BCLK DMA0 Bus privilege acquired DMA1 CPU INT0 DRQ bit in DMA0 INT1 DRQ bit in DMA1 Figure 13.9 DMA Transfers Triggered by INT Interrupt Requests REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 132 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 14. DMACII 14. DMACII DMACII performs memory-to-memory transfer, immediate data transfer, and calculation transfer which transfers a result of the addition of two data. DMACII transfer occurs in response to interrupt requests from the peripheral functions. Table 14.1 lists specifications of DMACII. Table 14.1 DMACII Specifications Item Specification DMACII request source Interrupt requests generated by any peripheral functions with bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 in the Interrupt Control Register set to 111b (level 7) Transfer data - Data in a memory location is transferred to another memory location (memory-to-memory transfer) - Immediate data is transferred to a memory location (immediate data transfer) - Data in a memory location (or immediate data) + data in another memory location is transferred to the other memory location (calculation transfer) Transfer unit 8 bits or 16 bits Transfer space 64-Kbyte space in addresses 00000h to 0FFFFh(1)(2) Transfer address Fixed address: one specified address Incremented address: address which is incremented by the transfer unit on each successive access. (Selectable for source address and destination address individually) Transfer mode Single transfer, burst transfer, multiple transfer Chain transfer function Address indicated by an interrupt vector for DMACII index is replaced when a transfer counter reaches zero End-of-transfer interrupt Interrupt occurs when a transfer counter reaches zero NOTES: 1. When a destination address is 0FFFFh and a 16-bit data is transferred, it is transferred to addresses 0FFFFh and 10000h. Likewise, when a source address is 0FFFFh, a 16-bit data in addresses 0FFFFh and 10000h is transferred to a given destination address. 2. The actual transferable space varies depending on internal RAM capacity. 14.1 DMACII Settings Set up the following registers and tables to activate DMACII. • RLVL register • DMACII Index • Interrupt Control Register of the peripheral functions triggering DMACII requests • The relocatable vector table of the peripheral functions triggering DMACII requests 14.1.1 RLVL Register When the DMAII bit is set to 1 (interrupt priority level 7 is used for DMACII transfer) and the FSIT bit to 0 (interrupt priority level 7 is used for normal interrupt), DMACII is activated by an interrupt request from any peripheral functions with bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 in the Interrupt Control Register set to 111b (level 7). Figure 14.1 shows the RLVL register. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 133 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 14. DMACII Exit Priority Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset RLVL 009Fh XXXX 0000b Bit Symbol Bit Name b2 b1 b0 RLVL0 RLVL1 Function Exit wait mode/stop mode interrupt priority level control bits(1) RLVL2 FSIT High-speed interrupt select bit − (b4) Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. DMAII DMACII select bit (4) − (b7-b6) Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. 0 0 0: Level 0 0 0 1: Level 1 0 1 0: Level 2 0 1 1: Level 3 1 0 0: Level 4 1 0 1: Level 5 1 1 0: Level 6 1 1 1: Level 7 0: Interrupt priority level 7 is used for normal interrupt 1: Interrupt priority level 7 is used for high-speed interrupt(2)(3) RW RW RW RW RW − 0: Interrupt priority level 7 is used for interrupt 1: Interrupt priority level 7 is used for DMACII transfer(2) RW NOTES: 1. The MCU exits stop or wait mode when an interrupt priority level of a requested interrupt is higher than a level set using bits RLVL2 to RLVL0. Set bits RLVL2 to RLVL0 to the same value as IPL in the FLG register. 2. Do not set both the FSIT and DMAII bits to 1. Set either the FSIT bit or the DMAII bit to 1 before setting bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 in the Interrupt Control Register to 111b. 3. Only one interrupt can have the interrupt priority level 7 when selecting the high-speed interrupt. 4. The DMAII bit is undefined after reset. To use interrupt priority level 7 for an interrupt, set it to 0 before setting the Interrupt Control Register. Figure 14.1 RLVL Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 134 of 385 − Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 14.1.2 14. DMACII DMACII Index The DMACII index is an 8- to 32-byte data table, which stores parameters for transfer mode, transfer counter, source address (or immediate data), operation address as an address to be calculated, destination address, chain transfer address, and end-of-transfer interrupt address. The DMACII index must be located on the RAM area. Figure 14.2 shows a configuration of the DMACII index. Table 14.2 lists an example configuration of the DMACII index. Memory-to-Memory Transfer, Immediate Transfer, Calculation Transfer Multiple Transfer 16 bits 16 bits DMACII Index Starting Address (BASE) BASE+2 Transfer mode (MOD) BASE Transfer mode (MOD) Transfer counter (COUNT) BASE+2 Transfer counter (COUNT) BASE+4 Transfer source address (or immediate data) (SADR) BASE+4 Transfer source address (SADR1) BASE+6 Operation address(1) (OADR) BASE+6 Transfer destination address (DADR1) BASE+8 Transfer destination address (DADR) BASE+8 Transfer source address (SADR2) BASE+10 Chain Transfer Address (lower byte) (2) (CADR0) BASE+10 Transfer destination address (DADR2) BASE+12 Chain Transfer Address (higher byte) (2) (CADR1) (3) BASE+14 End-of-Transfer Interrupt Address (lower byte) (IADR0) End-of-Transfer Interrupt Address (higher byte) (3) BASE+16 (IADR1) to BASE+28 Transfer source address (SADR7) BASE+30 Transfer destination address (DADR7) NOTES: 1. This data is not needed unless using the calculation transfer function. 2. This data is not needed unless using the chain transfer function. 3. This data is not needed unless using the end-of-transfer interrupt. Place the DMACII index in the RAM. Necessary data must be set top-aligned without any space. For example, if not using the calculation transfer function, assign a transfer destination address to BASE+6. The starting address of the DMACII index must be assigned to the interrupt vector of the peripheral function interrupt triggering a DMACII request. Figure 14.2 DMACII Index Details of the DMACII index are described below. Set these parameters in the specified order listed in Table 14.2, depending on DMACII transfer mode. • Transfer mode (MOD) MOD is two-byte data and required to set transfer mode. Figure 14.3 shows a configuration for transfer mode. • Transfer counter (COUNT) COUNT is two-byte data and required to set the number of transfer. • Transfer source address (SADR) SADR is two-byte data and required to set a source memory address or immediate data. • Operation address (OADR) OADR is two-byte data and required to set a memory address to be calculated. Set this data only when using the calculation transfer function. • Transfer destination address (DADR) DADR is two-byte data and required to set a destination memory address. • Chain transfer address (CADR) CADR is four-byte data and required to set the starting address of the DMACII index for the next transfer. Set this data only when using the chain transfer function. • End-of-transfer interrupt address (IADR) IADR is four-byte data and required to set a jump address for end-of-transfer interrupt processing. Set this data only when using the end-of-transfer interrupt. The abbreviations shown in parentheses( ) for each parameter are used in this section. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 135 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 14. DMACII Table 14.2 DMACII Index Configuration in Transfer Mode Memory-to-Memory Transfer/ Immediate Data Transfer Transfer data Multiple Transfer Calculation Transfer Chain transfer Not used Used Not used Used Not used Used Not used Used Cannot used End-ofTransfer Interrupt Not used Not used Used Used Not used Not used Used Used Cannot used MOD MOD MOD MOD MOD MOD MOD MOD MOD COUNT COUNT COUNT COUNT COUNT COUNT COUNT COUNT COUNT SADR SADR SADR SADR SADR SADR SADR SADR SADR1 DADR1 DMAC II index DADR DADR DADR DADR OADR OADR OADR OADR 8 bytes CADR0 IADR0 CADR0 DADR DADR DADR DADR CADR1 IADR1 CADR1 10 bytes CADR0 IADR0 CADR0 12 bytes 12 bytes IADR0 CADR1 IADR1 CADR1 IADR1 14 bytes 14 bytes IADR0 16 bytes IADR1 18 bytes SADRi DADRi i = 1 to 7 max. 32 bytes (when i = 7) Transfer Mode (MOD)(1) b15 b0 b8 b7 Bit Symbol Function (MULT = 0) Bit Name Function (MULT = 1) SIZE Transfer unit select bit 0: 8 bits 1: 16 bits IMM Transfer data select bit 0: Immediate data 1: Memory UPDS Transfer source direction select bit 0: Fixed address 1: Incremented address RW UPDD Transfer destination direction select bit 0: Fixed address 1: Incremented address RW OPER/ CNT0(2) Calculation transfer function select bit 0: Not used 1: Used BRST/ CNT1(2) Burst transfer select bit 0: Single transfer 1: Burst transfer INTE/ CNT2(2) End-of-transfer interrupt select bit 0: Interrupt not used 1: Interrupt used CHAIN Chain transfer select bit 0: Chain transfer not used 1: Chain transfer used − (b14-b8) MULT RW Set to 1 b6 b5 b4 RW Set to 0 RW Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. Multiple transfer select bit 0: Multiple transfer not used MOD REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 136 of 385 RW 0 0 0: Do not set to this value 0 0 1: Once 0 1 0: Twice : : 1 1 0: 6 times 1 1 1: 7 times RW RW − 1: Multiple transfer used NOTES: 1. MOD must be located in the RAM. 2. When the MULT bit is set to 0, bits 6 to 4 function as bits OPER, BRST, and INTE. When the MULT bit is set to 1, bits 6 to 4 function as bits CNT2 to CNT0. Figure 14.3 RW RW Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 14.1.3 14. DMACII Interrupt Control Register for the Peripheral Function To use the peripheral function interrupt as a DMACII request source, set bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 to 111b (level 7). 14.1.4 Relocatable Vector Table for the Peripheral Function Set the starting address of the DMACII index in an interrupt vector for the peripheral function interrupt used as a DMACII request source. When using the chain transfer, the relocatable vector table must be located in the RAM. 14.2 DMACII Performance The DMACII function is selected by setting the DMAII bit to 1 (interrupt priority level 7 is used for DMACII transfer). DMACII transfer request is generated by interrupt requests from any peripheral function with bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 set to 111b (level 7). These peripheral function interrupt requests are used as DMACII transfer requests and the peripheral function interrupts cannot be used. When an interrupt request with bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 set to 111b (level 7) is generated, DMACII is activated regardless of the I flag and IPL settings. 14.3 Transfer Data DMACII transfers data in 8-bit units or 16-bit units. • Memory-to-memory transfer: data is transferred from a given memory location in the 64-Kbyte space (addresses 00000h to 0FFFFh) to another given memory location in the same space. • Immediate data transfer: immediate data is transferred to a given memory location in the 64-Kbyte space. • Calculation transfer: two 8-bit or two 16-bit data are added together and the result is transferred to a given memory location in the 64-Kbyte space. When a 16-bit data is transferred to a destination address 0FFFFh, it is transferred to addresses 0FFFFh and 10000h. Likewise, when a source address is 0FFFFh, a 16-bit data in addresses 0FFFFh and 10000h is transferred to a given destination address. The actual transferable space varies depending on internal RAM capacity. Refer to Figure 3.1 for the internal memory. 14.3.1 Memory-to-memory Transfer Data transfer between any two memory locations in the 64-Kbyte space can be: • a transfer from a fixed address to another fixed address; • a transfer from a fixed address to an incremented address; • a transfer from an incremented address to a fixed address; • a transfer from an incremented address to another incremented address. When an incremented address is selected, DMACII increments an address after every transfer for the following transfer. In a 8-bit data transfer, a transfer address is incremented by one. In a 16-bit data transfer, a transfer address is incremented by two. When a source or destination address exceeds 0FFFFh as a result of address incrementation, the source or destination address returns to 00000h and continues incrementation. Maintain source and destination address at 0FFFFh or below. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 137 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 14.3.2 14. DMACII Immediate Data Transfer DMACII transfers immediate data to a given memory location. A fixed or incremented address can be selected as a destination address. Store immediate data into SADR. To transfer an 8-bit immediate data, write data in the low-order byte of SADR. (The high-order byte is ignored.) 14.3.3 Calculation Transfer After two memory data, or an immediate data and a memory data, are added together, DMACII transfers the calculated result to a given memory location. Set a memory address or immediate data to be calculated in SADR. Set another memory address to be calculated in OADR. To use a “memory + memory” calculation transfer, a fixed or incremented address can be selected as a source or destination address. If a source address is incremented, an operation address also becomes incremented. To use an “immediate data + memory” calculation transfer, a fixed or incremented address can be selected as a destination address. 14.4 Transfer Modes In DMACII, a single transfer, burst transfer, and multiple transfer are available. The BRST bit in MOD selects either a single transfer or burst transfer, and the MULT bit in MOD selects a multiple transfer. COUNT determines how many transfers occur. No transfer occurs when COUNT is set to 0000h. 14.4.1 Single Transfer For one transfer request, DMACII transfers an 8-bit or 16-bit data once. When an incremented address is selected for a source or destination address, DMACII increments the address after every transfer for the following transfer. COUNT is decremented every time a transfer occurs. If using the end-of-transfer interrupt, an interrupt occurs when COUNT reaches zero. 14.4.2 Burst Transfer For one transfer request, DMACII continuously transfers data the number of times determined by COUNT. COUNT is decremented every time DMACII transfers one transfer unit, and when it reaches zero, a burst transfer is completed. If using the end-of-transfer interrupt, an interrupt occurs at the end of the burst transfer. While the burst transfer is taking place, no interrupt can be acknowledged. 14.4.3 Multiple Transfer When using the multiple transfer, select the memory-to-memory transfer. For one transfer request, DMACII transfers data multiple times. Bits CNT2 to CNT0 in MOD selects the number of transfers from 001b (once) to 111b (7 times). Do not set bits CNT2 to CNT0 to 000b. Source and destination addresses enough for all transfers must be allocated alternately in addresses following MOD and COUNT in DMACII index. While the transfers are taking place the number of times set using bits CNT2 to CNT0, no interrupt can be acknowledged. When the multiple transfer is selected, a calculation transfer, burst transfer, chain transfer, and end-of-transfer interrupt cannot be used. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 138 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 14.5 14. DMACII Chain Transfer The chain transfer can be selected with the CHAIN bit in MOD. The chain transfer is performed as follows. (1) Transfer occurs in response to an interrupt request from a peripheral function and is performed according to the contents of the DMACII index at the address specified by the interrupt vector. For one transfer request, either a single transfer or burst transfer selected by the BRST bit in MOD occurs. (2) When COUNT reaches zero, the interrupt vector in (1) is replaced with the address written in CADR1 and CADR0. The end-of-transfer interrupt occurs after the replacement, if the INTE bit in MOD is set to 1. (3) When the next DMACII transfer request is generated, the transfer is performed according to the contents of the DMACII index specified by the interrupt vector which has been replaced in (2). Figure 14.4 shows the relocatable vector and DMACII index when using the chain transfer. For the chain transfer, the relocatable vector table must be located in the RAM. RAM INTB Relocatable Vector Interrupt vector of the peripheral function triggering DMACII request. Default value is BASE (a). BASE (a) DMACII index (a) (CADR1, CADR0) BASE (b) When COUNT reaches zero, the above interrupt vector is replaced with BASE (b), which is the address written in CADR1 and CADR0. When the next request occurs, a transfer starts according to the contents of the DMACII index at BASE (b). BASE (b) DMACII index (b) (CADR1, CADR0) Figure 14.4 14.6 BASE (c) When COUNT reaches zero, the interrupt vector is replaced wtih BASE (c). Relocatable Vector and DMACII Index When using the Chain Transfer End-of-Transfer Interrupt The end-of-transfer interrupt can be selected with the INTE bit in MOD. Set the starting address of the end-oftransfer interrupt routine in IADR1 and IADR0. The end-of-transfer interrupt occurs when COUNT reaches zero. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 139 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 14.7 14. DMACII Execution Time DMACII execution time is calculated by the following equations (single-speed mode): Multiple transfers: t [bus clock] = 21+ (11 + b + c) × k Other than multiple transfers: t [bus clock] = 6 + (26 + a + b + c + d) × m + (4 + e) × n a: If IMM = 0 (source is immediate data), a = 0; if IMM = 1 (source is data in memory location), a = -1. b: If UPDS = 1 (source address is incremented), b = 0; if UPDS = 0 (source address is fixed), b = 1. c: If UPDD = 1 (destination address is incremented), c = 0; if UPDD = 0 (destination address is fixed), c = 1. d: If OPER = 0 (calculation function is not selected), d = 0; if OPER = 1 (calculation function is selected) and UPDS = 0 (source is immediate data or fixed address in memory location), d = 7; if OPER = 1 (calculation function is selected) and UPDS = 1 (source is incremented address in memory location), d = 8. e: If CHAIN = 0 (chain transfer is not selected), e = 0; if CHAIN = 1 (chain transfer is selected), e = 4. m: If BRST = 0 (single transfer), m = 1; if BRST = 1 (burst transfer), m = a value set in COUNT. n: If COUNT = 1, n = 0; if COUNT = 2 or more, n = 1. k: The number of transfers set in bits CNT2 to CNT0 in MOD. The above equations are approximations. The execution time varies depending on CPU state, bus wait states, and DMACII index allocation. The first instruction of the end-of-transfer interrupt routine is executed in the eighth bus clock after the DMACII transfer is completed. Conditions of the example below: -memory-to-memory transfer (a = -1) -incremented source address (b = 0) -fixed destination address (c = 1) -no calculation function (d = 0) -no chain transfer (e = 0) -single transfer (m = 1) -the end-of-transfer interrupt (transfer counter = 2) occurs First DMACII transfer t = 6 + 26 x 1 + 4 x 1 = 36 bus clocks Second DMACII transfer t = 6 + 26 x 1 + 4 x 0 = 32 bus clocks DMACII transfer requested Program First DMACII transfer DMACII transfer requested Program 36 clocks Transfer counter = 2 32 clocks 7 clocks Transfer counter = 1 Transfer counter is decremented. Transfer counter = 1 Figure 14.5 End-of-transfer interrupt routine executed Second DMACII transfer Transfer counter is decremented. Transfer counter = 0 Transfer Time When a DMACII transfer request is generated simultaneously with another request having a higher priority (e.g., NMI or watchdog timer), the interrupt with higher priority is acknowledged first, and the pending DMACII transfer starts after the interrupt sequence of the higher priority interrupt has been completed. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 140 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timers 15. Timers The M32C/8B Group has eleven 16-bit timers, and they are separated into five timer A and six timer B based on their functions. Individual timers function independently. The count source for each timer is used to operate the timer for counting and reloading, etc. Figures 15.1 and 15.2 show block diagrams of timer A and timer B configurations. Clock Prescaler fC32 1/32 XCIN Set the CPSR bit in the CPSRF register to 1 Reset f1 f8 f2n fC32 00 01 10 11 TCK1 and TCK0 10 Noise filter TA0IN TMOD1 and TMOD0 00: Timer mode 10: One-shot timer mode 11: PWM mode Timer A0 01 00 Timer A0 interrupt 01: Event counter mode 11 TA0TGH and TA0TGL 00 01 10 11 TCK1 and TCK0 10 TMOD1 and TMOD0 00: Timer mode 10: One-shot timer mode 11: PWM mode Timer A1 interrupt Timer A1 Noise filter TA1IN 01 00 01: Event counter mode 11 TA1TGH and TA1TGL 00 01 10 11 TCK1 and TCK0 10 Noise filter TA2IN TMOD1 and TMOD0 00: Timer mode 10: One-shot timer mode 11: PWM mode Timer A2 01 00 Timer A2 interrupt 01: Event counter mode 11 TA2TGH and TA2TGL 00 01 10 11 TCK1 and TCK0 10 Noise filter TA3IN TMOD1 and TMOD0 00: Timer mode 10: One-shot timer mode 11: PWM mode Timer A3 interrupt Timer A3 01 00 01: Event counter mode 11 TA3TGH and TA3TGL 00 01 10 11 TCK1 and TCK0 10 Noise filter TA4IN TMOD1 and TMOD0 00: Timer mode 10: One-shot timer mode 11: PWM mode Timer A4 interrupt Timer A4 01 00 01: Event counter mode 11 TA4TGH and TA4TGL Timer B2 overflow or underflow signal TCK1 and TCK0, TMOD1 and TMOD0: Bits in the TAiMR register TAiGH, TAiGL: Bits in the ONSF register or the TRGSR register (i = 0 to 4) Figure 15.1 Timer A Configuration REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 141 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timers Clock prescaler 1/32 XCIN Set the CPSR bit in the CPSRF register to 1 f1 f8 f2n fC32 00 01 10 11 00 01 10 11 00 01 10 11 00 01 10 11 00 01 10 11 01: Event counter mode TCK1 TMOD1 and TMOD0 00: Timer mode 10: Pulse width measurement mode, Pulse cycle measurement mode 1 0 01: Event counter mode TCK1 TMOD1 and TMOD0 00: Timer mode 10: Pulse width measurement mode, Pulse cycle measurement mode 01: Event counter mode TCK1 TMOD1 and TMOD0 00: Timer mode 10: Pulse width measurement mode, Pulse cycle measurement mode TCK1 and TCK0 01: Event counter mode TCK1 TMOD1 and TMOD0 00: Timer mode 10: Pulse width measurement mode, Pulse cycle measurement mode TCK1 and TCK0 Timer B4 1 Noise filter TB4IN 00 01 10 11 0 01: Event counter mode TCK1 and TCK0 Noise filter TMOD1 and TMOD0 00: Timer mode 10: Pulse width measurement mode, Pulse cycle measurement mode 0 Timer B5 TCK1 01: Event counter mode TCK1 and TCK0, TMOD1 and TMOD0: Bits in the TBiMR register (i = 0 to 5) Figure 15.2 Timer B4 interrupt TCK1 1 TB5IN Timer B3 interrupt Timer B3 1 0 Timer B2 interrupt Timer B2 1 0 Timer B1 interrupt Timer B1 TCK1 and TCK0 Noise filter TB3IN 1 0 Timer B0 interrupt Timer B0 TCK1 and TCK0 Noise filter TB2IN TMOD1 and TMOD0 00: Timer mode 10: Pulse width measurement mode, Pulse cycle measurement mode TCK1 and TCK0 Noise filter TB1IN Reset Timer B2 overflow or underflow signal (to the count source of timer A) Noise filter TB0IN fC32 Timer B Configuration REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 142 of 385 Timer B5 interrupt Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15.1 15. Timer A Timer A Timer A contains the following four modes. Except in event counter mode, all timers A0 to A4 have the same functionality. Bits TMOD1 and TMOD0 in the TAiMR register (i = 0 to 4) determine which mode is used. • Timer mode: The timer counts the internal count source. • Event counter mode: The timer counts overflow/underflow signal of another timer or the external pulses. • One-shot timer mode: The timer operates only once for one trigger. • Pulse width modulation mode: The timer continuously outputs given pulse widths. Figure 15.3 shows a block diagram of timer A. Figures 15.4 to 15.13 show the registers associated with timer A. Table 15.1 lists TAiOUT pin settings to use in output mode. Table 15.2 lists TAiIN and TAiOUT pin settings to use in input mode. Clock select Clock source select High-order bits of data bus TCK1 and TCK0 f1 00 f8 01 f2n(1) 10 11 fC32 · Timer mode · One-shot timer mode TMOD1 and TMOD0, MR2 · Pulse width modulation mode Low-order bits of data bus 8 low-order bits Reload register · Timer Mode (Gate Function) 8 high-order bits · Event counter mode TAiIN Polarity Selector Counter TAiS Increment/decrement TB2 Overflow(2) TAj Overflow(2) TAk Overflow(2) Always decrement except in event counter mode 00 01 10 11 11 Decrement TAiTGH to TAiTGL 00 10 11 01 TAiUD TMOD1 and TMOD0 0 1 MR2 Function select register Toggle flip flop TAiOUT i = 0 to 4 j = i - 1, except j = 4 if i = 0 k = i + 1, except k = 0 if i = 4 NOTES: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). 2. Overflow signal or underflow signal. TAi Timer A0 Timer A1 Timer A2 Timer A3 Timer A4 TCK1 and TCK0, TMOD1 and TMOC0, MR2 and MR1: Bits in the TAiMR register TAiTGH to TAiTGL: Bits in the ONSF register if i = 0 or bits in the TRGSR register if i = 1 to 4 TAiS: Bit in the TABSR register TAiUD: Bit in the UDF register Figure 15.3 Timer A Block Diagram REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 143 of 385 Addresses 0347h 0346h 0349h 0348h 034Bh 034Ah 034Dh 034Ch 034Fh 034Eh TAj Timer A4 Timer A0 Timer A1 Timer A2 Timer A3 TAk Timer A1 Timer A2 Timer A3 Timer A4 Timer A0 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer A Count Source Prescaler Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol TCSPR After Reset(2) 0XXX 0000b Address 035Fh Bit Symbol Function Bit Name CNT0 RW RW CNT1 Divide ratio select bits (1) If the setting value is n, f2n is the main clock, on-chip oscillator, or PLL clock divided by 2n. No division if n = 0 RW CNT2 RW CNT3 RW − (b6-b4) CST Reserved bits Read as undefined value Operation enable bit 0: Divider stops 1: Divider operates − RW NOTES: 1. Set the CST bit to 0 before bits CNT3 to CNT0 are rewritten. 2. The TCSPR register maintains values set before reset, even after software reset or watchdog timer reset has been performed. Figure 15.4 TCSPR Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 144 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer A Timer Ai Mode Register (i = 0 to 4)(Timer Mode) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address After Reset TA0MR to TA4MR 0356h, 0357h, 0358h, 0359h, 035Ah 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function TMOD0 RW Operating mode select bits b1 b0 0 0: Timer mode TMOD1 − (b2) RW RW Reserved bit Set to 0 RW b4 b3 MR1 Gate function select bits MR2 MR3 0 0: Gate function disabled 0 1: (TAiIN pin is a programmable I/O port) 1 0: Timer counts only while an "L" signal is input to the TAiIN pin 1 1: Timer counts only while an "H" signal is input to the TAiIN pin Set to 0 in timer mode Count source select bits TCK1 0 0: f1 0 1: f8 1 0: f2n(1) 1 1: fC32 NOTE: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divided-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). To select f2n, set the CST bit in the TCSPR register to 1 before setting bits TCK1 and TCK0 to 10b. Figure 15.5 TA0MR to TA4MR Registers in Timer Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 145 of 385 RW RW b7 b6 TCK0 RW RW RW Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer A Timer Ai Mode Register (i = 0 to 4)(Event Counter Mode) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 1 Symbol Address After Reset TA0MR to TA4MR 0356h, 0357h, 0358h, 0359h, 035Ah 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function Function (When not processing two-phase pulse signals) (When processing two-phase pulse signals) TMOD0 RW RW Operating mode select bits b1 b0 0 1: Event counter mode(1) TMOD1 RW − (b2) Reserved bit Set to 0 MR1 Count polarity select bit (2) 0: Falling edges of an external signal counted 1: Rising edges of an external signal counted Set to 0 RW MR2 Increment/decrement switching source select bit 0: UDF registser setting 1: Signal applied to the TAiOUT pin (3) Set to 1 RW MR3 Set to 0 in event counter mode TCK0 Count operation type select bit TCK1 Two-phase pulse signal processing operation select bit(4,5) RW RW 0: Reload 1: Free running Set to 0 RW 0: Normal processing operation 1: Multiply-by-4 processing operation RW NOTES: 1. Bits TAiTGH and TAiTGL in the ONSF or TRGSR register determine a count source in event counter mode. 2. The MR1 bit is enabled only when counting external signals. 3. The counter decrements when an “L” signal is applied to the TAiOUT pin. The counter increments when an “H” signal is applied to the TAiOUT pin. 4. The TCK1 bit is enabled only in the TA3MR register. The TCK1 bit in registers TA0MR to TA2MR and TA4MR are disabled. 5. For two-phase pulse signal processing, set the TAjP bit in the UDF register (j = 2 to 4) to 1 (two-phase pulse signal processing function enabled). Also, set bits TAjTGH and TAjTGL in the TRGSR register to 00b (input to the TAjIN pin). Figure 15.6 TA0MR to TA4MR Registers in Event Counter Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 146 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer A Timer Ai Mode Register (i = 0 to 4)(One-Shot Timer Mode) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 1 0 Symbol Address After Reset TA0MR to TA4MR 0356h, 0357h, 0358h, 0359h, 035Ah 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function TMOD0 RW RW Operating mode select bits b1 b0 1 0: One-shot timer mode TMOD1 RW − (b2) Reserved bit Set to 0 RW MR1 External trigger select bit(1) 0: Falling edge of signal applied to the TAiIN pin 1: Rising edge of signal applied to the TAiIN pin RW MR2 Trigger select bit 0: The TAiOS bit enabled 1: Selected by bits TAiTGH and TAiTGL RW MR3 Set to 0 in one-shot timer mode RW b7 b6 TCK0 Count source select bits TCK1 0 0: f1 0 1: f8 1 0: f2n(2) 1 1: fC32 RW RW NOTES: 1. The MR1 bit is enabled only when bits TAiTGH and TAiTGL in the ONSF or TRGSR register are set to 00b (input to the TAiIN pin). The MR1 bit can be set to either 0 or 1 when bits TAiTGH and TAiTGL are set to 01b (TB2 overflow or underflow), 10b (TAj (j = i - 1, except j = 4 if i = 0) overflow or underflow), or 11b (TAk (k = i + 1, except i = 4 if k = 0) overflow or underflow). 2. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). To select f2n, set the CST bit in the TCSPR register to 1 before setting bits TCK1 and TCK0 to 10b. Figure 15.7 TA0MR to TA4MR Registers in One-Shot Timer Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 147 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer A Timer Ai Mode Register (i = 0 to 4)(Pulse Width Modulation Mode) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 1 1 Symbol Address After Reset TA0MR to TA4MR 0356h, 0357h, 0358h, 0359h, 035Ah 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function TMOD0 RW RW Operating mode select bits b1 b0 1 1: Pulse width modulation (PWM) mode TMOD1 RW − (b2) Reserved bit Set to 0 RW MR1 External trigger select bit(1) 0: Falling edge of signal applied to the TAiIN pin 1: Rising edge of signal applied to the TAiIN pin RW MR2 Trigger select bit 0: The TAiS bit is enabled 1: Selected by bits TAiTGH and TAiTGL RW MR3 16/8-bit PWM mode select bit 0: Functions as 16-bit pulse width modulator 1: Functions as 8-bit pulse width modulator RW b7 b6 TCK0 Count source select bits TCK1 0 0: f1 0 1: f8 1 0: f2n (2) 1 1: fC32 RW RW NOTES: 1. The MR1 bit is enabled only when bits TAiTGH and TAiTGL in the ONSF or TRGSR register are set to 00b (input to the TAiIN pin). The MR1 bit can be set to either 0 or 1 when bits TAiTGH and TAiTGL are set to 01b (TB2 overflow or underflow), 10b (TAj (j = i - 1, except j = 4 if i = 0) overflow or underflow), or 11b (TAk (k = i + 1, except i = 4 if k = 0) overflow or underflow). 2. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). To select f2n, set the CST bit in the TCSPR register to 1 before setting bits TCK1 and TCK0 to 10b. Figure 15.8 TA0MR to TA4MR Registers in Pulse Width Modulation Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 148 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer A Timer Ai Register(1) (i = 0 to 4) b15 b8 b7 b0 Symbol TA0 to TA2 TA3, TA4 Mode Address 0347h - 0346h, 0349h - 0348h, 034Bh - 034Ah 034Dh - 034Ch, 034Fh - 034Eh After Reset Undefined Undefined Function Setting Range RW Timer mode If a count source frequency is fj and the setting value of TAi register is n, the counter cycle is (n + 1) / fj 0000h to FFFFh RW Event counter mode If the setting value is n, the count times are (FFFFh - n+1) when the counter increments, and (n+1) when the counter decrements (2) 0000h to FFFFh RW One-shot timer mode If the setting value is n, the counter counts n times and stops. 0000h to FFFFh(3, 4) WO Pulse width modulation mode (16-bit PWM) If a count source frequency is fj and the setting value of the TAi register is n, PWM cycle: (216 - 1) / fj "H" width of PWM pulse: n / fj 0000h to FFFEh(3, 5) WO Pulse width modulation mode (8-bit PWM) If a count source frequency is fj, the setting value of high-order bits in the TAi register is n, and the setting value of low-order bits in the TAi register is m, PWM cycle: (28 -1) x (m+1) / fj "H" width of PWM pulse: (m+1) n / fj 00h to FEh(3, 6) (High-order address bits) 00h to FFh(3, 6) (Low-order address bits) fj: f1, f8, f2n, fC32 NOTES: 1. Read and write this register in 16-bit units. 2. The TAi register counts external pulses or another timer overflows or underflows. 3. Read-modify-write instructions cannot be used to set the TAi register. Refer to Usage Notes for details. 4. When the TAi register is set to 0000h, the counter does not start and a timer Ai interrupt request is not generated. 5. When the TAi register is set to 0000h, the pulse width modulator does not operate and the TAiOUT pin output is held "L". A timer Ai interrupt request is not generated. When the TAi register is set to FFFFh, the pulse width modulator does not operate and the TAiOUT pin output is held "H". A timer Ai interrupt request is not generated. 6. When 8 high-order bits are set to 00h, the pulse width modulator does not operate and the TAiOUT pin output is held "L". A timer Ai interrupt request is not generated. When 8 high-order bits are set to FFh, the pulse width modulator does not operate and the TAiOUT pin output is held "H". A timer Ai interrupt request is not generated. Figure 15.9 TA0 to TA4 Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 149 of 385 WO Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer A Up/Down Select Register(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset UDF 0344h 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW TA0UD Timer A0 up/down select bit (2) 0: Decrement 1: Increment RW TA1UD Timer A1 up/down select bit (2) 0: Decrement 1: Increment RW TA2UD Timer A2 up/down select bit (2) 0: Decrement 1: Increment RW TA3UD Timer A3 up/down select bit (2) 0: Decrement 1: Increment RW TA4UD Timer A4 up/down select bit (2) 0: Decrement 1: Increment RW TA2P Timer A2 two-phase pulse signal processing function select bit (3) 0: Two-phase pulse signal processing function disabled 1: Two-phase pulse signal processing function enabled WO TA3P Timer A3 two-phase pulse signal processing function select bit (3) 0: Two-phase pulse signal processing function disabled 1: Two-phase pulse signal processing function enabled WO TA4P Timer A4 two-phase pulse signal processing function select bit (3) 0: Two-phase pulse signal processing function disabled 1: Two-phase pulse signal processing function enabled WO NOTES: 1. Read-modify-write instructions cannot be used to set the UDF register. Refer to Usage Notes for details. 2. This bit is enabled when the MR2 bit in the TAiMR register (i = 0 to 4) is set to 0 (the UDF register causes increment/decrement switching) in event counter mode. 3. Set these bits to 0 when not using the two-phase pulse signal processing function. Figure 15.10 UDF Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 150 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer A Trigger Select Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset TRGSR 0343h 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name TA1TGL b1 b0 Timer A1 trigger select bits TA1TGH 0 0: Input to the TA1IN pin selected 0 1: TB2 overflows selected (1) 1 0: TA0 overflows selected (1) 1 1: TA2 overflows selected (1) b3 b2 TA2TGL Timer A2 trigger select bits TA2TGH 0 0: Input to the TA2IN pin selected 0 1: TB2 overflows selected (1) 1 0: TA1 overflows selected (1) 1 1: TA3 overflows selected (1) b5 b4 TA3TGL Timer A3 trigger select bits TA3TGH 0 0: Input to the TA3IN pin selected 0 1: TB2 overflows selected (1) 1 0: TA2 overflows selected (1) 1 1: TA4 overflows selected (1) b7 b6 TA4TGL Timer A4 trigger select bits TA4TGH NOTE: 1. Overflow or underflow. Figure 15.11 Function TRGSR Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 151 of 385 0 0: Input to the TA4IN pin selected 0 1: TB2 overflows selected (1) 1 0: TA3 overflows selected (1) 1 1: TA0 overflows selected (1) RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW RW Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer A Count Start Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset TABSR 0340h 00h Bit Symbol Figure 15.12 Bit Name Function RW TA0S Timer A0 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TA1S Timer A1 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TA2S Timer A2 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TA3S Timer A3 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TA4S Timer A4 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TB0S Timer B0 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TB1S Timer B1 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TB2S Timer B2 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TABSR Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 152 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer A One-Shot Start Register Symbol ONSF b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Address Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW TA0OS Timer A0 one-shot start bit (1) 0: In an idle state 1: Timer starts RW TA1OS Timer A1 one-shot start bit (1) 0: In an idle state 1: Timer starts RW TA2OS Timer A2 one-shot start bit (1) 0: In an idle state 1: Timer starts RW TA3OS Timer A3 one-shot start bit (1) 0: In an idle state 1: Timer starts RW TA4OS Timer A4 one-shot start bit (1) 0: In an idle state 1: Timer starts RW TAZIE Z-phase input enable bit 0: Z-phase input disabled 1: Z-phase input enabled RW b7 b6 TA0TGL Timer A0 trigger select bits TA0TGH NOTES: 1. Read as 0. 2. Overflow or underflow. Figure 15.13 After Reset 00h 0342h ONSF Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 153 of 385 0 0: Input to the TA0IN pin selected 0 1: TB2 overflows selected (2) 1 0: TA4 overflows selected (2) 1 1: TA1 overflows selected (2) RW RW Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 15.1 15. Timer A TAiOUT Pin Settings in Output Mode (i = 0 to 4) Bit Setting Port Function PSC Register PSL1, PSL2 Registers PS1, PS2 Registers(1) P7_0(2) TA0OUT − PSL1_0 = 1 PS1_0 = 1 P7_2 TA1OUT − PSL1_2 = 1 PS1_2 = 1 P7_4 TA2OUT PSC_4 = 0 PSL1_4 = 0 PS1_4 = 1 P7_6 TA3OUT − PSL1_6 = 1 PS1_6 = 1 P8_0 TA4OUT − PSL2_0 = 0 PS2_0 = 1 NOTES: 1. Set registers PS1and PS2 after setting registers PSC, PSL1, and PSL2. 2. P7_0 is an N-channel open drain output port. Table 15.2 TAiIN and TAiOUT Pin Settings in Input Mode (i = 0 to 4) Bit Setting Port Function PD7, PD8 Registers PS1, PS2 Registers P7_0 TA0OUT PD7_0 = 0 PS1_0 = 0 P7_1 TA0IN PD7_1 = 0 PS1_1 = 0 P7_2 TA1OUT PD7_2 = 0 PS1_2 = 0 P7_3 TA1IN PD7_3 = 0 PS1_3 = 0 P7_4 TA2OUT PD7_4 = 0 PS1_4 = 0 P7_5 TA2IN PD7_5 = 0 PS1_5 = 0 P7_6 TA3OUT PD7_6 = 0 PS1_6 = 0 P7_7 TA3IN PD7_7 = 0 PS1_7 = 0 P8_0 TA4OUT PD8_0 = 0 PS2_0 = 0 P8_1 TA4IN PD8_1 = 0 PS2_1 = 0 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 154 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15.1.1 15. Timer A Timer Mode In timer mode, the timer counts an internally generated count source. Table 15.3 lists specifications of timer mode. Figure 15.14 shows a timer mode operation (Timer A). Table 15.3 Specifications of Timer Mode Item Specification f2n(1), fC32 Count source f1, f8, Count operation • Counter decrements When the timer underflows, the contents of the reload register are reloaded into the counter and the count continues. Counter cycle n+1 fj fj: count source frequency n: setting value of the TAi register (i = 0 to 4), 0000h to FFFFh Count start condition The TAiS bit in the TABSR register is set to 1 (count starts) Count stop condition The TAiS bit is set to 0 (count stops) Interrupt request generation timing When the timer underflows TAiIN pin function Input for gate function TAiOUT pin function Pulse output Read from timer A read from the TAi register returns a counter value Write to timer • A write to the TAi register while the count is stopped: The value is written to both the reload register and the counter. • A write to the TAi register while counting: The value is written to the reload register (It is transferred to the counter at the next reload timing).(2) Selectable function • Gate function A signal applied to the TAiIN pin determines whether the count starts or stops. • Pulse output function The polarity of the TAiOUT pin is inverted whenever the timer underflows. The TAiOUT pin outputs an “L” signal while the TAiS bit is 0 (count stops). NOTES: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). 2. Wait for one or more count source cycles to write after the count starts. FFFFh Count starts Underflow Underflow n Contents of the counter n = contents of the reload register Reload Count stops Reload 0000h TAiS bit in the TABSR register 1 IR bit in the TAiIC register 1 0 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program TAiOUT pin (output) 0 “H” “L” i = 0 to 4 Figure 15.14 (Conditions) TAiMR register: Bits TMOD1 and TMOD0 are set to 00b (timer mode). Bits MR2 and MR1 are set to 00b (gate function disabled). Operation in Timer Mode (Timer A) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 155 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15.1.2 15. Timer A Event Counter Mode In event counter mode, the timer counts overflows/underflows of another timer, or the external pulse input. Timers A2, A3, and A4 can count externally generated two-phase signals. Table 15.4 lists specifications of event counter mode when not handling two-phase pulse signals. Table 15.5 lists specifications of event counter mode when handling two-phase pulse signals with timers A2, A3, and A4. Figure 15.15 shows a event counter mode operation when not handling two-phase pulse signals. Figure 15.16 shows a event counter mode operation when handling two-phase pulse signals with timers A2, A3, and A4. Table 15.4 Specifications of Event Counter Mode When Not Handling Two-Phase Pulse Signals Item Specification Count source • External signal applied to the TAiIN pin (i = 0 to 4) (valid edge is selectable by a program) • Timer B2 overflows or underflows • Timer Aj overflows or underflows (j = i - 1, except j = 4 if i = 0) • Timer Ak overflows or underflows (k = i + 1 except k = 0 if i = 4) Count operation • Count direction (increment or decrement) can be selected by external signal or by a program. • Reload/Free-run type can be selected. Reload function: The contents of the reload register are reloaded into the counter and the count continues when the timer underflows or overflows. Free-running function: The counter continues running without reloading when the timer underflows or overflows. Number of counting (FFFFh - n + 1): when incrementing n + 1: when decrementing n: setting value of the TAi register, 0000h to FFFFh Count start condition The TAiS bit in the TABSR register is set to 1 (count starts) Count stop condition The TAiS bit is set to 0 (count stops) Interrupt request generation timing When the timer overflows or underflows TAiIN pin function Count source input TAiOUT pin function Pulse output, or input to select the count direction Read from timer A read from the TAi register returns a counter value Write to timer • A write to the TAi register while the count is stopped: The value is written to both the reload register and the counter. • A write to the TAi register while counting: The value is written to the reload register (It is transferred to the counter at the next reload timing).(1) Selectable function Pulse output function The polarity of the TAiOUT pin is inverted whenever the timer overflows or underflows. The TAiOUT pin outputs “L” signal while the TAiS bit is 0 (count stops). NOTE: 1. Wait for one or more count source cycles to write after the count starts. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 156 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer A Overflow FFFFh Count resumes Reload Decrement to increment Underflow Count starts Count stops n Contents of the counter n = contents of the reload register Reload 0000h “H” Input to TAiIN pin “L” TAiS bit in the TABSR register 1 TAiUD bit in the UDF register 1 IR bit in the TAiIC register 1 0 0 Set to 1 by a program 0 i = 0 to 4 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program (Conditions) TAiMR register: Bits TMOD1 and TMOD0 are set to 01b (event counter mode) The MR1 bit is set to 1 (rising edges of an external signal counted) The MR2 bit is set to 0 (UDF register setting) Bits TCK1 to TCK0 bit are set to 00b (reload) Figure 15.15 Operation in Event Counter Mode When Not Handling Two-Phase Pulse Signals REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 157 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 15.5 15. Timer A Specifications of Event Counter Mode When Handling Two-Phase Pulse Signals on Timers A2, A3, and A4 Item Specification Count source Two-phase pulse signals applied to pins TAiIN and TAiOUT (i = 2 to 4) Count operation • Count direction (increment or decrement) is set by a two-phase pulse signal. • Reload/Free-run type can be selected. Reload function: The contents of the reload register are reloaded into the counter and the count continues when the timer underflows or overflows. Free-running function: The counter continues running without reloading when the timer underflows or overflows. Number of counting (FFFFh - n + 1): when incrementing n + 1: for decrementing n: setting value of the TAi register, 0000h to FFFFh Count start condition The TAiS bit in the TABSR Register is set to 1 (count starts) Count stop condition The TAiS bit is set to 0 (count stops) Interrupt request generation timing When the timer overflows or underflows TAiIN pin function Two-phase pulse input TAiOUT pin function Two-phase pulse input Read from timer A read from the TAi register returns a counter value Write to timer • A write to the TAi register while the count is stopped: The value is written to both the reload register and the counter. • A write to the TAi register while counting: The value is written to the reload register (It is transferred to the counter at the next reload timing).(1) Selectable function(2) • Normal processing operation (Timers A2 and A3) While a high-level (“H”) signal is applied to the TAjOUT pin (j = 2, 3), the timer increments a counter value at the rising edge of the TAjIN pin or decrements a counter value at the falling edge. • Multiply-by-4 processing operation (Timers A3 and A4) The timer increments the counter value in the following timings: -at the rising edge of TAkIN while TAkOUT is “H” (k = 3, 4) -at the falling edge of TAkIN while TAkOUT is “L” -at the rising edge of TAkOUT while TAkIN is “L” -at the falling edge of TAkOUT while TAkIN is “H” The timer decrements the counter in the following timings: -at the rising edge of TAkIN while TAkOUT is “L” -at the falling edge of TAkIN while TAkOUT is “H” -at the rising edge of TAkOUT while TAkIN is “H” -at the falling edge of TAkOUT while TAkIN is “L” • Counter reset by a Z-phase pulse signal input (Timer A3) The counter value is cleared to 0 by a Z-phase pulse signal input NOTES: 1. Wait for one or more count source cycles to write after the count starts. 2. Any operation can be selected for timer A3. Timer A2 is used only for the normal processing operation. Timer A4 is used only for the multiply-by-4 operation. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 158 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer A Normal processing operation (Timer A2 and timer A3) While an "H" is applied to the TAjOUT pin (j = 2, 3), the counter increments at the rising edge of the TAjIN pin and decrements at the falling edge. TAjOUT TAjIN <Free-running function> m Counter value m+1 m+2 m+1 m m-1 1 0 FFFF FFFE FFFF 0 IR bit in the TAjIC register Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program. <Reload function> Counter value m m+1 m+2 m+1 m m-1 1 0 FFFF m-1 m m+1 IR bit in the TAjIC register Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program. Multiply-by-4 processing operation (Timer A3 and timer A4) The counter decrements at the following timings: -at the rising edge of TAkIN while TAkOUT is “L” -at the falling edge of TAkIN while TAkOUT is “H” -at the rising edge of TAkOUT while TAkIN is “H” -at the falling edge of TAkOUT while TAkIN is “L” The counter increments at the following timings: -at the rising edge of TAkIN while TAkOUT is “H” -at the falling edge of TAkIN while TAkOUT is “L” -at the rising edge of TAkOUT while TAkIN is “L” -at the falling edge of TAkOUT while TAkIN is “H” TAkOUT TAkIN <Free-running function> Counter value m m+1 m+2 m+1 m m-1 1 0 FFFF FFFE FFFF 0 IR bit in the TAkIC register Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program. <Reload function> m Counter value m+1 m+2 m+1 m m-1 1 0 FFFF m-1 m m+1 IR bit in the TAkIC register Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program. : increment :decrement Figure 15.16 Operation in Event Counter Mode When Handling Two-Phase Pulse Signals on Timers A2, A3, and A4 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 159 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15.1.2.1 15. Timer A Counter Reset by Two-Phase Pulse Signal Processing The counter value of timer can be set to 0 by a Z-phase pulse signal input (counter reset) when processing two-phase pulse signals. This function can be used when all the following conditions are met; timer A3 event counter mode, two-phase pulse signal processing, free-running count operation type, and multiply-by-4 processing. The Z-phase pulse signal is applied to the INT2 pin. When the TAZIE bit in the ONSF register is set to 1 (Z-phase input enabled), Z-phase pulse input is enabled to reset the counter. To reset the counter by a Z-phase pulse input, set the TA3 register to 0000h beforehand. A Z-phase pulse input is enabled when the edge of a signal applied to the INT2 pin is detected. The POL bit in the INT2IC register can determine the edge polarity. The Z-phase pulse must have a pulse width of one or more timer A3 count source cycles. Figure 15.17 shows relations between two-phase pulses (A-phase and B-phase) and the Z-phase pulse. Z-phase pulse input resets the counter in the next count source timing followed a Z-phase pulse input. A timer A3 interrupt request is generated twice in a row if a timer A3 overflow or underflow, and the counter reset by an INT2 input occur at the same time. Do not generate a timer A3 interrupt request when this function is used. TA3OUT (A phase) TA3IN (B phase) Count source INT2(1) (Z phase) Pulse width of one or more count source cycles is required Counter value m m+1 1 2 3 4 5 6 NOTE: 1. Example when the rising edge of INT2 is selected. Figure 15.17 Relations between Two-Phase Pulses (A-Phase and B-Phase) and Z-Phase Pulse REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 160 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15.1.3 15. Timer A One-Shot Timer Mode When a trigger occurs, the counter decrements until underflows. Then, the counter is reloaded and stops until the next trigger occurs. Table 15.6 lists specifications of one-shot timer mode. Figure 15.18 shows a one-shot timer mode operation. Table 15.6 Specifications of One-Shot Timer Mode Item Specification f2n(1), fC32 Count source f1, f8, Count operation • Counter decrements When the counter reaches 0000h, the counter is reloaded and stops until the next trigger occurs. If a trigger occurs while counting, the contents of the reload register are reloaded into the counter and the count continues. Number of counting n times Count start condition A trigger, selectable from the following, occurs while the TAiS bit in the TABSR register is set to 1 (count starts): • the TAiOS bit in the ONSF register is set to 1 (timer starts) • an external trigger is applied to TAiIN pin • timer B2 overflows or underflows, • timer Aj overflows or underflows (j = i - 1, except j = 4 if i = 0), • timer Ak overflows or underflows (k = i + 1, except k = 0 if i = 4) Count stop condition • After the counter reaches 0000h and the counter value is reloaded • When the TAiS bit is set to 0 (count stops) n: setting value of the TAi register (i = 0 to 4), 0000h to FFFFh (but the counter does not run if n = 0000h) Interrupt request generation timing When the counter reaches 0000h TAiIN pin function Trigger input TAiOUT pin function Pulse output Read from timer A read from the TAi register returns undefined value Write to timer • A write to the TAi register while the count is stopped: The value is written to both the reload register and the counter. • A write to the TAi register while counting: The value is written to the reload register (It is transferred to the counter at the next reload timing).(2) Selectable function Pulse output function “L” is output while the count stops. “H” is output while counting. NOTES: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). 2. Wait for one or more count source cycles to write after the count starts. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 161 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer A Count stops Count stops FFFFh Count starts Count starts Count stops Count starts Re-trigger input Contents of the counter m = contents of the reload register m Reload Reload Reload 0000h TAiS bit in the TABSR register 1 0 Write signal to TAiOS bit in the ONSF register 1 / fj x m One-shot pulse output from the TAiOUT pin 1 / fj x (m + 1) “H” “L” Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program IR bit in the TAiIC register 1 0 fj: Frequency of the count source (f1, f8, f2n (1), fC32) i = 0 to 4 NOTE: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). (Conditions) TAiMR register: Bits TMOD1 and TMOD0 are set to 10b (one-shot timer mode). The MR2 bit is set to 0 (The TAiOS bit is enabled). Figure 15.18 Operation in One-Shot Timer Mode (Timer A) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 162 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15.1.4 15. Timer A Pulse Width Modulation Mode In pulse width modulation mode, the timer outputs pulse signals of a given width repeatedly. The counter functions as an 8-bit pulse width modulator or 16-bit pulse width modulator. Table 15.7 lists specifications of pulse width modulation mode. Figures 15.19 and 15.20 show examples of a 16-bit pulse width modulator and 8-bit pulse width modulator operations. Table 15.7 Specifications of Pulse Width Modulation Mode Item Specification f2n(1), fC32 Count source f1, f8, Count operation • Counter decrements (The counter functions as the 8-bit or 16-bit pulse width modulator.) The contents of the reload register are reloaded at the rising edge of the PWM pulse and the count continues. The count continues without reloading even if the re-trigger occurs while counting. 16-bit PWM • “H” width = n / fj n: setting value of the TAi register (i = 0 to 4), 0000h to FFFEh fj: count source frequency • Cycle = (216 - 1) / fj The cycle is fixed to this value 8-bit PWM • “H” width = n x (m + 1) / fj • Cycle = (28 - 1) x (m + 1) / fj m: setting value of low-order bit address of the TAi register, 00h to FFh n: setting value of high-order bit address of the TAi register, 00h to FEh Count start condition When a trigger is not used (the MR2 bit in the TAiMR register is 0): Set the TAiS bit in the TABSR register to 1 When a trigger is used (the MR2 bit in the TAiMR register is 1): A trigger, selectable from the following occurs while the TAiS bit in the TABSR register is set to 1(count starts): • an external trigger is applied to TAiIN pin • timer B2 overflows or underflows • timer Aj overflows or underflows (j = i - 1, except j = 4 if i = 0) • timer Ak overflows or underflows (k = i + 1, except k = 0 if i = 4) Count stop condition The TAiS bit is set to 0 (count stops) Interrupt request generation timing At the falling edge of the PWM pulse TAiIN pin function Trigger input TAiOUT pin function Pulse output Read from timer A read from the TAi register returns undefined value Write to timer • A write to the TAi register while the count is stopped: The value is written to both the reload register and the counter. • A write to the TAi register while counting: The value is written to the reload register (It is transferred to the counter at the next reload timing).(2) NOTES: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). 2. Wait for one or more count source cycles to write after the count starts. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 163 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer A Count stops Count starts End of 1 cycle 1 / fj × (216 - 1) Count source Input to the TAiIN pin “H” “L” No trigger is generated by this signal Set to 0 by a program Set to 1 by a program TAiS bit in the TABSR register 1 0 1 / fj × m PWM pulse output from the TAiOUT pin “H” “L” Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program IR bit in the TAiIC register 1 0 i = 0 to 4 fj: Count source frequency (f1, f8, f2n (1), fC32) m: Setting value of the TAi register (0000h to FFFEh) When the TAiS bit is set to 0 (count stops) while the TAiOUT output is "H", the TAiOUT output becomes "L" and the IR bit is set to 1 (interrupt requested). (Conditions) TAi register is set to 0005h. TAiMR register: MR1 bit is set to 1 (rising edge of signal applied to the TAiIN pin) NOTE: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). Figure 15.19 16-Bit Pulse Width Modulator Operation (Timer A) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 164 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer A Count starts End of 1 cycle Count stops Count source 1 / fj x (m+1) x (28-1) Signal applied to TAiIN pin “H” “L” Set to 1 by a program TAiS bit in the TABSR register Set to 0 by a program 1 0 Underflow signal of 8-bit prescaler 1 / fj x (m+1) x n PWM pulse output from TAiOUT pin “H” “L” Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program IR bit in the TAiIC register 1 0 i = 0 to 4 fj: Count source frequency (f1, f8, f2n(1), fC32) n: high-order bits in the TAi register (00h to FEh) m: low-order bits in the TAi register (00h to FFh) When the TAiS bit is set to 0 (count stops) while the TAiOUT output is "H", the TAiOUT output becomes "L" and the IR bit becomes 1 (interrupt requested). (Conditions) High-order bits in the TAi register are set to 02h. Low-order bits in the TAi register are set to 02h. TAiMR register: The MR1 bit is set to 0 (falling edge of signal applied to the TAiIN pin.) NOTES: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). 2. The 8-bit pulse width modulator counts underflow signals of the 8-bit prescaler. Figure 15.20 8-bit Pulse Width Modulator Operation (Timer A) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 165 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15.2 15. Timer B Timer B Timer B contains the following three modes. Bits TMOD1 and TMOD0 in the TBiMR register (i = 0 to 5) determine which mode is used. • Timer mode: The timer counts the internal count source. • Event counter mode: The timer counts overflows/underflows of another timer, or the external pulses. • Pulse period measurement mode, pulse width measurement mode: The timer measures the pulse period or pulse width of the external signal. Figure 15.21 shows a block diagram of timer B. Figures 15.22 to 15.26 show the registers associated with timer B. Table 15.8 shows TBiIN pin settings (i = 0 to 5). High-order bits of data bus Low-order bits of data bus Clock source select TCK1 and TCK0 00 f1 f8 01 f2n(1) 10 fC32 11 TBj overflow(2) Polarity switching TBiIN and edge pulse 1 TCK1 8 high-order bits 8 low-order bits TMOD1 and TMOD0 00: Timer mode 10: Pulse period and pulse width measurement mode Reload register Counter 01: Event counter mode 0 TBiS Counter reset circuit i= 0 to 5 j = i - 1, except j = 2 if i = 0, j = 5 if i = 3. NOTES: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). 2. Overflow signal or underflow signal. TCK1 and TCK0, TMOD1 and TMOD0: Bits in the TBiMR register TBiS: Bit in the TABSR register or the TBSR register Figure 15.21 Timer B Block Diagram REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 166 of 385 TBi Timer B0 Timer B1 Timer B2 Timer B3 Timer B4 Timer B5 Addresses 0351h 0350h 0353h 0352h 0355h 0354h 0311h 0310h 0313h 0312h 0315h 0314h TBj Timer B2 Timer B0 Timer B1 Timer B5 Timer B3 Timer B4 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer B Timer Bi Mode Register (i = 0 to 5)(Timer Mode) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 Symbol Address After Reset TB0MR to TB5MR 035Bh, 035Ch, 035Dh, 031Bh, 031Ch, 031Dh 00XX 0000b Bit Symbol Bit Name Function TMOD0 RW RW Operating mode select bits b1 b0 0 0: Timer mode TMOD1 RW MR0 RW Disabled in timer mode. Can be set to either 0 or 1 MR1 RW Registers TB0MR and TB3MR: Set to 0 in timer mode. MR2 MR3 RW Registers TB1MR, TB2MR, TB4MR, and TB5MR: Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. − Disabled in timer mode. Write 0. Read as undefined value. − b7 b6 TCK0 Count source select bits TCK1 0 0: f1 0 1: f8 1 0: f2n(1) 1 1: fC32 NOTE: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). To select f2n, set the CST bit in the TCSPR register to 1 before setting bits TCK1 and TCK0 to 10b. Figure 15.22 TB0MR to TB5MR Registers in Timer Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 167 of 385 RW RW Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer B Timer Bi Mode Register (i = 0 to 5)(Event Counter Mode) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 1 Symbol Address After Reset TB0MR to TB5MR 035Bh, 035Ch, 035Dh, 031Bh, 031Ch, 031Dh 00XX 0000b Bit Symbol Bit Name Function TMOD0 RW RW Operating mode select bits b1 b0 0 1: Event counter mode TMOD1 RW b3 b2 MR0 0 0: Falling edges of an external signal counted 0 1: Rising edges of an external signal counted 1 0: Falling and rising edges of an external signal counted 1 1: Do not set to this value Count polarity select bits (1) MR1 Registers TB0MR and TB3MR: Set to 0 in event counter mode. MR2 RW RW RW Registers TB1MR, TB2MR, TB4MR, and TB5MR: Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. − MR3 Disabled in event counter mode. Write 0. Read as undefined value. − TCK0 Disabled in event counter mode. Can be set to either 0 or 1 TCK1 Event clock select bit RW 0: Signal applied to the TBiIN pin 1: TBj overflows or underflows (2) RW NOTES: 1. Bits MR1 and MR0 are enabled when the TCK1 bit is set to 0. Bits MR1 and MR0 can be set to either 0 or 1 when the TCK1 bit is set to 1. 2. j = i - 1, except j = 2 if i = 0 and j = 5 if i = 3. Figure 15.23 TB0MR to TB5MR Registers in Event Counter Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 168 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer B Timer Bi Mode Register (i = 0 to 5) (Pulse Period Measurement Mode, Pulse Width Measurement Mode) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 1 0 Symbol Address After Reset TB0MR to TB5MR 035Bh, 035Ch, 035Dh, 031Bh, 031Ch, 031Dh 00XX 0000b Bit Symbol Bit Name Function TMOD0 RW RW b1 b0 Operating mode select bits TMOD1 1 0: Pulse period measurement mode Pulse width measurement mode b3 b2 MR0 Measurement mode select bits(1) MR1 0 0: Pulse period measurement 1 0 1: Pulse period measurement 2 1 0: Pulse width measurement 1 1: Do not set to this value Registers TB0MR and TB3MR: Set to 0 in pulse period measurement mode, pulse width measurement mode. MR2 MR3 Registers TB1MR, TB2MR, TB4MR, and TB5MR: Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. Timer Bi overflow flag(2) TCK0 Count source select bits TCK1 RW RW RW RW − 0: No overflow has occurred 1: Overflow has occurred (3) RO b7 b6 RW 0 0: f1 0 1: f8 1 0: f2n(4) 1 1: fC32 RW NOTES: 1. Bits MR1 and MR0 determine the following measurement modes: Pulse period measurement 1 (bits MR1 and MR0 are set to 00b): Measures the width between the falling edges of a pulse Pulse period measurement 2 (bits MR1 and MR0 bits are set to 01b): Measures the width between the rising edges of a pulse Pulse width measurement (bits MR1 and MR0 bits are set to 10b): Measures the width between a falling edge and a rising edge of a pulse, and between a rising edge and a falling edge of a pulse 2. The MR3 bit is undefined when reset. 3. To set the MR3 bit to 0 (no overflow), wait for one or more count source cycles to write to the TBiMR register after the MR3 bit becomes 1 (overflow), while the TBiS bit in TABSR or TBSR register is set to 1 (count starts). 4. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). To select f2n, set the CST bit in the TCSPR register to 1 before setting bits TCK1 and TCK0 to 10b. Figure 15.24 TB0MR to TB5MR Registers in Pulse Period Measurement Mode, Pulse Width Measurement Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 169 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer B Timer Bi Register(1) (i = 0 to 5) b15 b8 b7 b0 Symbol TB0 to TB2 TB3 to TB5 Mode Address 0351h - 0350h, 0353h - 0352h, 0355h - 0354h 0311h - 0310h, 0313h - 0312h, 0315h - 0314h Function Setting Range RW Timer Mode If a count source frequency is fj, and the setting value of the TBi register is n, the counter cycle is (n+1) / fj. 0000h to FFFFh RW Event Counter Mode If the setting value of the TBi register is n, the count times are (n+1)(2) 0000h to FFFFh RW Pulse Period Measurement Mode, Pulse Width Measurement Mode Increment the counter between one valid edge and another valid edge of a pulse applied to the TBiIN pin − RO NOTES: 1. Read and write this register in 16-bit units. 2. Timer Bi counts overflows/underflows of another timer, or the external pulses. Figure 15.25 After Reset Undefined Undefined TB0 to TB5 Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 170 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer B Count Start Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset TABSR 0340h 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW TA0S Timer A0 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TA1S Timer A1 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TA2S Timer A2 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TA3S Timer A3 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TA4S Timer A4 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TB0S Timer B0 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TB1S Timer B1 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TB2S Timer B2 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW Timer B3, B4, B5 Count Start Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset TBSR 0300h 000X XXXXb Bit Symbol − (b4-b0) Figure 15.26 Bit Name Function Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. RW − TB3S Timer B3 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TB4S Timer B4 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TB5S Timer B5 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TABSR Register, TBSR Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 171 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 15.8 15. Timer B TBiIN Pin Settings (i = 0 to 5) Bit Setting Port Function PD7, PD9(1) Registers PS1, PS3(1) Registers P7_1 TB5IN PD7_1 = 0 PS1_1 = 0 P9_0 TB0IN PD9_0 = 0 PS3_0 = 0 P9_1 TB1IN PD9_1 = 0 PS3_1 = 0 P9_2 TB2IN PD9_2 = 0 PS3_2 = 0 P9_3 TB3IN PD9_3 = 0 PS3_3 = 0 P9_4 TB4IN PD9_4 = 0 PS3_4 = 0 NOTE: 1. Set the PD9 or PS3 register immediately after the PRC2 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two instructions. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 172 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15.2.1 15. Timer B Timer Mode In timer mode, the timer counts an internally generated count source. Table 15.9 lists specifications of timer mode. Figure 15.27 shows a timer mode operation (Timer B). Table 15.9 Specifications of Timer Mode Item Specification f2n(1), fC32 Count source f1, f8, Count operation • Counter decrements When the timer underflows, the contents of the reload register are reloaded into the counter and the count continues. Counter cycle n+1 fj Count start condition The TBiS bit in the TABSR or TBSR register is set to 1 (count starts) Count stop condition The TBiS bit is set to 0 (count stops) fj: count source frequency n: setting value of the TBi register (i=0 to 5), 0000h to FFFFh Interrupt request generation timing When the timer underflows TBiIN pin function Programmable I/O port Read from timer A read from the TBi register returns a counter value. Write to timer • A write to the TBi register while the count is stopped: The value is written to both the reload register and the counter. • A write to the TBi register while counting: The value is written to the reload register (It is transferred to the counter at the next reload timing).(2) NOTES: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). 2. Wait for one or more count source cycles to write after the count starts. FFFFh Count resumes Count starts Underflow Underflow n Contents of the counter n = contents of the reload register Count stops Reload Reload 0000h TBiS bit in the TABSR or TBSR register 1 0 IR bit in the TBiIC register 1 0 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledged or by a program i = 0 to 5 (Condition) TBiMR register: Bits TMOD1 and TMOD0 are set to 00b (timer mode). Figure 15.27 Operation in Timer Mode (Timer B) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 173 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15.2.2 15. Timer B Event Counter Mode In event counter mode, the timer counts overflows/underflows of another timer, or the external pulses. Table 15.10 lists specifications of event counter mode. Figure 15.28 shows an event counter mode operation. Table 15.10 Specifications of Event Counter Mode Item Specification Count source • External signal applied to the TBiIN pin (i = 0 to 5) (valid edge can be selected by a program) • TBj overflows or underflows (j = i - 1, except j = 2 if i = 0, j = 5 if i = 3) Count operation • Counter decrements When the timer underflows, the contents of the reload register are reloaded into the counter and the count continues. Number of counting (n + 1) times Count start condition The TBiS bit in the TABSR or TBSR register is set to 1 (count starts) Count stop condition The TBiS bit is set to 0 (count stops) n: Setting value of the TBi register 0000h to FFFFh Interrupt request generation timing When the timer underflows TBiIN pin function Count source input Read from timer A read from the TBi register returns a counter value. Write to timer • A write to the TBi register while the count is stopped: The value is written to both the reload register and the counter. • A write to the TBi register while counting: The value is written to the reload register (It is transferred to the counter at the next reload timing).(1) NOTE: 1. Wait for one or more count source cycles to write after the count starts. FFFFh Count starts Underflow n Count resumes Count stops Reload Contents of the counter n = contents of the reload register 0000h Input to the TBiIN pin “H” “L” TBiS bit in the TABSR or TBSR regsiter 1 0 1 IR bit in the TBiIC regsiter 0 i = 0 to 5 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program (Condition) TBiMR register: Bits TMOD1 and TMOD0 are set to 01b (event counter mode) Bits MR1 and MR0 are set to 00b (count the falling edge of the external signal) The TCK1 bit is set to 0 (signal input to TBiIN pin) Figure 15.28 Operation in Event Counter Mode (Timer B) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 174 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15.2.3 15. Timer B Pulse Period Measurement Mode, Pulse Width Measurement Mode In pulse period measurement mode and pulse width measurement mode, the timer measures pulse period or pulse width of the external signal. Table 15.11 shows specifications in pulse period measurement mode and pulse width measurement mode. Figure 15.29 shows a pulse period measurement operation. Figure 15.30 shows a pulse width measurement operation. Table 15.11 Specifications of Pulse Period Measurement Mode, Pulse Width Measurement Mode Item Specification f2n(1), fC32 Count source f1, f8, Count operation • Counter increments The counter value is transferred to the reload register when the valid edge of a pulse is detected. Then the counter becomes 0000h and the count continues. Count start condition The TBiS bit (i = 0 to 5) in the TABSR or TBSR register is set to 1 (count starts) Count stop condition The TBiS bit is set to 0 (count stops) Interrupt request generation timing • When the valid edge of a pulse is input(2) • When the timer overflows(3) The MR3 bit in the TBiMR register is set to 1 (overflow) simultaneously. TBiIN pin function Pulse input Read from timer A read from the TBi register returns the contents of the reload register (measurement results)(4) Write to timer The TBi register cannot be written NOTES: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). 2. An interrupt request is not generated when the first valid edge is input after the count starts. 3. To set the MR3 bit to 0 (no overflow), wait for one or more count source cycles to write to the TBiMR register after the MR3 bit becomes 1, while the TBiS bit is set to 1. 4. A value read from the TBi register is undefined until the second valid edge is detected after the count starts. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 175 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer B Pulse input to TBiIN pin(2) 1st valid edge “H” 2nd valid edge “L” FFFFh n Contents of the counter (n = contents of the reload register) (note 1) 0000h TBiS bit in the TABSR register or TBSR register 1 0 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program IR bit in the TBiIC register 1 0 Transfer timing from counter to reload register Transfer (undefined value) TBi register Transfer (measured value n) Undefined value n i = 0 to 5 NOTES: 1. Counter is reset due to the completion of the measurement. 2. If an overflow and a valid edge input occur simultaneously, an interrupt request is generated only once, which results in the valid edge not being recognized. Do not let an overflow occur. Figure 15.29 Operation in Pulse Period Measurement Mode (Timer B) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 176 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 15. Timer B 2nd valid edge 1st valid edge “H” Pulse input to TBiIN pin 10000h + n “L” FFFFh n Contents of the counter n = contents of the reload register (note1) (note2) (note1) 0000h TBiS bit in the TABSR or TBSR register 1 MR3 bit in the TBiMR register 1 0 (note 3) 0 (note 4) IR bit in the TBiIC register (note 4) 1 0 Set to 0 by an interrupt acknowledgement or by a program Transfer timing from counter to reload register Transfer (measured value n) Transfer (undefined value) TBi register Undefined value n i = 0 to 5 NOTES: 1. Counter is reset due to the completion of the measurement. 2. Overflow 3. To set the MR3 bit to 0 (no overflow), wait for one or more count source cycles to write to the TBiMR register after the MR3 bit becomes 1 (overflow), while the TBiS bit in TABSR or TBSR register is set to 1 (count starts). 4. Determine whether an interrupt source is a valid edge input or an overflow by reading the port level in the TBi interrupt routine. Figure 15.30 Operation in Pulse Width Measurement Mode (Timer B) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 177 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function The PWM waveform can be output by using timers B2, A1, A2, and A4. Timer B2 is used for the carrier wave control, and timers A4, A1, and A2 for the U-, V-, and W-phase PWM control. Table 16.1 lists specifications of the three-phase motor control timer functions. Table 16.2 lists pin settings. Figure 16.1 shows a block diagram. Figures 16.2 to 16.10 show registers associated with the three-phase motor control timer function. Table 16.1 Specifications of Three-Phase Motor Control Timers Item Specification Control method Three-phase full wave method Modulation modes • Triangular wave modulation mode • Sawtooth wave modulation mode Active level Selectable either active High or active Low Timers to be used • Timer B2 (Carrier wave cycle control: used in timer mode) • Timers A4, A1, and A2 (U-, V-, W-phase PWM control: used in one-shot timer mode): Short circuit prevention features • Prevention function against upper and lower arm short circuit caused by program errors • Arm short circuit prevention function using dead time timer • Forced cutoff function by NMI input REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 178 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function TB2 register PWCON 0 1 Reload register ICTB2 register Timer A1 reload control signal INV02 f1 Timer A1 reload control signal Value written to INV03 bit Write signal to INV03 bit "1" write signal to INV07 bit RESET NMI INV05 INV06 INV06 Write signal to IDBi register Interrupt request Timer B2 interrupt request INV00 INV10 Write signal to TB2 register 1 0 Counter INV01 INV11 Timer B2 INV03 DQ T R INV02 SQ R INV04 U-phase W-phase DTT register Transfer trigger(1) V-Phase Output Control Circuit Start trigger V-phase upper/ lower arm short circuit detection signal Reload register INV16 0 1 Dead timer timer fDT Dead timer timer start trigger INV15 Data Bus Timer A1 reload control signal INV14 0 1 INV11 DQ DQ DQ DQ T T T INV14 0 1 TQ TA1 register TA11 register DQ Three-phase output D Q shift register DV1 DV0 V V DQ T Dead timer timer start trigger Data Bus Data Bus D TQ Start trigger f1 Reload register Timer A1 DQ DQ D T T TQ DQ DQ DVB1 DVB0 fDT Three-phase output shift register Data Bus Transfer trigger Start trigger DTT register U-Phase Output Control Circuit Transfer trigger Start trigger DTT register W-Phase Output Control Circuit INV00 to INV07: bits in the INVC0 register INV10 to INV15: bits in the INVC1 register DVi, DVBi: bits in the IDBi register (i = 0, 1) PWCON: bit in the TB2SC register NOTE: 1. When the INV06 bit is set to 0 (triangular wave modulation mode), a transfer trigger is generated at the first timer B2 underflow after writing to the IDBi register (i = 0, 1). Figure 16.1 Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Block Diagram REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 179 of 385 U U W W Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Three-Phase PWM Control Register 0(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol INVC0 After Reset 00h Address 0308h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW b1 b0 INV00 ICTB2 count condition select bits INV01 0 0: Timer B2 underflow 0 1: 1 0: Timer B2 underflow at the rising edge of the timer A1 reload control signal(2) (every odd-numbered timer B2 underflow) 1 1: Timer B2 underflow at the falling edge of the timer A1 reload control signal(2) (every even-numbered timer B2 underflow) RW RW INV02 Three-phase motor control timer function enable bit(3) 0: Three-phase motor control timer function not used 1: Three-phase motor control timer function used(4,5) RW INV03 Three-phase motor control timer output control bit 0: Three-phase motor control timer output disabled(5,6) 1: Three-phase motor control timer output enabled RW INV04 Upper and lower arm simultaneous turn-on disable bit 0: Simultaneous turn-on enabled 1: Simultaneous turn-on disabled RW INV05 Upper and lower arm simultaneous turn-on detect flag 0: Not detected 1: Detected (7) RO INV06 Modulation mode select bit 0: Triangular wave modulation mode 1: Sawtooth wave modulation mode RW INV07 Software trigger select bit Transfer trigger is generated when the INV07 bit is set to 1. Trigger for the dead time timer is also generated when the INV06 bit is set to 1. This bit is read as 0. RW NOTES: 1. Set the INVC0 register after the PRC1 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). Set bits INV06 and INV02 to INV00 while timers A1,A2, A4, and B2 are stopped. 2. Set the INV01 bit to 1 after setting a value to the ICTB2 register. Also, when the INV01 bit is set to 1, set the timer A1 count start bit to 1 prior to the first timer B2 underflow. 3. Set pins after the INV02 bit is set to 1. Refer to the table, Pin settings when using three-phase motor control timer function . 4. Set the INV02 bit to 1 to operate the dead time timer, U-, V-, and W-phase output control circuits, and ICTB2 counter. 5. When the INV03 bit is set to 0 and the INV02 bit to 1, pins U, U, V, V, W, and W (including when other output functions are assiged to these pins) are all placed in high-impedance states. 6. The INV03 bit becomes 0 when one of the following occurs: -Reset -The both upper and lower arms output the active level signals at the same time while the INV04 bit is set to 1 -The INV03 bit is set to 0 by a program -Signal applied to the NMI pin changes from "H" to "L" (while an "L" is applied to the NMI pin, the INV03 bit cannot be set to 1). 7. The INV05 bit cannot be set to 1 by a program. To set the INV05 bit to 0, write a 0 to the INV04 bit. Figure 16.2 INVC0 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 180 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Three-Phase PWM Control Register 1(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol INVC1 Address 0309h Bit Symbol Bit Name After Reset 00h Function RW INV10 Timers A1, A2, and A4 start trigger select bit 0: Timer B2 underflow 1: Timer B2 underflow and a write to the TB2 register RW INV11 Timers A11, A21, and A41 control bit 0: Timers A11, A21, and A41 not used (Three-phase mode 0) 1: Timers A11, A21, and A41 used (Three-phase mode 1) RW INV12 Dead time timer count source (fDT) select bit 0: f1 1: f1 divided-by-2 RW INV13 Carrier wave rise/fall detect flag(2) 0: Timer B2 underflow occurred an even number of times 1: Timer B2 underflow occurred an odd number of times RO INV14 Active level control bit 0: Active Low 1: Active High RW INV15 Dead time disable bit 0: Dead time enabled 1: Dead time disabled RW INV16 Dead time timer trigger select bit 0: Falling edge of one-shot pulse of timer (A4, A1, and A2 (3)) 1: Rising edge of the three-phase output shift register (U-, V-, W-phase) RW Reserved bit Set to 0 RW − (b7) NOTES: 1. Set the INVC1 register after the PRC1 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). Set the INVC1 register while timers A1, A2, A4, and B2 are stopped. 2. The INV13 bit is enabled only when the INV06 bit is set to 0 (triangular wave modulation mode) and the INV11 bit to 1. 3. If the following conditions are all met, set the INV16 bit to 1. - The INV15 bit is set to 0 - Bits Dij (i = U, V or W, j = 0, 1) and DiBj in the IDBj register always have different values when the INV03 bit in the INVC0 register is set to 1 (three-phase control timer output enabled). (The upper arm and lower arm always output opposite level signals at any time except dead time.) If any of the above conditions is not met, set the INV16 bit to 0. Figure 16.3 INVC1 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 181 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Timer B2 Mode Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 Symbol Address After Reset TB2MR 035Dh 00XX 0000b Bit Symbol Bit Name Function TMOD0 RW RW Operating mode select bits Set to 00b (timer mode) to use the three-phase motor control timer function TMOD1 RW MR0 RW Disabled to use the three-phase motor control timer function. Can be set to either 0 or 1. MR1 RW MR2 Set to 0 to use the three-phase motor control timer function MR3 Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. − TCK0 RW Count source select bits Set to 00b (f1) to use the three-phase motor control timer function TCK1 Figure 16.4 RW TB2MR Register when Using Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 182 of 385 RW Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Timer Ai Mode Register (i = 1, 2, 4) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 1 0 0 1 0 Symbol TA1MR, TA2MR, TA4MR Bit Symbol Address 0357h, 0358h, 035Ah Bit Name After Reset 00h Function TMOD0 RW Operating mode select bits Set to 10b (one-shot timer mode) to use the three-phase motor control timer function TMOD1 RW − (b2) Reserved bit Set to 0 RW MR1 External trigger select bit Set to 0 to use the three-phase motor control timer function RW MR2 Trigger select bit Set to 1 (selected by the TRGSR register) to use the three-phase motor control timer function RW MR3 Set to 0 to use the three-phase motor control timer function TCK0 RW RW Count source select bits TCK1 Figure 16.5 RW Set to 00b (f1) to use the three-phase motor control timer function RW TA1MR, TA2MR, and TM4MR Registers when Using Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 183 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Trigger Select Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset TRGSR 0343h 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function TA1TGL RW Timer A1 trigger select bits Set to 01b (TB2 underflow) to use the V-phase output control circuit TA1TGH RW TA2TGL RW Timer A2 trigger select bits Set to 01b (TB2 underflow) to use the W-phase output control circuit TA2TGH RW b5 b4 TA3TGL Timer A3 trigger select bits TA3TGH 0 0: Input to the TA3IN pin selected 0 1: TB2 overflow selected (1) 1 0: TA2 overflow selected (1) 1 1: TA4 overflow selected (1) TA4TGL RW RW RW Timer A4 trigger select bits Set to 01b (TB2 underflow) to use the U-phase output control circuit TA4TGH NOTE: 1. Overflow or underflow. Figure 16.6 RW TRGSR Register when Using Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 184 of 385 RW Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Timer B2 Special Mode Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 TB2SC 035Eh 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW PWCON Timer B2 reload timing switch bit 0: Timer B2 underflow 1: Timer B2 underflow at the rising edge of the timer A1 reload control signal (every odd-numbered timer B2 underflow) RW − (b7-b1) Reserved bits Set to 0 RW Timer B2 Interrupt Generation Frequency Set Counter(1, 2) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b0 Symbol Address After Reset ICTB2 030Dh Undefined Function Setting Range RW - When the INV01 bit in the INVC0 register is set to 0 (the ICTB2 counter increments every timer B2 underflows) and a setting value is n, the timer B2 interrupt request is generated every n-th timer B2 underflow. - When bits INV01 and INV00 are set to 10b (the ICTB2 counter increments when the timer B2 underflow at the rising edge of the timer A1 reload control signal) and a setting value is n, the first timer B2 interrupt request is generated at the (2n-1)th timer B2 underflow. From the 2nd time on, the request is generated every 2n-th timer B2 underflow. - When bits INV01 and INV00 are set to 11b (the ICTB2 counter increments when the timer B2 underflow occurs at the falling edge of the timer A1 reload control signal) and a setting value is n; • When n > 1, the first timer B2 interrupt request is generated at the (2n-2)th timer B2 underflow. From the 2nd time on, the request is generated every 2n-th timer B2 underflow. • When n = 1, the timer B2 interrupt request is generated every 2n-th timer B2 underflow. 1 to 15 WO Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. − NOTES: 1. Read-modify-write instructions cannot be used to set the ICTB2 register. Refer to Usage Notes for details. 2. If the INV01 bit in the INVC0 register is set to 1, set the ICTB2 register while the TB2S bit is set to 0 (count stops). If the INV01 bit is set to 0, do not set the ICTB2 register when timer B2 underflows, regardless of the TB2S bit setting. Figure 16.7 TB2SC Register, ICTB2 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 185 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Timer B2 Register(1) b15 b8 b7 b0 Symbol TB2 Address 0355h - 0354h Function If a setting value is n, f1 is divided by n+1. Timers A1, A2, and A4 start every time timer B2 underflows. After Reset Undefined Setting Range RW 0000h to FFFFh RW NOTE: 1. Read and write this register in 16-bit units. Dead Time Timer(1, 2, 3) b7 b0 Symbol Address After Reset DTT 030Ch Undefined Function Setting Range RW This one-shot timer is used to delay the timing for a turn-on signal to be switched to its active level in order to prevent the upper and lower arm short circuit. If a setting value is n, the count source is counted n times after the start trigger occurs, and then the timer stops. 01h to FFh WO NOTES: 1. Read-modify-write instructions cannot be used to set the DTT register. Refer to Usage Notes for details. 2. The DTT register setting is enabled when the INV15 bit in the INVC1 register is set to 0 (dead time enabled). No dead time is generated when the INV15 bit is set to 1 (dead time disabled). 3. The INV16 bit in the INVC1 register determines the start trigger of the DTT register. The INV12 bit determines the count source. Figure 16.8 TB2 Register, DTT Register when Using Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 186 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Timer Ai, Ai1 Register(1, 2, 3, 4, 5) (i = 1, 2, 4) b15 b8 b7 b0 Symbol Address After Reset TA1, TA2, TA4 TA11, TA21, TA41 0349h - 0348h, 034Bh - 034Ah, 034Fh - 034Eh 0303h - 0302h, 0305h - 0304h, 0307h - 0306h Undefined Undefined Function If a setting value is n, f1 is counted n times after a start trigger occurs, and then the timer stops. Output signal level for each phase changes when timers A1, A2, or A4 stop. Setting Range RW 0000h to FFFFh WO NOTES: 1. Write these registers in 16-bit units. Read-modify-write instructions cannot be used to set registers TAi and TAi1. Refer to Usage Notes for details. 2. If the TAi or TAi1 register is set to 0000h, the counter does not start and the timer Ai interrupt is not generated. 3. When the INV15 bit in the INVC1 register is set to 0 (dead timer enabled), an output signal is switched to its active level with delay simultaneously with the dead time timer underflow. 4. When the INV11 bit is set to 0 (Timers A11, A21, and A41 not used (three-phase mode 0)), the contents of the TAi register are transferred to the reload register by a timer Ai start trigger. When the INV11 bit is set to 1 (Timers A11, A21, and A41 are used (three-phase mode 1)), the contents of the TAi1 register are transferred by the first timer Ai start trigger, and then contents of the TAi register are transferred by the next timer Ai start trigger. Subsequently, the contents of registers TAi1 and TAi are transferred alternately to the reload register by each timer Ai start trigger. 5. Do not set registers TAi and TAi1 in the timer B2 underflow timing. Three-Phase Output Buffer Register i(1) (i = 0, 1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset IDB0, IDB1 030Ah, 030Bh XX11 1111b Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW DUi Upper arm (U-phase) output buffer i Set output levels of the three-phase output shift registers. The set value is reflected in each turn-on signal as follows: RW DUBi Lower arm (U-phase) output buffer i 0: Active (ON) 1: Inactive (OFF) RW DVi Upper arm (V-phase) output buffer i When read, the contents of the three-phase output shift registers are returned. RW DVBi Lower arm (V-phase) output buffer i RW DWi Upper arm (W-phase) output buffer i RW DWBi Lower arm (W-phase) output buffer i RW − (b7-b6) Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. − NOTE: 1. When values are written to registers IDB0 and IDB1, these values are transferred to the three-phase output shift registers by a transfer trigger. The value written in the IDB0 register becomes the initial output level of each phase when the transfer trigger occurs. The value written in the IDB1 register becomes the next output signal level when the falling edge of the timer A1, A2 and A4 one-shot pulses is detected. Figure 16.9 TA1, TA2, TA4, TA11, TA21, and TA41 Registers, IDB0, IDB1 Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 187 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Count Start Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol TABSR Address 0340h Bit Symbol Figure 16.10 Table 16.2 After Reset 00h Bit Name Function RW TA0S Timer A0 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TA1S Timer A1 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TA2S Timer A2 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TA3S Timer A3 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TA4S Timer A4 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TB0S Timer B0 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TB1S Timer B1 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TB2S Timer B2 count start bit 0: Count stops 1: Count starts RW TABSR Register when Using Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Pin Settings when Using Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function(1) Bit Setting Port P7_2 Function PSC Register PSL1, PSL2, Registers PS1, PS2 Registers(2) V PSC_2 = 1 PSL1_2 = 0 PS1_2 = 1 P7_3 V − PSL1_3 = 1 PS1_3 = 1 P7_4 W − PSL1_4 = 1 PS1_4 = 1 P7_5 W − PSL1_5 = 0 PS1_5 = 1 P8_0 U − PSL2_0 = 1 PS2_0 = 1 U − PSL2_1 = 0 PS2_1 = 1 P8_1 NOTES: 1. Set these registers after setting the INV02 bit in the INVC0 register to 1 (three-phase motor control timer function used). 2. Set registers PS1 and PS2 after setting the other registers. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 188 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 16.1 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Triangular Wave Modulation Mode In triangular wave modulation mode, one cycle of carrier waveform consists of two timer B2 underflow cycles. A timer Ai one-shot pulse (i = 1, 2, and 4) is generated by using a timer B2 underflow signal as a trigger. Two of the timer Ai one-shot pulses are used to output one cycle of the PWM waveform. Table 16.3 lists specifications and settings of triangular wave modulation mode. Triangular wave modulation mode has two operation modes, three-phase mode 0 and three-phase mode 1. TAi register is used in three-phase mode 0. Every time a timer B2 underflow interrupt occurs, the one-shot pulse width is set in the TAi register. Registers TAi and TAi1 are used in three-phase mode 1. Two different widths of the one-shot pulse can be set in these registers. If a setting value of the ICTB2 register is n, a timer B2 underflow interrupt is generated every n-th or every 2n-th timer B2 underflow to set values in registers TAi and TAi1. Table 16.3 Specifications and Settings of Triangular Wave Modulation Mode Item Three-Phase Mode 0 Three-Phase Mode 1 INV06 bit 0 0 INV11 bit 0 1 Bits INV01 and INV00 00b or 01b 00b 10b PWCON bit 0 0 or 1 ICTB2 register 1 n Carrier wave cycle 2 × (m + 1) f1 2 × (m+1) f1 Upper arm active level output width 1 ×(m+1 - a 2k-1+a2k) f1 1 × (m+1 - b +a ) k k f1 INV13 bit 0 or 1 11b Indicates the timer A1 reload control signal state. Timer B2 interrupt generation timing Timer B2 underflow Every n-th timer B2 underflow Every 2n-th timer B2 underflow Timer B2 reload timing Timer B2 underflow Transfer timing from IDBp register to three-phase output shift register When a value is written to the IDBp register (p = 0, 1), the value is transferred only once by the first transfer trigger. Every odd-numbered (2n × j - 1) timer B2 underflow Every evennumbered (2n × j) timer B2 underflow • Timer B2 underflow (PWCON = 0) • Timer B2 underflow at the rising edge of the timer A1 reload control signal (PWCON = 1) Dead time timer start • At the falling edge of the one-shot pulse of timer A1, A2 and A4 (INV16 = 0) timing • At the rising edge of the three-phase output shift register (INV16 = 1) m: Value of the TB2 register a2k-1: Value set to the TAi register at odd-numbered time. a2k: Value set to the TAi register at even-numbered time. bk: Value set to the TAi1 register at k-th time. ak: Value set to the TAi register at k-th time. j: the number of interrupts REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 189 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Figure 16.11 shows an example of the triangular wave modulation operation (three-phase mode 0). Figures 16.12 and 16.13 show examples of the triangular wave modulation operation (three-phase mode 1). Triangular Waveform as a Carrier Wave (Three-phase mode 0) Carrier wave Signal wave TB2S bit in the TABSR register Timer B2 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program IR bit in the TB2IC register Timer A4 start trigger signal (1) TA4 register a1 Reload register(1) a1 a2 a3 a2 a3 a2 a1 a4 a5 a4 a3 a6 a5 a4 a7 a6 a5 a8 a7 a6 a9 a8 a7 a9 a8 Timer A4 one-shot pulse(1) DU0 = 1 Upper arm (U-phase) output signal(1) Rewrite registers IDB0 and IDB1 DU0 = 1 DU1 = 0 DU1 = 1 Values are transferred to the three-phase output shift register from registers IDB0 and IDB1 Lower arm (U-phase) output signal(1) DUB1 = 1 DUB0 = 0 DUB0 = 0 INV14 bit in INVC1 register = 0 (Active Low) U-phase U-phase Dead time U-phase INV14 bit in INVC1 register = 1 (Active High) Dead time U-phase NOTE: 1. Internal signals. See Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Block Diagram. The above applies under the following conditions: - INVC0 register: INV01 bit = 0 (ICTB2 counter is incremented by 1 when timer B2 underflows) INV02 bit = 1 (Three-phase motor control timer function used) INV03 bit = 1 (Three-phase motor control timer output enabled) INV06 bit = 0 (Triangular wave modulation mode) - INVC1 register: INV10 bit = 0 (Timer B2 underflow) INV11 bit = 0 (Timers A11, A21, A41 not used (Three-phase mode 0)) INV15 bit = 0 (Dead time enabled) INV16 bit = 1 (Rising edge of the three-phase output shift register (U-, V-, W-phase)) - ICTB2 register = 01h (Timer B2 interrupt is generated every timer B2 underflow) The following shows examples to change PWM output levels. - Default value of the timer: TA4 = a1 (The TA4 register is rewritten every time the timer B2 interrupt occurs.) First time TA4 = a2, second time TA4 = a3, third time TA4 = a4, fourth time TA4 = a5, fifth time TA4 = a6 - Default value of the registers IDB0 and IDB1: DU0 = 1, DUB0 = 0, DU1 = 0, and DUB1 = 1 They are changed to DU0 = 1, DUB0 = 0, DU1 = 1, and DUB1 = 0 at the sixth timer B2 interrupt. Figure 16.11 Triangular Wave Modulation Operation (Three-Phase Mode 0) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 190 of 385 DUB1 = 0 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Triangular Waveform as a Carrier Wave (Three-phase mode 1: INV01 and INV00 = 10b) Carrier wave Signal wave TB2S bit in the TABSR register Timer B2 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program IR bit in the TB2IC register INV13 bit in the INVC1 register Timer A4 start trigger signal (1) TA4 register a1 a2 a3 a4 a5 TA41 register b1 b2 b3 b4 b5 Reload register(1) b1 a1 b2 a1 b1 a2 b2 b3 a3 a2 b3 b4 a3 a4 b4 b5 a4 Timer A4 one-shot pulse (1) Rewrite registers IDB0 and IDB1 DU0 = 1 Upper arm (U-phase) output signal(1) DU0 = 1 DU1 = 0 DU1 = 1 Values are transferred to the three-phase output shift register from registers IDB0 and IDB1 Lower arm (U-phase) output signal(1) DUB1 = 1 DUB0 = 0 DUB1 = 0 DUB0 = 0 INV14 bit in INVC1 register = 0 (Active Low) U-phase U-phase Dead time INV14 bit in INVC1 register = 1 (Active High) U-phase Dead time U-phase NOTE: 1. Internal signals. See Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Block Diagram. The above applies under the following conditions: - INVC0 register: Bits INV01 and INV00 = 10b (ICTB2 counter is incremented by 1 at the rising edge of the timer A1 reload control signal) INV02 bit = 1 (Three-phase motor control timer function used) INV03 bit = 1 (Three-phase motor control timer output enabled) INV06 bit = 0 (Triangular wave modulation mode) - INVC1 register: INV10 bit = 0 (Timer B2 underflow) INV11 bit = 1 (Timer A11, A21, A41 used (Three-phase mode 1)) INV15 bit = 0 (Dead time enabled) INV16 bit = 1 (Rising edge of the three-phase output shift register (U-, V-, W-phase)) - ICTB2 register = 01h (First timer B2 interrupt occurs when timer B2 underflows for the first time, and the subsequent interrupts occur every second timer B2 underflow.) The following shows examples to change PWM output levels. - Default value of the timer: TA41 = b1, TA4 = a1 (Registers TA4 and TA41 are rewritten every time the timer B2 interrupt occurs.) First time TA41 = b2, TA4 = a2, second time TA41 = b3, TA4 = a3 - Default value of the registers IDB0 and IDB1: DU0 = 1, DUB0 = 0, DU1 = 0, and DUB1 = 1 They are changed to DU0 = 1, DUB0 = 0, DU1 = 1, and DUB1 = 0 at the third timer B2 interrupt. Figure 16.12 Triangular Wave Modulation Operation (Three-Phase Mode 1)(INV01 and INV00 = 10b) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 191 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Triangular Waveform as a Carrier Wave (Three-phase mode 1: INV0 and INV00 = 11b) Carrier wave Signal wave TB2S bit in the TABSR register Timer B2 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program IR bit in the TB2IC register INV13 bit in the INVC1 register Timer A4 start trigger signal (1) TA4 register a1 a2 a3 a4 a5 TA41 register b1 b2 b3 b4 b5 Reload register(1) b1 a1 b1 a1 b1 b2 a2 b2 b2 b3 a2 a3 b3 b3 a3 b4 a4 b4 b4 b5 a4 Timer A4 one-shot pulse (1) Rewrite registers IDB0 and IDB1 DU0 = 1 Upper arm (U-phase) output signal(1) DU0 = 1 DU1 = 0 DU1 = 1 Values are transferred to the three-phase output shift register from registers IDB0 and IDB1 Lower arm (U-phase) output signal(1) DUB1 = 1 DUB0 = 0 DUB1 = 0 DUB0 = 0 INV14 bit in INVC1 register = 0 (Active Low) U-phase U-phase Dead time INV14 bit in INVC1 register = 1 (Active High) U-phase Dead time U-phase NOTE: 1. Internal signals. See Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Block Diagram. The above applies under the following conditions: - INVC0 register: Bits INV01 and INV00 = 11b (ICTB2 counter is incremented by 1 at the falling edge of the timer A1 reload control signal) INV02 bit = 1 (Three-phase control timer function used) INV03 bit = 1 (Three-phase control timer output enabled) INV06 bit = 0 (Triangular wave modulation mode) - INVC1 register: INV10 bit = 0 (Timer B2 underflow) INV11 bit = 1 (Timers A11, A21, A41 used (Three-phase mode 1)) INV15 bit = 0 (Dead time enabled) INV16 bit = 1 (Rising edge of the three-phase output shift register (U-, V-, W-phase)) - ICTB2 register = 01h (Every second timer B2 underflow.) (ICTB2 register = 02h, if INV01 bit = 0) The following shows examples to change PWM output levels. - Default value of the timer: TA41 = b1, TA4 = a1 (Registers TA4 and TA41 are rewritten every time the timer B2 interrupt occurs.) First time TA41 = b2, TA4 = a2, second time TA41 = b3, TA4 = a3 - Default value of the registers IDB0 and IDB1: DU0 = 1, DUB0 = 0, DU1 = 0, and DUB1 = 1 They are changed to DU0 = 1, DUB0 = 0, DU1 = 1, and DUB1 = 0 at the third timer B2 interrupt. Figure 16.13 Triangular Wave Modulation Operation (Three-Phase Mode 1)(INV01 and INV00 = 11b) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 192 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 16.2 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Sawtooth Wave Modulation Mode In sawtooth wave modulation mode, one cycle of carrier waveform consists of one timer B2 underflow cycle. A timer Ai one-shot pulse (i = 1, 2, and 4) is generated by using a timer B2 underflow signal as a trigger. Single one-shot pulse from timer Ai is used to output one cycle of the PWM waveform. Table 16.4 lists specifications and settings of sawtooth wave modulation mode. Table 16.4 Specifications and Settings of Sawtooth Wave Modulation Mode Item Three-Phase Mode 0 INV06 bit 1 INV11 bit 0 Bits INV01 and INV00 00b or 01b PWCON bit 0 ICTB2 register n INV16 bit 0 Carrier wave cycle 1 × (m + 1) f1 Upper arm active level output width 1 ×a k f1 Timer B2 interrupt generation timing Every n-th timer B2 underflow Timer B2 reload timing Timer B2 underflow Transfer timing from IDBp register to three-phase output shift register (p = 0, 1) Every time a transfer trigger occurs. Dead time timer start timing • At the falling edge of the one-shot pulse of timer A1, A2 and A4 • Transfer trigger m: Value of the TB2 register ak: Value set to the TAi register at k-th time. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 193 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Figure 16.14 shows an example of the sawtooth wave modulation operation. Sawtooth Waveform as a Carrier Wave Carrier wave Signal wave TB2S bit in the TABSR register Timer B2 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program IR bit in the TB2IC register Timer A4 start trigger signal (1) TA4 register a1 a2 a1 a3 a2 a4 a3 a5 a4 a6 a5 a7 a6 a8 a7 Timer A4 one-shot pulse (1) DU1 = 1 Upper arm (U-phase) output signal(1) DU0 = 1 DU1 = 1 Rewrite registers IDB0 and IDB1 DU0 = 0 DUB1 = 1 Lower arm (U-phase) output signal(1) DUB0 = 1 DUB1 = 1 DUB0 = 0 Values are transferred to the three-phase output shift register from registers IDB0 and IDB1 INV14 bit in INVC1 register = 0 (Active Low) INV14 bit in INVC1 register = 1 (Active High) U-phase Dead time U-phase U-phase Dead time U-phase NOTE: 1. Internal signals. See Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Block Diagram. The above applies under the following conditions: - INVC0 register: INV01 bit = 0 (ICTB2 counter is incremented by 1 when timer B2 underflows) INV02 bit = 1 (Three-phase motor control timer function used) INV03 bit = 1 (Three-phase motor control timer output enabled) INV06 bit = 1 (Sawtooth wave modulation mode) - INVC1 register: INV10 bit = 0 (Timer B2 underflow) INV11 bit = 0 (Timers A11, A21, A41 not used (Three-phase mode 0)) INV15 bit = 0 (Dead time enabled) INV16 bit = 0 (Falling edge of one-shot pulse of timers A1, A2, and A4) - ICTB2 register = 01h (Timer B2 interrupt is generated every timer B2 underflow) - TB2SC register: PWCON bit = 0 (Timer B2 underflow) The following shows examples to change PWM output levels. - Default value of the timer: TA4 = a1 (The TA4 register is changed every time the timer B2 interrupt occurs.) First time TA4 = a2, second time TA4 = a3, third time TA4 = a4, fourth time = a5 - Default value of the registers IDB0 and IDB1: DU0 = 0, DUB0 = 1, DU1 = 1, and DUB1 = 1 They are changed to DU0 = 1, DUB0 = 0, DU1 = 1, and DUB1 = 1 at the fourth timer B2 interrupt. Figure 16.14 Sawtooth Wave Modulation Operation REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 194 of 385 a8 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 16.3 16. Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function Short Circuit Prevention Features 16.3.1 Prevention Against Upper/Lower Arm Short Circuit by Program Errors This function prevents the upper and lower arm short circuit caused by setting the upper and lower output buffers in registers IDB0 and IDB1 to active simultaneously by program errors and so on. To use this function, set the INV04 bit in the INVC0 register to 1 (simultaneous turn-on signal output disabled). If any pair of output buffers (U and U, V and V, or W and W) are simultaneously set to active, the INV05 bit becomes 1 (detected), and the INV03 bit becomes 0 (three-phase motor control timer output disabled). Then, the port outputs are forcibly cutoff and the pins are placed in the high-impedance states. When this prevention function is performed, set the registers associated with the three-phase motor control timer function again. 16.3.2 Arm Short Circuit Prevention Using Dead Time Timer The dead time timer prevents arm short circuit caused by turn-off delay of external upper and lower transistors. To enable the dead time timer, set the INV15 bit in the INVC1 register to 0 (dead time enabled). The count source for dead time timer (fDT) can be selected using the INV12 bit, and the dead time can be set using the DTT register. The dead time is obtained from the following formulas. 1 f1 2 f1 × n (INV12 = 0) × n (INV12 = 1) n: Value in the DTT register Figure 16.15 shows an example of dead time timer operation. U-phase output signal (internal signal) OFF ON OFF U-phase output signal (internal signal) ON OFF ON Dead time Dead time Dead time timer Figure 16.15 16.3.3 U-phase turn-on signal output OFF ON OFF U-phase turn-on signal output ON OFF ON Dead Time Timer Operation Forced-Cutoff Function by the NMI Input When an “L” signal is input to the NMI pin, the INV03 bit in the INVC0 register becomes 0 (three-phase motor control timer output disabled), the port outputs are forcibly cutoff, and then the pins are placed in the highimpedance states. Also, the NMI interrupt occurs at the same time. To enable the three-phase motor control timer function after the forced cutoff is performed, set the registers associated with the three-phase motor control timer function again while an “H” signal is input to the NMI pin. Forced-cutoff function by the NMI input can be used when the INV02 bit in the INVC0 register is set to 1 (three-phase motor control timer function used) and the INV03 bit is set to 1 (three-phase motor control timer output enabled). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 195 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces 17. Serial Interfaces Serial interfaces consist of five channels (UART0 to UART4). Each UARTi (i = 0 to 4) has an exclusive timer to generate the serial clock and operates independently of each other. UARTi has the following modes. • Clock synchronous mode • Clock asynchronous mode • Special mode 1 (I2C mode) • Special mode 2 • Special mode 3 (clock-divided synchronous function, GCI mode) • Special mode 4 (SIM mode) • Special mode 5 (bus conflict detect function, IE mode) (optional)(1) NOTE: 1. Please contact a Renesas sales office for optional features. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 196 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17.1 17. Serial Interfaces UART0 to UART4 Figure 17.1 shows a UART0 to UART4 block diagram. Figures 17.2 to 17.10 show the registers associated with UART0 to UART4. Refer to the tables listing for register and pin settings in each mode. TXDi RXDi 1/16 CLK1 and CLK0 00 CKDIR f1 01 0 f8 F2n(1) 10 SMD2 to SMD0 100, 101, 110 UiBRG register 001 1/(m+1) 1/16 100, 101, 110 1 Receive Transmit/ clock receive unit Transmit clock Receive control circuit Transmit control circuit 001 CKDIR CKPOL CLKi input CLKi 1/2 Polarity switching Function Select Register(2) CLKi output 0 1 Polarity switching RTSi output CTSi input Function Select CRD Register(3) CRS CTSi / RTSi m = Setting value of the UiBRG register NOTES: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). 2. Select either Input/output port (CLKi input) or CLKi output in the Function Select Registers. (Refer to the chapter Programmable I/O Ports.) 3. Select either Input/output port or RTSi output in the Function Select Registers. (Refer to the chapter Programmable I/O Ports .) 0 IOPOL RXDi 1 STPS 0 SP 001 101 PRYE 001 0 SP PAR 1 1 SMD2 to SMD0 0 0 0 0 0 0 b7 b8 0 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 001 101 110 110 100 101 110 UARTi receive shift register 100 D8 D7 UiRB register Logic inverse circuit + MSB/LSB conversion circuit High-order bits of data bus Low-order bits of data bus Logic inverse circuit + MSB/LSB conversion circuit D8 PRYE 001 0 STPS 0 SP PAR SP 1 1 100 101 110 D7 001 101 110 b6 001 101 110 SMD2 to SMD0 i = 0 to 4 SP: Stop bit PAR: Parity bit SMD2 to SMD0, STPS, PRYE, IOPOL, and CKDIR: bits in the UiMR register CLK1 and CLK0, CKPOL, CRD, and CRS: bits in the UiC0 register UiERE: bit in the UiC1 register Figure 17.1 UART0 to UART 4 Block Diagram REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 197 of 385 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 UiTB register 100 b7 b8 D6 UARTi transmit shift register Error signal output circuit UiERE 0 1 IOPOL 0 1 TXDi Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces UARTi transmit/receive mode register (i = 0 to 4) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset U0MR to U2MR U3MR, U4MR 0368h, 02E8h, 0338h 0328h,02F8h 00h 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name b2 b1 b0 SMD0 SMD1 Serial interface mode select bits SMD2 Figure 17.2 Function 0 0 0: Serial interface disabled 0 0 1: Clock synchronous mode 0 1 0: I2C mode 1 0 0: UART mode, 7-bit data length 1 0 1: UART mode, 8-bit data length 1 1 0: UART mode, 9-bit data length Do not set to values other than the above RW RW RW RW CKDIR Clock select bit 0: Internal clock 1: External clock RW STPS Stop bit length select bit 0: 1 stop bit 1: 2 stop bits RW PRY Parity select bit Enabled when PRYE=1 0: Odd parity 1: Even parity RW PRYE Parity enable bit 0: Parity disabled 1: Parity enabled RW IOPOL TXD, RXD input/output polarity switch bit 0: Not inverted 1: Inverted RW U0MR to U4MR Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 198 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces UARTi Special Mode Register (i = 0 to 4) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol Address After Reset U0SMR to U2SMR U3SMR, U4SMR 0367h, 02E7h, 0337h 0327h, 02F7h 00h 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function IICM I2C mode select bit 0 : Other than I 2C mode 1 : I2C mode RW ABC Arbitration lost detect flag control bit(1) 0: Updated per bit 1: Updated per byte RW BBS Bus busy flag(1, 2) 0: Stop condition detected (bus is free) 1: Start condition detected (bus is busy) RW − (b3) Reserved bit Set to 0 RW ABSCS Bus conflict detect sampling clock select bit (3) 0: Rising edge of serial clock 1: Timer Aj underflow (j = 0, 3, 4) (4) RW ACSE Auto clear function select bit for transmit enable bit (3) 0: No auto clear function 1: Auto cleared when bus conflict occurs RW Transmit start condition select bit(3) 0 : Not related to RXDi 1 : Synchronized with RXDi RW Clock division synchronous bit(5,6) 0: External clock not divided 1: External clock divided by 2 RW SSS SCLKDIV NOTES: 1. These bits are used in I 2C mode. 2. The BBS bit can be set to 0 by a program. Writing a 1 has no effect. 3. These bits are used in IE mode. 4. UART0: Timer A3 underflow signal, UART1: Timer A4 underflow signal, UART2: Timer A0 underflow signal, UART3: Timer A3 underflow signal, UART4: Timer A4 underflow signal. 5. The SCLKDIV bit is used in GCI mode. 6. Refer to the note for the SU1HIM bit in the UiSMR2 register. Figure 17.3 RW U0SMR to U4SMR Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 199 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces UARTi Special Mode Register 2 (i = 0 to 4) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset U0SMR2 to U2SMR2 U3SMR2, U4SMR2 0366h, 02E6h, 0336h 0326h, 02F6h 00h 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW IICM2 I2C mode select bit 2 0: ACK/NACK interrupt used 1: Transmit/receive interrupt used RW CSC Clock synchronous bit(1) 0: Not clock synchronized 1: Clock synchronized RW SWC SCL wait output bit(2) 0: No wait state/release wait states 1:SCLi pin is held "L" after receiving 8th bit. RW ALS SDA output auto stop bit (1) When arbitration lost is detected, 0: SDAi output not stopped 1: SDAi output stopped RW STC UARTi auto initialization bit(2) When start condition is detected, 0: UARTi not initialized 1: UARTi initialized RW SWC2 SCL wait output bit 2 (1) 0: Serial clock output from SCLi pin 1: SCLi pin is held "L" RW SDHI SDA output stop bit(2) 0: Output data 1: Output stopped (Hi-impedance state) RW External clock synchronous enable bit(3) 0: Not synchronized with external clock 1: Synchronized with external clock RW SU1HIM NOTES: 1. These bits are used when the MCU is in master mode in I 2C mode. 2. These bits are used when the MCU is in slave mode in I 2C mode. 3. The external clock synchronous function can be selected with the combination of the SU1HIM bit and the SCLKDIV bit in the UiSMR register. The SU1HIM bit is used in GCI mode. Figure 17.4 SCLKDIV Bit in the UiSMR register SU1HIM Bit in the UiSMR2 register 0 0 Not synchronized 0 1 Same frequency as external clock 1 0 or 1 U0SMR2 to U4SMR2 Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 200 of 385 External Clock Synchronous Function Select External clock divided by 2 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces UARTi Special Mode Register 3 (i = 0 to 4) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset U0SMR3 to U2SMR3 U3SMR3, U4SMR3 0365h, 02E5h, 0335h 0325h, 02F5h 00h 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW SS function enable bit(1) 0: SS function disabled 1: SS function enabled(2) RW CKPH Clock phase set bit (1) 0: No Clock delay 1: Clock delay RW DINC Serial I/O pin set bit(1) 0: Pins TXDi and RXDi selected (master mode) 1: Pins STXDi and SRXDi selected (slave mode) RW NODC Clock output select bit 0: CLKi is CMOS output 1: CLKi is N-channel open drain output RW Mode error flag(1) 0: No mode error 1: Mode error occurred(3) RW SSE ERR SDAi output is delayed by the following cycles. DL0 DL1 b7 b6 b5 SDAi digital delay set bits (4, 5) DL2 0 0 0: No delay 0 0 1: 1-to-2 cycles of BRG count source 0 1 0: 2-to-3 cycles of BRG count source 0 1 1: 3-to-4 cycles of BRG count source 1 0 0: 4-to-5 cycles of BRG count source 1 0 1: 5-to-6 cycles of BRG count source 1 1 0: 6-to-7 cycles of BRG count source 1 1 1: 7-to-8 cycles of BRG count source RW RW RW NOTES: 1. These bits are used in special mode 2. 2. When the SS pin is set to 1, set the CRD bit in the UiC0 register to 1 ( CTS function disabled). 3. The ERR bit can be set to 0 by a program. Writing a 1 has no effect. 4. Digital delay is added to a SDAi output using bits DL2 to DL0 in I 2C mode. Set them to 000b (no delay) in other than I 2C mode. 5. When the external clock is selected, SDAi output is delayed by approximately 100 ns in addition. Figure 17.5 U0SMR3 to U4SMR3 Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 201 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces UARTi Special Mode Register 4 (i = 0 to 4) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset U0SMR4 to U2SMR4 U3SMR4, U4SMR4 0364h, 02E4h, 0334h 0324h, 02F4h 00h 00h Bit Name STAREQ Start condition generate bit(1, 3) 0: Clear 1: Start RW Restart condition generate bit(1, 3) 0: Clear 1: Start RW STPREQ Stop condition generate bit(1, 3) 0: Clear 1: Start RW STSPSEL SCL, SDA output select bit (1, 5) 0: Serial input/output circuit selected 1: Start/stop condition generation circuit selected (4) RW ACKD ACK data bit(2, 5) 0: ACK 1: NACK RW ACKC ACK data output enable bit(2, 5) 0: Serial data output 1: ACK data output RW SCLHI SCL output stop bit(1, 5) When the bus is free, 0: SCLi output not stopped 1: SCLi output stopped RW SWC9 SCL wait output bit 3 (1, 5) 0: No wait state/release wait state 1: SCLi pin is held "L" after receiving 9th bit RW RSTAREQ Function RW Bit Symbol NOTES: 1. These bits are used when the MCU is in master mode in I 2C mode. 2. These bits are used when the MCU is in slave mode in I 2C mode. 3. When each condition generation is completed, the corresponding bit becomes 0. When a condition generation is failed, the bit remains 1. 4. Set the STSPSEL bit to 1 (start/stop condition generation circuit selected) after setting the STAREQ bit, RSTAREQ bit, or STPREQ bit to 1 (start). 5. Bits STPSEL, ACKD, ACKC, SCLHI, and SWC9 can be set to 1 when the IICM bit in the UiSMR register is set to 1 (I 2C mode). When the IICM bit is set to 0 (Other than I 2C mode), these bits become 0. Figure 17.6 U0SMR4 to U4SMR4 Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 202 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces UARTi Transmit/Receive Control Register 0 (i = 0 to 4) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset U0C0 to U2C0 U3C0, U4C0 036Ch, 02ECh, 033Ch 032Ch, 02FCh 0000 1000b 0000 1000b Bit Symbol Bit Name Function b1 b0 CLK0 UiBRG count source select bits(1) CLK1 0 0: f1 selected 0 1: f8 selected 1 0: f2n selected (2) 1 1: Do not set to this value RW RW RW CRS CTS function select bit Enabled when CRD = 0 0: CTS function selected 1: CTS function not selected RW TXEPT Transmit shift register empty flag 0: Data in the transmit shift register (during transmit operation) 1: No data in the transmit shift register (transmit operation is completed) RO CRD CTS function disable bit 0: CTS function enabled 1: CTS function disabled RW NCH Data output select bit (3) 0: TXDi/SDAi and SCLi are CMOS output ports 1: TXDi/SDAi and SCLi are N-channel open drain output ports RW CKPOL CLK polarity select bit 0: Transmit data output at the falling edge and receive data input at the rising edge of the serial clock 1: Transmit data output at the rising edge and receive data input at the falling edge of the serial clock RW UFORM Bit order select bit(4) 0 : LSB first 1 : MSB first RW NOTES: 1. Set the UiBRG register after setting bits CLK1 and CLK0. 2. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). To select f2n, set the CST bit in the TCSPR register to 1 before setting bits CLK1 and CLK0 to 10b. 3. P7_0/TXD2, P7_1/SCL2 are N-channel open drain output ports. They cannot be set as CMOS output ports even if the NCH bit is set to 0. 4. The UFORM bit is enabled when bits SMD2 to SMD0 in the UiMR register are set to 001b (clock synchronous mode) or 101b (UART mode, 8-bit data length). Set the UFORM bit to 1 when bits SMD2 to SMD0 are set to 010b (I 2C mode), or to 0 when bits SMD2 to SMD0 are set to 100b (UART mode, 7-bit data length) or 110b (UART mode, 9-bit data length). Figure 17.7 U0C0 to U4C0 Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 203 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces UARTi Baud Rate Register(1, 2) (i = 0 to 4) b0 b7 Symbol U0BRG to U2BRG U3BRG, U4BRG After Reset Undefined Undefined Address 0369h, 02E9h, 0339h 0329h, 02F9h Function Setting Range RW 00h to FFh WO If the setting value is n, the UiBRG register divides a count source by n+1 NOTES: 1. Read-modify-write instructions cannot be used to set the UiBRG register. Refer to Usage Notes for details. 2. Set the UiBRG register after setting bits CLK1 and CLK0 in the UiC0 register. UARTi Transmit/Receive Control Register 1 (i = 0 to 4) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol Address After Reset U0C1 to U2C1 U3C1, U4C1 036Dh, 02EDh, 033Dh 032Dh, 02FDh 0000 0010b 0000 0010b Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW TE Transmit enable bit 0: Transmit operation disabled 1: Transmit operation enabled RW TI UiTB register empty flag 0: Data in the UiTB register 1: No data in the UiTB register RO RE Receive enable bit 0: Receive operation disabled 1: Receive operation enabled RW RI Receive complete flag 0: No Data in the UiRB register 1: Data in the UiRB register RO UARTi transmit interrupt source select bit 0: No data in the UiTB register (TI = 1) 1: Transmit operation is completed (TXEPT = 1) RW UiRRM Continuous receive mode enable bit 0: Continuous receive mode disabled 1: Continuous receive mode enabled (3) RW UiLCH Data logic select bit (1) 0: Not inverted 1: Inverted RW Special mode 3 Clock-divided synchronous stop bit 0: Synchronization stopped 1: Synchronization started Special mode 4 Error signal output enable bit (2) 0: Not output 1: Output UilRS SCLKSTPB UiERE RW NOTES: 1. The UiLCH bit is enabled when bits SMD2 to SMD0 in the UiMR register are set to 001b (clock synchronous mode), 100b (UART mode, 7-bit data length), or 101b (UART mode, 8-bit data length). Set the UiLCH bit to 0 when bits SMD2 to SMD0 are set to 010b (I2C mode) or 110b (UART mode, 9-bit data length). 2. Set bits SMD2 to SMD0 before setting the UiERE bit. 3. When the UiRRM bit is set to 1, set the CKDIR bit in the UiMR register to 1 (external clock) and also disable the RTS function. Figure 17.8 U0BRG to U4BRG Registers, U0C1 to U4C1 Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 204 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces External Interrupt Source Select Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol IFSR Address 031Fh Bit Symbol Bit Name After Reset 00h Function IFSR0 INT0 interrupt polarity select bit(1) 0: One edge 1: Both edges RW IFSR1 INT1 interrupt polarity select bit(1) 0: One edge 1: Both edges RW IFSR2 INT2 interrupt polarity select bit(1) 0: One edge 1: Both edges RW IFSR3 INT3 interrupt polarity select bit(1) 0: One edge 1: Both edges RW IFSR4 INT4 interrupt polarity select bit(1) 0: One edge 1: Both edges RW IFSR5 INT5 interrupt polarity select bit(1) 0: One edge 1: Both edges RW IFSR6 UART0, UART3 interrupt source select bit 0: UART3 bus conflict, start condition detection, stop condition detection 1: UART0 bus conflict, start condition detection, stop condition detection RW IFSR7 UART1, UART4 interrupt source select bit 0: UART4 bus conflict, start condition detection, stop condition detection 1: UART1 bus conflict, start condition detection, stop condition detection RW NOTE: 1. Set the IFSRi bit (i = 0 to 5) to 0 to select a level-sensitive triggering. When selecting both edges, set the POL bit in the corresponding INTilC register to 0 (falling edge). Figure 17.9 RW IFSR Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 205 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces UARTi Transmit Buffer Register (1) (i = 0 to 4) b15 b8 b7 b0 Symbol Address After Reset U0TB to U2TB U3TB, U4TB 036Bh - 036Ah, 02EBh - 02EAh, 033Bh - 033Ah 032Bh - 032Ah, 02FBh - 02FAh Undefined Undefined Bit Symbol − (b7-b0) − (b8) − (b15-b9) Function RW Transmit data (D7 to D0) WO Transmit data (D8) WO Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. − NOTE: 1. Read-modify-write instructions cannot be used to set the UiTB register. Refer to Usage Notes for details. UARTi Receive Buffer Register (i = 0 to 4) b15 b8 b7 b0 Symbol Address After Reset U0RB to U2RB U3RB, U4RB 036Fh - 036Eh, 02EFh - 02EEh, 033Fh - 033Eh 032Fh - 032Eh, 02FFh - 02FEh Undefined Undefined Function RW Bit Symbol Bit Name − (b7-b0) − Received data (D7 to D0) RO − (b8) − Received data (D8) RO − (b10-b9) Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. − ABT Arbitration lost detect flag (1) 0: Not detected (won) 1: Detected (lost) RW OER Overrun error flag(2) 0: No overrun error 1: Overrun error RO FER Framing error flag(2, 3) 0: No framing error 1: Framing error RO PER Parity error flag(2, 3) 0: No parity error 1: Parity error RO SUM Error sum flag(2, 3) 0 No error occurred 1: Error occurred RO NOTES: 1. Only a 0 can be written to the ABT bit. 2. When bits SMD2 to SMD0 in the UiMR register are set to 000b (serial interface disabled) or the RE bit in the UiC1 register is set to 0 (receive operation disabled), bits OER, FER, PER and SUM become 0. When all of bits OER, FER and PER become 0, the SUM bit also becomes 0. Bits FER and PER become 0 by reading the low-order byte in the UiRB register. 3. Bits FER, PER and SUM are disabled when bits SMD2 to SMD0 in the UiMR register are set to 001b (clock synchronous mode) or 010b (I2C mode). A read from these bits returns undefined value. Figure 17.10 U0TB to U4TB Registers, U0RB to U4RB Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 206 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17.1.1 17. Serial Interfaces Clock Synchronous Mode Full-duplex clock synchronous serial communications are allowed in this mode. CTS/RTS function can be used for transmit and receive control. Table 17.1 lists specifications of clock synchronous mode. Table 17.2 lists pin settings. Figure 17.11 shows register settings. Figure 17.12 shows an example of a transmit and receive operation when an internal clock is selected. Figure 17.13 shows an example of a receive operation when an external clock is selected. Table 17.1 Clock Synchronous Mode Specifications Item Specification Data format Data length: 8 bits long Serial clock Internal clock or external clock can be selected by the CKDIR bit in the UiMR register (i = 0 to 4) Baud rate • When the CKDIR bit is set to 0 (internal clock): fj / (2 (m + 1) fj = f1, f8, f2n(1) m: setting value of the UiBRG register (00h to FFh) • When the CKDIR bit is set to 1 (external clock): clock input to the CLKi pin Transmit/receive control Selectable among the CTS function, RTS function, or CTS/RTS function disabled Transmit and receive start condition Internal clock is selected: • Set the TE bit in the UiC1 register to 1 (transmit operation enabled) • The TI bit in the UiC1 register is 0 (data in the UiTB register) • Set the RE bit in the UiC1 register to 1 (receive operation enabled) • “L” signal is applied to the CTSi pin when the CTS function is used External clock is selected(2): • Set the TE bit to 1 • The TI bit is 0 • Set the RE bit to 1 • The RI bit in the UiC1 register is 0 when the RTS function is used When above 4 conditions are met, RTSi pin outputs “L” If transmit-only operation is performed, the RE bit setting is not required in both cases. Interrupt request generation timing Transmit interrupt (The UiIRS bit in the UiC1 register selects one of the following): • The UiIRS bit is set to 0 (no data in the UiTB register): when data is transferred from the UiTB register to the UARTi transmit shift register (transmit operation started) • The UiIRS bit is set to 1 (transmit operation completed): when data transmit operation from the UARTi transmit shift register is completed Receive interrupt: • When data is transferred from the UARTi receive shift register to the UiRB register (receive operation completed) Error detection • Overrun error(3) Overrun error occurs when the 7th bit of the next data is received before reading the UiRB register Selectable function • CLK polarity Transmit data output timing and receive data input timing can be selected • LSB first or MSB first Data is transmitted and received from either bit 0 or bit 7 • Serial data logic inverse Transmit and receive data are logically inverted • Continuous receive mode The TI bit becomes 0 by reading the UiRB register NOTES: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). 2. If an external clock is selected, ensure that an “H” signal is applied to the CLKi pin when the CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register is set to 0, and that an “L” signal is applied when the CKPOL bit is set to 1. 3. If an overrun error occurs, a read from the UiRB register returns undefined values. The IR bit in the SiRIC register remains unchanged as 0 (interrupt not requested). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 207 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 17.2 17. Serial Interfaces Pin Settings in Clock Synchronous Mode Bit Setting Port Function PD6, PD7, PD9 Registers(2) PSC Register PD6_0 = 0 − RTS0 output − CLK0 input PD6_1 = 0 CLK0 output RXD0 input PSL0, PSL1, PSL3 Registers PS0, PS1, PS3 Registers(1)(2) − PS0_0 = 0 − PSL0_0 = 0 PS0_0 = 1 − − PS0_1 = 0 − − PSL0_1 = 0 PS0_1 = 1 PD6_2 = 0 − − PS0_2 = 0 − − PSL0_3 = 0 PS0_3 = 1 CTS1 input PD6_4 = 0 − − PS0_4 = 0 RTS1 output − − PSL0_4 = 0 PS0_4 = 1 P6_5 CLK1 input PD6_5 = 0 − − PS0_5 = 0 CLK1 output − − PSL0_5 = 0 PS0_5 = 1 P6_6 RXD1 input PD6_6 = 0 − − PS0_6 = 0 TXD1 output(4) − − PSL0_7 = 0 PS0_7 = 1 TXD2 output(4) − PSC_0 = 0 PSL1_0 = 0 PS1_0 = 1 P6_0 CTS0 input P6_1 P6_2 P6_3 P6_4 P6_7 P7_0(3) TXD0 output(4) P7_1 RXD2 input PD7_1 = 0 − − PS1_1 = 0 P7_2 CLK2 input PD7_2 = 0 − − PS1_2 = 0 CLK2 output − PSC_2 = 0 PSL1_2 = 0 PS1_2 = 1 P7_3 CTS2 input PD7_3 = 0 − − PS1_3 = 0 RTS2 output − PSC_3 = 0 PSL1_3 = 0 PS1_3 = 1 P9_0 CLK3 input PD9_0 = 0 − − PS3_0 = 0 CLK3 output − − PSL3_0 = 0 PS3_0 = 1 RXD3 input PD9_1 = 0 − − PS3_1 = 0 − − PSL3_2 = 0 PS3_2 = 1 CTS3 input PD9_3 = 0 − PSL3_3 = 0 PS3_3 = 0 RTS3 output − − − PS3_3 = 1 P9_4 CTS4 input PD9_4 = 0 − PSL3_4 = 0 PS3_4 = 0 RTS4 output − − − PS3_4 = 1 P9_5 CLK4 input PD9_5 = 0 − PSL3_5 = 0 PS3_5 = 0 CLK4 output − − − PS3_5 = 1 − − − PS3_6 = 1 PD9_7 = 0 − − PS3_7 = 0 P9_1 P9_2 P9_3 TXD3 output(4) output(4) P9_6 TXD4 P9_7 RXD4 input NOTES: 1. Set registers PS0, PS1, and PS3 after setting the other registers. 2. Set the PD9 or PS3 register immediately after the PRC2 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two instructions. 3. P7_0 is an N-channel open drain output port. 4. After UARTi (i = 0 to 4) operating mode is selected in the UiMR register and the pin function is set in the Function Select Registers, the TXDi pin outputs an “H” signal until a transmit operation starts (the TXDi pin is in a high-impedance state when N-channel open drain output is selected). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 208 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces Start I flag = 0 Interrupt disabled UiMR register: bits SMD2 to SMD0 = 001b CKDIR bit bits 7 to 4 = 0000b Clock synchronous mode Clock select bit UiSMR register = 00h UiSMR2 register = 00h UiSMR3 register = 00h UiSMR4 register = 00h UiC0 register: bits CLK1 and CLK0 CRS bit CRD bit NCH bit CKPOL bit UFORM bit UiBRG register count source select bits CTS function select bit CTS function disable bit Data output select bit CLK polarity select bit Bit order select bit When an internal clock is used fj 2(m + 1) UiBRG register = m m = 00h to FFh UiC1 register: TE bit = 0 RE bit = 0 UiIRS bit UiRRM bit UiLCH bit Bit 7 = 0 Transmit operation disabled Receive operation disabled UARTi transmit interrupt source select bit Continuous receive mode enable bit(2) Data logic select bit SiTIC register: bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 IR bit = 0 Transmit interrupt priority level select bit Interrupt not requested SiRIC register: bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 IR bit= 0 Receive interrupt priority level select bit Interrupt not requested Baud rate = fj: f1, f8, f2n (1) Pin settings in the Function Select Registers I flag = 1 Interrupt enabled UiC1 register: TE bit = 1 RE bit = 1 Transmit operation enabled Receive operation enabled End Transmit/receive operation starts by writing data to the UiTB register. Read the UiRB register when a receive operation is completed. i = 0 to 4 NOTES: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). 2. The UiRRM bit can be set to 1 (continuous receive mode enabled), only when the CKDIR bit in the UiMR register is set to 1 (external clock) and RTS function is disabled. Figure 17.11 Register Settings in Clock Synchronous Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 209 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces TC Internal clock TE bit in the UiC1 register 1 TI bit in the UiC1 register 1 0 Write data to the UiTB register 0 Transfer data from UiTB register to UARTi transmit shift register “H” CTSi Input “L” TCLK Communication stops because CTSi = “H” “H” Communication stops because TE bit = 0 CLKi output “L” “H” TXDi output D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 “L” TXEP bit in the UiC0 register 1 IR bit in the SiTIC register 1 0 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program 0 “H” RXDi input D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 “L” RI bit in the UiC1 register 1 IR bit in the SiRIC register 1 Transfer data from UARTi receive shift register to UiRB register 0 A read from the UiRB register 0 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowlegement or by a program TC = TCLK = i = 0 to 4 2(m + 1) fj fj = f1, f8, f2n (1) The above applies under the following conditions: m = Setting value of the UiBRG register - UiMR register: CKDIR bit = 0 (internal clock) (00h to FFh) - UiC0 register: CRD bit in the = 0 and CRS bit = 0 (CTS function used) CKPOL bit = 0 (transmit data output at the falling edge of the serial clock) - UiC1 register: UiIRS bit = 0 (Transmit interrupt request is generated when no data in the UiTB register) NOTE: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). Figure 17.12 Transmit and Receive Operations when Internal Clock is Selected REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 210 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces RE bit in the UiC1 register 1 TE bit in the UiC1 register 1 TI bit in the UiC1 register 1 0 0 Write dummy data to UiTB register 0 Transfer data from UiTB register to UARTi transmit shift register “H” RTSi output “L” 1 fEXT Becomes "L" by reading UiRB register “H” CLKi input(1) “L” “H” RXDi input D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 “L” RI bit in the UiC1 register 1 IR bit in the SiRIC register 1 OER bit in the UiRB register 1 Transfer data from UARTi receive shift register to UiRB register A read from UiRB register 0 0 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program 0 i = 0 to 4 fEXT = external clock frequency The above applies under the following conditions: - UiMR register: CKDIR bit = 1 (external clock) - UiC0 reigster: CRD bit = 1 (CTS function disabled) CKPOL bit = 0 (receive data input at the rising edge of the serial clock) NOTE: 1. Satisfy the following conditions, while the CLKi pin input is "H" before the data receive operation. - UiC1 register: TE bit = 1 (transmit operation enabled) RE bit = 1 (receive operation enabled) - Write dummy data to the UiTB register Figure 17.13 Receive Operations when External Clock is Selected REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 211 of 385 D7 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces 17.1.1.1 CLK Polarity As shown in figure 17.14, the CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register (i = 0 to 4) determines the polarity of the serial clock. (1) When the CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register (i = 0 to 4) is set to 0 (transmit data output at the falling edge and receive data input at the rising edge of the serial clock ) "H" (note 1) CLKi "L" TXDi "H" D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 "L" "H" RXDi "L" (2) When the CKPOL bit is set to 1 (transmit data output at the rising edge and receive data input at the falling edge of the serial clock) "H" (note 2) CLKi "L" TXDi "H" D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 "L" "H" RXDi "L" The above applies under the following conditions: - UFORM bit in the UiC0 register is set to 0 (LSB first) - UiLCH bit in the UiC1 register is set to 0 (not inverted). NOTES: 1. The CLKi pin output level is "H" when no transmit and receive operation is in progress. 2. The CLKi pin output level is "L" when no transmit and receive operation is in progress. Figure 17.14 Serial Clock Polarity REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 212 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces 17.1.1.2 LSB First or MSB First As shown in figure 17.15, the UFORM bit in the UiC0 register (i = 0 to 4) determines a bit order. (1) When the UFORM bit in the UiC0 register (i = 0 to 4) is set to 0 (LSB first) "H" CLKi "L" TXDi "H" D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 "L" "H" RXDi "L" (2) When the UFORM bit is set to 1 (MSB first) "H" CLKi "L" TXDi "H" D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 "L" "H" RXDi "L" The above applies under the following conditions: - CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register is set to 0 (transmit data is output at the falling edge and received data is input at the rising edge) - UiLCH bit in the UiC1 register is set to 0 (not inverted). Figure 17.15 Bit Order (8-Bit Data Length) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 213 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces 17.1.1.3 Serial Data Logic Inverse When the UiLCH bit in the UiC1 register is set to 1 (inverted), data logic written in the UiTB register is inverted for transmit operation. A read from the UiRB register returns the inverted logic of receive data. Figure 17.16 shows an example of serial data logic inverse operation. (1) When the UiLCH bit in the UiC1 register (i = 0 to 4) is set to 0 (not inverted) Serial clock "H" "L" TXDi "H" (not inverted) "L" D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 RXDi "H" (not inverted) "L" D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 (2) When the UiLCH bit is set to 1 (inverted) Serial clock "H" "L" TXDi "H" (inverted) "L" D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 RXDi "H" (inverted) "L" D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 The above applies under the following conditions: - CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register is set to 0 (transmit data is output at the falling edge and received data is input at the rising edge) - UFORM bit in the UiC0 register is set to 0 (LSB first). Figure 17.16 Serial Data Logic Inverse REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 214 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces 17.1.1.4 Continuous Receive Mode Continuous receive mode can be used when all of the following conditions are met. • External clock is selected (the CKDIR bit in the UiMR register (i = 0 to 4) is set to 1) • RTS function is disabled (RTSi pin is not selected in the Function Select Register) When the UiRRM bit in the UiC1 register is set to 1 (continuous receive mode enabled), the TI bit in the UiC1 register becomes 0 (data in the UiTB register) by reading the UiRB register. Do not set dummy data to the UiTB register if the UiRRM bit is set to 1. 17.1.1.5 CTS/RTS Function • CTS Function Transmit and receive operation is controlled by using the input signal to the CTSi pin (i = 0 to 4). To use the CTS function, select the I/O port in the Function Select Register, set the CRD bit in the UiC0 register to 0 (CTS function enabled), and the CRS bit to 0 (CTS function selected). With the CTS function used, the transmit and receive operation starts when all the following conditions are met and an “L” signal is applied to the CTSi pin. -The TE bit in the UiC1 register is set to 1 (transmit operation enabled) -The TI bit in the UiC1 register is 0 (data in the UiTB register) -The RE bit in the UiC1 register is set to 1 (receive operation enabled) (If transmit-only operation is performed, the RE bit setting is not required) When a high-level (“H”) signal is applied to the CTSi pin during transmitting and receiving, the transmit and receive operation is disabled after the transmit and receive operation in progress is completed. • RTS Function The MCU can inform the external device that it is ready for a transmit and receive operation by using the output signal from the RTSi pin. To use the RTS function, select the RTSi pin in the Function Select Register. With the RTS function used, the RTSi pin outputs an “L” signal when all the following conditions are met, and outputs an “H” when the serial clock is input to the CLKi pin. -The RI bit in the UiC1 register is 0 (no data in the UiRB register) -The TE bit is set to 1 (transmit operation enabled) -The RE bit is set to 1 (receive operation enabled) (If transmit-only operation is performed, the RE bit setting is not required) -The TI bit is 0 (data in the UiTB register) 17.1.1.6 Procedure When the Communication Error is Occurred Follow the procedure below when a communication error is occurred in clock synchronous mode. (1) Set the TE bit in the UiC1 register (i = 0 to 4) to 0 (transmit operation disabled) and the RE bit to 0 (receive operation disabled). (2) Set bits SMD2 to SMD0 in the UiMR register to 000b (serial interface disabled). (3) Set bits SMD2 to SMD0 in the UiMR register to 001b (clock synchronous mode). (4) Set the TE bit to 1 (transmit operation enabled) and the RE bit to 1 (receive operation enabled). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 215 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17.1.2 17. Serial Interfaces Clock Asynchronous (UART) Mode Full-duplex asynchronous serial communications are allowed in this mode. Table 17.3 lists specifications of UART mode. Table 17.4 lists pin settings. Figure 17.17 shows register settings. Figure 17.18 shows an example of a transmit operation. Figure 17.19 shows an example of a receive operation. Table 17.3 UART Mode Specifications Item Specification Data format • Data length: selectable among 7 bits, 8 bits, or 9 bits long • Start bit: 1 bit long • Parity bit: selectable among odd, even, or none • Stop bit: selectable from 1 bit or 2 bits long Baud rate fj / (16 (m + 1)) fj = f1, f8, f2n(1), fEXT m: setting value of the UiBRG register (00h to FFh) fEXT: clock input to the CLKi pin when the CKDIR bit in the UiMR register is set to 1 (external clock) Transmit/receive control Selectable among CTS function, RTS function or CTS/RTS function disabled Transmit start condition To start transmit operation, all of the following must be met: • Set the TE bit in the UiC1 register to 1 (transmit operation enabled) • The TI bit in the UiC1 register is 0 (data in the UiTB register) • Apply a low-level (“L”) signal to the CTSi pin when the CTS function is selected Receive start condition To start receive operation, all of the following must be met: • Set the RE bit in the UiC1 register to 1 (receive operation enabled) • The RI bit is 1 (no data in UiRB register) when RTS function is used. When the above two conditions are met, the RTSi pin output an “L” signal. • The start bit is detected Interrupt request generation timing Transmit interrupt (The UiIRS bit in the UiC1 register selects one of the following): • The UiIRS bit is set to 0 (no data in the UiTB register): when data is transferred from the UiTB register to the UARTi transmit shift register (transmit operation started) • The UiIRS bit is set to 1 (transmit operation completed): when the final stop bit is output from the UARTi transmit shift register Receive interrupt: • When data is transferred from the UARTi receive shift register to the UiRB register (receive operation completed) Error detection • Overrun error(2) Overrun error occurs when the preceding bit of the final stop bit of the next data (the first stop bit when selecting 2 stop bits) is received before reading the UiRB register • Framing error Framing error occurs when the number of the stop bits set by the STPS bit in the UiMR register is not detected • Parity error Parity error occurs when parity is enabled and the received data does not have the correct even or odd parity set by the PRY bit in the UiMR register. • Error sum flag Error sum flag is set to 1 when any of overrun, framing, and parity errors occurs Selectable function • LSB first or MSB first Data is transmitted or received from either bit 0 or bit 7 • Serial data logic inverse Transmit and receive data are logically inverted. The start bit and stop bit are not inverted • TXD and RXD I/O polarity inverse The level output from the TXD pin and the level applied to the RXD pin are inverted. All the data including the start bit and stop bit are inverted. NOTES: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). 2. If an overrun error occurs, a read from the UiRB register returns undefined values. The IR bit in the SiRIC register remains unchanged as 0 (interrupt not requested). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 216 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 17.4 17. Serial Interfaces Pin Settings in UART Mode Bit Setting Port P6_0 P6_1 Function PD6, PD7, PD9 Registers(2) PSC Register PSL0, PSL1, PSL3 Registers PS0, PS1, PS3 Registers(1)(2) CTS0 input PD6_0 = 0 − − PS0_0 = 0 RTS0 output − − PSL0_0 = 0 PS0_0 = 1 CLK0 input PD6_1 = 0 − − PS0_1 = 0 PD6_2 = 0 − − PS0_2 = 0 − PSL0_3 = 0 PS0_3 = 1 PD6_4 = 0 − − PS0_4 = 0 RTS1 output − − PSL0_4 = 0 PS0_4 = 1 P6_2 RXD0 input P6_3 TXD0 output(4) − P6_4 CTS1 input P6_5 CLK1 input PD6_5 = 0 − − PS0_5 = 0 P6_6 RXD1 input PD6_6 = 0 − − PS0_6 = 0 P6_7 TXD1 output(4) − − PSL0_7 = 0 PS0_7 = 1 PSC_0 = 0 PSL1_0 = 0 PS1_0 = 1 P7_0(3) TXD2 output(4) − P7_1 RXD2 input PD7_1 = 0 − − PS1_1 = 0 P7_2 CLK2 input PD7_2 = 0 − − PS1_2 = 0 P7_3 CTS2 input PD7_3 = 0 − − PS1_3 = 0 RTS2 output − PSC_3 = 0 PSL1_3 = 0 PS1_3 = 1 CLK3 input PD9_0 = 0 − − PS3_0 = 0 PD9_1 = 0 P9_0 − − PS3_1 = 0 − PSL3_2 = 0 PS3_2 = 1 PD9_3 = 0 − PSL3_3 = 0 PS3_3 = 0 RTS3 output − − − PS3_3 = 1 CTS4 input PD9_4 = 0 − PSL3_4 = 0 PS3_4 = 0 RTS4 output − − − PS3_4 = 1 CLK4 input PD9_5 = 0 − PSL3_5 = 0 PS3_5 = 0 − − − PS3_6 = 1 PD9_7 = 0 − − PS3_7 = 0 P9_1 RXD3 input P9_2 TXD3 output(4) − P9_3 CTS3 input P9_4 P9_5 output(4) P9_6 TXD4 P9_7 RXD4 input NOTES: 1. Set registers PS0, PS1, and PS3 after setting the other registers. 2. Set the PD9 or PS3 register immediately after the PRC2 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two instructions. 3. P7_0 is an N-channel open drain output port. 4. After UARTi (i = 0 to 4) operating mode is selected in the UiMR register and the pin function is set in the Function Select Registers, the TXDi pin outputs an “H” signal until a transmit operation starts (the TXDi pin is in a high-impedance state when N-channel open drain output is selected). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 217 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces Start I flag = 0 Interrupt disabled UiMR register: bits SMD2 to SMD0 CKDIR bit STPS bit PRY bit PRYE bit IOPOL bit UART mode(1) select bits Clock select bit Stop bit length select bit Parity select bit Parity enable bit TXD, RXD I/O polarity switch bit UiSMR register = 00h UiSMR2 register = 00h UiSMR3 register = 00h UiSMR4 register = 00h UiC0 register: bits CLK1 and CLK0 CRS bit CRD bit NCH bit CKPOL bit = 0 UFORM bit UiBRG register count source select bits CTS function select bit CTS function disable bit Data output select bit UiBRG register = m m = 00h to FFh UiC1 register: TE bit = 0 RE bit = 0 UiIRS bit UiRRM bit = 0 UiLCH bit bit 7 = 0 Transmit operation disabled Receive operation disabled UARTi transmit interrupt source select bit SiTIC register: bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 IR bit = 0 Transmit interrupt priority level select bits Interrupt not requested SiRIC register: bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 IR bit = 0 Receive interrupt priority level select bits Interrupt not requested Bit order select bit(2) Baud rate = fj 16(m+1) fj = f1, f8, f2n (3), fEXT Data logic select bit (4) Pin settings in the Function Select Registers I flag = 1 Interrupt enabled UiC1 register: TE bit = 1 RE bit = 1 Transmit operation enabled Receive operation enabled End Transmit operation starts by writing data to the UiTB register Receive operation starts when the start bit is detected. Read the UiRB register when the receive operation is completed. i = 0 to 4 fEXT: clock input to the CLKi pin when the external clock is selected NOTES: 1. Set bits SMD2 to SMD0 to the following: 100b (7 bits long), 101b (8 bits long), or 110b (9 bits long). 2. A bit order can be selected when 8-bit data length is selected. Set to 0 when 7-bit or 9-bit data length is selected. 3. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). 4. Whether data logic is inverted or not can be selected when 7-bit or 8-bit data length is selected. Set to 0 when 9-bit data length is selected. Figure 17.17 Register Settings in UART Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 218 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces (1) Example of the transmit operation timing in 8-bit data length (parity enabled, 1 stop bit) TC Internal transmit clock TE bit in the UiC1 register 1 TI bit in the UiC1 register 1 0 Write data to UiTB register 0 Transfer data from UiTB register to UARTi transmit shift register “H” CTSi input “L” “H” TXDi output Start bit ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP “L” TXEPT bit in the UiC0 register 1 IR bit in the SiTIC register 1 Transmission stops because TE = 0 Stop bit ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP ST D0 Parity bit 0 0 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program The above applies under the following conditions: - UiMR register: PRYE bit = 1 (parity enabled), STPS bit = 0 (1 stop bit) - UiC0 register: CRD bit = 0 and CRS bit = 0 (CTS function used) - UiC1 register: UiIRS bit = 1 (transmit interrupt is generated when the transmit operation is completed) (2) Example of the transmit operation timing in 9-bit data length (parity disabled, 2 stop bit) TC Internal transmit clock TE bit in the UiC1 register 1 TI bit in the UiC1 register 1 0 Write data to UiTB register Transfer data from UiTB register to UARTi transmit shift register 0 “H” TXDi output Start bit Stop bits ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 SP SP ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 SP SP “L” TXEPT bit in the UiC0 register 1 IR bit in the SiTIC register 1 0 0 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program The above applies under the following conditions: - UiMR register: PRYE bit = 0 (parity disabled), STPS bit = 1 (2 stop bits) - UiC0 register: CRD bit = 1 (CTS function disabled) - UiC1 register: UiIRS bit = 0 (transmit interrupt is generated when no data in the UiTB register) TC = 16(m + 1) fj fj: f1, f8, f2n (1), fEXT fEXT: clock input to the CLKi pin when the external clock is selected m: setting value of the UiBRG register (00h to FFh) i = 0 to 4 NOTE: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). Figure 17.18 Transmit Operation in UART Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 219 of 385 ST D0 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces Example of the receive operation timing (1 stop bit) (note 1) “H” RXDi input Start bit D0 Stop bit “L” Verify the level (note 2) Input the receive data Clock divided by UiBRG register Internal receive clock Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program IR bit in the SiRIC register 1 0 This bit becomes 1 when the data is transferred from UARTi receive shift register to UiRB register RI bit in the UiC1 register 1 0 The output signal becomes "H" when the receive operation starts RTSi output “H” “L” The output signal becomes "L" when the RE bit in the UiC1 register is set to 1 The RI bit becomes 0 and RTSi output becomes "L" by reading the UiRB register i = 0 to 4 The above applies under the following conditions: - UiMR register: STPS bit = 0 (1 stop bit) - UiC0 register: CRS bit = 1 (CTS function not used) NOTES: 1. RXDi input is sampled using the clock divided by the setting value of the UiBRG register. The internal receive clock is generated after detecting the falling edge of the start bit, and then the receive operation starts. 2. When "L" is detected, the receive operation continues. When "H" is detected, the receive operation is cancelled. When the receive operatin is cancelled, the RTSi output becomes "L". Figure 17.19 Receive Operation in UART Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 220 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces 17.1.2.1 Baud Rate In UART mode, the baud rate is the frequency of the clock divided by the setting value of the UiBRG register (i = 0 to 4) and again divided by 16. Table 17.5 lists an example of baud rate setting. Actual baud rate = Table 17.5 Target Baud Rate (bps) UiBRG register count source 16 × (UiBRG register setting value + 1) Baud Rate UiBRG Count Source Peripheral Clock: 16MHz UiBRG Setting Value: n Actual Baud Rate (bps) Peripheral Clock: 24MHz UiBRG Setting Value: n Peripheral Clock: 32MHz Actual Baud Rate (bps) UiBRG Setting Value: n Actual Baud Rate (bps) 1200 f8 103(67h) 1202 155(9Bh) 1202 207(CFh) 1202 2400 f8 51(33h) 2404 77(4Dh) 2404 103(67h) 2404 4800 f8 25(19h) 4808 38(26h) 4808 51(33h) 4808 9600 f1 103(67h) 9615 155(9Bh) 9615 207(CFh) 9615 14400 f1 68(44h) 14493 103(67h) 14423 138(8Ah) 14388 19200 f1 51(33h) 19231 77(4Dh) 19231 103(67h) 19231 28800 f1 34(22h) 28571 51(33h) 28846 68(44h) 28986 31250 f1 31(1Fh) 31250 47(2Fh) 31250 63(3Fh) 31250 38400 f1 25(19h) 38462 38(26h) 38462 51(33h) 38462 51200 f1 19(13h) 50000 28(1Ch) 51724 38(26h) 51282 17.1.2.2 LSB First or MSB First As shown in Figure 17.20, the UFORM bit in the UiC0 register (i = 0 to 4) determines a bit order. This function can be used when data length is 8 bits long. (1) When the UFORM bit in the UiC0 register (i = 0 to 4) is set to 0 (LSB first) "H" TXDi "L" ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP "H" RXDi "L" (2) When the UFORM bit is set to 1 (MSB first) TXDi "H" ST D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 P SP ST D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 P SP "L" RXDi "H" "L" The above applies under the following conditions: - UiC0 register: CKPOL bit = 0 (transmit data output at the falling edge and receive data input at the rising edge of the serial clock) - UiC1 register: UiLCH bit = 0 (not inverted) and the UiLCH bit in the UiC1 register is set to 0 (not inverted). ST: Start bit P: Parity bit SP: Stop bit Figure 17.20 Bit Order REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 221 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces 17.1.2.3 Serial Data Logic Inverse When the UiLCH bit in the UiC1 register is set to 1 (inverted), data logic written in the UiTB register is inverted for transmit operation. A read from the UiRB register returns the inverted logic of receive data. This function can be used when data length is 7 bits or 8 bits long. Figure 17.21 shows an example of serial data logic inverse operation. (1) When the UiLCH bit in the UiC1 register (i = 0 to 4) is set to 0 (not inverted) TXDi (not inverted) "H" ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP "L" (2) When the UiLCH bit is set to 1 (inverted) TXDi (inverted) "H" ST D0 "L" The above applies under the following conditions: - UiC0 register: UFORM bit = 0 (LSB first) - UiMR register: STPS bit = 0 (1 stop bit) PRYE bit = 1 (parity enabled). Figure 17.21 Serial Data Logic Inverse 17.1.2.4 TXD and RXD I/O Polarity Inverse The level output from the TXD pin and the level applied to the RXD pin are inverted with this function. When the IOPOL bit in the UiMR register (i = 0 to 4) is set to 1 (inverted), all the input/output data levels, including the start bit, stop bit and parity bit, are inverted. Figure 17.22 shows TXD and RXD I/O polarity inverse. (1) When the IOPOL bit in the UiMR register (i = 0 to 4) is set to 0 (not inverted) TXDi "H" (not inverted) "L" ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP RXDi "H" (not inverted) "L" ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP (2) When the IOPOL bit is set to 1 (inverted) TXDi "H" (inverted) "L" ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP RXDi "H" (inverted) "L" ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP The above applies under the following conditions: - UiC0 register: UFORM bit = 0 (LSB first) - UiMR register: STPS bit = 0 (1 stop bit) PRYE bit = 1 (parity enabled) Figure 17.22 TXD and RXD I/O Polarity Inverse REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 222 of 385 ST: Start bit P: Parity bit SP: Stop bit Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces 17.1.2.5 CTS/RTS Function • CTS Function Transmit operation is controlled by using the input signal to the CTSi pin . To use the CTS function, select the I/O port in the Function Select Register, set the CRD bit in the UiC0 register to 0 (CTS function enabled), and the CRS bit to 0 (CTS function selected). With the CTS function used, the transmit operation starts when all the following conditions are met and an “L” signal is applied to the CTSi pin (i = 0 to 4). -The TE bit in the UiC1 register is set to 1 (transmit operation enabled) -The TI bit in the UiC1 register is 0 (data in the UiTB register) When a high-level (“H”) signal is applied to the CTSi pin during transmitting, the transmit operation is disabled after the transmit operation in progress is completed. • RTS Function The MCU can inform the external device that it is ready for a receive operation by using the output signal from the RTSi pin. To use the RTS function, select the RTSi pin in the Function Select Register. With the RTS function used, the RTSi pin outputs an “L” signal when all the following conditions are met, and outputs an “H” when the start bit is detected. -The RI bit in the UiC1 register is 0 (no data in the UiRB register) -The RE bit is set to 1 (receive operation enabled) 17.1.2.6 Procedure When the Communication Error is Occurred Follow the procedure below when a communication error is occurred in UART mode. (1) Set the TE bit in the UiC1 register (i = 0 to 4) to 0 (transmit operation disabled) and the RE bit to 0 (receive operation disabled). (2) Set bits SMD2 to SMD0 in the UiMR register to 000b (serial interface disabled). (3) Set bits SMD2 to SMD0 in the UiMR register to 100b (UART mode, 7-bit data length), 101b (UART mode, 8-bit data length), or 110b (UART mode, 9-bit data length). (4) Set the TE bit to 1 (transmit operation enabled) and the RE bit to 1 (receive operation enabled). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 223 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17.1.3 17. Serial Interfaces Special Mode 1 (I2C Mode) In I2C mode, the simplified I2C helps to communicate with external devices. Table 17.6 lists specifications of I2C mode. Tables 17.7 and 17.8 list register settings. Tables 17.9 and 17.10 list individual functions in I2C mode. Table 17.11 lists pin settings. Figure 17.23 shows a block diagram of I2C mode. Figure 17.24 shows a transfer timing to the UiRB register (i = 0 to 4) and interrupt timing. I2C Mode Specifications Table 17.6 Item Specification Data format • Data length: 8 bits long Baud rate • In master mode When the CKDIR bit in the UiMR register (i = 0 to 4) is set to 0 (internal clock): fj / (2 (m + 1)) fj = f1, f8, f2n(1) m: setting value of the UiBRG register (00h to FFh) • In slave mode When the CKDIR bit is set to 1 (external clock): input from the SCLi pin Transmit start condition To start transmit operation, all of the following must be met(2): • Set the TE bit in the UiC1 register to 1 (transmit operation enabled) • The TI bit in the UiC1 register is 0 (data in the UiTB register) Receive start condition To start receive operation, all of the following must be met(2): • Set the TE bit to 1 (transmit operation enabled) • The TI bit is 0 (data in the UiTB register) • Set the RE bit in the UiC1 register to 1 (receive operation enabled) Interrupt request generation timing • Start condition detection • Stop condition detection • ACK (Acknowledge) detection • NACK (Not-Acknowledge) detection Error detection • Overrun error(3) Overrun error occurs when the 8th bit of the next data is received before reading the UiRB register Selectable function • Arbitration lost detect timing Update timing of the ABT bit in the UiRB register (i = 0 to 4) can be selected. • SDAi digital delay No digital delay or 2 to 8 cycle delay of the UiBRG count source can be selected. • Clock phase setting Clock delay or no clock delay can be selected. NOTES: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). 2. If an external clock is selected, satisfy the conditions while an “H” signal is applied to the SCLi pin. 3. If an overrun error occurs, a read from the UiRB register returns undefined values. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 224 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces (note 1, 2) NCH ABT SDAi Select SDA output in Function Control Register DQ T ALS SDHI 0 1 ACKD UARTi transmit shift register Noise filter ACKC IICM = 0 or IICM2 = 1 Transmission control circuit 0 1 STSPSEL Delay circuit DMA 0 to 3 request UARTi transmit interrupt request NACK interrupt request IICM = 1 and IICM2 = 0 UARTi transmit shift register IICM = 0 or IICM2 = 1 Reception control circuit DMA 0 to 3 request UARTi receive interrupt request ACK interrupt request IICM = 1 and IICM2 = 0 Start condition detection Start/stop condition detection interrupt request BBS SQ R Stop condition detection NACK DQ T DQ Logic 0 write signal to PDk_m Logic 1 write signal to PDk_m T ACK SQ (note 1, 2) NCH Falling edge detection R Start/stop condition generation block SCLi Select SCL output in Function Control Register Noise filter 9th clock UARTi CLK control SWC2 SWC STSPSEL IICM 0 0 1 1 SQ R Falling edge of 9th bit i = 0 to 4 IICM, BBS: bits in the UiSMR register IICM2, SWC, ALS, SWC2, SDHI: bits in the UiSMR2 register STSPSEL, ACKD, ACKC: bits in the UiSMR4 register NCH: bit in the UiC0 register ABT: UiRB register PDk_m: bit in the Port Pk Direction Register corresponding to the SCLi pin NOTES: 1. P7_0 and P7_1 do not have the dotted rectangular portion of the circuit. The absolute maximum rating of the input voltage for P7_0 and P7_1 is from -0.3 V to 6.0 V. 2. P6_2, P6_3, P6_6, P6_7, P9_1, P9_2, P9_6, and P9_7 are used with turning off the P channel of the CMOS port all the time. The absolute maximum rating of the input voltage for these ports is from - 0.3 V to VCC1 + 0.3 V. Figure 17.23 I2C Mode Block Diagram REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 225 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 17.7 17. Serial Interfaces Register Settings in I2C Mode (1/2) Register UiMR UiSMR UiSMR2 UiSMR3 UiSMR4 Setting Value Bit Master SMD2 to SMD0 Set to 010b CKDIR Set to 0 IOPOL Set to 0 Slave Set to 1 IICM Set to 1 ABC Select an arbitration lost detect timing Disabled BBS Bus busy flag 7 to 3 Set to 00000b IICM2 See Tables 17.9 and 17.10 Functions in I2C Mode CSC Set to 1 to enable clock synchronization SWC Set to 1 to hold an “L” signal output from SCLi at the falling edge of the ninth bit of the serial clock ALS Set to 1 to abort an SDAi output when Set to 0 detecting the arbitration lost STC Set to 0 SWC2 Set to 1 to forcibly make a signal output from SCL an “L” SDHI Set to 1 to disable SDA output SU1HIM Set to 0 SSE Set to 0 CKPH See Tables 17.9 and 17.10 Functions in I2C Mode DINC, NODC, ERR Set to 0 DL2 to DL0 Set SDAi digital delay value STAREQ Set to 1 to generate the start condition RSTAREQ Set to 1 to generate the restart condition STPREQ Set to 1 to generate the stop condition STSPSEL Set to 1 when using a condition generation function ACKD Select ACK or NACK ACKC Set to 1 to output ACK data SCLHI Set to 1 to enable SCL output stop when detecting the stop condition Set to 0 SWC9 Set to 0 Set to 1 to hold an “L” signal output from SCLi at the falling edge of the ninth bit of the serial clock i = 0 to 4 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 226 of 385 Set to 0 Set to 1 to initialize UARTi by detecting the start condition Set to 0 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 17.8 17. Serial Interfaces Register Settings in I2C Mode (2/2) Register UiC0 UiC1 Setting Value Bit Master Slave CLK1, CLK0 Select the count source of the UiBRG Disabled register CRS Disabled because the CRD bit is set to 1 TXEPT Transmit shift register empty flag CRD, NCH Set to 1 CKPOL Set to 0 UFORM Set to 1 TE Set to 1 to enable transmit operation TI UiTB register empty flag RE Set to 1 to enable receive operation RI Receive operation complete flag UiLCH, UiERE Set to 0 UiBRG 7 to 0 Set baud rate IFSR IFSR7, IFSR6 Select the UARTi interrupt source UiTB 7 to 0 Set transmit data UiRB 7 to 0 Receive data can be read 8 ACK or NACK is received ABT Arbitration lost detect flag OER Overrun error flag i = 0 to 4 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 227 of 385 Disabled Disabled Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces As shown in Tables 17.9 and 17.10, I2C mode is entered when bits SMD2 to SMD0 in the UiMR register are set to 010b (I2C mode) and the IICM bit in the UiSMR register to 1 (I2C mode). Because an SDAi transmit output passes through a delay circuit, output signal from the SDAi pin changes after the SCLi pin level becomes low (“L”) and the “L” output stabilizes. Table 17.9 Functions in I2C Mode (1/2) I2C Mode (SMD2 to SMD0 = 010b, IICM = 1) IICM2 = 0 (NACK/ACK interrupt) Function CKPH = 0 (no clock delay) Interrupt source for numbers 39 to 41(1) (See Figure 17.24) CKPH = 1 (clock delay) IICM2 = 1 (UART transmit/receive interrupt) CKPH = 0 (no clock delay) CKPH = 1 (clock delay) Start condition or stop condition detection (See Table 17.12 STSPSEL Bit Function) No acknowledgement detection (NACKi) Interrupt source for numbers 17, 19, 33, 35, at the rising edge of 9th bit of SCLi 37(1) (See Figure 17.24) UARTi transmit operation - at the rising edge of 9th bit of SCLi Acknowledgement detection (ACKi) Interrupt source for numbers 18, 20, 34, 36, at the rising edge of 9th bit of SCLi 38(1) (See Figure 17.24) UARTi receive operation - at the falling edge of 9th bit of SCLi Data transfer timing At rising edge of 9th bit of SCLi from the UART receive shift register to the UiRB register Falling edge of 9th bit Falling edge and of SCLi rising edge of 9th bit of SCLi UARTi transmit output delay Delay Functions of P6_3, P6_7, P7_0, P9_2, P9_6 SDAi input and output Functions of P6_2, P6_6, P7_1, P9_1, P9_7 SCLi input and output Noise filter width 200 ns i = 0 to 4 NOTE: 1. Use the following procedures to change an interrupt source. (a) Disable an interrupt of the corresponding interrupt number. (b) Change an interrupt source. (c) Set the IR bit of a corresponding interrupt number to 0 (interrupt not requested). (d) Set bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 of the corresponding interrupt number. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 228 of 385 UARTi transmit operation - at the next falling edge after the 9th bit of SCLi Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 17.10 17. Serial Interfaces Functions in I2C Mode (2/2) I2C Mode (SMD2 to SMD0 = 010b, IICM = 1) IICM2 = 0 (NACK/ACK interrupt) Function CKPH = 0 (no clock delay) IICM2 = 1 (UART transmit/receive interrupt) CKPH = 1 (clock delay) CKPH = 0 (no clock delay) CKPH = 1 (clock delay) Reading RXDi, SCLi pin Can be read regardless of the corresponding port direction bit levels Default value of TXDi, SDAi output Value set in the port register before entering I2C mode(1) SCLi default and end values H DMA source (See Figure 17.24) Acknowledgement detection (ACKi) UARTi receive operation - at the falling edge of 9th bit of SCLi Storing receive data 1st to 8th bit of the receive data are stored into bits 7 to 0 in the UiRB register 1st to 7th bits of the receive data are stored into bits 6 to 0 in the UiRB register. 8th bit is stored into bit 8 in the UiRB register L H L 1st to 8th bits are stored into bits 7 to 0 in the UiRB register(2) Reading receive data The value in the UiRB register is read as it is Bits 6 to 0 in the UiRB register are read as bits 7 to 1. Bit 8 in the UiRB register is read as bit 0(3) i = 0 to 4 NOTES: 1. Set default value of the SDAi output while bits SMD2 to SMD0 in the UiMR register are set to 000b (serial interface disabled). 2. Second data transfer to the UiRB register (at the rising edge of the ninth bit of SCLi). 3. First data transfer to the UiRB register (at the falling edge of the ninth bit of SCLi). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 229 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces (1) When the IICM2 bit is set to 0 (ACK or NACK interrupt) and the CKPH bit is set to 0 (no clock delay) 1st bit 2nd bit 3rd bit 4th bit 5th bit 6th bit 7th bit 8th bit D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 9th bit SCLi SDAi D8 (ACK,NACK) ACK interrupt (DMA request) or NACK interrupt Transferred to the UiRB register b15 b9 b8 b7 b0 D8 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 Contents of the UiRB register (2) When the IICM2 bit is set to 0 and the CKPH bit is set to 1 (clock delay) 1st bit 2nd bit 3rd bit 4th bit 5th bit 6th bit 7th bit 8th bit D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 9th bit SCLi SDAi D8 (ACK, NACK) ACK interrupt (DMA request) or NACK interrupt Transferred to the UiRB register b15 b9 b8 b7 b0 D8 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 Contents of the UiRB register (3)When the IICM2 bit is set to 1 (UART transmit or receive interrupt) and the CKPH bit is set to 0 1st bit 2nd bit 3rd bit 4th bit 5th bit 6th bit 7th bit 8th bit D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 9th bit SCLi SDAi D8 (ACK,NACK) Receive interrupt (DMA request) Transmit interrupt Transferred to the UiRB register b15 b9 b8 b7 D0 − b0 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 Contents of the UiRB register (4) When the IICM2 bit is set to 1 and the CKPH bit is set to 1 1st bit 2nd bit 3rd bit 4th bit 5th bit 6th bit 7th bit 8th bit D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 9th bit SCLi SDAi D7 D8 (ACK, NACK) Transmit interrupt Receive interrupt (DMA request) Transferred to the UiRB register (first time) b15 b9 b8 b7 D0 − Transferred to the UiRB register (second time) b15 b9 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 i = 0 to 4 The above applies when the CKDIR bit in UiMR register is set to 1 (external clock) Transfer Timing to the UiRB Register and Interrupt Timing REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 230 of 385 b7 Contents of the UiRB register Contents of the UiRB register Figure 17.24 b8 b0 D8 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 b0 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 17.11 17. Serial Interfaces Pin Settings in I2C Mode Bit Setting Port P6_2 P6_3 P6_6 P6_7 P7_0(3) P7_1(3) P9_1 P9_2 P9_6 P9_7 Function PSC Register PD6, PD7, PD9 Registers(2) PSL0, PSL1, PSL3 Registers PS0, PS1, PS3 Registers(1)(2) SCL0 output − − PSL0_2 = 0 PS0_2 = 1 SCL0 input PD6_2 = 0 − − PS0_2 = 0 SDA0 output − − PSL0_3 = 0 PS0_3 = 1 SDA0 input PD6_3 = 0 − − PS0_3 = 0 SCL1 output − − PSL0_6 = 0 PS0_6 = 1 SCL1 input PD6_6 = 0 − − PS0_6 = 0 SDA1 output − − PSL0_7 = 0 PS0_7 = 1 SDA1 input PD6_7 = 0 − − PS0_7 = 0 SDA2 output − PSC_0 = 0 PSL1_0 = 0 PS1_0 = 1 SDA2 input PD7_0 = 0 − − PS1_0 = 0 SCL2 output − PSC_1 = 0 PSL1_1 = 0 PS1_1 = 1 SCL2 input PD7_1 = 0 − − PS1_1 = 0 SCL3 output − − PSL3_1 = 0 PS3_1 = 1 SCL3 input PD9_1 = 0 − − PS3_1 = 0 SDA3 output − − PSL3_2 = 0 PS3_2 = 1 SDA3 input PD9_2 = 0 − − PS3_2 = 0 SDA4 output − − − PS3_6 = 1 SDA4 input PD9_6 = 0 − − PS3_6 = 0 SCL4 output − − PSL3_7 = 0 PS3_7 = 1 SCL4 input PD9_7 = 0 − − PS3_7 = 0 NOTES: 1. Set registers PS0, PS1, and PS3 after setting the other registers. 2. Set the PD9 or PS3 register immediately after the PRC2 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two instructions. 3. P7_0 and P7_1 are N-channel open drain output ports. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 231 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces 17.1.3.1 Detecting Start Condition and Stop Condition The MCU detects the start condition and stop condition. The start condition detection interrupt request is generated when the SDAi (i = 0 to 4) pin level changes from high (“H”) to low (“L”) while the SCLi pin level is held “H”. The stop condition detection interrupt request is generated when the SDAi pin level changes from “L” to “H” while the SCLi pin level is held “H”. The start condition detection interrupt shares the Interrupt Control Register and interrupt vector with the stop condition detection interrupt. The BBS bit in the UiSMR register determines which interrupt is requested. 6 cycles < setup time (1) 6 cycles < hold time (1) Setup time Hold time SCLi SDAi (start condition) SDAi (stop condition) i=0 to 4 NOTE: 1. These are cycles of the main clock oscillation frequency f(XIN). Figure 17.25 Start Condition or Stop Condition Detection 17.1.3.2 Start Condition or Stop Condition Output The start condition is generated when the STAREQ bit in the UiSMR4 register (i = 0 to 4) is set to 1 (start). The restart condition is generated when the RSTAREQ bit in the UiSMR4 register is set to 1 (start). The stop condition is generated when the STPREQ bit in the UiSMR4 is set to 1 (start). The following is the procedure to output the start condition, restart condition, or stop condition. (1) Set the STAREQ bit, RSTAREQ bit, or STPREQ bit to 1 (start). (2) Set the STSPSEL bit in the UiSMR4 register to 1 (start/stop condition generation circuit selected). Table 17.12 and Figure 17.26 show functions of the STSPSEL bit. Table 17.12 STSPSEL Bit Function Function STSPSEL = 0 STSPSEL = 1 Output from pins SCLi and SDAi Output the serial clock and data. Output of the start condition or stop condition is controlled by software utilizing port functions. (The start condition and stop condition are not automatically generated by hardware) Output of the start condition or stop condition is controlled by the status of bits STAREQ, RSTAREQ, and STPREQ. Timing to generate start condition and stop condition interrupt requests When start condition and stop condition are detected When start condition and stop condition generation are completed REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 232 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces (1) In slave mode, the CKDIR bit is set to 1 (external clock) and the STSPSEL bit is set to 0 (no start condition and stop condition output) SCLi SDAi Stop condition detection interrupt Start condition detection interrupt IR bit in the BCNiIC register 1 0 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program (2) In master mode, the CKDIR bit is set to 0 (internal clock) and the STSPSEL bit is set to 1 (start condition and stop condition output) 0 Setting value of STSPSEL bit 1 0 1 0 SCLi SDAi The STAREQ bit is set to 1 (start) IR bit in the BCNiIC register Start condition detection interrupt The STAREQ bit is set to 1 (start) Stop condition detection interrupt 1 0 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program i = 0 to 4 Figure 17.26 STSPSEL Bit Function REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 233 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces 17.1.3.3 Arbitration The ABC bit in the UiSMR register (i = 0 to 4) determines an update timing of the ABT bit in the UiRB register. At the rising edge of the clock input to the SCLi pin, the MCU determines whether a transmit data matches data input to the SDAi pin. When the ABC bit is set to 0 (update per bit), the ABT bit becomes 1 (detected - arbitration is lost) as soon as a data discrepancy is detected. The ABT bit remains 0 (not detected - arbitration is won) if not detected. When the ABC bit is set to 1 (update per byte), the ABT bit becomes 1 at the falling edge of the ninth cycle of the serial clock if discrepancy is ever detected. When the ABT bit is updated per byte, set the ABT bit to 0 after an ACK detection in the first byte data is completed. Then the next byte data transfer can be started. When the ALS bit in the UiSMR2 register is set to 1 (SDAi output stopped) and the ABT bit becomes 1 (detected - arbitration is lost), the SDAi pin is placed in a high-impedance state simultaneously. 17.1.3.4 Serial Clock The serial clock is used to transmit and receive data as is shown in Figure 17.24. By setting the CSC bit in the UiSMR2 register to 1 (clock synchronized), an internally generated clock (internal SCLi) is synchronized with the external clock applied to the SCLi pin. If the CSC bit is set to 1, the internal SCLi becomes low (“L”) when the internal SCLi is held high (“H”) and the external clock applied to the SCLi pin is at the falling edge. The contents of the UiBRG register are reloaded and a counting for “L” period is started. When the external clock applied to SCLi pin is held “L” and then the internal SCLi changes “L” to “H”, the UiBRG counter stops. The counting is resumed when the clock applied to SCLi pin becomes “H”. The UARTi serial clock is equivalent to logical AND operation of the internal SCLi and the clock signal applied to the SCLi pin. The serial clock is synchronized between a half cycle before the falling edge of the first bit and the rising edge of the ninth bit of the internal SCLi. Select the internal clock as the serial clock while the CSC bit is set to 1. The SWC bit in the UiSMR2 register determines whether an output signal from the SCLi pin is held “L” at the falling edge of the ninth cycle of the serial clock or not. When the SCLHI bit in the UiSMR4 register is set to 1 (SCLi output stopped), a SCLi output stops as soon as the stop condition is detected (the SCLi pin is in a high-impedance state). When the SWC2 bit in the UiSMR2 register is set to 1 (SCLi pin is held “L”), the SCLi pin forcibly outputs an “L” even in the middle of transmitting and receiving. The fixed “L” output from the SCLi pin is cancelled by setting the SWC2 bit to 0 (serial clock), and then the serial clock inputs to or outputs from the SCLi pin. When the CKPH bit in the UiSMR3 register is set to 1 (clock delay) and the SWC9 bit in the UiSMR4 register is set to 1 (SCLi pin is held “L” after receiving 9th bit), an output signal from the SCLi pin is held “L” at the next falling edge to the ninth bit of the clock. The fixed “L” output from the SCLi pin is cancelled by setting the SWC9 bit to 0 (no wait state/release wait state). 17.1.3.5 SDA Output Values set in bits 7 to 0 (D7 to D0) in the UiTB register are output in descending order from D7. The ninth bit (D8) is ACK or NACK. Set the default value of SDAi transmit output, while the IICM bit in the UiSMR register is set to 1 (I2C mode) and bits SMD2 to SMD0 in the UiMR register are set to 000b (serial interface disabled). Bits DL2 to DL0 in the UiSMR3 register determine no delay or delay of 2 to 8 UiBRG register count source cycles are added to an SDAi output. When the SDHI bit in the UiSMR2 register is set to 1 (SDA output stopped), the SDAi pin is forcibly placed in a high-impedance state. Do not write to the SDHI bit at the rising edge of the UARTi serial clock. The ABT bit in the UiRB register may become 1 (detected). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 234 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces 17.1.3.6 SDA Input When the IICM2 bit in the UiSMR2 register (i = 0 to 4) is set to 0, the first eight bits of received data are stored into bits 7 to 0 (D7 to D0) in the UiRB register. The ninth bit (D8) is ACK or NACK. When the IICM2 bit is set to 1, the first seven bits (D7 to D1) of received data are stored into bits 6 to 0 in the UiRB register. The eighth bit (D0) is stored into bit 8 in the UiRB register. If the IICM2 bit is set to 1 and the CKPH bit in the UiSMR3 register is set to 1 (clock delay), the same data as that of when setting the IICM2 bit to 0 can be returned, by reading the UiRB register after the rising edge of the ninth bit of the serial clock. 17.1.3.7 ACK, NACK When the STSPSEL bit in the UiSMR4 register is set to 0 (start/stop condition not output) and the ACKC bit in the UiSMR4 register is set to 1 (ACK data output), the SDAi pin outputs the setting value, ACK or NACK, of the ACKD bit in the UiSMR4 register. If the IICM2 bit is set to 0, the NACK interrupt request is generated when the SDAi pin is held high (“H”) at the rising edge of the ninth bit of the serial clock. The ACK interrupt request is generated when the SDAi pin is held low (“L”) at the rising edge of the ninth bit of the serial clock. When ACK is selected to generate a DMA request source, the DMA transfer is activated by an ACK detection. 17.1.3.8 Transmit and Receive Operation Initialization The following occurs when the STC bit in the UiSMR2 register is set to 1 (UARTi initialized) and the start condition is detected: • The UARTi transmit shift register is initialized and the contents of the UiTB register are transferred to the UARTi transmit shift register. Then, the transmit operation is started at the next serial clock input to the SCLi pin. UARTi output value remains the same as when the start condition was detected until the first bit data is output. • The UARTi receive shift register is initialized and the receive operation is started at the next serial clock input to the SCLi pin. • The SWC bit in the UiSMR2 register becomes 1 (SCLi pin is held “L” after receiving 8th bit). An output from the SCLi pin becomes “L” at the falling edge of the ninth bit of the serial clock. When UARTi transmit/receive operation is started with setting the STC bit to 1, the TI bit in the UiC1 register remains unchanged. Also, select the external clock as the serial clock to start UARTi transmit/receive operation with setting the STC bit to 1. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 235 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17.1.4 17. Serial Interfaces Special Mode 2 Full-duplex clock synchronous serial communications are allowed in this mode. SS function is used for transmit and receive control. The input signal to the SSi pin (i = 0 to 4) determines whether the transmit and receive operation is enabled or disabled. When it is disabled, the output pin is placed in a high-impedance state. Table 17.13 lists specifications of special mode 2. Table 17.14 lists pin settings. Figure 17.27 shows register settings. Table 17.13 Special Mode 2 Specifications Item Specification Data format Data length: 8 bits long Baud rate • The CKDiR bit in the UiMR register (i = 0 to 4) is set to 0 (internal clock): fj / (2 (m + 1)) fj = f1, f8, f2n(1) m: setting value of the UiBRG register (00h to FFh) • The CKDIR bit to 1 (external clock): input from the CLKi pin Transmit/receive control • SS function Output pin is placed in a high-impedance state to avoid data conflict between a master and other masters, or a slave and other slaves. Transmit and receive start condition Internal clock is selected (master mode): • Set the TE bit in the UiC1 register to 1 (transmit operation enabled) • The TI bit in the UiC1 register is 0 (data in the UiTB register) • Set the RE bit in the UiC1 register to 1 (receive operation enabled) • “H” signal is applied to the SSi pin when the SS function is used External clock is selected (slave mode)(2): • Set the TE bit to 1 • The TI bit is 0 • Set the RE bit to 1 • “L” signal is applied to the SSi pin If transmit-only operation is performed, the RE bit setting is not required in both cases. Interrupt request generation timing Transmit interrupt (The UiIRS bit in the UiC1 register selects one of the following): • The UiIRS bit is set to 0 (no data in the UiTB register): when data is transferred from the UiTB register to the UARTi transmit shift register (transmit operation started) • The UiIRS bit is set to 1 (transmit operation completed): when data transmit operation from the UARTi transmit shift register is completed Receive interrupt: • When data is transferred from the UARTi receive shift register to the UiRB register (receive operation completed) Error detection • Overrun error(3) Overrun error occurs when the 7th bit of the next data is received before reading the UiRB register • Mode error Mode error occurs when an “L” signal is applied to the SSi pin in master mode Selectable function • CLK polarity Transmit data output timing and receive data input timing can be selected • LSB first or MSB first Data is transmitted or received from either bit 0 or bit 7 • Serial data logic inverse Transmit and receive data are logically inverted • TXD and RXD I/O polarity Inverse The level output from the TXD pin and the level applied to the RXD pin are inverted. • Clock phase One of four combinations of serial clock polarity and phase can be selected NOTES: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). 2. If an external clock is selected, ensure that an “H” signal is applied to the CLKi pin when the CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register is set to 0, and that an “L” signal is applied when the CKPOL bit is set to 1. 3. If an overrun error occurs, a read from the UiRB register returns undefined values. The IR bit in the SiRIC register remains unchanged as 0 (interrupt not requested). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 236 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 17.14 17. Serial Interfaces Pin Settings in Special Mode 2 Bit Setting Port Function PD6, PD7, PD9 Registers(2) PSC Register PSL0, PSL1, PSL3 Registers PS0, PS1, PS3 Registers(1)(2) − − PS0_0 = 0 CLK0 output (master) − − PSL0_1 = 0 PS0_1 = 1 CLK0 input (slave) PD6_1 = 0 − − PS0_1 = 0 RXD0 input (master) PD6_2 = 0 P6_0 SS0 input P6_1 PD6_0 = 0 − − PS0_2 = 0 STXD0 output (slave) − − PSL0_2 = 1 PS0_2 = 1 TXD0 output (master) − − PSL0_3 = 0 PS0_3 = 1 SRXD0 input (slave) PD6_3 = 0 − − PS0_3 = 0 P6_4 SS1 input PD6_4 = 0 − − PS0_4 = 0 P6_5 CLK1 output (master) − − PSL0_5 = 0 PS0_5 = 1 CLK1 input (slave) PD6_5 = 0 − − PS0_5 = 0 RXD1 input (master) PD6_6 = 0 − − PS0_6 = 0 STXD1 output (slave) − − PSL0_6 = 1 PS0_6 = 1 TXD1 output (master) − − PSL0_7 = 0 PS0_7 = 1 SRXD1 input (slave) − − PS0_7 = 0 TXD2 output (master) − PSC_0 = 0 PSL1_0 = 0 PS1_0 = 1 SRXD2 input (slave) PD7_0 = 0 − − PS1_0 = 0 RXD2 input (master) PD7_1 = 0 P6_2 P6_3 P6_6 P6_7 P7_0(3) PD6_7 = 0 − − PS1_1 = 0 STXD2 output (slave) − − PSL1_1 = 1 PS1_1 = 1 CLK2 output (master) − PSC_2 = 0 PSL1_2 = 0 PS1_2 = 1 CLK2 input (slave) PD7_2 = 0 − − PS1_2 = 0 P7_3 SS2 input PD7_3 = 0 − − PS1_3 = 0 P9_0 CLK3 output (master) − − PSL3_0 = 0 PS3_0 = 1 CLK3 input (slave) PD9_0 = 0 − − PS3_0 = 0 RXD3 input (master) PD9_1 = 0 − − PS3_1 = 0 STXD3 output (slave) − − PSL3_1 = 1 PS3_1 = 1 TXD3 output (master) − − PSL3_2 = 0 PS3_2 = 1 SRXD3 input (slave) PD9_2 = 0 − − PS3_2 = 0 SS3 input PD9_3 = 0 − PSL3_3 = 0 PS3_3 = 0 P9_4 SS4 input PD9_4 = 0 − PSL3_4 = 0 PS3_4 = 0 P9_5 CLK4 output (master) − − − PS3_5 = 1 CLK4 input (slave) − PSL3_5 = 0 PS3_5 = 0 − − PS3_6 = 1 P7_1(3) P7_2 P9_1 P9_2 P9_3 P9_6 P9_7 PD9_5 = 0 TXD4 output (master) − SRXD4 input (slave) PD9_6 = 0 − PSL3_6 = 0 PS3_6 = 0 RXD4 input (master) PD9_7 = 0 − − PS3_7 = 0 − PSL3_7 = 1 PS3_7 = 1 STXD4 output (slave) − NOTES: 1. Set registers PS0, PS1, and PS3 after setting the other registers. 2. Set the PD9 or PS3 register immediately after the PRC2 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two instructions. 3. P7_0 and P7_1 are N-channel open drain output ports. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 237 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces Start I flag = 0 Interrupt disabled UiMR register: bits SMD2 to SMD0 = 001b CKDIR bit IOPOL bit = 0 Clock synchronous mode Clock select bit (1) UiSMR register = 00h UiSMR2 register = 00h UiSMR3 register: SSE bit = 1 CKPH bit DINC bit NODC bit = 0 bits DL2 to DL0 = 000b SS function enabled Clock phase set bit (2) Serial I/O pin set bit(1) UiSMR4 register = 00h UiC0 register: bits CLK1 to CLK0 CRD bit = 1 NCH bit CKPOL bit UFORM bit UiBRG count source select bits CTS function disabled Data output select bit CLK polarity select bit (2) Bit order select bit When an internal clock is used Baud rate = fj 2(m + 1) UiBRG register = m m = 00h to FFh UiC1 register: TE bit = 0 RE bit = 0 UiIRS bit UiRRM bit = 0 UiLCH bit = 0 bit 7 = 0 Transmit operation disabled Receive operation disabled UARTi transmit interrupt souce select bit SiTIC register: bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 IR bit = 0 Transmit interrupt priority level select bit Interrupt not requested SiRIC register: bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 IR bit = 0 Receive interrupt priority level select bit Interrupt not requested fj: f1, f8, f2n (3) Pin setting in the Function Select Registers I flag = 1 Interrupt enabled UiC1 register: TE bit = 1 RE bit = 1 Transmit operation enabled Receive operation enabled End Transmit/receive operation starts by writing data to UiTB register. Read the UiRB register when the receive operation is completed. i = 0 to 4 NOTES: 1. Set to 0 in master mode, and set to 1 in slave mode. 2. The clock phase is determined by the combination of the CKPH and CKPOL bits in the UiSMR3 register. 3. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). Figure 17.27 Register Settings in Special Mode 2 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 238 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces 17.1.4.1 Master Mode Master mode is entered when the DINC bit in the UiSMR3 register (i = 0 to 4) is set to 1. The following pins are used in master mode. • TXDi: transmit data output • RXDi: receive data input • CLKi: serial clock output To use the SS function, set the SSE bit in the UiSMR3 register to 1. A transmit and receive operation is performed while an “H” is applied to the SSi pin. If an “L” is applied to the SSi pin, the ERR bit in the UiSMR3 register becomes 1 (mode error occurred) and pins CLKi and TXDi are placed in high-impedance states. Set the UiIRS bit in the UiC1 register to 1 (Transmit completion as interrupt source) to verify whether a mode error has occurred or not by checking the EER bit in the transmission complete interrupt routine. To resume serial communication after a mode error occurs, set the ERR bit to 0 (no mode error) while an “H” signal is applied to the SSi pin. Pins TXDi and CLKi become in output mode. 17.1.4.2 Slave Mode Slave mode is entered when the DINC bit in the UiSMR3 register is set to 0. The following pins are used in slave mode. • STXDi: transmit data output • SRXDi: receive data input • CLKi: serial clock input To use the SS function, set the SSE bit in the UiSMR3 register to 1. When an “L” signal is applied to the SSi input pin, the serial clock input is enabled, and a transmit and receive operation becomes available. When an “H” signal is applied to the SSi pin, the serial clock input to the CLKi pin is ignored and the STXDi pin is placed in a high-impedance state. MCU P1_3 MCU P1_2 P9_3(SS3) P9_0(CLK3) P9_3(SS3) P9_1(RXD3) P9_0(CLK3) P9_2(TXD3) P9_1(STXD3) (Master) P9_2(SRXD3) (Slave) MCU P9_3(SS3) P9_0(CLK3) P9_1(STXD3) P9_2(SRXD3) (Slave) Figure 17.28 Serial Bus Communication Control with SSi Pin REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 239 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces 17.1.4.3 Clock Phase Setting Function The clock polarity and clock phase are selected from four combinations of the CKPH and CKPOL bits in the UiSMR3 register (i = 0 to 4). The master must have the same serial clock polarity and phase as the slaves involved in the communication. Figure 17.29 shows a transmit and receive operation timing. (1) When the CKPH = 0 (no clock delay) CLKi I/O (CKPOL = 0) CLKi I/O (CKPOL = 1) “H” “L” “H” “L” SSi input pin In master mode (internal clock) (DINC = 0) TXDi output “H” “L” “H” “L” D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Receive data input timing “H” SSi input pin In slave mode (external clock) (DINC = 1) “L” STXDi output (1) “H” undefined “L” Hi-Z Hi-Z Receive data input timing (2) When the CKPH = 1 (clock delay) CLKi I/O (CKPOL = 0) “H” “L” CLKi I/O (CKPOL = 1) “H” “L” “H” SSi input pin In master mode (internal clock) (DINC = 0) TXDi output “L” “H” D0 “L” D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 Receive data input timing SSi input pin In slave mode (external clock) (DINC = 1) STXDi output (1) “H” “L” “H” “L” D0 Hi-Z Receive data input timing i=0 to 4 CKPH, DINC: bits in the UiSMR3 register CKPOL: bit in the UiC0 register NOTE: 1. P7_0 and P7_1 are N-channel open drain output ports. They must be pulled up externally to output data. Figure 17.29 Transmit and Receive Operation Timing in Special Mode 2 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 240 of 385 D7 Hi-Z Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17.1.5 17. Serial Interfaces Special Mode 3 (GCI Mode) Full-duplex clock synchronous serial communications are allowed in this mode. When a trigger is input to the CTSi (i = 0 to 4) pin, the internal clock which is synchronized with the continuous external clock is generated, and a transmit and receive operation is started. Table 17.15 lists specifications of GCI mode. Table 17.16 lists pin settings. Figure 17.30 shows register settings. Table 17.15 GCI Mode Specifications Item Specification Data format Data length: 8 bits long Serial clock Select the external clock Set the CKDIR bit in the UiMR register (i = 0 to 4) to 1 (external clock). When a trigger is input, the external clock or the clock divided by 2 becomes the serial clock. Transmit and receive start condition A transmit and receive operation starts when a trigger is input to the CTSi pin after all the following are met: • Set the TE bit in the UiC1 register to 1 (transmit operation enabled) • The TI bit in the UiC1 register is 1 (data in the UiTB register) • Set the RE bit in the UiC1 register to 1 (receive operation enabled) • Set the SCLKSTPB bit in the UiC1 register is set to 0 (clock-divided synchronization stopped) The SCLKSTPB bit becomes 1 (clock-divided synchronization started) when a trigger is input to the CTSi pin Transmit and receive stop condition The SCLKSTPB bit in the UiC1 register is set to 0 Interrupt request generation timing Transmit interrupt (The UiIRS bit in the UiC1 register selects one of the following): • The UiIRS bit is set to 0 (no data in the UiTB register): when data is transferred from the UiTB register to the UARTi transmit shift register (transmit operation started) • The UiIRS bit is set to 1 (transmit operation completed): when data transmit operation from the UARTi transmit shift register is completed Receive interrupt: • When data is transferred from the UARTi receive shift register to the UiRB register (receive operation completed) Error detection Overrun error(1) Overrun error occurs when the 7th bit of the next data is received before reading the UiRB register NOTE: 1. If an overrun error occurs, a read from the UiRB register returns undefined values. The IR bit in the SiRIC register remains unchanged as 0 (interrupt not requested). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 241 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 17.16 17. Serial Interfaces Pin Settings in GCI Mode Bit Setting Port Function PD6, PD7, PD9 Registers(2) PSC Register PSL0, PSL1, PSL3 Registers PS0, PS1, PS3 Registers(1)(2) P6_0 CTS0 input(3) PD6_0 = 0 − − PS0_0 = 0 P6_1 CLK0 input PD6_1 = 0 − − PS0_1 = 0 P6_2 RXD0 input PD6_2 = 0 − − PS0_2 = 0 P6_3 TXD0 output − − PSL0_3 = 0 PS0_3 = 1 PD6_4 = 0 − − PS0_4 = 0 P6_4 CTS1 P6_5 CLK1 input PD6_5 = 0 − − PS0_5 = 0 P6_6 RXD1 input PD6_6 = 0 − − PS0_6 = 0 input(3) P6_7 TXD1 output − − PSL0_7 = 0 PS0_7 = 1 P7_0(4) TXD2 output − PSC_0 = 0 PSL1_0 = 0 PS1_0 = 1 P7_1 RXD2 input PD7_1 = 0 − − PS1_1 = 0 P7_2 CLK2 input PD7_2 = 0 − − PS1_2 = 0 P7_3 CTS2 PD7_3 = 0 − − PS1_3 = 0 P9_0 CLK3 input PD9_0 = 0 − − PS3_0 = 0 P9_1 RXD3 input PD9_1 = 0 − − PS3_1 = 0 P9_2 TXD3 output − − PSL3_2 = 0 PS3_2 = 1 PD9_3 = 0 − PSL3_3 = 0 PS3_3 = 0 P9_3 input(3) CTS3 input(3) P9_4 CTS4 input(3) PD9_4 = 0 − PSL3_4 = 0 PS3_4 = 0 P9_5 CLK4 input PD9_5 = 0 − PSL3_5 = 0 PS3_5 = 0 P9_6 TXD4 output − − − PS3_6 = 1 P9_7 RXD4 input PD9_7 = 0 − − PS3_7 = 0 NOTES: 1. Set registers PS0, PS1, and PS3 after setting the other registers. 2. Set the PD9 or PS3 register immediately after the PRC2 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two instructions. 3. CTS input is used as a trigger signal input. 4. P7_0 is an N-channel open drain output port. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 242 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces Start Interrupt disabled I flag = 0 UiMR register: bits SMD2 to SMD0 = 001b CKDIR bit = 1 IOPOL bit = 0 Clock synchronous mode Select external clock UiSMR register: bits 6 to 0 = 0000000b SCLKDIV bit Clock division synchronous bit (1) UiSMR2 register: bits 6 to 0 = 0000000b SU1HIM bit External clock synchronous enable bit (1) UiSMR3 register = 00h UiSMR4 register = 00h UiC0 register: bits CLK1 and CLK0 = 00b CRD bit = 1 NCH bit CKPOL bit = 0 UFORM bit = 0 CTS function disabled Data output select bit UiBRG register = 00h UiC1 register: TE bit = 0 RE bit = 0 UiIRS bit UiRRM bit = 0 UiLCH bit = 0 SCLKSTPB bit = 0 Transmit operation disabled Receive operation disabled UARTi transmit interrupt source select bit Clock-divided synchronization stopped SiTIC register: bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 IR bit = 0 Transmit interrupt priority level select bits Interrupt not requested SiRIC register: bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 IR bit = 0 Receive interrupt priority level select bits Interrupt not requested Pin setting in the Function Select Registers I flag = 1 Interrupt enabled UiC1 register: TE bit = 1 RE bit = 1 Transmit operation enabled Receive operation enabled End Transmit/receive operation starts when a trigger is input to the CTSi pin after writing data to the UiTB register. Read the UiRB register when a receive operation is completed. i = 0 to 4 NOTE: 1. The external clock synchronization function is determined by the combination of the SCLKDIV bit in the UiSMR register and the SU1HIM bit in the UiSMR2 register. Refer to the table " Clock-Divided Synchronous Function Select " for details. Figure 17.30 Register Settings in GCI Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 243 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces Set the SU1HIM bit in the UiSMR2 register (i = 0 to 4) and the SCLKDIV bit in the UiSMR register to values shown in Table 17.17, and apply a trigger signal to the CTSi pin. Then, the SCLKSTPB bit becomes 1 and a transmit and receive operation starts. Either the same clock cycle as the external clock or the external clock cycle divided by two can be selected for the serial clock. When the SCLKSTPB bit in the UiC1 register is set to 0, a transmission and reception in progress stops immediately. Figure 17.31 shows an example of the clock-divided synchronous function. Table 17.17 Clock-Divided Synchronous Function Select SCLKDIV bit in the UiSMR register SU1HIM bit in the UiSMR2 register Clock-Divided Synchronous Function 0 0 Not synchronized 0 1 Same clock cycle as the external clock 1 0 or 1 External clock cycle divided by 2 External clock from the CLKi pin More than 1 clock cycle is required Trigger signal input to the CTSi pin 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Serial clock The clock is stopped by the SCLKSTPB bit in the UiC1 register A TXDi 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Serial clock B TXDi 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 i = 0 to 4 A: When the SCLKDIV bit in the UiSMR register is set to 0, and the SU1HIM bit in the UiSMR2 register is set to 1 B: When the SCLKDIV bit is set to 1, and SU1HIM bit is set to either 0 or 1. Figure 17.31 Clock-Divided Synchronous Function REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 244 of 385 8 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17.1.6 17. Serial Interfaces Special Mode 4 (SIM Mode) In SIM mode, the MCU can communicate with SIM interface devices using UART mode. Both direct and inverse formats are available. The TXDi pin (i = 0 to 4) outputs a low-level (“L”) signal when a parity error is detected. Table 17.18 lists specifications of SIM mode. Table 17.19 list pin settings. Figure 17.32 lists register settings. Figure 17.33 shows an example of SIM interface operation. Figure 17.34 shows an example of SIM interface connection. Table 17.18 SIM Mode Specifications Item Specification Data format • Data length 8-bit UART mode • One stop bit • Direct format: Parity: even Data logic: direct (not inverted) Bit order: LSB first • Inverse format: Parity: odd Data logic: inverse (inverted) Bit order: MSB first Baud rate Set the CKDIR bit in the UiMR register is 0 (internal clock): fj / (16 (m + 1)) fj = f1, f8, f2n(1) m: setting value of the UiBRG register (00h to FFh) Transmit/receive control CTS/RTS function disabled Transmit start condition To start transmit operation, all of the following must be met: • Set the TE bit in the UiC1 register to 1 (transmit operation enabled) • The TI bit in the UiC1 register is 0 (data in the UiTB register) Receive start condition To start receive operation, all of the following must be met: • Set the RE bit in the UiC1 register to 1 (receive operation enabled) • The start bit is detected Interrupt request generation timing Transmit interrupt: • Set the UiIRS bit in the UiC1 register to 1 (transmit operation completed) when the stop bit is output from the UARTi transmit shift register Receive interrupt: • when data is transferred from the UARTi receive shift register to the UiRB register (receive operation completed) Error detection • Overrun error(2) Overrun error occurs when the preceding bit of the stop bit of the next data is received before reading the UiRB register • Framing error Framing error occurs when the number of the stop bits set using the STPS bit in the UiMR register is not detected • Parity error Parity error occurs when parity is enabled and the received data does not have the correct even or odd parity set with the PRY bit in the UiMR register. • Error sum flag Error sum flag becomes 1 when an overrun, framing, or parity error occurs NOTES: 1. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). 2. If an overrun error occurs, a read from the UiRB register returns undefined values. The IR bit in the SiRIC register remains unchanged as 0 (interrupt not requested). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 245 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 17.19 17. Serial Interfaces Pin Settings in SIM Mode Bit Setting Port Function PD6, PD7, PD9 Registers(2) PSC Register PSL0, PSL1, PSL3 Registers PS0, PS1, PS3 Registers(1)(2) P6_2 RXD0 input PD6_2 = 0 − − PS0_2 = 0 P6_3 TXD0 output − − PSL0_3 = 0 PS0_3 = 1 P6_6 RXD1 input PD6_6 = 0 − − PS0_6 = 0 P6_7 TXD1 output − − PSL0_7 = 0 PS0_7 = 1 P7_0(3) TXD2 output − PSC_0 = 0 PSL1_0 = 0 PS1_0 = 1 P7_1 RXD2 input PD7_1 = 0 − − PS1_1 = 0 P9_1 RXD3 input PD9_1 = 0 − − PS3_1 = 0 P9_2 TXD3 output − − PSL3_2 = 0 PS3_2 = 1 P9_6 TXD4 output − − − PS3_6 = 1 P9_7 RXD4 input PD9_7 = 0 − − PS3_7 = 0 NOTES: 1. Set registers PS0, PS1, and PS3 after setting the other registers. 2. Set the PD9 or PS3 register immediately after the PRC2 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two instructions. 3. P7_0 is an N-channel open drain output port. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 246 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces Start I flag = 0 Interrupt disabled UiMR register: bits SMD2 to SMD0 = 101b CKDIR bit = 0 STPS bit = 0 PRY bit PRYE bit = 1 IOPOL bit = 0 UART mode: 8-bit data length Select internal clock Select 1 stop bit Parity select bit (1) Parity enabled UiSMR register = 00h UiSMR2 register = 00h UiSMR3 register = 00h UiSMR4 register = 00h UiC0 register: bits CLK1 and CLK0 CRD bit = 1 NCH bit = 1 CKPOL bit = 0 UFORM bit UiBRG register count source select bits CTS function disabled N-channel open drain output UiBRG register = m m = 00h to FFh UiC1 register: TE bit = 0 RE bit = 0 UiIRS bit = 1 UiRRM bit = 0 UiLCH bit UiERE bit = 1 Transmit operation disabled Receive operation disabled Transmit completion as transmit interrupt source Data logic select bit (2) Error signal output enabled SiTIC register: bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 IR bit = 0 Transmit interrupt priority level select bits Interrupt not requested SiRIC register: bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 IR bit = 0 Receive interrupt priority level select bits Interrupt not requested Bit order select bit(2) Baud rate = fj 16(m + 1) fj = f1, f8, f2n (3) Pin setting in the Function Select Registers I flag = 1 Interrupt enabled UiC1 register: TE bit = 1 RE bit = 1 Transmit operation enabled Receive operation enabled End Transmit operation starts by writing data to the UiTB register Receive operation starts when the start bit is detected. Read the UiRB register when the receive operation is completed. i = 0 to 4 NOTES: 1. Set to 1 in the direct format, and set to 0 in the inverse format. 2. Set to 0 in the direct format, and set to 1 in the inverse format. 3. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register select no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). 4. Determine whether an "L" is output from the TXDi pin by reading the port that shares a pin with the RXDi pin in the receive operation complete interrupt routine. When an "L" is output, wait for one clock cycle to read the UiRB register. Figure 17.32 Register Settings in SIM Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 247 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces (1) Transmit operation TC Internal transmit clock 1 TE bit in the UiC1 register (note 1) 0 Data is set in UiTB register TI bit in the UiC1 register 1 0 “H” TXDi output Data is transfer from UiTB register to UARTi transmit shift register Start bit Stop bit ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP “L” Parity bit Parity error signal sent back from receiving device ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP Detect the level in interrupt routine "L" level is sent back from the SIM card since parity error has occurred Signal line level(2) ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP TXEPT bit in the UiC0 register 1 IR bit in the SiTIC register 1 ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP 0 0 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program The above applies under the following conditions: - UiMR register: PRYE bit = 1 (parity enabled), STPS bit = 0 (1 stop bit) - UiC1 register: UiIRS bit = 1 (transmit interrupt is generated at the transmit completion) (2) Receive operation TC Internal receive clock 1 RE bit in the UiC1 register 0 Start bit Transmit waveform sent by transmitting device Stop bit ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP Parity bit “H” TXDi ouput TXDi pin outputs "L" level since parity error has occurred “L” Signal line level(3) ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP RI bit in the UiC1 register 1 IR bit in the SiRIC register 1 ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP 0 Read from the UiRB register 0 Set to 0 by an interrupt request acknowledgement or by a program The above applies under the following conditions: - UiMR register: PRYE bit = 1 (parity enabled), STPS bit = 0 (1 stop bit) i = 0 to 4 TC = 16( m+ 1) fj fj: f1, f8, f2n (4) m: setting value of the UiBRG register (00 to FF) NOTES: 1. Transmit operation is started when UiBRG overflows after data is set in the UiTB register in the indicated timing. 2. Because pins TXDi and RXDi are connected, a composite waveform, consisting of transmit waveform from the TXDi pin and parity error signal from the receiving device, is generated. 3. Because pins TXDi and RXDi are connected, a composite waveform consisting of transmit waveform from the transmitting device and parity error signal from the TXDi pin, is generated. 4. Bits CNT3 to CNT0 in the TCSPR register selects no division (n = 0) or divide-by-2n (n = 1 to 15). Figure 17.33 SIM Interface Operation REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 248 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces MCU SIM card TXDi RXDi i = 0 to 4 NOTE: 1. Connect the TXDi and RXDi pins and pull up these pins. Figure 17.34 SIM Interface Connection 17.1.6.1 Parity Error Signal Output Function When the UiERE bit in the UiC1 register (i = 0 to 4) is set to 1 (error signal output), the parity error signal output is enabled. The parity error signal is output when a parity error is detected upon receiving data, and an “L” signal is output from the TXDi pin in the timing shown in Figure 17.35. If the UiRB register is read while a parity error signal is output, the PER bit in the UiRB register is set to 0 (no parity error) and the TXDi pin level becomes back to “H”. To determine whether the parity error signal is output or not, read the port that shares a pin with the RXDi pin in the transmission complete interrupt routine. "H" RXDi TXDi ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP "L" "H" Hi-Z "L" Receive operation complete flag 1 0 i = 0 to 4 The above applies under direct format conditions: - UiMR register: PRY bit = 1 (even parity) - UiC0 register: UFORM bit = 0 (LSB first) - UiC1 register: UiLCH bit = 0 (not inverted) Figure 17.35 Parity Error Signal Output Timing REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 249 of 385 ST: Start bit P: Even parity bit SP: Stop bit Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 17. Serial Interfaces 17.1.6.2 Formats 17.1.6.2.1 Direct Format When data is transmitted, data set in the UiTB register (i = 0 to 4) is transmitted with even parity, starting from D0. When data is received, received data is stored into the UiRB register, starting from D0. A parity error is determined with even parity. Set the bits as follows to transmit or receive in the direct format. • Set the PRYE bit in the UiMR register to 1 (parity enabled). • Set the PRY bit in the UiMR register to 1 (even parity). • Set the UFORM bit in the UiC0 register to 0 (LSB first). • Set the UiLCH bit in the UiC1 register to 0 (not inverted). 17.1.6.2.2 Inverse Format When data is transmitted, values set in the UiTB register are logically inverted. The data with the inverted values is transmitted with odd parity, starting from D7. When data is received, received data is logically inverted to be stored into the UiRB register, starting from D7. A parity error is determined with odd parity. Set the bits as follows to transmit or receive in the inverse format. • Set the PRYE bit to 1 (parity enabled). • Set the PRY bit to 0 (odd parity). • Set the UFORM bit to 1 (MSB first). • Set the UiLCH bit to 1 (inverted). (1) Direct format P: Even parity "H" TXDi ST D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 P SP "L" (2) Inverse format P: Odd parity TXDi "H" ST D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 P SP "L" ST: Start bit SP: Stop bit i = 0 to 4 Figure 17.36 SIM Interface Formats REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 250 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18. A/D Converter 18. A/D Converter NOTE The 144-pin package is described as an example in this chapter. Pins AN15_0 to AN15_7 are not provided in the 100-pin package. M32C/8B Group has one 10-bit successive approximation A/D converter with a capacitance coupled amplifier. The results of A/D conversion are stored into the AD0i registers (i = 0 to 7) corresponding to the selected pins. When using DMAC operating mode, the conversion results are stored only into the AD00 register. Table 18.1 lists specifications of the A/D converter. Figure 18.1 shows a block diagram of the A/D converter. Figures 18.2 to 18.6 show registers associated with the A/D converter. Table 18.1 A/D Converter Specifications Item Specification A/D conversion method Successive approximation (with capacitance coupled amplifier) Analog input voltage 0 V to AVCC (VCC1) Operating clock φAD(1) fAD, fAD/2, fAD/3, fAD/4, fAD/6, fAD/8 Resolution Selectable from 8 bits or 10 bits Operating modes • One-shot mode • Repeat mode • Single sweep mode • Repeat sweep mode 0 • Repeat sweep mode 1 • Multi-port single sweep mode • Multi-port repeat sweep mode 0 Analog input pins(2) 144 pin package: 34 pins 8 pins each for AN (AN_0 to AN_7), AN0 (AN0_0 to AN0_7), AN2 (AN2_0 to AN2_7), and AN15 (AN15_0 to AN15_7) 2 extended input pins (ANEX0 and ANEX1) 100 pin package: 26 pins 8 pins each for AN (AN_0 to AN_7), AN0 (AN0_0 to AN0_7), AN2 (AN2_0 to AN2_7) 2 extended input pins (ANEX0 and ANEX1) A/D conversion start condition • Software trigger The ADST bit in the AD0CON0 register is set to 1 (A/D conversion starts). • External trigger (retrigger is enabled) When the falling edge is detected at the ADTRG pin after the ADST bit is set to 1. • Hardware trigger (retrigger is enabled) Timer B2 interrupt request of the three-phase motor control timer function (after the ICTB2 register completes counting) is generated after the ADST bit is set to 1. Conversion rate per pin • Without sample and hold function 8-bit resolution: 49 φAD cycles, 10-bit resolution: 59 φAD cycles • With sample and hold function 8-bit resolution: 28 φAD cycles, 10-bit resolution: 33 φAD cycles NOTES: 1. The φAD frequency must be 16 MHz or lower when VCC1 = 4.2 to 5.5 V. The φAD frequency must be 10 MHz or lower when VCC1 = 3.0 to 5.5 V. Without the sample and hold function, the φAD frequency must be 250 kHz or higher. With the sample and hold function, the φAD frequency must be 1 MHz or higher. 2. AVCC = VCC1 ≥ VCC2 AD input (AN_0 to AN_7, AN15_0 to AN15_7, ANEX0, ANEX1) ≤ VCC1, AD input (AN0_0 to AN0_7, AN2_0 to AN2_7) ≤ VCC2 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 251 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18. A/D Converter 0 Software trigger TRG bit in AD0CON0 register 1 000 AN2_0 001 AN2_1 010 Start trigger AN2_2 011 ADTRG ADST bit 0 AN2_3 100 Timer B2 interrupt request 1 (after ICTB2 register completes counting) of the three-phase TRG0 bit in control timer function AD0CON2 register 101 AN2_5 110 AN2_6 111 AN2_7 000 AN0_0 001 P9_6 P9_5 AN0_3 100 AN0_4 101 X1 ANEX0 AN0_6 111 11 AN0_7 000 AN_0 000 001 AN_2 AN15_1 010 00 010 11 AN_3 10 AN15_2 011 00 011 AN_4 AN15_3 100 101 AN_5 101 AN15_5 110 AN_6 Bits APS1 and APS0 in AD0CON2 register 110 111 AN15_6 111 Bits CH2 to CH0 in AD0CON0 register AN15_7 Bits CH2 to CH0 in AD0CON0 register AD00 register AD0CON0 register AD01 register AD02 register Decoder AD0CON1 register AD03 register AD04 register AD0CON2 register Comparator AD05 register AD06 register AD07 register AD0CON3 register Successive conversion register AD0CON4 register Resistor ladder CKS0 bit in AD0CON0 register 1 1/3 1/2 fAD 1 0 1/2 1/2 CKS2 bit in AD0CON3 register NOTES: 1. These pins can be used in single-chip mode only. 2. These pins are provided in the 144-pin package only. 3. AVCC = VCC1 ≥ VCC2, AD input (AN_0 to AN_7, AN15_0 to AN15_7, ANEX0, ANEX1) ≤ VCC1, AD input (AN0_0 to AN0_7, AN2_0 to AN2_7) ≤ VCC2 Figure 18.1 P15(2, 3) AN15_4 01 100 AN_7 AN15_0 001 AN_1 P0(1, 3) AN0_5 110 01 P10(3) AN0_2 011 1X ANEX1 AN0_1 010 Bits OPA1 and OPA0 in AD0CON1 register P2(1, 3) AN2_4 A/D Converter Block Diagram REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 252 of 385 0 1 1 0 0 CKS1 bit in AD0CON1 register φAD Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18. A/D Converter A/D0 Control Register 0(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset AD0CON0 0396h 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function b2 b1 b0 CH0 CH1 0 0 0: ANi_0 0 0 1: ANi_1 0 1 0: ANi_2 0 1 1: ANi_3 1 0 0: ANi_4 1 0 1: ANi_5 1 1 0: ANi_6 1 1 1: ANi_7 (i = none, 0, 2, 15) Analog input pin select bits(2, 3) CH2 RW RW RW RW When the MSS bit in the AD0CON3 register = 0 b4 b3 0 0: One-shot mode 0 1: Repeat mode 1 0: Single sweep mode 1 1: Repeat sweep mode 0, repeat sweep mode 1 MD0 A/D operating mode select bits 0 (2) RW When the MSS bit in the AD0CON3 register = 1 b4 b3 0 0: Do not set to these values. 0 1: 1 0: Multi-port single sweep mode 1 1: Multi-port repeat sweep mode 0 MD1 RW TRG Trigger select bit 0: Software trigger 1: External trigger, hardware trigger (4) RW ADST A/D conversion start bit 0: A/D conversion stops 1: A/D conversion starts (4) RW CKS0 Frequency select bit 0 (Note 5) RW NOTES: 1. If the AD0CON0 register is rewritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result will be incorrect. 2. Analog input pins must be configured again after an A/D operating mode is changed. 3. Bits CH2 to CH0 are enabled in one-shot mode and repeat mode. 4. To set the TRG bit to 1, select a trigger source using the TRG0 bit in the AD0CON2 register. Then, set the ADST bit to 1 after the TRG bit is set to 1. 5. φAD frequency must be 16 MHz or lower when VCC1 = 4.2 to 5.5V. φAD frequency must be 10 MHz or lower when VCC1 = 3.0 to 5.5V. φAD is selected by the combination of the CKS0 bit, the CKS1 in the AD0CON1 register, and the CKS2 bit in the AD0CON3 register. CKS2 bit in AD0CON3 register CKS0 bit in AD0CON0 register CKS1 bit in AD0CON1 register φAD 0 fAD divided by 4 1 fAD divided by 3 0 fAD divided by 2 0 0 1 1 Figure 18.2 1 fAD 0 fAD divided by 8 1 fAD divided by 6 0 AD0CON0 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 253 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18. A/D Converter A/D0 Control Register 1(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol AD0CON1 Bit Symbol After Reset 00h Address 0397h Bit Name Function RW Single sweep mode and repeat sweep mode 0 b1 b0 0 0: ANi_0, ANi_1 (i = none, 0, 2, 15) 0 1: ANi_0 to ANi_3 1 0: ANi_0 to ANi_5 1 1: ANi_0 to ANi_7 Repeat sweep mode 1 (3) SCAN0 A/D sweep pin select bits (2) b1 b0 0 0: ANi_0 0 1: ANi_0, ANi_1 1 0: ANi_0 to ANi_2 1 1: ANi_0 to ANi_3 Multi-port single sweep mode and multi-port repeat sweep mode 0(4) Set to 11b. SCAN1 RW RW MD2 A/D operating mode select bit 1(4) 0: Other than repeat sweep mode 1 1: Repeat sweep mode 1 RW BITS Resolution select bit 0: 8-bit mode 1: 10-bit mode RW CKS1 Frequency select bit 1 (Note 5) RW VCUT VREF connection bit (8) 0: VREF not connected (7) 1: VREF connected RW b7 b6 RW OPA0 Extended input pin function select bits(4, 6) OPA1 0 0: ANEX0 and ANEX1 are not used 0 1: Signal applied to ANEX0 is A/D converted 1 0: Signal applied to ANEX1 is A/D converted 1 1: External op-amp connection RW NOTES: 1. If the AD0CON1 register is rewritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result will be incorrect. 2. Bits SCAN1 and SCAN0 are enabled in single sweep mode, repeat sweep mode 0, 1, multi-port single sweep mode, and multiport repeat sweep mode 0. 3. These are prioritized pins used for A/D conversion when the MD2 bit is set to 1. 4. When the MSS bit in the AD0CON3 register is set to 1 (multi-port sweep mode used); -set bits SCAN1 and SCAN0 to 11b -set the MD2 bit to 0 -set bits OPA1 and OPA0 to 00b. 5. Refer to the note for the CKS0 bit in the AD0CON0 register. 6. Bits OPA1 and OPA0 can be set to 01b or 10b in one-shot mode and repeat mode. Set these bits to 00b or 11b in other modes. 7. Do not set the VCUT bit to 0 during A/D conversion. Even if the VCUT bit is set to 0, VREF remains connected to the D/A converter. 8. When the VCUT bit is set to 1 from 0, wait for 1 μs or more to start the A/D conversion. Figure 18.3 AD0CON1 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 254 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18. A/D Converter A/D0 Control Register 2(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 Symbol AD0CON2 Bit Symbol SMP Address After Reset XX0X X000b 0394h Bit Name A/D conversion method select bit Function 0: Without sample and hold 1: With sample and hold RW RW When the MSS bit in the AD0CON3 register = 0 b2 b1 APS0 Analog input port select bits(3) APS1 − (b4-b3) 0 0: AN_0 to AN_7, ANEX0, ANEX1 0 1: AN15_0 to AN15_7(2) 1 0: AN0_0 to AN0_7 1 1: AN2_0 to AN2_7 When the MSS bit in the AD0CON3 register = 1 Set to 01b. Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. TRG0 External trigger source select bit 0: ADTRG selected 1: Timer B2 interrupt request of the three-phase motor control timer function (after the ICTB2 register completes counting) selected − (b7-b6) Reserved bits Set to 0. Read as undefined value. AD0CON2 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 255 of 385 RW − NOTES: 1. If the AD0CON2 register is rewritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result will be incorrect. 2. In the 100-pin package, do not set to 01b. 3. Set to 00b or 01b in memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode. Figure 18.4 RW RW RW Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18. A/D Converter A/D0 Control Register 3(1, 2) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 Symbol AD0CON3 Bit Symbol Address 0395h Bit Name After Reset XXXX X000b Function RW DUS DMAC operating mode select bit 0: DMAC operating mode not used 1: DMAC operating mode used RW MSS Multi-port sweep mode select bit 0: Multi-port sweep mode not used 1: Multi-port sweep mode used (3) RW CKS2 Frequency select bit 2 (Note 4) RW b4 b3 RO MSF0 Multi-port sweep status flags MSF1 − (b7-b5) Reserved bits (5) 0 0: AN_0 to AN_7 0 1: AN15_0 to AN15_7 1 0: AN0_0 to AN0_7 1 1: AN2_0 to AN2_7 Set to 0. Read as undefined value. RO RW NOTES: 1. If the AD0CON3 register is rewritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result will be incorrect. 2. The AD0CON3 register may return an incorrect value if read during A/D conversion. It must be read or written after the A/D conversion stops. 3. When the MSS bit is set to 1; -set the DUS bit to 1 and configure DMAC. -set bits MD1 and MD0 in the AD0CON0 register to 10b or 11b. -set bits SCAN1 and SCAN0 in the AD0CON1 register to 11b, the MD2 bit to 0, bits OPA1 and OPA0 to 00b. -set bits APS1 and APS0 in the AD0CON2 register to 01b. -set bits MPS11 and MPS10 to 01b, 10b, or 11b. 4. Refer to the note for the CKS0 bit in the AD0CON0 register. 5. Bits MSF1 and MSF0 are enabled when the MSS bit is set to 1. When the MSS bit is set to 0, a read from these bits returns an undefined value. Figure 18.5 AD0CON3 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 256 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18. A/D Converter A/D0 Control Register 4(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset 0 0 0 0 AD0CON4 0392h XXXX 00XXb 0 0 Bit Symbol − (b1-b0) Bit Name Reserved bits MPS10 Multi-port sweep port select bits(2, 3) MPS11 − (b7-b4) Function RW Set to 0. Read as undefined value. RW b3 b2 RW 0 0: (Note 4) 0 1: AN_0 to AN_7, AN15_0 to AN15_7 1 0: AN_0 to AN_7, AN0_0 to AN0_7 1 1: AN_0 to AN_7, AN2_0 to AN2_7 RW Set to 0. Read as undefined value. Reserved bits RW NOTES: 1. If the AD0CON4 register is rewritten during A/D conversion, the conversion result will be incorrect. 2. Do not set bits MPS11 and MPS10 to 01b in the 100-pin package. 3. Bits MPS11 and MPS10 cannot be set to 10b or 11b in memory expansion mode or microprocessor mode. 4. When the MSS bit in the AD0CON3 register is set to 0 (multi-port sweep mode not used), set bits MPS11 and MPS10 to 00b. When the MSS bit is set to 1 (multi-port sweep mode used), set bits MPS11 and MPS10 to other than 00b. A/D0 Register i(1, 2, 3, 4) (i = 0 to 7) b8 b7 b15 0 00 0 0 0 b0 Symbol Address After Reset AD00 AD01 to AD03 AD04 to AD06 AD07 0381h - 0380h 0383h - 0382h, 0385h - 0384h, 0387h - 0386h 0389h - 0388h, 038Bh - 038Ah, 038Dh - 038Ch 038Fh - 038Eh 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 Function XXXXXXXXb XXXXXXXXb XXXXXXXXb XXXXXXXXb RW 8 low-order bits of A/D conversion result RO In 10-bit mode: 2 high-order bits of A/D conversion result In 8-bit mode: Read as 0. RO Reserved bits. Read as 0. RO NOTES: 1. When the AD0i register is read by a program in DMAC operating mode, the conversion result is incorrect. 2. If the next A/D conversion result is stored before reading the previous result in the AD0i register, the result will be incorrect. 3. Only AD00 register is enabled in DMAC operating mode. The contents of other registers are undefined. 4. When using both DMAC operating mode and 10-bit mode, select a 16-bit transfer for DMAC. Figure 18.6 AD0CON4 Register, AD00 to AD07 Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 257 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18. A/D Converter If analog input shares the pin with other peripheral function inputs, a through current may flow to the peripheral function inputs when an intermediate voltage is applied to the pin. To prevent through current, set the control bit for the corresponding pin to 1, and other peripheral inputs are disconnected. Table 18.2 lists settings of an analog input pin. Table 18.2 Analog Input Pin Setting Port Control Bit Function PSC Register PSL3 Register P9_5 ANEX0 − PSL3_5 = 1 P9_6 ANEX1 − PSL3_6 = 1 P10_4 AN_4 P10_5 AN_5 P10_6 AN_6 P10_7 AN_7 18.1 − − PSC_7 = 1 − − Mode Descriptions The A/D converter has seven different modes. Table 18.3 lists settings for these modes. Table 18.3 Mode Settings Mode AD0CON0 register MD1 bit MD0 bit AD0CON1 register MD2 bit AD0CON3 register MSS bit DUS bit One-shot mode 0 0 0 0 0 or 1 Repeat mode 0 1 0 0 0 or 1 Single sweep mode 1 0 0 0 0 or 1 Repeat sweep mode 0 1 1 0 0 0 or 1 Repeat sweep mode 1 1 1 1 0 0 or 1 Multi-port single sweep mode 1 0 0 1 1 Multi-port repeat sweep mode 0 1 1 0 1 1 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 258 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18.1.1 18. A/D Converter One-Shot Mode In one-shot mode, analog voltage applied to a selected pin is converted to a digital code once. Table 18.4 lists specifications of one-shot mode. Table 18.4 One-Shot Mode Specifications Item Specification Function Analog voltage applied to a selected pin is converted once Analog input pins Select one pin from AN_0 to AN_7, AN0_0 to AN0_7, AN2_0 to AN2_7, AN15_0 to AN15_7, ANEX0, or ANEX1. The following register settings determine which pin is used: • Bits CH2 to CH0 in the AD0CON0 register • Bits OPA1 and OPA0 in the AD0CON1 register • Bits APS1 and APS0 in the AD0CON2 register Start Condition Software trigger is selected (TRG bit in the AD0CON0 register = 0): • The ADST bit in the AD0CON0 register is set to 1 (A/D conversion starts) External trigger, hardware trigger is selected (TRG bit = 1): • TRG0 bit in the AD0CON2 register = 0 The falling edge is detected on the ADTRG pin after the ADST bit is set to 1 • TRG0 bit = 1 Timer B2 interrupt request of three-phase motor control timer function (after the ICTB2 register completes counting) is generated after the ADST bit is set to 1. Stop condition • A/D conversion is completed (the ADST bit becomes 0 when software trigger is selected). • Set the ADST bit to 0 by a program (A/D conversion stops). Interrupt request generation timing When the A/D conversion is completed Reading A/D conversion result • DMAC operating mode is not used (DUS bit in the AD0CON3 register = 0): Read the AD0j register (j = 0 to 7) corresponding to a selected pin by a program. • DMAC operating mode is used (DUS bit = 1): A/D conversion result is stored into the AD00 register after A/D conversion is completed. Then, DMAC transfers the data from the AD00 register to a given memory space. (Refer to 13. DMAC for DMAC settings) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 259 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18.1.2 18. A/D Converter Repeat Mode In repeat mode, analog voltage applied to a selected pin is repeatedly converted to a digital code. Table 18.5 lists specifications of repeat mode. Table 18.5 Repeat Mode Specifications Item Specification Function Analog voltage applied to a selected pin is repeatedly converted Analog input pins Select one pin from AN_0 to AN_7, AN0_0 to AN0_7, AN2_0 to AN2_7, AN15_0 to AN15_7, ANEX0, or ANEX1 The following register settings determine which pin is used: • Bits CH2 to CH0 in the AD0CON0 register • Bits OPA1 and OPA0 in the AD0CON1 register • Bits APS1 and APS0 in the AD0CON2 register Start condition Software trigger is selected (TRG bit in the AD0CON0 register = 0): • The ADST bit in the AD0CON0 register is set to 1 (A/D conversion starts) External trigger, hardware trigger is selected (TRG bit = 1): • TRG0 bit in the AD0CON2 register = 0 The falling edge is detected on the ADTRG pin after the ADST bit is set to 1 • TRG0 bit = 1 Timer B2 interrupt request of three-phase motor control timer function (after the ICTB2 register completes counting) is generated after the ADST bit is set to 1. Stop condition Set the ADST bit to 0 (A/D conversion stops) Interrupt request generation timing • DMAC operating mode is not used (DUS bit in the AD0CON3 register = 0): Interrupt request is not generated. • DMAC operating mode is used (DUS bit = 1): Interrupt request is generated every time each A/D conversion is completed. Reading A/D conversion result • DMAC operating mode is not used (DUS bit = 0): Read the AD0j register (j = 0 to 7) corresponding to a selected pin by a program. • DMAC operating mode is used (DUS bit = 1): A/D conversion result is stored into the AD00 register after A/D conversion is completed. Then, DMAC transfers the data from the AD00 register to a given memory space. (Refer to 13. DMAC for DMAC settings) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 260 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18.1.3 18. A/D Converter Single Sweep Mode In single sweep mode, analog voltage applied to multiple selected pins is converted to a digital code once for each pin. Table 18.6 lists specifications of single sweep mode. Table 18.6 Single Sweep Mode Specifications Item Specification Function Analog voltage applied to selected pins is converted once for each pin Analog input pins Select one of the following. • 2 pins (ANi_0 and ANi_1) (i = none, 0, 2, 15) • 4 pins (ANi_0 to ANi_3) • 6 pins (ANi_0 to ANi_5) • 8 pins (ANi_0 to ANi_7) The following register settings determine which pins are used: • Bits SCAN1 and SCAN0 in the AD0CON1 register • Bits APS1 and APS0 in the AD0CON2 register Start condition Software trigger is selected (TRG bit in the AD0CON0 register = 0): • The ADST bit in the AD0CON0 register is set to 1 (A/D conversion starts) External trigger, hardware trigger is selected (TRG bit = 1): • TRG0 bit in the AD0CON2 register = 0 The falling edge is detected on the ADTRG pin after the ADST bit is set to 1 • TRG0 bit = 1 Timer B2 interrupt request of three-phase motor control timer function (after the ICTB2 register completes counting) is generated after the ADST bit is set to 1. Stop condition • A sequence of A/D conversions is completed (the ADST bit becomes 0 when software trigger is selected) • Set the ADST bit to 0 by a program (A/D conversion stops) Interrupt request generation timing • DMAC operating mode is not used (DUS bit in the AD0CON3 register = 0): Interrupt request is generated after a sequence of A/D conversions is completed. • DMAC operating mode is used (DUS bit = 1): Interrupt request is generated every time each A/D conversion is completed Reading A/D conversion result • DMAC operating mode is not used (DUS bit = 0): Read the AD0j register (j = 0 to 7) corresponding to a selected pin by a program. • DMAC operating mode is used (DUS bit = 1): A/D conversion result is stored into the AD00 register after A/D conversion is completed. Then, DMAC transfers the data from the AD00 register to a given memory space. (Refer to 13. DMAC for DMAC settings) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 261 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18.1.4 18. A/D Converter Repeat Sweep Mode 0 In repeat sweep mode 0, analog voltage applied to multiple selected pins is repeatedly converted to a digital code. Table 18.7 lists specifications of repeat sweep mode 0. Table 18.7 Repeat Sweep Mode 0 Specifications Item Specification Function Analog voltage applied to selected pins is repeatedly converted Analog input pins Select one of the following. • 2 pins (ANi_0 and ANi_1) (i = none, 0, 2, 15) • 4 pins (ANi_0 to ANi_3) • 6 pins (ANi_0 to ANi_5) • 8 pins (ANi_0 to ANi_7) The following register settings determine which pins are used: • Bits SCAN1 and SCAN0 in the AD0CON1 register • Bits APS1 and APS0 in the AD0CON2 register Start condition Software trigger is selected (TRG bit in the AD0CON0 register = 0): • The ADST bit in the AD0CON0 register is set to 1 (A/D conversion starts) External trigger, hardware trigger is selected (TRG bit = 1): • TRG0 bit in the AD0CON2 register = 0 The falling edge is detected on the ADTRG pin after the ADST bit is set to 1 • TRG0 bit = 1 Timer B2 interrupt request of three-phase motor control timer function (after the ICTB2 register completes counting) is generated after the ADST bit is set to 1. Stop condition Set the ADST bit to 0 (A/D conversion stops) Interrupt request generation timing • DMAC operating mode is not used (DUS bit in the AD0CON3 register = 0): Interrupt request is not generated • DMAC operating mode is used (DUS bit = 1): Interrupt request is generated every time each A/D conversion is completed Reading A/D conversion result • DMAC operating mode is not used (DUS bit = 0): Read the AD0j register (j = 0 to 7) corresponding to a selected pin by a program. • DMAC operating mode is used (DUS bit = 1): A/D conversion result is stored into the AD00 register after A/D conversion is completed. Then, DMAC transfers the data from the AD00 register to a given memory space. (Refer to 13. DMAC for DMAC settings) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 262 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18.1.5 18. A/D Converter Repeat Sweep Mode 1 In repeat sweep mode 1, analog voltage applied to eight pins, prioritizing one to four pins, is repeatedly converted to a digital code. Table 18.8 lists specifications of repeat sweep mode 1. Table 18.8 Repeat Sweep Mode 1 Specification Item Specification Function Analog voltage applied to 8 selected pins, prioritizing one to four pins, is repeatedly converted. Analog input pins ANi_0 to ANi_7 (8 pins are selected from these pins) (i = none, 0, 2, 15) Prioritized pins Select one of the following. • single pin (ANi_0) • 2 pins (ANi_0 and ANi_1) • 3 pins (ANi_0 to ANi_2) • 4 pins (ANi_0 to ANi_3) The following register settings determine which pins are used: • Bits SCAN1 and SCAN0 in the AD0CON1 register • Bits APS1 and APS0 in the AD0CON2 register Start condition Software trigger is selected (TRG bit in the AD0CON0 register = 0): • The ADST bit in the AD0CON0 register is set to 1 (A/D conversion starts) External trigger, hardware trigger is selected (TRG bit = 1): • TRG0 bit in the AD0CON2 register = 0 The falling edge is detected on the ADTRG pin after the ADST bit is set to 1 • TRG0 bit = 1 Timer B2 interrupt request of three-phase motor control timer function (after the ICTB2 register completes counting) is generated after the ADST bit is set to 1. Stop condition Set the ADST bit is set to 0 (A/D conversion stops) Interrupt request generation timing • DMAC operating mode is not used (DUS bit in the AD0CON3 register = 0): Interrupt request is not generated. • DMAC operating mode is used (DUS bit = 1): Interrupt request is generated every time each A/D conversion is completed. Reading A/D conversion result • DMAC operating mode is not used (DUS bit = 0): Read the AD0j register (j = 0 to 7) corresponding to a selected pin by a program. • DMAC operating mode is used (DUS bit = 1): A/D conversion result is stored into the AD00 register after A/D conversion is completed. Then, DMAC transfers the data from the AD00 register to a given memory space. (Refer to 13. DMAC for DMAC settings) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 263 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18. A/D Converter When ANi_0 is prioritized (single pin) Time ANi_0 ANi_1 ANi_2 ANi_3 ANi_4 ANi_5 ANi_6 ANi_7 When ANi_0 and ANi_1 are prioritized (2 pins) ANi_0 ANi_1 ANi_2 ANi_3 ANi_4 ANi_5 ANi_6 ANi_7 When ANi_0 to ANi_2 are prioritized (3 pins) ANi_0 ANi_1 ANi_2 ANi_3 ANi_4 ANi_5 ANi_6 ANi_7 When ANi_0 to ANi_3 are prioritized (4 pins) ANi_0 ANi_1 ANi_2 ANi_3 ANi_4 ANi_5 ANi_6 ANi_7 : A/D conversion i = none, 0, 2, 15 Figure 18.7 Transition Diagram of Pins used in A/D Conversion in Repeat Sweep Mode 1 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 264 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18.1.6 18. A/D Converter Multi-Port Single Sweep Mode In multi-port single sweep mode, analog voltage applied to 16 selected pins is converted to a digital code once for each pin. Set the DUS bit in the AD0CON3 register to 1 (DMAC operating mode used). Table 18.9 lists specifications of multi-port single sweep mode. Table 18.9 Multi-Port Single Sweep Mode Specifications Item Specification Function Analog voltage applied to the 16 selected pins is repeatedly converted once for each pin in the following order: AN_0 to AN_7 → ANi_0 to ANi_7 (i = 0, 2, 15) Analog input pins Select one of the following. • AN_0 → AN_1 → . . . → AN_7 → AN0_0 → AN0_1→ . . . → AN0_7 • AN_0 → AN_1 → . . . → AN_7 → AN2_0 → AN2_1→ . . . → AN2_7 • AN_0 → AN_1 → . . . → AN_7 → AN15_0 → AN15_1→ . . . → AN15_7 The following register settings determine which pins are used: Bits MPS11 and MPS10 in the AD0CON4 register Start condition Software trigger is selected (TRG bit in the AD0CON0 register = 0): • The ADST bit in the AD0CON0 register is set to 1 (A/D conversion starts) External trigger, hardware trigger is selected (TRG bit = 1): • TRG0 bit in the AD0CON2 register = 0 The falling edge is detected on the ADTRG pin after the ADST bit is set to 1 • TRG0 bit = 1 Timer B2 interrupt request of three-phase motor control timer function (after the ICTB2 register completes counting) is generated after the ADST bit is set to 1. Stop condition • A sequence of A/D conversions is completed (the ADST bit becomes 0 when software trigger is selected) • Set the ADST bit to 0 by a program (A/D conversion stops) Interrupt request generation timing An interrupt request is generated every time each A/D conversion is completed (Set the DUS bit in the AD0CON3 register to 1) Reading A/D conversion result A/D conversion result is stored into the AD00 register after A/D conversion is completed. Then, DMAC transfers the data from the AD00 register to a given memory space. Refer to 13. DMAC for DMAC settings. (Set the DUS bit in the AD0CON3 register to 1) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 265 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18.1.7 18. A/D Converter Multi-Port Repeat Sweep Mode 0 In multi-port repeat sweep mode 0, analog voltage applied to 16 selected pins is repeatedly converted to a digital code. Set the DUS bit in the AD0CON3 register to 1 (DMAC operating mode used). Table 18.10 lists specifications of multi-port repeat sweep mode 0. Table 18.10 Multi-Port Repeat Sweep Mode 0 Specifications Item Specification Function Analog voltage applied to the 16 selected pins is repeatedly converted in the following order: AN_0 to AN_7 → ANi_0 to ANi_7 (i = 0, 2, 15) Analog input pins Select one of the following. • AN_0 → AN_1 → . . . → AN_7 → AN0_0 → AN0_1→ . . . → AN0_7 • AN_0 → AN_1 → . . . → AN_7 → AN2_0 → AN2_1→ . . . → AN2_7 • AN_0 → AN_1 → . . . → AN_7 → AN15_0 → AN15_1→ . . . → AN15_7 The following register settings determine which pins are used: Bits MPS11 and MPS10 in the AD0CON4 register Start condition Software trigger is selected (TRG bit in the AD0CON0 register = 0): • The ADST bit in the AD0CON0 register is set to 1 (A/D conversion starts) External trigger, hardware trigger is selected (TRG bit = 1): • TRG0 bit in the AD0CON2 register = 0 The falling edge is detected on the ADTRG pin after the ADST bit is set to 1 • TRG0 bit = 1 Timer B2 interrupt request of three-phase motor control timer function (after the ICTB2 register completes counting) is generated after the ADST bit is set to 1. Stop condition Set the ADST bit is set to 0 (A/D conversion stops) Interrupt request generation timing An interrupt request is generated every time each A/D conversion is completed (Set the DUS bit in the AD0CON3 register to 1) Reading A/D conversion result A/D conversion result is stored into the AD00 register after A/D conversion is completed. Then, DMAC transfers the data from the AD00 register to a given memory space. Refer to 13. DMAC for DMAC settings (Set the DUS bit in the AD0CON3 register to 1) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 266 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18.2 18. A/D Converter Functions 18.2.1 Resolution The BITS bit in the AD0CON1 register determines the resolution. When the BITS bit is set to 1 (10-bit mode), the A/D conversion result is stored into bits 9 to 0 in the AD0i register (i = 0 to 7). When the BITS bit is set to 0 (8-bit mode), the A/D conversion result is stored into bits 7 to 0 in the AD0i register. 18.2.2 Sample and Hold When the SMP bit in the AD0CON2 register is set to 1 (with sample and hold), the A/D conversion rate per pin increases to 28 φAD cycles for 8-bit resolution and 33 φAD cycles for 10-bit resolution. The sample and hold function is available in all operating modes. Start A/D conversion after selecting whether the sample and hold circuit is used or not. 18.2.3 Trigger Select Function The TRG bit in the AD0CON0 register and the TRG0 bit in the AD0CON2 register determine a trigger to start A/D conversion. Table 18.11 lists setting values for the trigger select function. Table 18.11 Trigger Select Function Setting Values Bit and Setting Trigger AD0CON0 Register AD0CON2 Register TRG = 0 − TRG = 1(1) TRG0 = 0 External trigger(2) Falling edge of a signal applied to ADTRG TRG0 = 1 Hardware trigger(2) Timer B2 interrupt request of three-phase motor control timer function (after the ICTB2 register completes counting) Software trigger A/D conversion starts when the ADST bit in the AD0CON0 register is set to 1 by a program NOTES: 1. A/D conversion starts when the ADST bit is set to 1 (A/D conversion starts) and a trigger is input. 2. If an external trigger or a hardware trigger (retrigger) is input during A/D conversion, the sequence of A/D conversions in progress is aborted and starts over from the beginning. 18.2.4 DMAC Operating Mode DMAC operating mode is available in all operating modes. To select multi-port single sweep mode or multiport repeat sweep mode 0, DMAC operating mode must be used. When the DUS bit in the AD0CON3 register is set to 1 (DMAC operating mode used), all A/D conversion results are stored into the AD00 register. DMAC transfers the result from the AD00 register to a given memory space every time A/D conversion on a single pin is completed. 8-bit DMA transfer must be selected for 8-bit resolution and 16-bit DMA transfer for 10-bit resolution. Refer to 13. DMAC for DMAC instructions. When using DMAC operating mode in single sweep mode, repeat sweep mode 0, repeat sweep mode 1, multiport single sweep mode, or multi-port repeat sweep mode 0, do not input an external retrigger or hardware retrigger. If a retrigger is input, the sequence of A/D conversions in progress is aborted and starts over from the ANi_0 pin (i = none, 0, 2, 15). As a result, a pin and the conversion result of the pin transferred to the RAM do not correspond to each other. 18.2.5 Extended Analog Input Pins In one-shot mode and repeat mode, the ANEX0 pin or ANEX1 pin can be used as the analog input pin. These pins can be selected using bits OPA1 and OPA0 in the AD0CON1 register. The A/D conversion result for ANEX0 input is stored into the AD00 register, and for ANEX1 input into the AD01 register. Both results are stored into the AD00 register when the DUS bit in the AD0CON3 register is set to 1 (DMAC operating mode used). Set bits APS1 and APS0 in the AD0CON2 register to 00b (AN_0 to AN_7, ANEX0, ANEX1) and the MSS bit in the AD0CON3 register to 0 (multi-port sweep mode not used). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 267 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18.2.6 18. A/D Converter External Operating Amplifier (Op-Amp) Connection Mode In external op-amp connection mode, multiple analog voltage can be amplified by one external op-amp using extended analog input pins, ANEX0 and ANEX1. When bits OPA1 and OPA0 are set to 11b (external op-amp connection), voltage applied to pins AN_0 to AN_7 are output from the ANEX0. Amplify this output signal by external op-amp and apply it to the ANEX1. Analog voltage applied to ANEX1 is converted to a digital code and the A/D conversion result is stored into the corresponding AD0i register (i = 0 to 7). The A/D conversion rate varies depending on the response characteristics of the external op-amp. The ANEX0 pin cannot be connected to the ANEX1 pin directly. Set bits APS1 and APS0 in the AD0CON2 register to 00b (AN_0 to AN_7, ANEX0, ANEX1). Figure 18.8 shows a connection example of external op-amp connection mode. Table 18.12 Extended Analog Input Pin Settings AD0CON1 Register ANEX0 Function ANEX1 Function OPA1 Bit OPA0 Bit 0 0 Not used Not used 0 1 P9_5 as an analog input Not used 1 0 Not used P9_6 as an analog input 1 1 Output to external op-amp Input from external op-amp Resistor ladder AN_0 AN_1 AN_2 AN_3 Analog input AN_4 Successive conversion register AN_5 AN_6 AN_7 ANEX0 00b ANEX1 External op-amp Figure 18.8 18.2.7 Bits APS1 and APS0 in the AD0CON2 register Comparator Connection Example in External Op-Amp Connection Mode Power Consumption Reduce Function When not using the A/D converter, the VCUT bit in the AD0CON1 register can disconnect the resistor ladder of the A/D converter from the reference voltage input pin (VREF). As a result, power consumption can be reduced by shutting off any current flow into the resistor ladder from the VREF pin. When using the A/D converter, set the VCUT bit to 1 (VREF connected) prior to setting the ADST bit in the AD0CON0 register to 1 (A/D conversion starts). Do not set the VCUT bit to 0 (VREF not connected) during A/D conversion. Even if the VCUT bit is set to 0, VREF remains connected to the D/A converter. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 268 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18.3 18. A/D Converter Read from the AD0i Register (i = 0 to 7) Use the following procedure to read the AD0i register by a program. • In one-shot mode and single sweep mode: Ensure that the A/D conversion is completed before reading the corresponding AD0i register. The IR bit in the AD0IC register becomes 1 when the A/D conversion is completed. • In repeat mode, repeat sweep mode 0, and repeat sweep mode 1: Read the AD0i register after setting the CPU clock as follows. (1) Set the CM07 bit in the CM0 register to 0 (clock selected by the CM21 bit divided by the MCD register). (2) Set the MCD register to 12h (no division). 18.4 Output Impedance of Sensor Equivalent Circuit under A/D Conversion To take full advantage of the A/D converter performance, Internal capacitor (C) charge shown in Figure 18.9 must be completed within the specified period (T) as sampling time. Output impedance of the sensor equivalent circuit (R0) is determined by the following equation: 1 – ----------------------------t ⎧ C ( R0 + R ) ⎫ VC = VIN ⎨ 1 – e ⎬ ⎩ ⎭ X ⎛ VC = VIN – ---- VIN = VIN 1 – X ----⎞⎠ ⎝ Y Y When t = T, e 1 – ---------------------------- T C ( R0 + R ) X = ---Y 1 X – ---------------------------- T = ln ---C ( R0 + R ) Y T R0 = – -------------–R X C ln ---Y where: VC = Internal capacitor voltage R = Internal resistance of the MCU X = Accuracy (error) of the A/D converter Y = Resolution (1024 in 10-bit mode, and 256 in 8-bit mode) Figure 18.9 shows a connection example of analog input pin and external sensor equivalent circuit. In the following example, the impedance R0 is obtained from the equation above when VC changes from 0 to VIN-(1/1024)VIN within the time (T), if the difference between VIN and VC becomes 1LSB. (1/1024) means that A/D accuracy drop, due to insufficient capacitor charge, is held to 1LSB at time of A/D conversion in the 10-bit mode. Actual error, however, is the value of absolute accuracy added to 1LSB. When φAD = 10 MHz, T = 0.3 μs in A/D conversion with the sample and hold function. Output impedance (R0) enough to complete charging the capacitor (C) within the time (T) is determined by the following equation: Using T = 0.3 μs, R = 2.0 kΩ, C = 8.6 pF, X = 1, Y = 1024, –6 3 0.3 × 10 R0 = – ---------------------------------------------------– 2.0 × 10 ≅ 3.0 × 10 3 Ω – 12 1 ⋅ ln ------------8.6 × 10 1024 Thus, the allowable output impedance R0 of the sensor equivalent circuit, making the accuracy (error) 1LSB or less, is approximately 3.0 kΩ maximum. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 269 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 18. A/D Converter Sensor equivalent Circuit R0 MCU R (2.0 kΩ) VIN C (8.6 pF) VC Sampling time Sample and hold is enabled : Sample and hold is disabled : Figure 18.9 Analog Input Pin and External Sensor Equivalent Circuit REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 270 of 385 3 φAD 2 φAD Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 19. D/A Converter 19. D/A Converter The D/A converter consists of two independent 8-bit R-2R ladder D/A converter circuits. Digital code is converted to analog voltage every time a value to be converted is written to the corresponding DAi register (i = 0, 1). The DAiE bit in the DACON register determines whether the D/A conversion result is output or not. When the DAiE bit is set to 1 (output enabled), pull-up for the corresponding port is disabled. When the D/A converter is not used, set the DAi register to 00h and the DAiE bit to 0 (output disabled). Output analog voltage (V) is obtained from the following equation using the value n (n = decimal) set in the DAi register. V= VREF x n 256 (n = 0 to 255) VREF: Reference voltage (VREF remains connected even if the VCUT bit in the AD0CON1 register is set to 0) Table 19.1 lists specifications of the D/A converter. Figure 19.1 shows a block diagram of the D/A converter. Table 19.2 lists pin settings of DA0 and DA1. Figure 19.2 shows registers associated with the D/A converter. Figure 19.3 shows a D/A converter equivalent circuit. Table 19.1 D/A Converter Specifications Item Specification D/A conversion method R-2R Resolution 8 bits Analog output pin 2 channels Low-order bits of data bus DA0E 0 DA0 DA0 Register 1 R-2R Resistor Ladder DA1E 0 DA1 DA1 Register 1 R-2R Resistor Ladder Figure 19.1 D/A Converter Block Diagram REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 271 of 385 DA0E, DA1E: Bits in the DACON register Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 19.2 Port 19. D/A Converter Pin Settings Bit Setting Function PD9 Register(2) PSL3 Register PS3 Register(1)(2) P9_3 DA0 output PD9_3=0 PSL3_3=1 PS3_3=0 P9_4 DA1 output PD9_4=0 PSL3_4=1 PS3_4=0 NOTES: 1. Set the PS3 register after setting the other registers. 2. Set the PD9 or PS3 register immediately after the PRC2 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two instructions. D/A Control Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol DACON Address 039Ch Bit Symbol Bit Name After Reset XXXX XX00b Function RW DA0E D/A0 output enable bit 0: Output disabled 1: Output enabled RW DA1E D/A1 output enable bit 0: Output disabled 1: Output enabled RW − (b7-b2) Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. − D/A Register i (i = 0,1) b7 b0 Symbol DA0, DA1 Address 0398h, 039Ah Function Set output value to be D/A converted. Figure 19.2 DACON Register, DA0 and DA1 Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 272 of 385 After Reset Undefined Setting Range RW 00h to FFh RW Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 19. D/A Converter DA0E 0 R R R R R R 2R R r DA0 1 2R 2R 2R 2R 2R 2R 2R 2R LSB MSB Set in the DA0 register 0 1 AVSS VREF(4) NOTES: 1. The above applies when the DA0 register is set to 2Ah. 2. D/A1 has the same circuitry as the avove. 3. When the D/A converter is not used, set the DAiE bit (i = 0,1) in the DACON register to 0 (output disabled) and the DAi register to 00h to stop current from flowing into the R-2R resistor to reduce unnecessary power consumption. 4. VREF remains connected even if the VCUT bit in the AD0CON1 register is set to 0 (VREF not connected). Figure 19.3 D/A Converter Equivalent Circuit REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 273 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 20. CRC Calculation 20. CRC Calculation The CRC (Cyclic Redundancy Check) calculation detects an error in data blocks. A generator polynomial of CRC CCITT (X16 + X12 + X5 + 1) generates CRC code. The CRC code is a 16-bit code generated for a given length of the data block in bytes. The CRC code is stored in the CRCD register every time one-byte data is transferred to the CRCIN register after a default value is written to the CRCD register. CRC code generation for one-byte data is completed in two bus clock cycles. Figure 20.1 shows a block diagram of the CRC circuit. Figure 20.2 shows CRC-associated registers. Figure 20.3 shows an example of the CRC calculation. High-order bits of data bus Low-order bits of data bus 8 low-order bits 8 high-order bits CRCD register CRC code generation circuit X16 + X12 + X5 + 1 CRCIN register Figure 20.1 CRC Calculation Block Diagram CRC Data Register b15 b8 b7 b0 Symbol CRCD Address 037Dh - 037Ch After Reset Undefined Function Setting Range RW After an initial value is written to the CRCD register, the CRC code can be read from the CRCD register by writing data to the CRCIN register. Bit position of the initial value is inverted. The inverted value is read as the CRC code. 0000h to FFFFh RW CRC Input Register b7 b0 Symbol Adddress 037Eh CRCIN Function Data input. Inverse bit position of data Figure 20.2 CRCD Register, CRCIN Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 274 of 385 After Reset Undefined Setting Range RW 00h to FFh RW Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 20. CRC Calculation CRC Calculation and Setup Procedure to Generate CRC Code for 80C4h CRC Calculation for M32C CRC code: a remainder of division, value of the CRCIN register with inversed bit position Generator polynomial Generator polynomial: X16 + X12 + X5 + 1 (1 0001 0000 0010 0001b) Setting Steps (1) Invert a bit position of 80C4h per byte by a program 80h 01h, C4h 23h b15 b0 CRCD register (2) Set 0000h (default value) b7 b0 (3) Set 01h CRCIN register Bit position of the CRC code for 80h (9188h) is inverted to 1189h, which is stored into the CRCD register in the 3rd cycle. b0 b15 CRCD register 1189h b7 b0 (4) Set 23h CRCIN register Bit position of the CRC code for 80C4h (8250h) is inverted to 0A41h, which is stored into the CRCD register in the 3rd cycle. b15 b0 CRCD register 0A41h Details of CRC Calculation As shown in (3) above, bit position of 01h (00000001b) written to the CRCIN register is inverted to 10000000b. Add 1000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000b, as 10000000b plus 16 digits, to 0000h as the initial value of the CRCD register to perform the modulo-2 division. 1000 1000 1 0001 0000 0010 0001 1000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 1000 1000 0001 0000 1 Generator polynomial 1000 0001 0000 1000 0 1000 1000 0001 0000 1 1001 0001 1000 1000 Data Modulo-2 Arithmetic is calculated on the law below 0+0=0 0+1=1 1+0=1 1+1=0 -1 = 1 CRC code 0001 0001 1000 1001b (1189h), the remainder 1001 0001 1000 1000b (9188h) with inversed bit position, can be read from the CRCD register. When going on to (4) above, 23h (00100011b) written in the CRCIN register is inverted to 11000100b. Add 1100 0100 0000 0000 0000 0000b plus 16 digits, to 1001 0001 1000 1000b as a remainder of (3) left in the CRCD register to perform the modulo-2 division. 0000 1010 0100 0001b (0A41h), the remainder with inverted bit position, can be read from CRCD register. Figure 20.3 CRC Calculation REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 275 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 21. X/Y Conversion 21. X/Y Conversion The X/Y conversion rotates a 16 x 16 matrix data by 90 degrees and also inverts high-order bits and low-order bits of a 16-bit data. Figure 21.1 shows the XYC register. The 16-bit XiR register (i = 0 to 15) and 16-bit YjR register (j = 0 to 15) are allocated to the same address. The XiR register is a write-only register, while the YjR register is a read-only register. Access registers XiR and YjR from an even address in 16-bit units. Performance cannot be guaranteed if registers XiR and YjR are accessed in 8-bit units. X/Y Control Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol XYC Address 02E0h Bit Symbol XXXX XX00b Function RW XYC0 Read mode set bit 0: Data converted 1: Data not converted RW XYC1 Write mode set bit 0: Bit alignment not converted 1: Bit alignment converted RW − (b7-b2) Figure 21.1 Bit Name After Reset Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. − XYC Register The XYC0 bit in the XYC register determines how to read the YjR register. When setting the XYC0 bit to 0 (data converted) and reading the YjR register, all the bits j in registers X0R to X15R can be read. For example, bit 0 in the X0R register can be read when reading bit 0 in the Y0R register, bit 0 in the X1R register when reading bit 1 in the Y0R register..., bit 0 in the X14R register when reading bit 14 in the Y0R register, and bit 0 in the X15R register when reading bit 15 in the Y0R register. Figure 21.2 shows a conversion table when the XYC0 bit is set to 0. Figure 21.3 shows an example of the X/Y conversion. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 276 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 21. X/Y Conversion b0 Y1R register Y0R register Y4R register Y3R register Y2R register Y5R register Y8R register Y7R register Y6R register Y10R register Y9R register Y12R register Y11R register Y13R register Y15R register Y14R register Read address X0R register X1R register X2R register X3R register Bits in YjR register X4R register X5R register X6R register X7R register Write address X8R register X9R register X10R register X11R register X12R register X13R register b15 X14R register X15R register b15 i = 0 to 15 j = 0 to 15 b0 Bits in XiR register Y0R register X0R register X1R register Y1R register X2R register Y2R register X3R register Y3R register X4R register Y4R register X5R register Y5R register X6R register Y6R register X7R register Y7R register X8R register Y8R register X9R register Y9R register X10R register Y10R register X11R register Y11R register X12R register Y12R register X13R register Y13R register X14R register Y14R register X15R register Y15R register Figure 21.3 X/Y Conversion REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 277 of 385 b0 b1 b2 b3 b4 b5 b6 b7 b8 b9 b10 b11 b12 b13 b14 b15 b0 b1 b2 b3 b4 b5 b6 b7 b8 b9 b10 b11 b12 b13 Conversion Table when the XYC0 Bit is Set to 0 b14 b15 Figure 21.2 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 21. X/Y Conversion When setting the XYC0 bit in the XYC register to 1 (data not converted) and reading the YjR register, the value written to the XiR register can be read. Figure 21.4 shows a conversion table when the XYC0 bit is set to 1. Write address Read address X0R register, Y0R register X1R register, Y1R register X2R register, Y2R register X3R register, Y3R register X4R register, Y4R register X5R register, Y5R register X6R register, Y6R register X7R register, Y7R register X8R register, Y8R register X9R register, Y9R register X10R register, Y10R register X11R register, Y11R register X12R register, Y12R register X13R register, Y13R register X14R register, Y14R register X15R register, Y15R register b15 b0 Bits in XiR register Bits in YjR register Figure 21.4 i = 0 to 15 j = 0 to 15 Conversion Table when the XYC0 Bit is Set to 1 The XYC1 bit in the XYC register selects bit alignment written to the XiR register. When the XYC1 bit is set to 0 (bit alignment not converted) and writing to the XiR register, bit alignment is written as is. When the XYC1 bit is set to 1 (bit alignment converted) and writing to the XiR register, inverted bit alignment is written. Figure 21.5 shows a conversion when the XYC1 bit is set to 1. b15 b0 Write data b15 XiR register (i = 0 to 15) Figure 21.5 Conversion when the XYC1 Bit is Set to 1 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 278 of 385 b0 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 22. Programmable I/O Ports 22. Programmable I/O Ports 123 programmable I/O ports, P0 to P15 (excluding P8_5), are available in the 144-pin package. 87 programmable I/O ports, P0 to P10 (excluding P8_5), are available in the 100-pin package. The Port Pi Direction Registers determine individual port status, input or output. The pull-up control registers determine whether the ports, divided into groups of four, are pulled up or not. P8_5 is an input-only port and cannot be pulled up internally. The P8_5 bit in the P8 register indicates an NMI input level since P8_5 shares its pin with NMI. Figures 22.1 to 22.4 show programmable I/O port configurations. Each pin functions as a programmable I/O port, I/O pin for internal peripheral function, or bus control pin. To use as an I/O pin for peripheral function, refer to the description for individual peripheral functions. Refer to 8. Bus when used as a bus control pin. Registers associated with the programmable I/O ports are as follows. 22.1 Port Pi Direction Register (PDi Register, i = 0 to 15) Figure 22.5 shows the PDi register. The PDi register configures a programmable I/O port as either input or output. Each bit in the PDi register corresponds to one port. In memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode, the PDi register corresponding to the following bus control pins cannot be written: A0 to A22, A23, D0 to D15, CS0 to CS3, WRL / WR, WRH / BHE, RD, BCLK / ALE / CLKOUT, HLDA / ALE, HOLD, ALE, and RDY. No bit controlling P8_5 is provided in the PDi register. 22.2 Port Pi Register (Pi Register, i = 0 to 15) Figure 22.6 shows the Pi register. The MCU inputs/outputs data from/to external devices by reading and writing to the Pi register. The Pi register consists of a port latch to hold output data and a circuit to read the pin level. Each bit in the Pi register corresponds to one port. In memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode, the Pi register corresponding to the following bus control pins cannot be written and the port level cannot be read from the Pi register: A0 to A22, A23, D0 to D15, CS0 to CS3, WRL/ WR, WRH / BHE, RD, BCLK / ALE / CLKOUT, HLDA / ALE, HOLD, ALE, and RDY. 22.3 Function Select Register A (PSj Register, j = 0 to 3) Figures 22.7 to 22.8 show the PSj registers. The PSj register selects either I/O port or peripheral function output if these functions share a single pin (excluding DA0 and DA1). When multiple peripheral function outputs are assigned to a single pin, set registers PSL0 to PSL3, and PSC to select which function to use. Tables 22.3 to 22.7 list peripheral function output control settings for each pin. 22.4 Function Select Register B (PSLk Register, k = 0 to 3) Figures 22.9 to 22.10 show the PSLk register. When multiple peripheral function outputs are assigned to a single pin, the PSLk register selects which peripheral function output to use. Refer to 22.8 Analog Input and Other Peripheral Function Input for information on bits PSL3_3 to PSL3_6 in the PSL3 register. 22.5 Function Select Register C (PSC Register) Figure 22.11 shows the PSC register. When multiple peripheral function outputs are assigned to a single pin, the PSC register selects which peripheral function output to use. Refer to 22.8 Analog Input and Other Peripheral Function Input for information on the PSC_7 bit in the PSC register. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 279 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 22.6 22. Programmable I/O Ports Pull-up Control Register 0 to 4 (PUR0 to PUR4 Registers) Figures 22.12 to 22.15 show registers PUR0 to PUR4. Registers PUR0 to PUR4 select whether the ports, divided into groups of four, are pulled up or not. Set the bit in registers PUR0 to PUR4 to 1 (pull-up) and the bit in the PDi register to 0 (input mode) to pull-up the corresponding port. In memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode, set bits, corresponding to the bus control pins (P0 to P5), in registers PUR0 and PUR1 to 0 (no pull-up). P0, P1, and P4_0 to P4_3 can be pulled up when they are used as input ports in memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode. 22.7 Port Control Register (PCR Register) Figure 22.16 shows the PCR register. The PCR register selects either CMOS output or N-channel open drain output as port P1 output format. When the PCR0 bit is set to 1, P channel in the CMOS port is turned off at all times and in result port P1 becomes N-channel open drain output. This is, however, pseudo open drain. Therefore, the absolute maximum rating of the input voltage is from -0.3 V to VCC2 + 0.3 V. To use port P1 as data bus in memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode, set the PCR0 bit to 0 (CMOS output). When port P1 is used as a port in memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode, set the output format using the PCR0 bit. 22.8 Analog Input and Other Peripheral Function Input Bits PSL3_3 to PSL3_6 in the PSL3 register, and the PSC_7 bit in the PSC register are used to separate peripheral function inputs from analog input/output. If the analog I/O shares the pin with other peripheral function inputs, a through current may flow to the peripheral function inputs when an intermediate voltage is applied to the pin. To use the analog I/O (DA0, DA1, ANEX0, ANEX1, or AN_4 to AN_7), set the corresponding bit to 1 (analog I/ O), and disconnect the peripheral function inputs to prevent an intermediate voltage from being applied to the peripheral function inputs. For P10_4 to P10_7 (AN_4 to AN_7/KI0 to KI3), when the PSC_7 bit is set to 1, the input buffer for the peripheral functions including the port function is disconnected and ports P10_4 to P10_7 are read as undefined. Also, the IR bit in the KUPIC register remains unchanged as 0 (interrupt not requested) even if KI0 to KI3 pin input levels are changed. Set the corresponding bit to 0 (except analog I/O) when analog I/O is not used. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 280 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 22. Programmable I/O Ports Programmable I/O ports Pull-up select PDi register Port latch Data bus A Peripheral function input B Peripheral function input C Analog signal Option Port D (A) Hysteresis (B) Peripheral function input (C) Peripheral function input − − − − − − − − − − P0_0 to P0_7 P2_0 to P2_7 (D) Analog I/F P3_0 to P3_7 P4_0 to P4_7 − P5_0 to P5_2 P5_5, P5_7 P8_3, P8_4 P8_6, P8_7 : Available Figure 22.1 −: Not available Programmable I/O Ports (1/4) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 281 of 385 − − − − − Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 22. Programmable I/O Ports Programmable I/O ports with the port control register Pull-up select PDi register PCR0 bit Port latch Data bus A Peripheral function input B PCR0 bit: bit in the PCR register Option Port (A) Hysteresis (B) Peripheral function input − − P1_0 to P1_4 P1_5 to P1_7 : Available −: Not available Programmable I/O ports with the function select register INV03 Value written to INV03 bit D Write signal to INV03 bit T Q R RESET NMI INV05 INV02 Pull-up select Registers PS1 and PS2 PDi register Peripheral function output Port latch Data bus Peripheral function input Port P7_2 to P7_5, P8_0, P8_1 Figure 22.2 Programmable I/O Ports (2/4) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 282 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 22. Programmable I/O Ports Programmable I/O ports with the function select register E Pull-up select Registers PS0 to PS3(1, 2) PDi register Peripheral function output Port latch Data bus A Peripheral function input B Peripheral function input C Analog signal D Port (A) Hysteresis (B) Peripheral fucntion input (C) Peripheral fucntion input (D) Analog I/F P5_3(1) − − − − P5_4, P5_6(2) − − − − P6_0 to P6_7 − − − P7_0, P7_1(3) − − − P7_6, P7_7 − − − P9_0 to P9_2 − − P9_3 to P9_6 − − P9_7 − − P10_0 to P10_3 − − P11_0 to P11_3 − − − − P11_4, P12_0 − − − − P12_1 to P12_3 − − − − P12_4 to P12_7 − − − − P13_5, P13_6 − − − − P13_7 − − − − P14_0 to P14_3 − − − − P14_4 to P14_6 − − − − P15_0 − − − P15_1 to P15_3 − − − P15_4 − − − P15_5 to P15_7 − − − Option − P8_2 (note 4) − − − − − − P10_4 to P10_7 P13_0 to P13_4 (E) Circuit : Available −: Not available NOTES: 1. For P5_3, use the PM07 bit in the PM0 register, bits PM15 and PM14 in the PM1 register, and bits CM01 and CM00 in the CM0 register to select CLKOUT or ALE output. 2. For P5_4 and P5_6, use bits PM15 and PM14 to select ALE output. 3. P7_0 and P7_1 are N-channel open drain output ports. 4. These ports are provided in the 144-pin package only. Figure 22.3 Programmable I/O Ports (3/4) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 283 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 22. Programmable I/O Ports Input-only port (P8_5) Data bus NMI Figure 22.4 Programmable I/O Ports (4/4) Port Pi Direction Register (i = 0 to 15)(2) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol PD0 to PD3 PD4 to PD7 PD8 PD9, PD10 PD11 PD12, PD13 PD14 PD15 Bit Symbol Address 03E2h, 03E3h, 03E6h, 03E7h 03EAh, 03EBh, 03C2h, 03C3h 03C6h(4) 03C7h(1), 03CAh 03CBh(3, 4) 03CEh, 03CFh(3) 03D2h(3, 4) 03D3h(3) Bit Name After Reset 00h 00h 00X0 0000b 00h XXX0 0000b 00h X000 0000b 00h Function RW PDi_0 Port Pi_0 direction bit 0: Input mode (functions as input port) 1: Output mode (functions as output port) RW PDi_1 Port Pi_1 direction bit 0: Input mode (functions as input port) 1: Output mode (functions as output port) RW PDi_2 Port Pi_2 direction bit 0: Input mode (functions as input port) 1: Output mode (functions as output port) RW PDi_3 Port Pi_3 direction bit 0: Input mode (functions as input port) 1: Output mode (functions as output port) RW PDi_4 Port Pi_4 direction bit 0: Input mode (functions as input port) 1: Output mode (functions as output port) RW PDi_5 Port Pi_5 direction bit 0: Input mode (functions as input port) 1: Output mode (functions as output port) RW PDi_6 Port Pi_6 direction bit 0: Input mode (functions as input port) 1: Output mode (functions as output port) RW PDi_7 Port Pi_7 direction bit 0: Input mode (functions as input port) 1: Output mode (functions as output port) RW NOTES: 1. Set the PD9 register immediately after the PRC2 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two instructions. 2. In memory expansion mode or microprocessor mode, the PDi register corresponding to the following bus control pins cannot be written: A0 to A22, A23, D0 to D15, CS0 to CS3, WRL/ WR, WRH/BHE, RD, BCLK/ALE/CLKOUT, HLDA/ALE, HOLD, ALE, RDY. 3. Set registers PD11 to PD15 to FFh in the 100-pin package. 4. Nothing is implemented to the PD8_5 bit in the PD8 register, bits PD11_7 to PD11_5 in the PD11 register, and the P14_7 bit in the PD14 register. Write a 0. A read from these bits returns undefined value. Figure 22.5 PD0 to PD15 Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 284 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 22. Programmable I/O Ports Port Pi Register (1, 2) (i = 0 to 15) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset P0 to P5 P6 to P10 P11 to P15 03E0h, 03E1h, 03E4h, 03E5h, 03E8h, 03E9h 03C0h, 03C1h(3), 03C4h(4), 03C5h, 03C8h 03C9h(5), 03CCh, 03CDh, 03D0h(5), 03D1h Undefined Undefined Undefined Bit Symbol Bit Name Pi_0 Port Pi_0 bit Pi_1 Port Pi_1 bit Function Input mode (The PDi_j bit (j = 0 to 7) in the PDi register = 0) Read: Return the pin level. Write: Write to the port latch. RW RW RW Output mode (The PDi_j bit in the PDi register = 1) Read: Return the port latch value. Write: Write to the port latch and the port latch value is output from the pin. Pi_2 Port Pi_2 bit Pi_3 Port Pi_3 bit Pi_4 Port Pi_4 bit RW Pi_5 Port Pi_5 bit RW Pi_6 Port Pi_6 bit RW Pi_7 Port Pi_7 bit RW 0: "L" level 1: "H" level RW RW NOTES: 1. In memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode, the Pi register corresponding to the following bus control pins cannot be written: A0 to A22, A23, D0 to D15, CS0 to CS3, WRL/ WR, WRH/BHE, RD, BCLK/ALE/CLKOUT, HLDA/ALE, HOLD, ALE, RDY. 2. Ports P11 to P15 are provided in the 144-pin package only. 3. P7_0 and P7_1 are N-channel open drain output ports. The pins are placed into high-impedance states when the corresponding bits to P7_0 and P7_1 are set to 1. 4. The P8_5 bit is a read-only bit. 5. Nothing is implemented to bits P11_5 to P11_7 in the P11 register and the P14_7 bit in the P14 register. Write a 0. A read from these bits returns undefined value. Figure 22.6 P0 to P15 Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 285 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 22. Programmable I/O Ports Function Select Register A0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset PS0 03B0h 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW PS0_0 Port P6_0 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL0_0 bit RW PS0_1 Port P6_1 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL0_1 bit RW PS0_2 Port P6_2 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL0_2 bit RW PS0_3 Port P6_3 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL0_3 bit RW PS0_4 Port P6_4 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL0_4 bit RW PS0_5 Port P6_5 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL0_5 bit RW PS0_6 Port P6_6 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL0_6 bit RW PS0_7 Port P6_7 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL0_7 bit RW Function Select Register A1 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset 0 PS1 03B1h 00h Bit Symbol Figure 22.7 Bit Name Function RW PS1_0 Port P7_0 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL1_0 bit RW PS1_1 Port P7_1 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL1_1 bit RW PS1_2 Port P7_2 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL1_2 bit RW PS1_3 Port P7_3 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL1_3 bit RW PS1_4 Port P7_4 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL1_4 bit RW PS1_5 Port P7_5 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL1_5 bit RW PS1_6 Port P7_6 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL1_6 bit RW PS1_7 Port P7_7 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Do not set to this value RW PS0 Register, PS1 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 286 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 22. Programmable I/O Ports Function Select Register A2 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset 0 0 PS2 03B4h 00X0 0000b 0 0 0 Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW PS2_0 Port P8_0 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL2_0 bit RW PS2_1 Port P8_1 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL2_1 bit RW − (b4-b2) Reserved bits Set to 0 RW − (b5) − (b7-b6) Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. Reserved bits − Set to 0 RW Function Select Register A3(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset PS3 03B5h 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW PS3_0 Port P9_0 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL3_0 bit RW PS3_1 Port P9_1 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL3_1 bit RW PS3_2 Port P9_2 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL3_2 bit RW PS3_3 Port P9_3 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: RTS3 RW PS3_4 Port P9_4 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: RTS4 RW PS3_5 Port P9_5 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: CLK4 output RW PS3_6 Port P9_6 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: TXD4/SDA4 output RW PS3_7 Port P9_7 output function select bit 0: I/O port/peripheral function input 1: Select by the PSL3_7 bit RW NOTE: 1. Set the PS3 register immediately after the PRC2 bit in the PRCR register is set to 1 (write enable). Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two instructions. Figure 22.8 PS2 Register, PS3 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 287 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 22. Programmable I/O Ports Function Select Register B0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset 0 PSL0 03B2h 00h 0 0 0 0 0 Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW PSL0_0 Port P6_0 peripheral function output select bit 0: RTS0 1: Do not set to this value RW PSL0_1 Port P6_1 peripheral function output select bit 0: CLK0 output 1: Do not set to this value RW PSL0_2 Port P6_2 peripheral function output select bit 0: SCL0 output 1: STXD0 RW PSL0_3 Port P6_3 peripheral function output select bit 0: TXD0/SDA0 output 1: Do not set to this value RW PSL0_4 Port P6_4 peripheral function output select bit 0: RTS1 1: Do not set to this value RW PSL0_5 Port P6_5 peripheral function output select bit 0: CLK1 output 1: Do not set to this value RW PSL0_6 Port P6_6 peripheral function output select bit 0: SCL1 output 1: STXD1 RW PSL0_7 Port P6_7 peripheral function output select bit 0: TXD1/SDA1 output 1: Do not set to this value RW Function Select Register B1 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset 0 1 0 PSL1 03B3h 00h Bit Symbol Function RW PSL1_0 Port P7_0 peripheral function output select bit 0: Select by the PSC_0 bit 1: TA0OUT output RW PSL1_1 Port P7_1 peripheral function output select bit 0: Select by the PSC_1 bit 1: STXD2 RW PSL1_2 Port P7_2 peripheral function output select bit 0: Select by the PSC_2 bit 1: TA1OUT output RW PSL1_3 Port P7_3 peripheral function output select bit 0: Select by the PSC_3 bit 1: V RW PSL1_4 Port P7_4 peripheral function output select bit 0: Select by the PSC_4 bit 1: W RW PSL1_5 Port P7_5 peripheral function output select bit 0: W 1: Do not set to this value RW PSL1_6 Port P7_6 peripheral function output select bit 0: Do not set to this value 1: TA3OUT output RW Reserved bit Set to 0 RW − (b7) Figure 22.9 Bit Name PSL0 Register, PSL1 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 288 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 22. Programmable I/O Ports Function Select Register B2 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset 0 0 PSL2 03B6h 00X0 0000b 0 0 0 0 Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW PSL2_0 Port P8_0 peripheral function output select bit 0: TA4OUT output 1: U RW PSL2_1 Port P8_1 peripheral function output select bit 0: U 1: Do not set to this value RW − (b4-b2) Reserved bits Set to 0 RW − (b5) − (b7-b6) Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. Reserved bits − Set to 0 RW Function Select Register B3 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 Symbol Address After Reset PSL3 03B7h 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function PSL3_0 Port P9_0 peripheral function output select bit 0: CLK3 output 1: Do not set to this value RW PSL3_1 Port P9_1 peripheral function output select bit 0: SCL3 output 1: STXD3 RW PSL3_2 Port P9_2 peripheral function output select bit 0: TXD3/SDA3 output 1: Do not set to this value RW PSL3_3 Port P9_3 peripheral function output select bit (1) 0: Peripheral function input 1: DA0 RW PSL3_4 Port P9_4 peripheral function output select bit (1) 0: Peripheral function input 1: DA1 RW PSL3_5 Port P9_5 peripheral function output select bit (1) 0: Peripheral function input except ANEX0 1: ANEX0 RW PSL3_6 Port P9_6 peripheral function output select bit (1) 0: Peripheral function input except ANEX1 1: ANEX1 RW PSL3_7 Port P9_7 peripheral function output select bit 0: SCL4 output 1: STXD4 RW NOTE: 1. If DA0, DA1, ANEX0, and ANEX1 are used with the PSL3_i bit (i = 3 to 6) setting to 0, current consumption may increase. Figure 22.10 RW PSL2 Register, PSL3 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 289 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 22. Programmable I/O Ports Function Select Register C b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Symbol Address After Reset PSC 03AFh 00X0 0000b Bit Symbol Bit Name Function PSC_0 Port P7_0 peripheral function output select bit 0: TXD2/SDA2 output 1: Do not set to this value RW PSC_1 Port P7_1 peripheral function output select bit 0: SCL2 output 1: Do not set to this value RW PSC_2 Port P7_2 peripheral function output select bit 0: CLK2 output 1: V RW PSC_3 Port P7_3 peripheral function output select bit 0: RTS2 1: Do not set to this value RW PSC_4 Port P7_4 peripheral function output select bit 0: TA2OUT output 1: Do not set to this value RW − (b6-b5) Reserved bits Set to 0 RW PSC_7 Port P10_4 to P10_7 peripheral function input select bit 0: P10_4 to P10_7 or KI0 to KI3 1: AN_4 to AN_7(1) RW NOTE: 1. Set bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 in the KUPIC register to 000b (interrupt disabled) to change the PSC_7 bit. If AN_4 to AN_7 are used with the PSC_7 bit setting to 0, current consumption may increase. Figure 22.11 RW PSC Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 290 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 22. Programmable I/O Ports Pull-Up Control Register 0(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset PUR0 03F0h 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW Pull-up setting for the corresponding ports 0: Not pulled up 1: Pulled up PU00 P0_0 to P0_3 pull-up RW PU01 P0_4 to P0_7 pull-up RW PU02 P1_0 to P1_3 pull-up RW PU03 P1_4 to P1_7 pull-up RW PU04 P2_0 to P2_3 pull-up RW PU05 P2_4 to P2_7 pull-up RW PU06 P3_0 to P3_3 pull-up RW PU07 P3_4 to P3_7 pull-up RW NOTE: 1. In memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode, set each bit in the PUR0 register to 0 since port P0 to P5 are used as bus control pins. When using as I/O ports, it can be selected whether the ports are pulled up or not. Pull-Up Control Register 1(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset PUR1 03F1h XXXX 0000b Bit Symbol Bit Name Function Pull-up setting for the corresponding ports 0: Not pulled up 1: Pulled up RW PU10 P4_0 to P4_3 pull-up PU11 P4_4 to P4_7 pull-up RW PU12 P5_0 to P5_3 pull-up RW PU13 P5_4 to P5_7 pull-up RW − (b7-b4) Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. RW − NOTE: 1. In memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode, set each bit in the PUR0 register to 0 since port P0 to P5 are used as bus control pins. When using as I/O ports, it can be selected whether the ports are pulled up or not. Figure 22.12 PUR0 Register, PUR1 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 291 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 22. Programmable I/O Ports Pull-Up Control Register 2 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset PUR2 03DAh 00h Bit Symbol Bit Name Pull-up setting for the corresponding ports 0: Not pulled up 1: Pulled up RW PU20 P6_0 to P6_3 pull-up PU21 P6_4 to P6_7 pull-up RW PU22 P7_2 to P7_3 pull-up(1) RW PU23 P7_4 to P7_7 pull-up RW PU24 P8_0 to P8_3 pull-up RW PU25 P8_4 to P8_7 pull-up(2) RW PU26 P9_0 to P9_3 pull-up RW PU27 P9_4 to P9_7 pull-up RW NOTES: 1. P7_0 and P7_1 cannot be pulled up. 2. P8_5 cannot be pulled up internally. Figure 22.13 Function PUR2 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 292 of 385 RW Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 22. Programmable I/O Ports Pull-Up Control Register 3 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 <144-pin package> Symbol Address After Reset PUR3 03DBh 00h Bit Symbol Function Bit Name Pull-up setting for the corresponding ports 0: Not pulled up 1: Pulled up PU30 P10_0 to P10_3 pull-up PU31 P10_4 to P10_7 pull-up RW PU32 P11_0 to P11_3 pull-up RW PU33 P11_4 pull-up RW PU34 P12_0 to P12_3 pull-up RW PU35 P12_4 to P12_7 pull-up RW PU36 P13_0 to P13_3 pull-up RW PU37 P13_4 to P13_7 pull-up RW Pull-Up Control Register 3 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Address After Reset 00h 03DBh Bit Name PU30 P10_0 to P10_3 pull-up PU31 P10_4 to P10_7 pull-up − (b7-b2) Reserved bits PUR3 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 293 of 385 RW <100-pin package> Symbol PUR3 Bit Symbol Figure 22.14 RW Function Pull-up setting for the corresponding ports 0: Not pulled up 1: Pulled up RW RW RW Set to 0 RW Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 22. Programmable I/O Ports Pull-Up Control Register 4(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset PUR4 03DCh XXXX 0000b Bit Symbol Bit Name Pull-up setting for the corresponding ports 0: Not pulled up 1: Pulled up RW PU40 P14_0 to P14_3 pull-up PU41 P14_4 to P14_6 pull-up RW PU42 P15_0 to P15_3 pull-up RW PU43 P15_4 to P15_7 pull-up RW − (b7-b4) Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. NOTE: 1. Set the PUR4 register to 00h in the 100-pin package. Figure 22.15 Function PUR4 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 294 of 385 RW − Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 22. Programmable I/O Ports Port Control Register b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 0 Symbol Address After Reset PCR 03FFh XXXX X000b Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW PCR0 Port P1 control bit(1) 0: CMOS output 1: N-channel open drain output(2) RW − (b2-b1) Reserved bits Set to 0 RW − (b7-b3) Unimplemented. Write 0. Read as undefined value. − NOTES: 1. In memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode, set the PCR0 bit to 0 since port P1 is used as data bus. When using port P1 as an I/O port, CMOS or N-channel open drain output can be selected. 2. This function is designed to use port P1 as pseudo open drain by always turning off P channel of the CMOS port . Therefore, the absolute maximum rating of the input voltage is from -0.3 V to VCC2 + 0.3 V. Figure 22.16 PCR Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 295 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 22.1 22. Programmable I/O Ports Unassigned Pin Handling in Single-Chip Mode Pin Name Handling P0 to P15 (excluding P8_5)(1) Set pins to input mode and connect each pin to VSS via a resistor (pull-down), or set pins to output mode and leave them open XOUT(2) Leave the pin open NMI (P8_5) Connect the pin to VCC1 via a resistor (pull-up) VREF Connect the pin to VSS NOTES: 1. P11 to P15 are provided in the 144-pin package only. 2. It is when the external clock is input to the XIN pin. Table 22.2 Unassigned Pin Handling in Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode Pin Name Handling P1, P6 to P15 (excluding P8_5)(1) Set pins to input mode and connect each pin to VSS via a resistor (pull-down), or set pins to output mode and leave them open BHE, ALE, HLDA, XOUT(2), BCLK Leave the pin open HOLD, RDY Connect the pin to VCC2 via a resistor (pull-up) NMI(P8_5) Connect the pin to VCC1 via a resistor (pull-up) VREF Connect the pin to VSS NOTES: 1. P11 to P15 are provided in the 144-pin package only. 2. It is when the external clock is applied to the XIN pin. MCU (Input mode) (Output mode) (Input mode) Open (Output mode) VCC1 NMI (P8_5) XOUT ... (Input mode) (Input mode) ... P1, P6 to P15(1) (except for P8_5) ... ... P0 to P15(1) (except for P8_5) MCU Open VCC1 NMI (P8_5) Open BHE HLDA ALE XOUT BCLK VCC1 AVCC HOLD RDY BYTE Open VCC2 VCC1 AVSS AVCC VREF AVSS VREF VSS In single-chip mode NOTE: 1. P11 to P15 are provided in the 144-pin package only. Figure 22.17 Unassigned Pin Handling REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 296 of 385 VSS In memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 22.3 22. Programmable I/O Ports Port P6 Peripheral Function Output Control PS0 Register PSL0 Register Bit 0 0: P6_0/CTS0/SS0 1: Select by the PSL0_0 bit 0: RTS0 1: Do not set to this value Bit 1 0: P6_1/CLK0 input 1: Select by the PSL0_1 bit 0: CLK0 output 1:Do not set to this value Bit 2 0: P6_2/RXD0/SCL0 input 1: Select by the PSL0_2 bit 0: SCL0 output 1: STXD0 Bit 3 0: P6_3/SRXD0/SDA0 input 1: Select by the PSL0_3 bit 0: TXD0/SDA0 output 1: Do not set to this value Bit 4 0: P6_4/CTS1/SS1 1: Select by the PSL0_4 bit 0: RTS1 1: Do not set to this value Bit 5 0: P6_5/CKL1 input 1: Select by the PSL0_5 bit 0: CLK1 output 1: Do not set to this value Bit 6 0: P6_6/RXD1/SCL1 input 1: Select by the PSL0_6 bit 0: SCL1 output 1: STXD1 Bit 7 0: P6_7/SRXD1/SDA1 input 1: Select by the PSL0_7 bit 0: TXD1/SDA1 output 1: Do not set to this value Table 22.4 Port P7 Peripheral Function Output Control PS1 Register PSL1 Register PSC Register Bit 0 0: P7_0/TA0OUT input/ SRXD2/SDA2 input 1: Select by the PSL1_0 bit 0: Select by the PSC_0 bit 1: TA0OUT output 0: TXD2/SDA2 output 1: Do not set to this value Bit 1 0: P7_1/TA0IN/TB5IN/RXD2/ SCL2 input 1: Select by the PSL1_1 bit 0: Select by the PSC_1 bit 1: STXD2 0: SCL2 output 1: Do not set to this value Bit 2 0: P7_2/TA1OUT input/CLK2 input 1: Select by the PSL1_2 bit 0: Select by the PSC_2 bit 1: TA1OUT output 0: CLK2 output 1: V Bit 3 0: P7_3/TA1IN/CTS2/SS2 1: Select by the PSL1_3 bit 0: Select by the PSC_3 bit 1: V 0: RTS2 1: Do not set to this value Bit 4 0: P7_4/TA2OUT input 1: Select by the PSL1_4 bit 0: Select by the PSC_4 bit 1: W 0: TA2OUT output 1: Do not set to this value Bit 5 0: P7_5/TA2IN 1: Select by the PSL1_5 bit 0: W 1: Do not set to this value Set to 0 Bit 6 0: P7_6/TA3OUT input 1: Select by the PSL1_6 bit 0: Do not set to this value 1: TA3OUT output Set to 0 Bit 7 0: P7_7/TA3IN 1: Do not set to this value Set to 0 − REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 297 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 22.5 22. Programmable I/O Ports Port P8 Peripheral Function Output Control PS2 Register PSL2 Register Bit 0 0: P8_0/TA4OUT input 1: Select by the PSL2_0 bit 0: TA4OUT output 1: U Bit 1 0: P8_1/TA4IN 1: Select by the PSL2_1 bit 0: U 1: Do not set to this value Bits 2 to 7 Set to 000000b Table 22.6 Port P9 Peripheral Function Output Control PS3 Register PSL3 Register Bit 0 0: P9_0/TB0IN/CLK3 input 1: Select by the PSL3_0 bit 0: CLK3 output 1: Do not set to this value Bit 1 0: P9_1/TB1IN/RXD3/SCL3 input 1: Select by the PSL3_1 bit 0: SCL3 output 1: STXD3 Bit 2 0: P9_2/TB2IN/SRXD3/SDA3 input 1: Select by the PSL3_2 bit 0: TXD3/SDA3 output 1: Do not set to this value Bit 3 0: P9_3/TB3IN/CTS3/SS3/DA0 1: RTS3 0: Peripheral function input 1: DA0 Bit 4 0: P9_4/TB4IN/CTS4/SS4/DA1 1: RTS4 0: Peripheral function input 1: DA1 Bit 5 0: P9_5/ANEX0/CLK4 input 1: CLK4 output 0: Peripheral function input except ANEX0 1: ANEX0 Bit 6 0: P9_6/SRXD4/ANEX1/SDA4 input 1: TXD4/SDA4 output 0: Peripheral function input except ANEX1 1: ANEX1 Bit 7 0: P9_7/RXD4/ADTRG/SCL4 input 1: Select by the PSL3_7 bit 0: SCL4 output 1: STXD4 Table 22.7 Port P10 Peripheral Function Output Control PSC Register Bit 7 0: P10_4 to P10_7 or KI0 to KI3 1: AN_4 to AN_7 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 298 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23. Flash Memory 23. Flash Memory CPU rewrite mode, standard serial I/O mode, and parallel I/O mode can be used to erase and program the flash memory. Table 23.1 lists specifications of the flash memory. Table 23.1 Flash Memory Specifications Item Specification Erase unit On a block basis (See Figure 23.1) Program unit 4 bytes Erase and program endurance 100 times(1) Erase and program control method Software commands control erasing and programming on the flash memory Number of commands 9 commands Protect function • Lock bit protect function (All modes) • ROM code protect function (Parallel I/O mode) • ID code check function (Standard serial I/O mode) Flash memory stop function Flash memory can be stopped and initialized Flash memory rewrite mode • CPU rewrite mode • Standard serial I/O mode • Parallel I/O mode NOTE: 1. The erase and program endurance is the number of erase operations performed on individual blocks. For example, if the block A is erased without programming, the erased and program count stands at one for the block A. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 299 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23.1 23. Flash Memory Memory Map The user ROM area has an area to store programs, and another 4-Kbyte areas as the block A and the block B for data storage. The user ROM area can be programmed in CPU rewrite mode, standard serial I/O mode, or parallel I/O mode. The boot ROM area has one 8-Kbyte block and is allocated in addresses FFE000h to FFFFFFh, which overlap with part of the user ROM area . The rewrite control program for the standard serial I/O mode is stored in the boot ROM area. Do not rewrite the boot ROM area. Figure 23.1 shows the flash memory map. 00E000h 00EFFFh 00F000h 00FFFFh Block B: 4 Kbytes Block A: 4 Kbytes FC0000h Block 3: 64 Kbytes FCFFFFh FD0000h Block 2: 64 Kbytes FDFFFFh FE0000h Block 1: 64 Kbytes FEFFFFh FF0000h Block 0: 64 Kbytes FFE000h 8 Kbytes FFFFFFh FFFFFFh User ROM area Boot ROM area(1) NOTES: 1. The rewrite control program for standard serial I/O mode is stored in the boot ROM area before shipment. 2. When specifying a block, use the highest-order even address of the specified block. 3. This is a flash memory map in single-chip mode. Figure 23.1 Flash Memory Map REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 300 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23.2 23. Flash Memory Registers Figures 23.2 to 23.4 show registers associated with the flash memory. Flash Memory Control Register 0 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol Address After Reset FMR0 0057h 0000 0001b Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW FMR00 RY/BY status flag 0: BUSY (programming or erasing in progress) (6) 1: READY RO FMR01 CPU rewrite mode select bit (1)(7) 0: CPU rewrite mode disabled 1: CPU rewrite mode enabled RW FMR02 Lock bit disable select bit (2) 0: Lock bit enabled 1: Lock bit disabled RW FMSTP Flash memory stop bit (3)(5) 0: Flash memory started 1: Flash memory stopped (enters low-power consumption state and flash memory is initialized) RW Reserved bit Set to 0 RW FMR05 User ROM area select bit (3) (available in boot mode only) 0: Boot ROM area accessed 1: User ROM area accessed RW FMR06 Program status flag(4) 0: Successfully completed 1: Terminated by error RO FMR07 Erase status flag (4) 0: Successfully completed 1: Terminated by error RO − (b4) NOTES: 1. Set bits FMR01 and FMR02 while the NMI pin level is held "H". 2. To set the FMR02 bit to 1, write a 1 to the FMR02 bit immediately after writing a 0 to the bit while the FMR01 bit is set to 1. Write the value in 8-bit units. Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two settings. 3. Set bits FMSTP and FMR05 by the program placed in an area other than the flash memory. 4. Bits FMR07 and FMR06 are set to 0 by executing the clear status command. 5. The FMSTP bit is enabled when the FMR01 bit is set to 1 (CPU rewrite mode enabled). Bits FMSTP can be set to 1 even when the FMR01 bit is set to 0, but the flash memory does not enter low-power consumption state nor is initialized. 6. Program and read operations by lock bit program command, read lock bit status command, and protect bit program command are included. 7. To change the FMR01 bit from 0 to 1 , write a 1 to the FMR01 bit immediately after writing a 0 to it. Write the value in 8-bit units. Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two settings. To change the FMR01 bit from 1 to 0 , enter read array mode first, and then write to the address 0057h in 16-bit units. Set the eight high-order bits to 00h. e.g., To change the FMR01 bit from 1 to 0; Assembly language: mov.w #0000h, 0057h Figure 23.2 FMR0 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 301 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23. Flash Memory Flash Memory Control Register 2 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset FMR2 0052h XXXX XXX0b Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW FMR20 Protect bit Writing to the FMR3 register is enabled. 0: Write disable 1: Write enable − (b7-b1) Reserved bits Read as undefined value. RW − Flash Memory Control Register 3(1) b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 0 Symbol Address After Reset FMR3 0050h XX0X XX00b Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW FMR30 EW1 mode select bit 0: EW0 mode 1: EW1 mode RW FMR31 Lock bit read setting bit 0: Read via data bus 1: Read by the FMR16 bit in the FMR1 register RW − (b4-b2) Reserved bits Read as undefined value. RO − (b5) Reserved bit Set to 0 RW − (b7-b6) Reserved bits Read as undefined value. RO NOTE: 1. Write the FMR3 register after the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register is set to 1 (CPU rewrite mode enabled) and the FMR20 bit in the FMR2 register is set to 1 (write enable). After exiting wait mode or stop mode, the FMR3 register becomes the value after reset. Figure 23.3 FMR2 and FMR3 Registers REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 302 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23. Flash Memory Flash Memory Control Register 1 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Symbol Address After Reset 0 FMR1 0055h 0000 XX0Xb 0 0 0 Bit Symbol Bit Name Function RW − (b0) Reserved bit Read as undefined value. − (b1) Reserved bit Set to 0 − (b3-b2) Reserved bits Read as undefined value. − (b5-b4) Reserved bits Set to 0 RW FMR16 Lock bit status flag (1) 0: Locked 1: Unlocked RO Reserved bit Set to 0 RW − (b7) − RW − NOTE: 1. The FMR16 bit is enabled when the FMR31 bit in the FMR3 register is set to 1 ( Read by the FMR16 bit in the FMR1 register). Figure 23.4 FMR1 Register REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 303 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23.3 23. Flash Memory Protect Function There are two types of protect function. One is to protect data from accidentally erase or program on the flash memory, which is provided by the lock bit protect function. The other is to prevent the program code from being leaked to the third party, which is provided by the ROM code protect function and the ID code check function. 23.3.1 Lock bit Protect Function The lock bit protect function is used in any flash memory rewrite mode. This function provides protection against erase or program on a block basis. To use the lock bit protect function, set the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register to 0 (lock bit enabled). Each block in the flash memory has the lock bit. When the lock bit is set to 0 (locked), the block cannot be erased nor programmed. To set the lock bit to 0, execute the lock bit program command in the software command. The FMR31 bit in the FMR3 register determines whether the lock bit status is read via the data bus or by the FMR16 bit in the FMR1 register. When the lock bit program command is executed, the lock bit status is read via the data bus if the FMR31 bit is set to 0, or is stored in the FMR16 bit if the FMR31 bit is set to 1. To disable the lock bit protect function, set the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register to 1 (lock bit disabled). The FMR02 bit diables the lock bit protect function without changing the lock bit status. When the FMR02 bit is set to 1, all the blocks can be erased and programmed regardless of the lock bit status. When the block erase command is executed while the FMR02 bit is set to 1, the lock bit data as well as data in the block are erased and the lock bit becomes 1 (unlocked). 23.3.2 ROM Code Protect Function The ROM code protect function is used in parallel I/O mode. This function provides protection against read and program to all blocks. Each block has two protect bits. Table 23.2 lists addresses of the protect bits. If any of these protect bits is set to 0 (protected), all blocks becomes protected and the parallel programmer cannot read nor program to any areas in the flash memory. To set the protect bit to 0, execute the protect bit program command. To enhance security, set all the protect bits in the flash memory to 0 when using the ROM code protect function. The protect bit status is read via the data bus by executing the read protect bit status command. To disable the ROM code protect function, erase all the blocks whose protect bit is set to 0 by executing the block erase command. All the protect bits of the erased blocks become 1 (unprotected) and the ROM code protect function is disabled. Table 23.2 Address of Protect Bit Block Protect bit 1 Protect bit 0 Block B 00E300h 00E100h Block A 00F300h 00F100h Block 3 FC0300h FC0100h Block 2 FD0300h FD0100h Block 1 FE0300h FE0100h Block 0 FF0300h FF0100h REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 304 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23.3.3 23. Flash Memory ID Code Check Function The ID code check function is used in standard serial I/O mode. The ID code sent from the serial programmer and the ID code written in the user ROM area of the flash memory are checked to see if they match. If these ID codes do not match, the commands sent from the serial programmer are not accepted. However, if the four bytes of the reset vector are set to FFFFFFFFh(1), the ID codes are not checked and all commands can be accepted. The ID code is 7-byte data stored consecutively, beginning with the first byte, into addresses 0FFFFDFh, 0FFFFE3h, 0FFFFEBh, 0FFFFEFh, 0FFFFF3h, 0FFFFF7h, and 0FFFFFBh. To use the ID code check function, write the program which specifies the ID code to these addresses. NOTE: 1. FFFFFFFFh is the factory default setting. Address FFFFDFh to FFFFDCh ID1 Undefined Instruction Vector FFFFE3h to FFFFE0h ID2 Overflow Vector BRK Instruction Vector FFFFE7h to FFFFE4h FFFFEBh to FFFFE8h ID3 FFFFEFh to FFFFECh ID4 FFFFF3h to FFFFF0h ID5 FFFFF7h to FFFFF4h ID6 FFFFFBh to FFFFF8h ID7 FFFFFFh to FFFFFCh Address Match Vector Watchdog Timer Vector NMI Vector Reset Vector 4 bytes Figure 23.5 Addresses for Stored ID Codes REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 305 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23.4 23. Flash Memory Flash Memory Stop Function When the FMSTP bit in the FMR0 register is set to 1 (flash memory stopped), the flash memory control circuit stops and as a result power consumption in the flash memory can be reduced. When the FMSTP bit is set to 1 from 0 (flash memory started), the flash memory control circuit is initialized. Access to the flash memory is disabled when the FMSTP bit is set to 1. Set the FMSTP bit to 1 by the program placed in an area other than the flash memory. Set the FMSTP bit to 1 in one of the following cases in accordance with the procedure shown in Figure 23.6. • A flash memory access error occurs while erasing or programming in EW0 mode (the FMR00 bit does not switch back to 1 (ready)). • To further reduce power consumption in low-power consumption mode or on-chip oscillator low-power consumption mode. The flash memory is automatically turned off when entering wait mode or stop mode, and turned back on when exiting wait mode or stop mode. Set the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register to 0 (CPU rewrite mode disabled) before entering wait mode or stop mode. Start Transfer the program to the internal RAM Jump to the program transferred to the internal RAM Execute the following procedure using the program transferred to the internal RAM <Program transferred to the internal RAM> CPU rewrite mode enabled FMR0 register: FMR01 bit = 0 FMR0 register: FMR01 bit = 1 FMR0 register: FMSTP bit = 1 - To set the FMR01 bit to 1, write a 1 to the FMR01 bit immediately after writing a 0. Write the value to the FMR0 register in 8-bit units. Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two settings. - Set it while "H" is applied to the NMI pin. Flash memory stops operating (Enters low-power consumption state and a flash memory is initialized) Switch the CPU clock source Stop main clock Processing in low-power consumption mode or on-chip oscillator low-power consumption mode When switching the CPU clock source, wait until the new CPU clock source stabilizes. Oscillate main clock Switch the CPU clock source FMR0 register: FMSTP bit = 0 Flash memory starts operating FMR0 register: FMR01 bit = 0 CPU rewrite mode disabled - To change the FMR01 bit from 1 to 0, enter read array mode Wait for tps Jump to a given address in the flash memory End Figure 23.6 Procedure to Stop Flash Memory REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 306 of 385 and then write to address 0057h in 16-bit units. Set the eight high-order bits to 00h. Wait time to stabilize flash memory circuit - Add tps wait time by a program. - Do not access the flash memory during this wait time. Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23.5 23. Flash Memory Boot Mode Use the following procedure to enter boot mode and a program in the boot ROM area is executed. (1) Apply an “L” (pull-down) to the P6_5 pin or apply an “H” (pull-up) to the P6_7 pin (2) Apply an “L” (pull-down) to the EPM (P5_5) pin and apply an “H” (pull-up) to the CE (P5_0) pin (3) Apply an “H” to the CNVSS pin (4) Perform a hardware reset When switching from the boot ROM area to the user ROM area, set the FMR05 bit in the FMR0 register to 1 (access the user ROM area) by the program placed in the area other than the flash memory. The rewrite control program for standard serial I/O mode is stored in the boot ROM area in the factory default configuration. Do not rewrite the boot ROM area. 23.6 Flash Memory Rewrite Mode CPU rewrite mode, standard serial I/O mode, and parallel I/O mode can be used to erase and program the flash memory. Table 23.3 lists overview of flash memory rewrite mode. Table 23.3 Flash Memory Rewrite Mode Overview Flash Memory Rewrite Mode CPU Rewrite Mode Standard Serial I/O Mode Parallel I/O Mode(1) Function User ROM area is programmed by the CPU writing software commands. EW0 mode: Execute the rewrite control program placed in an area other than the flash memory. EW1 mode: Execute the rewrite control program placed in the flash memory. User ROM area is programmed User ROM area is programmed using a dedicated serial using a dedicated parallel programmer. programmer. Standard serial I/O mode 1: Clock synchronous mode in UART1 Standard serial I/O mode 2: Clock asynchronous mode in UART1 Rewritable area User ROM area User ROM area User ROM area Operating mode Single-chip mode Memory expansion mode (EW0 mode) Boot mode Parallel I/O mode Serial programmer Parallel programmer ROM programmer − NOTE: 1. In parallel I/O mode, the boot ROM area can be programmed. However, do not rewrite the boot ROM area since the rewrite control program for standard serial I/O mode is stored in the boot ROM area in the factory default configuration. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 307 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23.6.1 23. Flash Memory CPU Rewrite Mode In CPU rewrite mode, the user ROM area can be programmed by the CPU writing software commands with the MCU mounted on a board. In CPU rewrite mode, only the user ROM area shown in Figure 23.1 can be programmed. The boot ROM area cannot be rewritten. EW0 mode and EW1 mode are provided as CPU rewrite mode. Prior to accessing registers FMR0 to FMR3 or to entering CPU rewrite mode (EW0, EW1 mode), set the CPU clock frequency to 10 MHz or lower using bits MCD4 to MCD0 in the MCD register, and also set the PM12 bit in the PM1 register to 1 (1 wait state). Table 23.4 lists specifications of EW0 mode and EW1 mode. Figure 23.7 shows a setting procedure for EW0 mode. Figure 23.8 shows a setting procedure for EW1 mode. Table 23.4 Specifications of EW0 Mode and EW1 Mode Item EW0 Mode EW1 Mode Operation • Program the user ROM area by executing • Erase and program a block where the the rewrite control program placed in an rewrite control program is not placed, by area other than the flash memory. executing the rewrite control program placed in the user ROM area. Processor mode • Single-chip mode • Memory expansion mode • Single-chip mode Areas where a rewrite program can be stored • User ROM area • User ROM area Software command All commands are available • Program command and block erase command cannot be executed to the block storing a rewrite control program • Read status register command cannot be executed • Read lock bit status command(4), read protect bit status command are executed in the RAM Flash memory mode after Read status register mode erasing or programming Read array mode Flash memory status detection • Read bits FMR00, FMR06, and FMR07 in • Read bits FMR00, FMR06, and FMR07 in the FMR0 register by a program the FMR0 register by a program • Execute the read status register command to read bits SR7, SR5, and SR4 in the SRD register CPU status during erase or program operation Operating In a hold state (CPU stops) (I/O port maintains the status which is before executing a command) Peripheral interrupt request, DMA request, and DMACII request during erase or program operation Acknowledged(2) Not acknowledged(3) NOTES: 1. In both the EW0 mode and EW1 mode, when an NMI interrupt or watchdog timer interrupt is generated, the erase or program operation in progress is aborted and the interrupt is acknowledged. 2. To use peripheral function interrupts, place interrupt routine programs and the relocatable vector table in an area other than flash memory. 3. Do not generate an interrupt (except NMI interrupt and watchdog timer interrupt) or a DMA or DMACII transfer during erase or program operation. 4. When the FMR31 bit in the FMR3 register is 0 (read through the data bus). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 308 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23. Flash Memory Start Transfer the rewrite control program to an area other than the flash memory Jump to the rewrite control program transferred to an area other than the flash memory (Execute the following procedure using the rewrite control program transferred to an area other than the flash memory ) <Rewrite control program> MCD register Set the CPU clock frequency to 10 MHz or lower in CPU rewrite mode PM1 register: PM12 bit = 1 Internal memory wait state inserted <In boot mode> FMR0 register: FMR05 bit = 1 User ROM area accessed CPU rewrite mode enabled FMR0 register: FMR01 bit = 0 FMR0 register: FMR01 bit = 1 - To set the FMR01 bit to 1, write a 1 to the FMR01 bit immediately after writing a 0. Write the value to the FMR0 register in 8-bit units. Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two settings. - Set it while "H" is applied to the NMI pin. Execute the software commands Execute the read array command FMR0 register: FMR01 bit = 0 End Figure 23.7 Setting Procedure for EW0 Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 309 of 385 CPU rewrite mode disabled - To change the FMR01 bit from 1 to 0, enter read array mode and then write to address 0057h in 16-bit units. Set the eight high-order bits to 00h. Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23. Flash Memory Start MCD register Set the CPU clock frequency to 10 MHz or lower in CPU rewrite mode PM1 register: PM12 bit = 1 Internal memory wait state inserted CPU rewrite mode enabled FMR0 register: FMR01 bit = 0 FMR0 register: FMR01 bit = 1 - To set the FMR01 bit to 1, write a 1 to the FMR01 bit immediately after writing a 0. Write the value to the FMR0 register in 8-bit units. Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two setting. - Set it while the NMI pin level is held "H". FMR2 register: FMR20 bit = 1 Enable writing to the FMR3 register FMR3 register: FMR30 bit = 1 Enter EW1 mode - Write a 1 to the FMR30 bit while the FMR01 bit is set to 1. Execute the software commands FMR3 register: FMR30 bit = 0 Exit EW1 mode FMR2 register: FMR20 bit = 0 Disable writing to the FMR3 register FMR0 register: FMR01 bit = 0 CPU rewrite mode disabled - To change the FMR01 bit from 1 to 0, enter read array mode and then write to address 0057h in 16-bit units. Set the eight high-order bits to 00h. End NOTE: 1. Do not use EW1 mode in memory expansion mode or boot mode. Figure 23.8 Setting Procedure for EW1 Mode REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 310 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23.6.1.1 23. Flash Memory Software Commands Write commands or read and write data to the specified even addresses in the user ROM area in 16-bit units. When writing a command code, 8 high-order bits (D15 to D8) are ignored. Table 23.5 Software Commands First Bus Cycle Software Command Mode Address Second Bus Cycle Third Bus Cycle Data Data Data Mode Address Mode Address (D15 to D0) (D15 to D0) (D15 to D0) Read array Write FA xxFFh − − − − − − Read status register Write FA xx70h Read FA SRD − − − Clear status register Write FA xx50h − − − − − − Program Write WA0 xx41h Write WA0 WD0 Write WA1 WD1 Block erase Write FA xx20h Write BA0 xxD0h − − − Write BA0 xxD0h − − − Lock bit program Write BA0 xx77h status(1) Write FA xx71h Write BA0 xxD0h − − − Read lock bit status(2) Write FA xx71h Read BA1 RD0 − − − Protect bit program Write PBA xx67h Write PBA xxD0h − − − FA xx61h Read PBA RD1 − − − Read lock bit Read protect bit status Write FA: Any even address in the user ROM area WA0: 16 low-order bits of write address • Set the lowest 2-bit of the address to 00b. • The address specified in the first bus cycle is the same even address as the write address specified in the second bus cycle. WA1: 16 high-order bits of write address • Set the lowest 2-bit of the address to 10b. • Specify WA0 and WA1 in the consecutive even addresses. BA0: Highest-order even address of a block BA1: Any even address of a block PBA: The protect bit address (See table 23.2) WD0: 16 low-order bit of write data WD1: 16 high-order bit of write data RD0: Read data (bit 6 is the lock bit data) RD1: Read data (bit 6 is the protect bit data) SRD: Data in the Status Register (b7 to b0) xx: 8 high-order bits of command code (ignored) NOTES: 1. When the FMR31 bit in the FMR3 register is set to 1 (read by the FMR16 bit in the FMR1 register). 2. When the FMR31 bit in the FMR3 register is set to 0 (read via the data bus). (1) Read Array Command The read array command is used to read the flash memory. The flash memory enters read array mode when the command code xxFFh is written in the first bus cycle. The content of the specified address can be read in 16-bit units when a read address is specified after the next bus cycle. The flash memory remains in read array mode until the other command is written. Therefore, the contents of multiple addresses can be read in succession. (2) Read Status Register Command The read status register command is used to read the Status Register. When the command code xx70h is written in the first bus cycle, the Status Register can be read after the second bus cycle (refer to 23.6.1.2 Status Register for details). To read the Status Register, read an even address in the user ROM area. Do not execute this command in EW1 mode. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 311 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23. Flash Memory (3) Clear Status Register Command The clear status register command is used to clear the Status Register. When the command code xx50h is written in the first bus cycle, bits FMR07 and FMR06 in the FMR0 register become 00b and bits SR5 and SR4 in the Status Register become 00b. (4) Program Command The program command is used to write data to the flash memory in 4-byte units. A program operation (program and verify data) starts by writing the command code xx41h in the first bus cycle, and data to the 16 low-order bits of write address in the second bus cycle and to the 16 high-order bits of write address in the third bus cycle. The address value specified in the first bus cycle must be the same even address as the 16 low-order bits of write address specified in the second bus cycle. Specify the 16 low-order bits of write address and the 16 high-order bits of write address in the consecutive even addresses. The FMR00 bit in the FMR0 register can be used to determine whether a program operation has been completed or not. The FMR00 bit becomes 0 (busy) during the program operation and becomes 1 (ready) when the program operation is completed. After a program operation is completed, the FMR06 bit in the FMR0 register is used to determine whether a program operation is completed successfully or not. (Refer to 23.6.1.3 Error Check for details.) Do not execute the program command to the same address more than once without executing the block erase command. Figure 23.9 shows a flow chart of the program command. The lock bit can protect each block from being programmed inadvertently. (Refer to 23.3.1 Lock bit Protect Function for details.) In EW1 mode, do not execute this command to the block where the rewrite control program is stored. In EW0 mode, the flash memory enters read status register mode when a program operation starts. Start Write the command code xx41h to the 16 low-order bits of write address Write 16 low-order bits of write data to the 16 loworder bits of write address Write 16 high-order bits of write data to the 16 highorder bits of write address FMR00 = 1? YES Error check End Figure 23.9 Program Command REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 312 of 385 NO Write the command code and data in the even address. Specify the 16 low-order bits of write address and the 16 high-order bits of write address in the consecutive even addresses. Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23. Flash Memory (5) Block Erase Command By writing the command code xx20h in the first bus cycle and xxD0h to the highest-order even address of a block to be erased in the second bus cycle, an erase operation (erase and verify) starts on the specified block. The FMR00 bit in the FMR0 register can be used to determine whether an erase operation has been completed or not. The FMR00 bit becomes 0 (busy) during the erase operation, and becomes 1 (ready) when the erase operation is completed. After the erase operation is completed, the FMR07 bit in the FMR0 register is used to determine whether the erase operation is completed successfully or not. (Refer to 23.6.1.3 Error Check for details.) Figure 23.10 shows a flow chart of block erase command. The lock bit can protect each block from being erased inadvertently. (Refer to 23.3.1 Lock bit Protect Function for details.) In EW1 mode, do not execute this command to the block where the rewrite control program is stored. In EW0 mode, the flash memory enters read status register mode when an erase operation starts. Start Write the command code xx20h Write command code and data to even address Write xxD0h to the highest-order even address of block FMR00 = 1? YES Error check End Figure 23.10 Block Erase Command REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 313 of 385 NO Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23. Flash Memory (6) Lock Bit Program Command The lock bit program command is used to set the lock bit of a given block to 0 (locked). By writing the command code xx77h in the first bus cycle and xxD0h to the highest-order even address of a block to be locked in the second bus cycle, the lock bit of the specified block becomes 0. The address specified in the first bus cycle must be the same highest-order even address of the block specified in the second bus cycle. Figure 23.11 shows a flow chart of lock bit program command. Execute the read lock bit status command to read lock bit status (lock bit data). The FMR00 bit in the FMR0 register can be used to determine whether a lock bit program operation has been completed or not. Refer to 23.3.1 Lock bit Protect Function for information on lock bit functions and how to set it to 1 (unlocked). In EW1 mode, do not execute this command to the block where the rewrite control program is stored. In EW0 mode, the flash memory enters read status register mode when a program operation starts. Start Write the command code xx77h to the highest-order even address of block Write command code and data to the same even address. Write xxD0h to the same highest-order even address of block FMR00 = 1? NO YES Error check End Figure 23.11 Lock Bit Program Command REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 314 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23. Flash Memory (7) Read Lock Bit Status Command The read lock bit status command reads a lock bit status of a given block. If the FMR31 bit in the FMR3 register is set to 1 (read by the FMR16 bit in the FMR1 register), the lock bit status of the specified block is stored into the FMR16 bit by writing the command code xx71h in the first bus cycle and xxD0h to the highest-order even address of the block in the second bus cycle. Read the FMR16 bit after the FMR00 bit in the FMR0 register becomes 1 (ready). If the FMR31 bit in the FMR3 register is set to 0 (read via the data bus), execute the read lock bit status command by the program placed in the RAM. By writing xx71h in the first bus cycle and reading any even address of the specified block in the second bus cycle, the lock bit status of the block can be read by the bit 6 of the read data. When the bit 6 is 0, the block is locked; when the bit 6 is 1, the block is unlocked. Figure 23.12 shows a flow chart of read lock bit status command. [When the FMR31 bit is 1] (Note 3) [When the FMR31 bit is 0] (Note 4) Start Start Write the command code xx71h Write the command code xx71h(2) (Note 1) Write xxD0h to the highest-order even address of block Read any even address of block Read the bit 6 of the read data FMR00 = 1? End NO YES Read FMR16 bit End NOTES: 1. Write command code and data to even address. 2. Write command code and data by the program placed in the RAM. 3. The flash memory enters read array mode after this command is executed. 4. The flash memory enters read lock bit status mode after this command is executed. A lock bit status can be read in succession by reading any even address of the specified block. Figure 23.12 Read Lock Bit Status Command REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 315 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23. Flash Memory (8) Protect Bit Program Command The protect bit program command is used to set the protect bit of a given block to 0 (protected). By writing the command code xx67h in the first bus cycle and xxD0h to the address of the protect bit in the second bus cycle, the protect bit of the specified block becomes 0. The address specified in the first bus cycle must be the same address of the protect bit specified in the second bus cycle. Figure 23.13 shows a flow chart of protect bit program command. Execute the read protect bit status command to read protect bit status (protect bit data). The FMR00 bit in the FMR0 register can be used to determine whether a protect bit program operation has been completed or not. Refer to 23.3.2 ROM Code Protect Function for addresses of the protect bits, information on protect bit functions, and how to set it to 1 (unprotected). In EW1 mode, do not execute this command to the block where the rewrite control program is stored. In EW0 mode, the flash memory enters read status register mode when a program operation starts. Start Write the command code xx67h to the address of the protect bit Write xxD0h to the address of the protect bit FMR00 = 1? NO YES Error check End Figure 23.13 Protect Bit Program Command REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 316 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23. Flash Memory (9) Read Protect Bit Status Command The read protect bit status command reads a protect bit status of a given block. Execute the read protect bit status command by the program placed in the RAM. By writing xx61h in the first bus cycle and reading the protect bit address of the specified block in the second bus cycle, the protect bit status of the block can be read by the bit 6 of the read data. When the bit 6 is 0 (protected), the flash memory is protected by the specified protect bit; when the bit 6 is 1 (unprotected), the flash memory is not protected by the specified protect bit. Figure 23.14 shows a flow chart of read protect bit status command. The flash memory enters read protect bit status mode after this command is executed. A protect bit status can be read in succession by reading a protect bit address. Start Write the command code xx61h Read the protect bit address Read the bit 6 of the read data End Figure 23.14 Read Protect Bit Status Command REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 317 of 385 Write command code to an even address. Write by a program placed in the RAM. Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23.6.1.2 23. Flash Memory Status Register The Status Register can be read in EW0 mode. It indicates the operating status of the flash memory and whether an erase or program operation has completed successfully or not. The Status Register value is reflected on bits FMR00, FMR06, and FMR07 in the FMR0 register. After executing the read status register command, program command, block erase command, lock bit program command, or protect bit program command, the flash memory enters read status register mode and the Status Register returns its value by reading any even address in the user ROM area. Table 23.6 shows the Status Register. Table 23.6 Status Register Bit in Status Register Bit in FMR0 Register Status Name Description SR0 (b0) − SR1 (b1) − 0 1 Value after Reset Reserved bit − − − Reserved bit − − − SR2 (b2) − Reserved bit − − − SR3 (b3) − Reserved bit − − − SR4 (b4) FMR06(1) Program status Successfully completed Error 0 SR5 (b5) FMR07(1) Erase status Successfully completed Error 0 SR6 (b6) − Reserved bit − − − SR7 (b7) FMR00 Sequencer status BUSY READY 1 b7 to b0: These bits return the value of 8 low-order bits by reading an even address of the flash memory in 16-bit units. NOTE: 1. Bits FMR07 (SR5) and FMR06 (SR4) become 0 by executing the clear status register command. When the FMR07 (SR5) or FMR06 (SR4) bit is 1, the program command, block erase command, lock bit program command, read lock bit status command, and protect bit program command cannot be accepted by the flash memory. 23.6.1.3 Error Check To confirm whether the program command, block erase command, lock bit program command, or protect bit program command is executed successfully, read bits FMR07 and FMR06 in the FMR0 register after each operation is completed. Table 23.7 lists error types and occurrence conditions. Figure 23.15 shows a flow chart of the error check and handling procedure for each error. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 318 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 23.7 23. Flash Memory Error Types and Occurrence Conditions FMR0 Register (Status Register) values FMR07 (SR5) 1 1 0 Error Error Occurrence Condition Command sequence error • When a command is written incorrectly • When invalid data (data other than xxD0h or xxFFh) is written in the second bus cycle of the lock bit program command, block erase command, read lock bit status command, or protect bit program command(1) Erase error • When the block erase command is executed to a locked block(2) • When the block erase command is executed to an unlocked block, but the erase operation is not completed successfully Program error • When the program command is executed to a locked block(2) • When the program command is executed to an unlocked block, but the program operation is not completed successfully • The lock bit program command is executed, but the program operation is not completed successfully • The protect bit program command is executed, but the program operation is not completed successfully FMR06 (SR4) 1 0 1 NOTES: 1. The flash memory enters read array mode when the command code xxFFh is written in the second bus cycle of these commands. At the same time, the command code written in the first bus cycle is ignored. 2. When the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register is set to 1 (lock bit disabled), no error occurs under these conditions. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 319 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23. Flash Memory Start FMR06 = 1 and FMR07 = 1? YES (1) Execute the clear status register command to set bits FMR06 and FMR07 to 0 (successfully completed). (2) Check if the command is written correctly and execute the correct command. NO FMR07 = 0 ? NO Erase error (1) Execute the clear status register command to set the erase status flag to 0 (successfully completed). (2) Execute the read lock bit status command. Set the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register to 1 (lock bit disabled) if the lock bit of the block where the error has occurred is set to 0 (locked). (3) Execute the block erase command again. NOTE: 1. If an error still occurs, the block in error cannot be used. YES FMR06 = 0 ? Command sequence error NO YES Program error [When a program operation is executed] (1) Execute the clear status register command to set the program status flag to 0. (2) Execute the read lock bit status command. Set the FMR02 bit to 1 if the lock bit of the block where the error has occurred is set to 0. If the lock bit is set to 1 (unlocked), the address in which error has occurred cannot be used as it is. Execute the block erase command to erase the block, in which error has occurred, before executing the program command to program to the same address again. (3) Execute the program command again. NOTE: 2. If an error still occurs, the address in error cannot be used. [When lock bit program or protect bit program command is executed] (1) Execute the clear status register command to set the program status flag to 0. (2) Set the FMR02 bit to 1. (3) Execute the block erase command to erase the block where the error has occurred. (4) Execute the lock bit program command or protect bit program command again after programming data. NOTE: 3. If an error still occurs, the block in error cannot be used. End NOTE: 4. When either the FMR06 or FMR07 bit is 1 (terminated by error), the program command, block erase command, lock bit program command, read lock bit status command and protect bit program command cannot be accepted. Execute the clear status register command before executing these commands. Figure 23.15 Error Check and Handling Procedure for Each Error REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 320 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23.6.2 23. Flash Memory Standard Serial I/O Mode In standard serial I/O mode, the user ROM area can be programmed with the MCU mounted on a board by using a serial programmer supporting the M32C/8B Group. For additional information about the serial programmer, contact your serial programmer manufacturer. Refer to the user’s manual of your serial programmer for details on operating instructions. Table 23.8 lists pin functions for flash memory standard serial I/O mode. Figures 23.16 to 23.17 show pin connections for standard serial I/O mode. Table 23.8 Pin Name Pin Functions for Flash Memory Standard Serial I/O Mode Function Input/ Output Supply Voltage Description Power supply input I − Apply the guaranteed erase/program supply voltage to the VCC1 pin. Apply 0 V to the VSS pin CNVSS CNVSS I VCC1 Apply an “H” signal to the pin RESET Reset input I VCC1 Reset input pin XIN Clock input I VCC1 Connect a ceramic resonator or a crystal oscillator between pins XIN and XOUT XOUT Clock output O VCC1 To use the external clock, input the clock to the XIN pin and leave the XOUT pin open BYTE BYTE input I VCC1 Apply an “H” or “L” signal to the pin AVCC, AVSS Analog power supply input I − Connect AVCC to VCC1 Connect AVSS to VSS VREF Reference voltage input I − Reference voltage input pin for the A/D converter P0_0 to P0_7 Input port P0 I VCC2 Apply an “H” or “L” signal to the pin, or leave it open P1_0 to P1_7 Input port P1 I VCC2 Apply an “H” or “L” signal to the pin, or leave it open P2_0 to P2_7 Input port P2 I VCC2 Apply an “H” or “L” signal to the pin, or leave it open P3_0 to P3_7 Input port P3 I VCC2 Apply an “H” or “L” signal to the pin, or leave it open P4_0 to P4_7 Input port P4 I VCC2 Apply an “H” or “L” signal to the pin, or leave it open P5_0 VCC VSS CE input I VCC2 Apply an “H” signal to the pin P5_5 EPM input I VCC2 Apply an “L” signal to the pin P5_1 to P5_4 P5_6, P5_7 Input port P5 I VCC2 Apply an “H” or “L” signal to the pin, or leave it open P6_0 to P6_3 Input port P6 I VCC1 Apply an “H” or “L” signal to the pin, or leave it open P6_4 BUSY output O VCC1 Standard serial I/O mode 1: BUSY signal output pin Standard serial I/O mode 2: Program operation verify monitor P6_5 SCLK input I VCC1 Standard serial I/O mode 1: Serial clock input pin. This pin needs to be pulled up. Standard serial I/O mode 2: Apply an “L” signal to the pin P6_6 Data input RXD I VCC1 Serial data input pin P6_7 Data output TXD O VCC1 Serial data output pin. This pin needs to be pulled up when used in standard serial I/O mode1. P7_0 to P7_7 Input port P7 I VCC1 Apply an “H” or “L” signal to the pin, or leave it open P8_0 to P8_4 P8_6, P8_7 Input port P8 I VCC1 Apply an “H” or “L” signal to the pin, or leave it open P8_5 NMI input I VCC1 Apply an “H” signal P9_0 to P9_7 Input port P9 I VCC1 Apply an “H” or “L” signal to the pin, or leave it open P10_0 to P10_7 Input port P10 I VCC1 Apply an “H” or “L” signal to the pin, or leave it open P11_0 to P11_7 Input port P11 I VCC2 Apply an “H” or “L” signal to the pin, or leave it open(1) P12_0 to P12_7 Input port P12 I VCC2 Apply an “H” or “L” signal to the pin, or leave it open(1) P13_0 to P13_7 Input port P13 I VCC2 Apply an “H” or “L” signal to the pin, or leave it open(1) P14_0 to P14_7 Input port P14 I VCC1 Apply an “H” or “L” signal to the pin, or leave it open(1) P15_0 to P15_7 Input port P15 I VCC1 Apply an “H” or “L” signal to the pin, or leave it open(1) NOTE: 1. These pins are provided in the 144-pin package only. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 321 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23. Flash Memory Mode setting Signal CNVSS EPM RESET CE Value VCC1 VSS VSS→VCC1 VCC2 VCC2 75 74 73 72 71 70 69 68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 76 50 77 49 78 48 79 47 80 46 81 45 82 44 83 43 84 42 85 41 86 CE 40 M32C/8B Group (100-pin package) Flash Memory Version PLQP0100KB-A(100P6Q-A) 87 88 89 39 37 90 36 91 35 92 34 93 33 94 32 95 31 96 30 97 29 98 28 99 27 100 EPM 38 BUSY SCLK RXD TXD 26 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 VSS VCC1 CNVSS Connect an oscillation circuit RESET Figure 23.16 Pin Connections in Standard Serial I/O Mode (1) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 322 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23. Flash Memory Mode setting Signal CNVSS EPM RESET CE Value VCC1 VSS VSS→VCC1 VCC2 VCC2 108 107 106 105 104 103 102 101 100 99 98 97 96 95 94 93 92 91 90 89 88 87 86 85 84 83 82 81 80 79 78 77 76 75 74 73 109 110 111 112 113 114 115 116 117 118 119 120 121 122 123 124 125 126 127 128 129 130 131 132 133 134 135 136 137 138 139 140 141 142 143 144 M32C/8B Group (144-pin package) Flash Memory Version PLQP0144KA-A(144P6Q-A) 72 71 70 69 68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 CE EPM BUSY SCLK RXD TXD 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 VSS VCC1 CNVSS Connect an oscillation circuit RESET Figure 23.17 Pin Connections in Standard Serial I/O Mode (2) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 323 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23.6.2.1 23. Flash Memory Pin Handling in Standard Serial I/O Mode Figure 23.18 shows an example of a pin handling in standard serial I/O mode 1. Figure 23.19 shows an example of a pin handling in standard serial I/O mode 2. Refer to the user’s manual of your serial programmer to handle pins controlled by the serial programmer since controlled pins vary depending on the serial programmer. MCU VCC1 Clock input VCC2 SCLK CE(P5_0) VCC1 EPM(P5_5) Data output VCC1 TXD BUSY output BUSY CNVSS Data input RXD VCC1 VCC1 Reset input RESET NMI User reset signal NOTES: 1. Control pins and external circuit vary depending on the programmer. Refer to the user's manual of the programmer for information. 2. In this example, a selector controls the input voltage applied to CNVSS to switch between single-chip mode and standard serial I/O mode. 3. If there is a possibility the user reset signal becomes "L" in standard serial I/O mode 1, break the connection between the user reset signal and the RESET pin by using such as a jumper selector. Figure 23.18 Pin Handling in Standard Serial I/O Mode 1 MCU VCC2 SCLK CE(P5_0) EPM(P5_5) Data output VCC1 TXD Monitor output BUSY CNVSS Data input RXD VCC1 VCC1 Reset input RESET NMI User reset signal NOTE: 1. In this example, a selector controls the input voltage applied to CNVSS to switch between single-chip mode and standard serial I/O mode. Figure 23.19 Pin Handling in Standard Serial I/O Mode 2 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 324 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 23.6.3 23. Flash Memory Parallel I/O Mode In parallel I/O mode, the user ROM area can be programmed by using a parallel programmer supporting the M32C/ 8B Group. The boot ROM area can also be programmed. However, do not rewrite the boot ROM area since the rewrite control program for standard serial I/O mode is stored in the boot ROM area in the factory default configuration. For additional information about the parallel programmer, contact your parallel programmer manufacturer. Refer to the user's manual of your parallel programmer for details on operating instructions. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 325 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics 24. Electrical Characteristics Table 24.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings Symbol Parameter Condition Value Unit VCC1, VCC2 Supply voltage VCC1 = AVCC -0.3 to 6.0 V VCC2 Supply voltage − -0.3 to VCC1 + 0.1 V AVCC Analog supply voltage VCC1 = AVCC -0.3 to 6.0 V VI Input voltage RESET, CNVSS, BYTE, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(1), VREF, XIN -0.3 to VCC1 + 0.3 V P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7(1) -0.3 to VCC2 + 0.3 P7_0, P7_1 VO Output voltage -0.3 to 6.0 P6_0 to P6_7, P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7, P14_0 to 14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(1), XOUT -0.3 to VCC1 + 0.3 P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7(1) -0.3 to VCC2 + 0.3 P7_0, P7_1 Pd Power consumption Topr Operating ambient temperature Tstg -0.3 to 6.0 -40°C≤Topr≤85°C during CPU operation during programming or erasing Flash memory Storage temperature NOTES: 1. P11 to P15 are provided in the 144-pin package only. 2. Contact a Renesas sales office if temperature range of -40 to 85°C is required. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 326 of 385 V 500 mW -20 to 85/ -40 to 85(2) °C 0 to 60 °C -65 to 150 °C Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 24.2 24. Electrical Characteristics Recommended Operating Conditions (1/3) (VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.0 to 5.5 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C unless otherwise specified) Symbol Parameter VCC1, VCC2 Supply voltage (VCC1 ≥ VCC2) AVCC Analog supply voltage Standard Min. Typ. Max. 3.0 5.0 5.5 VCC1 Unit V V VSS Supply voltage 0 V AVSS Analog supply voltage 0 V VIH 0.8VCC2 Input high “H” P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, voltage P5_0 to P5_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7(2) VCC2 0.8VCC1 P6_0 to P6_7, P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7(1), P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(2), XIN, RESET, CNVSS, BYTE VCC1 P7_0, P7_1 VIL Input low “L” voltage 0.8VCC1 V 6.0 P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7 (in single-chip mode) 0.8VCC2 VCC2 P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7 (in memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode) 0.5VCC2 VCC2 P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7(2) 0 0.2VCC2 P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7(1), P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(2), XIN, RESET, CNVSS, BYTE 0 0.2VCC1 P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7 (in single-chip mode) 0 0.2VCC2 P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7 (in memory expansion mode and microprocessor mode) 0 0.16VCC2 V NOTES: 1. VIH and VIL reference for P8_7 apply when P8_7 is used as a programmable input port. It does not apply when P8_7 is used as XCIN. 2. P11 to P15 are provided in the 144-pin package only. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 327 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 24.3 24. Electrical Characteristics Recommended Operating Conditions (2/3) (VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.0 to 5.5 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C unless otherwise specified) Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Typ. Max. Unit IOH(peak) Peak output high “H” current(2) P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(3) -10.0 mA IOH(avg) Average output high “H” current(1) P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(3) -5.0 mA IOL(peak) Peak output low “L” current(2) P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(3) 10.0 mA IOL(avg) Average P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, output low “L” P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, current(1) P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(3) 5.0 mA NOTES: 1. Average output current is the average value within 100 ms. 2. A total IOL(peak) of P0, P1, P2, P8_6, P8_7, P9, P10, P11, P14, and P15 must be 80 mA or less. A total IOL(peak) of P3, P4, P5, P6, P7,P8_0 to P8_4, P12, and P13 must be 80 mA or less. A total IOH(peak) of P0, P1, P2, and P11 must be -40 mA or less. A total IOH(peak) of P8_6 to P8_7, P9, P10, P14, and P15 must be -40 mA or less. A total IOH(peak) of P3, P4, P5, P12, and P13 must be -40 mA or less. A total IOH(peak) of P6, P7, and P8_0 to P8_4 must be -40 mA or less. 3. P11 to P15 are provided in the 144-pin package only. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 328 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Table 24.4 24. Electrical Characteristics Recommended Operating Conditions (3/3) (VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.0 to 5.5 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C unless otherwise specified) Symbol Standard Parameter Min. Typ. Unit Max. f(CPU) CPU clock frequency (same frequency as f(BCLK)) VCC1 = 3.0 to 5.5V 0 32 MHz f(XIN) Main clock input frequency VCC1 = 3.0 to 5.5V 0 16 MHz f(XCIN) Sub clock frequency 32.768 50 kHz f(Ring) On-chip oscillator frequency 1 2 MHz f(PLL) PLL clock frequency VCC1 = 3.0 to 5.5V 32 MHz tsu(PLL) Wait time to stabilize PLL frequency synthesizer VCC1 = 5.0V 20 ms VCC1 = 3.3V 50 ms Table 24.5 Symbol − − − − − 0.5 10 Flash Memory Electrical Characteristics (VCC1 = 3.0 V to 5.5 V, Topr = 0 to 60°C unless otherwise specified) Parameter Measurement Condition Min. Standard Typ. Max. CPU clock frequency (in CPU rewrite mode)(2) Erase and program 10 endurance(1) Program time (4 bytes) (Topr = 25°C) Lock bit program time Block erase time (Topr = 25°C) tps Wait time to stabilize flash memory circuit − Data hold time (Topr = -40 to 85°C) 100 Unit MHz times Other than Data flash 150 900 Data flash 300 1700 Other than Data flash 70 500 Data flash 140 1000 4-Kbyte block 0.2 3 s 8-Kbyte block 0.2 3 s 64-Kbyte block 0.2 3 s 50 μs 10 μs μs years NOTES: 1. If erase and program endurance is n times (n = 100), each block can be erased n times. For example, if a 4Kbyte block A is erased after programming four-byte data 1,024 times, each to a different address, this counts as one erase and program time. Data cannot be programmed to the same address more than once without erasing the block (rewrite prohibited). 2. Prior to accessing registers FMR0 to FMR3 or to entering CPU rewrite mode (EW0, EW1 mode), set the CPU clock frequency to 10 MHz or lower using bits MCD4 to MCD0 in the MCD register, and also set the PM12 bit in the PM1 register to 1 (1 wait state). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 329 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 5V Table 24.6 Electrical Characteristics (1/3) (VCC1 = VCC2 = 4.2 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C, f(CPU) = 32 MHz unless otherwise specified) Symbol VOH Parameter Output high “H” voltage Max. VCC2 - 2.0 VCC2 P6_0 to P6_7, P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7,P10_0 to P10_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(1) IOH = -5 mA VCC1 - 2.0 VCC1 P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7 IOH = -200 μA VCC2 - 0.3 P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7(1) VCC2 P6_0 to P6_7, P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4, IOH = -200 μA VCC1 - 0.3 P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7,P10_0 to P10_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(1) VCC1 XOUT VCC1 IOH = -1 mA V V V No load applied 2.5 V Drive capability = low No load applied 1.7 V XOUT XCOUT 3.0 Unit Drive capability = high Output low P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, “L” voltage P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7,P10_0 to P10_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(1) Hysteresis Typ. IOH = -5 mA P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7,P10_0 to P10_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(1) VT+ - VT- Standard Min. P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7(1) XCOUT VOL Condition IOL = 5 mA 2.0 V IOL = 200 μA 0.45 V IOL = 1 mA 2.0 V Drive capability = high No load applied 0 V Drive capability = low No load applied 0 V HOLD, RDY, TA0IN to TA4IN, TB0IN to TB5IN, INT0 to INT5, ADTRG, CTS0 to CTS4, CLK0 to CLK4, TA0OUT to TA4OUT, NMI, KI0 to KI3, RXD0 to RXD4, SCL0 to SCL4, SDA0 to SDA4 0.2 1.0 V RESET 0.2 1.8 V NOTE: 1. P11 to P15 are provided in the 144-pin package only. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 330 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 5V Table 24.7 Electrical Characteristics (2/3) (VCC1 = VCC2 = 4.2 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C, f(CPU) = 32 MHz unless otherwise specified) Symbol Parameter Condition Standard Min. Typ. Max. Unit IIH Input high “H” current P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(1), XIN, RESET, CNVSS, BYTE VI = 5 V 5.0 μA IIL Input low “L” P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, current P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(1), XIN, RESET, CNVSS, BYTE VI = 0V -5.0 μA 170 kΩ RPULLUP Pull-up resistance P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7,P10_0 to P10_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(1) RfXIN Feedback resistance XIN 1.5 MΩ RfXCIN Feedback resistance XCIN 15 MΩ VRAM RAM data retention voltage In stop mode NOTE: 1. P11 to P15 are provided in the 144-pin package only. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 331 of 385 VI = 0V 30 2.0 50 V Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 5V Table 24.8 Electrical Characteristics (3/3) (VCC1 = VCC2 = 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = 25°C) Condition(1) Symbol Parameter ICC Power supply current f(CPU) = 32 MHz f(CPU) = 16 MHz f(CPU) = 8 MHz f(CPU) = f(Ring)(3) In on-chip oscillator low-power consumption mode In on-chip oscillator low-power consumption mode, flash memory is stopped(2) f(CPU) = 32 kHz(4) In low-power consumption mode, flash memory is operating f(CPU) = 32 kHz(5) In low-power consumption mode, flash memory is stopped(2) Wait mode: f(CPU) = f(Ring) After entering wait mode from on-chip oscillator low-power consumption mode Wait mode: f(CPU) = 32kHz(6) After entering wait mode from low-power consumption mode Stop mode (clock is stopped) Stop mode (clock is stopped) Topr = 85°C Standard Unit Min. Typ. Max. 26 42 mA 16 mA 10 mA 1.5 mA 400 μA 430 μA 50 μA 110 μA 10 μA 4 TBD TBD μA μA NOTES: 1. In single-chip mode, leave the output pins open and connect the input pins to VSS. 2. When setting the FMSTP bit in the FMR0 register to 1 (flash memory stopped) and running the program on RAM. 3. When the FMR40 bit in the FMR4 register is set to 1 (low-speed access). 4. When the FMR40 bit is set to 1 and the MRS bit in the VRCR register is set to 1 (main voltage regulator stops). 5. When the MRS bit is set to 1. 6. When the MRS bit is set to 1 and the CM0 bit in the CM03 register is set to 0 (XCIN-XCOUT drive capability Low). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 332 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 5V Table 24.9 A/D Conversion Characteristics (VCC1 = VCC2 = AVCC = VREF = 4.2 to 5.5 V, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C, f(CPU) = 32MHz unless otherwise specified) Symbol Parameter Measurement Condition − Resolution VREF = VCC1 INL Integral nonlinearity error VREF = VCC1 = VCC2 = 5 V Standard Min. Typ. Max. Unit 10 Bits AN_0 to AN_7, AN0_0 to AN0_7, AN2_0 to AN2_7, AN15_0 to AN15_7, ANEX0, ANEX1 ±3 LSB External op-amp connection mode ±7 LSB DNL Differential nonlinearity error ±1 LSB − Offset error ±3 LSB − Gain error ±3 LSB 20 kΩ RLADDER Resistor ladder VREF = VCC1 4 tCONV 10-bit conversion 2.06 μs tCONV 8-bit conversion time(1)(2) 1.75 μs tSAMP Sampling time(1) 0.188 μs VREF Reference voltage 3 VCC1 V VIA Analog input voltage 0 VREF V time(1)(2) NOTES: 1. The value is obtained when φAD frequency is at 16 MHz. Keep φAD frequency at 16 MHz or lower. 2. With using the sample and hold function Table 24.10 Symbol D/A Conversion Characteristics (VCC1 = VCC2 = VREF = 4.2 to 5.5 V, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C, f(CPU) = 32MHz unless otherwise specified) Parameter − Resolution − Absolute accuracy tsu Setup time RO Output resistance IVREF Reference power supply input current Measurement Condition Standard Min. 4 (note 1) Typ. 10 Max. Unit 8 Bits 1.0 % 3 μs 20 kΩ 1.5 mA NOTE: 1. Measured when one D/A converter is used, and the DAi register (i = 0, 1) of the unused D/A converter is set to 00h. The current flown into the resistor ladder in the A/D converter is excluded. IVREF flows even if the VCUT bit in the AD0CON1 register is set to 0 (VREF not connected) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 333 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 5V Table 24.11 Voltage Detection Circuit Electrical Characteristics (VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.0 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = 25°C unless otherwise specified) Symbol ΔVdet Table 24.12 Symbol Standard Parameter Min. Detection voltage level accuracy Typ. VCC1 = 3.0 V to 5.5 V Max. ±0.20 Unit V Power Supply Timing Characteristics Parameter Measurement Condition Standard Min. Typ. Max. Unit td(P-R) Wait time to stabilize internal supply voltage when power-on VCC1 = 3.0 to 5.5 V 2 ms td(E-A) Start-up time for Vdet detection circuit VCC1 = 3.0 to 5.5 V 150 μs td(P-R) Wait time to stabilize internal supply voltage when power-on Recommended operating voltage VCC1 td(P-R) CPU clock td(E-A) Start-up time for Vdet detection circuit VDEN Vdet detection circuit Stop Operating td(E-A) Figure 24.1 Power Supply Timing Diagram REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 334 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 5V Timing Requirements (VCC1 = VCC2 = 4.2 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C unless otherwise specified) Table 24.13 External Clock Input Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tc External clock input cycle time 62.5 ns tw(H) External clock input high (“H”) pulse width 27.5 ns tw(L) External clock input low (“L”) pulse width 27.5 ns tr External clock rise time 5 ns tf External clock fall time 5 ns Table 24.14 Timer A Input (Count Source Input in Event Counter Mode) Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tc(TA) TAiIN input cycle time 100 ns tw(TAH) TAiIN input high (“H”) pulse width 40 ns tw(TAL) TAiIN input low (“L”) pulse width 40 ns i = 0 to 4 Table 24.15 Timer A Input (Gate Signal Input in Timer Mode) Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tc(TA) TAiIN input cycle time 400 ns tw(TAH) TAiIN input high (“H”) pulse width 200 ns tw(TAL) TAiIN input low (“L”) pulse width 200 ns i = 0 to 4 Table 24.16 Timer A Input (External Trigger Input in One-Shot Timer Mode) Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tc(TA) TAiIN input cycle time 200 ns tw(TAH) TAiIN input high (“H”) pulse width 100 ns tw(TAL) TAiIN input low (“L”) pulse width 100 ns i = 0 to 4 Table 24.17 Timer A Input (External Trigger Input in Pulse Width Modulation Mode) Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tw(TAH) TAiIN input high (“H”) pulse width 100 ns tw(TAL) TAiIN input low (“L”) pulse width 100 ns i = 0 to 4 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 335 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 5V Timing Requirements (VCC1 = VCC2 = 4.2 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C unless otherwise specified) Table 24.18 Timer A Input (Counter Increment/Decrement Input in Event Counter Mode) Symbol tc(UP) Parameter TAiOUT input cycle time Standard Min. Max. 2000 Unit ns tw(UPH) TAiOUT input high (“H”) pulse width 1000 ns tw(UPL) TAiOUT input low (“L”) pulse width 1000 ns tsu(UP-TIN) TAiOUT input setup time 400 ns th(TIN-UP) TAiOUT input hold time 400 ns i = 0 to 4 Table 24.19 Timer A Input (Two-Phase Pulse Input in Event Counter Mode) Symbol tc(TA) Parameter TAiIN input cycle time Standard Min. Max. Unit 800 ns tsu(TAIN-TAOUT) TAiOUT input setup time 200 ns tsu(TAOUT-TAIN) TAiIN input setup time 200 ns i = 0 to 4 Table 24.20 Timer B Input (Count Source Input in Event Counter Mode) Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tc(TB) TBiIN input cycle time (counted on one edge) 100 ns tw(TBH) TBiIN input high (“H”) pulse width (counted on one edge) 40 ns tw(TBL) TBiIN input low (“L”) pulse width (counted on one edge) 40 ns tc(TB) TBiIN input cycle time (counted on both edges) 200 ns tw(TBH) TBiIN input high (“H”) pulse width (counted on both edges) 80 ns tw(TBL) TBiIN input low (“L”) pulse width (counted on both edges) 80 ns i = 0 to 5 Table 24.21 Timer B Input (Pulse Period Measurement Mode) Symbol tc(TB) Parameter TBiIN input cycle time Standard Min. Max. Unit 400 ns tw(TBH) TBiIN input high (“H”) pulse width 200 ns tw(TBL) TBiIN input low (“L”) pulse width 200 ns i = 0 to 5 Table 24.22 Timer B Input (Pulse Width Measurement Mode) Symbol tc(TB) Parameter TBiIN input cycle time Standard Min. Max. Unit 400 ns tw(TBH) TBiIN input high (“H”) pulse width 200 ns tw(TBL) TBiIN input low (“L”) pulse width 200 ns i = 0 to 5 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 336 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 5V Timing Requirements (VCC1 = VCC2 = 4.2 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C unless otherwise specified) Table 24.23 A/D Trigger Input Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tc(AD) ADTRG input cycle time (required for trigger) 1000 ns tw(ADL) ADTRG input low (“L”) pulse width 125 ns Table 24.24 Serial Interface Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tc(CK) CLKi input cycle time 200 ns tw(CKH) CLKi input high (“H”) pulse width 100 ns tw(CKL) CLKi input low (“L”) pulse width 100 ns td(C-Q) TXDi output delay time th(C-Q) TXDi output hold time tsu(D-C) RXDi input setup time 30 ns th(C-D) RXDi input hold time 90 ns 80 0 ns ns i=0 to 4 Table 24.25 External Interrupt INTi Input (Edge Sensitive) Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tw(INH) INTi input high (“H”) pulse width 250 ns tw(INL) INTi input low (“L”) pulse width 250 ns i=0 to 5 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 337 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 5V Timing Requirements (VCC1 = VCC2 = 4.2 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C unless otherwise specified) Table 24.26 Memory Expansion mode and Microprocessor Mode Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tac1(RD-DB) Data input access time (RD standard) (note 1) ns tac1(AD-DB) Data input access time (AD standard, CS standard) (note 1) ns (note 1) ns (note 1) ns tac2(RD-DB) tac2(AD-DB) Data input access time (RD standard, when accessing a space with the multiplexed bus) Data input access time (AD standard, when accessing a space with the multiplexed bus) tsu(DB-BCLK) Data input setup time 26 ns tsu(RDY-BCLK) RDY input setup time 26 ns 30 ns tsu(HOLD-BCLK) HOLD input setup time th(RD-DB) Data input hold time 0 ns th(BCLK-RDY) RDY input hold time 0 ns th(BCLK-HOLD) HOLD input hold time 0 ns td(BCLK-HLDA) HLDA output delay time 25 ns NOTE: 1. Values, which depend on BCLK frequency and external bus cycles, can be obtained from the following equations. Insert wait states or lower the operation frequency, f(BCLK), if the calculated value is negative. tac1(RD-DB) = 109 × m f(BCLK) × 2 - 35 [ns] (if external bus cycle is aφ + bφ, m = (b × 2) + 1) tac1(AD-DB) = 109 × n f(BCLK) tac2(RD-DB) = 109 × m f(BCLK) × 2 - 35 [ns] (if external bus cycle is aφ + bφ, m = (b × 2) - 1) tac2(AD-DB) = 109 × p f(BCLK) × 2 - 35 [ns] (if external bus cycle is aφ + bφ, p = {(a + b - 1) × 2} + 1) - 35 [ns] (if external bus cycle is aφ + bφ, n = a + b) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 338 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 5V Switching Characteristics (VCC1 = VCC2 = 4.2 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C unless otherwise specified) Table 24.27 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (when accessing external memory space) Symbol Measurement Condition Parameter td(BCLK-AD) Address output delay time th(BCLK-AD) Address output hold time (BCLK standard) 18 standard)(3) th(RD-AD) Address output hold time (RD th(WR-AD) Address output hold time (WR standard)(3) td(BCLK-CS) Chip-select signal output delay time th(BCLK-CS) Chip-select signal output hold time (BCLK standard) Chip-select signal output hold time (RD th(WR-CS) Chip-select signal output hold time (WR standard)(3) td(BCLK-RD) RD signal output delay time th(BCLK-RD) RD signal output hold time td(BCLK-WR) WR signal output delay time th(BCLK-WR) WR signal output hold time td(DB-WR) Data output delay time (WR standard) Data output hold time (WR tw(WR) WR output width See Figure 24.2 0 ns ns ns 0 ns (note 1) ns 18 109 f(BCLK) × 2 18 109 f(BCLK) × 2 - 10 [ns] th(WR-CS) = 109 f(BCLK) × 2 - 10 [ns] ns (note 2) ns (note 1) ns (note 2) ns 2. Values, which depend on BCLK frequency and external bus cycles, can be obtained from the following equations. td(DB-WR) = tw(WR) = 109 × m f(BCLK) 109 × n f(BCLK) × 2 - 20 [ns] (if external bus cycle is aφ + bφ, m = b) - 15 [ns] (if external bus cycle is aφ + bφ, n = (b × 2) - 1) 3. tc [ns] is added when recovery cycle is inserted. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 339 of 385 ns -5 - 10 [ns] th(WR-AD) = ns ns NOTES: 1. Values, which depend on BCLK frequency, can be obtained from the following equations. th(WR-DB) = ns -3 -5 standard)(3) ns ns (note 1) standard)(3) Unit -3 18 th(RD-CS) th(WR-DB) Standard Min. Max. Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 5V Switching Characteristics (VCC1 = VCC2 = 4.2 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C unless otherwise specified) Table 24.28 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (when accessing external memory space with multiplexed bus) Symbol Parameter Measurement Condition Standard Min. Max. 18 Unit td(BCLK-AD) Address output delay time th(BCLK-AD) Address output hold time (BCLK standard) -3 ns th(RD-AD) Address output hold time (RD standard)(5) (note 1) ns th(WR-AD) Address output hold time (WR standard)(5) (note 1) ns td(BCLK-CS) Chip-select signal output delay time th(BCLK-CS) Chip-select signal output hold time (BCLK standard) -3 ns th(RD-CS) Chip-select signal output hold time (RD standard)(5) (note 1) ns th(WR-CS) Chip-select signal output hold time (WR standard)(5) (note 1) ns td(BCLK-RD) RD signal output delay time th(BCLK-RD) RD signal output hold time td(BCLK-WR) WR signal output delay time th(BCLK-WR) WR signal output hold time td(DB-WR) th(WR-DB) td(BCLK-ALE) ALE signal output delay time (BCLK standard) th(BCLK-ALE) ALE signal output hold time (BCLK standard) td(AD-ALE) th(ALE-AD) tdz(RD-AD) Address output float start time 18 18 See Figure 24.2 -5 ns ns ns ns 18 ns -5 ns Data output delay time (WR standard) (note 2) ns Data output hold time (WR standard)(5) (note 1) ns 18 ns -2 ns ALE signal output delay time (address standard) (note 3) ns ALE signal output hold time (address standard) (note 4) ns 8 ns NOTES: 1. Values, which depend on BCLK frequency, can be obtained from the following equations. th(RD-AD) = 109 f(BCLK) × 2 - 10 [ns] th(WR-AD) = 109 f(BCLK) × 2 - 10 [ns] th(RD-CS) = 109 f(BCLK) × 2 - 10 [ns] th(WR-CS) = 109 f(BCLK) × 2 - 10 [ns] th(WR-DB) = 109 f(BCLK) × 2 - 10 [ns] 2. Values, which depend on BCLK frequency and external bus cycles, can be obtained from the following equation. td(DB-WR) = 109 × m f(BCLK) × 2 - 25 [ns] (if external bus cycle is aφ + bφ, m = (b × 2) - 1) 3. Values, which depend on BCLK frequency and external bus cycles, can be obtained from the following equation. td(AD-ALE) = 109 × n f(BCLK) × 2 - 20 [ns] (if external bus cycle is aφ + bφ, n = a) 4. Values, which depend on BCLK frequency and external bus cycles, can be obtained from the following equation. th(ALE-AD) = 109 × n f(BCLK) × 2 - 10 [ns] (if external bus cycle is aφ + bφ, n = a) 5. tc [ns] is added when recovery cycle is inserted. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 340 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics P0 P1 P2 P3 P4 P5 P6 P7 P8 P9 P10 P11 P12 P13 P14 P15 30 pF Note 1 NOTE: 1. P11 to P15 are provided in the 144-pin package only. Figure 24.2 P0 to P15 Measurement Circuit REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 341 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1=VCC2=5V tc XIN input tr tf tw(H) tw(L) tc(TA) tw(TAH) TAiIN input tw(TAL) tc(UP) tw(UPH) TAiOUT input tw(UPL) TAiOUT input (counter increment/ decrement select input) In event counter mode th(TIN-UP) TAiIN input (count on falling edge) tsu(UP-TIN) TAiIN input (count on rising edge) In event counter mode with two-phase pulse tc(TA) TAiIN input tsu(TAIN-TAOUT) TAiOUT input tsu(TAIN-TAOUT) tsu(TAOUT-TAIN) tsu(TAOUT-TAIN) tc(TB) tw(TBH) TBiIN input tw(TBL) tc(AD) tw(ADL) ADTRG input tc(CK) tw(CKH) CLKi tw(CKL) th(C-Q) TXDi td(C-Q) tsu(D-C) RXDi tw(INL) INTi input tw(INH) NMI input 2 CPU clock cycles + 300 ns or more ("L" width) Figure 24.3 VCC1 = VCC2 = 5 V Timing Diagram (1) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 342 of 385 2 CPU clock cycles + 300 ns or more th(C-D) Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1=VCC2=5V Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode BCLK RD (Separate bus) WR, WRL, WRH (Separate bus) RD (Multiplexed bus) WR, WRL, WRH (Multiplexed bus) RDY Input tsu(RDY-BCLK) th(BCLK-RDY) BCLK th(BCLK-HOLD) tsu(HOLD-BCLK) HOLD Input HLDA Output td(BCLK-HLDA) P0, P1, P2, P3, P4, P5_0 to P5_2 td(BCLK-HLDA) Hi-Z Measurement Conditions - VCC1 = VCC2 = 4.2 to 5.5 V - Input high and low voltage: VIH = 4.0 V, VIL = 1.0 V - Output high and low voltage: VOH = 2.5 V, VOL = 2.5 V Figure 24.4 VCC1 = VCC2 = 5 V Timing Diagram (2) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 343 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (when accessing an external memory space) VCC1=VCC2=5V Read Timing (1φ + 1φ Bus Cycle) BCLK th(BCLK-CS) -3ns.min td(BCLK-CS) 18ns.max(1) CSi tcyc th(RD-CS) 0ns.min td(BCLK-AD) 18ns.max(1) th(BCLK-AD) -3ns.min ADi BHE th(RD-AD) 0ns.min td(BCLK-RD) 18ns.max RD th(BCLK-RD) -5ns.min tac1(RD-DB)(2) tac1(AD-DB)(2) DBi Hi-Z tsu(DB-BCLK) 26ns.min(1) th(RD-DB) 0ns.min NOTES: 1. Values guaranteed only when the MCU is used stand-alone. A maximum of 35 ns is guaranteed for td(BCLK-AD) + tsu(DB-BCLK). 2. Varies with operation frequency: tac1(RD-DB) = (tcyc / 2 x m - 35) ns.max (if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, m = (b x 2) + 1) tac1(AD-DB) = (tcyc x n - 35) ns.max (if external bus cycle aφ + bφ, n = a + b) Write Timing (1φ + 1φ Bus Cycle) BCLK th(BCLK-CS) -3ns.min td(BCLK-CS) 18ns.max(1) CSi tcyc th(WR-CS)(3) td(BCLK-AD) 18ns.max(1) th(BCLK-AD) -3ns.min ADi BHE th(WR-AD)(3) td(BCLK-WR) 18ns.max tw(WR)(3) WR,WRL,WRH th(BCLK-WR) -5ns.min td(DB-WR)(3) th(WR-DB)(3) DBi NOTES: 3. Varies with operation frequency: td(DB-WR) = (tcyc x m - 20) ns.min ( if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, m = b) th(WR-DB) = (tcyc / 2 - 10) ns.min th(WR-AD) = (tcyc / 2 - 10) ns.min th(WR-CS) = (tcyc / 2 - 10) ns.min tw(WR) = (tcyc / 2 x n - 15) ns.min ( if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, n = (b x 2) - 1) Figure 24.5 Measurement Conditions: - VCC1 = VCC2 = 4.2 to 5.5 V - Input high and low voltage: VIH = 2.5 V, VIL = 0.8 V - Output high and low voltage: VOH = 2.0 V, VOL = 0.8 V VCC1 = VCC2 = 5 V Timing Diagram (3) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 344 of 385 tcyc= 109 f(BCLK) Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (when accessing an external memory space with the multiplexed bus) VCC1=VCC2=5V Read Timing (2φ + 2φ Bus Cycle) BCLK td(BCLK-ALE) 18ns.max th(BCLK-ALE) -2ns.min ALE td(BCLK-CS) 18ns.max th(BCLK-CS) -3ns.min tcyc th(RD-CS)(1) CSi ADi /DBi tsu(DB-BCLK) 26ns.min th(ALE-AD)(1) td(AD-ALE)(1) Address Data input Address tdz(RD-AD) 8ns.max td(BCLK-AD) 18ns.max th(RD-DB) 0ns.min th(BCLK-AD) -3ns.min tac2(RD-DB)(1) ADi BHE th(RD-AD)(1) tac2(AD-DB)(1) td(BCLK-RD) 18ns.max RD th(BCLK-RD) -5ns.min NOTES: 1. Varies with operation frequency: td(AD-ALE) = (tcyc / 2 x n - 20) ns.min (if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, n = a) th(ALE-AD) = (tcyc / 2 x n - 10) ns.min (if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, n = a) th(RD-AD) = (tcyc / 2 - 10) ns.min, th(RD-CS) = (tcyc / 2 - 10) ns.min tac2(RD-DB) = (tcyc / 2 x m - 35) ns.max (if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, m = (b x 2) - 1) tac2(AD-DB) = (tcyc / 2 x p - 35) ns.max (if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, p = {(a + b - 1) x 2} + 1) Write Timing (2φ + 2φ Bus Cycle) BCLK td(BCLK-ALE) 18ns.max th(BCLK-ALE) -2ns.min ALE td(BCLK-CS) 18ns.max th(BCLK-CS) -3ns.min tcyc th(WR-CS)(2) CSi td(AD-ALE)(2) th(ALE-AD)(2) Address ADi /DBi Data output td(DB-WR)(2) td(BCLK-AD) 18ns.max Address th(WR-DB)(2) th(BCLK-AD) -3ns.min ADi BHE td(BCLK-WR) 18ns.max WR,WRL,WRH th(BCLK-WR) -5ns.min th(WR-AD)(2) NOTES: 1. Varies with operation frequency: td(AD-ALE) = (tcyc / 2 x n - 20) ns.min (if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, n = a) th(ALE-AD) = (tcyc / 2 x n - 10) ns.min (if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, n = a) th(WR-AD) = (tcyc / 2 - 10) ns.min, th(WR-CS) = (tcyc / 2 - 10) ns.min th(WR-DB) = (tcyc / 2 - 10) ns.min td(DB-WR) = (tcyc / 2 x m - 25) ns.min (if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, m = (b x 2) - 1) tcyc= Figure 24.6 109 f(BCLK) VCC1 = VCC2 = 5 V Timing Diagram (4) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 345 of 385 Measurement Conditions: - VCC1 = VCC2 = 4.2 to 5.5 V - Input high and low voltage VIH = 2.5 V, VIL = 0.8 V - Output high and low voltage VOH = 2.0 V, VOL = 0.8 V Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V Table 24.29 Electrical Characteristics (1/3) (VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.0 to 3.6 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C, f(CPU) = 24 MHz unless otherwise specified) Symbol VOH Parameter Output high “H” voltage Condition P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7(1) IOH = -1 mA P6_0 to P6_7, P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7,P10_0 to P10_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(1) XOUT XCOUT VOL IOH = -0.1 mA Hysteresis Typ. Max. VCC2 - 0.6 VCC2 VCC1 - 0.6 VCC1 2.7 VCC1 Unit V V No load applied 2.5 V Drive capability = low No load applied 1.7 V XOUT VT+ - VT- Min. Drive capability = high Output low P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, “L” voltage P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7,P10_0 to P10_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(1) XCOUT Standard IOL = 1 mA 0.5 V IOL = 0.1 mA 0.5 V Drive capability = high No load applied 0 V Drive capability = low No load applied 0 V HOLD, RDY, TA0IN to TA4IN, TB0IN to TB5IN, INT0 to INT5, ADTRG, CTS0 to CTS4, CLK0 to CLK4, TA0OUT to TA4OUT, NMI, KI0 to KI3, RXD0 to RXD4, SCL0 to SCL4, SDA0 to SDA4 0.2 1.0 V RESET 0.2 1.8 V NOTE: 1. P11 to P15 are provided in the 144-pin package only. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 346 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V Table 24.30 Electrical Characteristics (2/3) (VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.0 to 3.6 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C, f(CPU) = 24 MHz unless otherwise specified) Symbol Standard Parameter Condition IIH Input high P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, “H” current P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(1), XIN, RESET, CNVSS, BYTE VI = 3 V 4.0 μA IIL Input low “L” current P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_0 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7, P10_0 to P10_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(1), XIN, RESET, CNVSS, BYTE VI = 0V -4.0 μA RPULLUP Pull-up resistance P0_0 to P0_7, P1_0 to P1_7, P2_0 to P2_7, P3_0 to P3_7, P4_0 to P4_7, P5_0 to P5_7, P6_0 to P6_7, P7_2 to P7_7, P8_0 to P8_4, P8_6, P8_7, P9_0 to P9_7,P10_0 to P10_7, P11_0 to P11_4, P12_0 to P12_7, P13_0 to P13_7, P14_0 to P14_6, P15_0 to P15_7(1) VI=0V 500 kΩ RfXIN Feedback resistance XIN 3.0 MΩ RfXCIN Feedback resistance XCIN 25 MΩ VRAM RAM data retention voltage In stop mode NOTE: 1. P11 to P15 are provided in the 144-pin package only. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 347 of 385 Min. 50 2.0 Typ. 100 Max. Unit V Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V Table 24.31 Electrical Characteristics (3/3) (VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = 25°C) Condition(1) Symbol Parameter ICC Power supply current f(CPU) = 32 MHz f(CPU) = 16 MHz f(CPU) = 8 MHz f(CPU) = f(Ring)(3) In on-chip oscillator low-power consumption mode In on-chip oscillator low-power consumption mode, flash memory is stopped(2) f(CPU) = 32 kHz(4) In low-power consumption mode, flash memory is operating f(CPU) = 32 kHz(5) In low-power consumption mode, flash memory is stopped(2) Wait mode: f(CPU) = f(Ring) After entering wait mode from on-chip oscillator low-power consumption mode Wait mode: f(CPU) = 32kHz(6) After entering wait mode from low-power consumption mode Stop mode (clock is stopped) Stop mode (clock is stopped) Topr = 85°C Standard Unit Min. Typ. Max. 23 37 mA 15 mA 9 mA 1.5 mA 400 μA 430 μA 50 μA 110 μA 8 μA 4 TBD TBD μA μA NOTES: 1. In single-chip mode, leave the output pins open and connect the input pins to VSS. 2. When setting the FMSTP bit in the FMR0 register to 1 (flash memory stopped) and running the program on RAM. 3. When the FMR40 bit in the FMR4 register is set to 1 (low-speed access). 4. When the FMR40 bit is set to 1 and the MRS bit in the VRCR register is set to 1 (main voltage regulator stops). 5. When the MRS bit is set to 1. 6. When the MRS bit is set to 1 and the CM0 bit in the CM03 register is set to 0 (XCIN-XCOUT drive capability Low). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 348 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V Table 24.32 A/D Conversion Characteristics (VCC1 = VCC2 = AVCC = VREF = 3.0 to 3.6 V, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C, f(CPU) = 24MHz unless otherwise specified) Symbol Parameter Measurement Condition Standard Min. Typ. Max. Unit − Resolution VREF = VCC1 10 Bits INL Integral nonlinearity error (8-bit) VREF = VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V ±2 LSB DNL Differential nonlinearity error (8-bit) ±1 LSB − Offset error (8-bit) ±2 LSB − Gain error (8-bit) ±2 LSB 20 kΩ RLADDER Resistor ladder VREF = VCC1 time(1)(2) 4 μs 4.9 tCONV 8-bit conversion VREF Reference voltage 3 VCC1 V VIA Analog input voltage 0 VREF V NOTES: 1. The value when φAD frequency is at 10 MHz. Keep φAD frequency at 10 MHz or lower. If f(CPU) (=fAD) is 24 MHz, divide f(CPU) by 3 to make it 8 MHz. The conversion time in this case is 6.1 μs. 2. S&H not available. Table 24.33 Symbol D/A Conversion Characteristics (VCC1 = VCC2 = VREF = 3.0 to 3.6 V, VSS = AVSS = 0 V at Topr = -20 to 85°C, f(CPU) = 24MHz unless otherwise specified) Parameter − Resolution − Absolute accuracy tsu Setup time RO Output resistance IVREF Reference power supply input current Measurement Condition Standard Min. Typ. Max. 8 4 (note 1) 10 Unit Bits 1.0 % 3 μs 20 kΩ 1.0 mA NOTE: 1. Measurement when one D/A converter is used, and the DAi register (i = 0, 1) of the unused D/A converter is set to 00h. The current flown into the resistor ladder in the A/D converter is excluded. IVREF flows even if VCUT bit in the AD0CON1 register is set to 0 (VREF not connected). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 349 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V Timing Requirements (VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.0 to 3.6 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C unless otherwise specified) Table 24.34 External Clock Input Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tc External clock input cycle time 62.5 ns tw(H) External clock input high (“H”) pulse width 27.5 ns tw(L) External clock input low (“L”) pulse width 27.5 tr External clock rise time 5 ns tf External clock fall time 5 ns Table 24.35 ns Timer A Input (Count Source Input in Event Counter Mode) Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tc(TA) TAiIN input cycle time 100 ns tw(TAH) TAiIN input high (“H”) pulse width 40 ns tw(TAL) TAiIN input low (“L”) pulse width 40 ns i = 0 to 4 Table 24.36 Timer A Input (Gate Signal Input in Timer Mode) Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tc(TA) TAiIN input cycle time 400 ns tw(TAH) TAiIN input high (“H”) pulse width 200 ns tw(TAL) TAiIN input low (“L”) pulse width 200 ns i = 0 to 4 Table 24.37 Timer A Input (External Trigger Input in One-Shot Timer Mode) Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tc(TA) TAiIN input cycle time 200 ns tw(TAH) TAiIN input high (“H”) pulse width 100 ns tw(TAL) TAiIN input low (“L”) pulse width 100 ns i = 0 to 4 Table 24.38 Timer A Input (External Trigger Input in Pulse Width Modulation Mode) Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tw(TAH) TAiIN input high (“H”) pulse width 100 ns tw(TAL) TAiIN input low (“L”) pulse width 100 ns i = 0 to 4 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 350 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V Timing Requirements (VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.0 to 3.6 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C unless otherwise specified) Table 24.39 Timer A Input (Counter Increment/Decrement Input in Event Counter Mode) Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tc(UP) TAiOUT input cycle time 2000 ns tw(UPH) TAiOUT input high (“H”) pulse width 1000 ns tw(UPL) TAiOUT input low (“L”) pulse width 1000 ns tsu(UP-TIN) TAiOUT input setup time 400 ns th(TIN-UP) TAiOUT input hold time 400 ns i = 0 to 4 Table 24.40 Timer A Input (Two-Phase Pulse Input in Event Counter Mode) Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit 2 μs tsu(TAIN-TAOUT) TAiOUT input setup time 500 ns tsu(TAOUT-TAIN) TAiIN input setup time 500 ns tc(TA) TAiIN input cycle time i = 0 to 4 Table 24.41 Timer B Input (Count Source Input in Event Counter Mode) Symbol tc(TB) Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit TBiIN input cycle time (counted on one edge) 100 ns tw(TBH) TBiIN input high (“H”) pulse width (counted on one edge) 40 ns tw(TBL) TBiIN input low (“L”) pulse width (counted on one edge) 40 ns tc(TB) TBiIN input cycle time (counted on both edges) 200 ns tw(TBH) TBiIN input high (“H”) pulse width (counted on both edges) 80 ns tw(TBL) TBiIN input low (“L”) pulse width (counted on both edges) 80 ns i = 0 to 5 Table 24.42 Timer B Input (Pulse Period Measurement Mode) Symbol tc(TB) Parameter TBiIN input cycle time Standard Min. Max. Unit 400 ns tw(TBH) TBiIN input high (“H”) pulse width 200 ns tw(TBL) TBiIN input low (“L”) pulse width 200 ns i = 0 to 5 Table 24.43 Timer B Input (Pulse Width Measurement Mode) Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tc(TB) TBiIN input cycle time 400 ns tw(TBH) TBiIN input high (“H”) pulse width 200 ns tw(TBL) TBiIN input low (“L”) pulse width 200 ns i = 0 to 5 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 351 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V Timing Requirements (VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.0 to 3.6 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C unless otherwise specified) Table 24.44 A/D Trigger Input Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tc(AD) ADTRG input cycle time (required for trigger) 1000 ns tw(ADL) ADTRG input low (“L”) pulse width 125 ns Table 24.45 Serial Interface Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tc(CK) CLKi input cycle time 200 ns tw(CKH) CLKi input high (“H”) pulse width 100 ns tw(CKL) CLKi input low (“L”) pulse width 100 ns td(C-Q) TXDi output delay time th(C-Q) TXDi output hold time tsu(D-C) RXDi input setup time 30 ns th(C-D) RXDi input hold time 90 ns 80 0 ns ns i=0 to 4 Table 24.46 External Interrupt INTi Input (Edge Sensitive) Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tw(INH) INTi input high (“H”) pulse width 250 ns tw(INL) INTi input low (“L”) pulse width 250 ns i=0 to 5 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 352 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V Timing Requirements (VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.0 to 3.6 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C unless otherwise specified) Table 24.47 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode Symbol Parameter Standard Min. Max. Unit tac1(RD-DB) Data input access time (RD standard) (note 1) ns tac1(AD-DB) Data input access time (AD standard, CS standard) (note 1) ns (note 1) ns (note 1) ns tac2(RD-DB) tac2(AD-DB) Data input access time (RD standard, when accessing a space with the multiplexed bus) Data input access time (AD standard, when accessing a space with the multiplexed bus) tsu(DB-BCLK) Data input setup time tsu(RDY-BCLK) RDY input setup time tsu(HOLD-BCLK) HOLD input setup time 30 ns 40 ns 60 ns th(RD-DB) Data input hold time 0 ns th(BCLK-RDY) RDY input hold time 0 ns th(BCLK-HOLD) HOLD input hold time 0 td(BCLK-HLDA) HLDA output delay time ns 25 ns NOTE: 1. Values, which depend on BCLK frequency and external bus cycles, can be obtained from the following equations. Insert wait states or lower the operation frequency, f(BCLK), if the calculated value is negative. tac1(RD-DB) = 109 × m f(BCLK) × 2 - 35 [ns] (if external bus cycle is aφ + bφ, m = (b × 2) + 1) tac1(AD-DB) = 109 × n f(BCLK) tac2(RD-DB) = 109 × m f(BCLK) × 2 - 35 [ns] (if external bus cycle is aφ + bφ, m = (b × 2) - 1) tac2(AD-DB) = 109 × p f(BCLK) × 2 - 35 [ns] (if external bus cycle is aφ + bφ, p = {(a + b - 1) × 2} + 1) - 35 [ns] (if external bus cycle is aφ + bφ, n = a + b) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 353 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V Switching Characteristics (VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.0 to 3.6 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C unless otherwise specified) Table 24.48 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (when accessing external memory space) Symbol Parameter Measurement Condition Standard Min. Max. 18 Unit td(BCLK-AD) Address output delay time th(BCLK-AD) Address output hold time (BCLK standard) 0 ns th(RD-AD) Address output hold time (RD standard)(3) 0 ns th(WR-AD) Address output hold time (WR standard)(3) (note 1) ns td(BCLK-CS) Chip-select signal output delay time th(BCLK-CS) Chip-select signal output hold time (BCLK standard) 0 ns th(RD-CS) Chip-select signal output hold time (RD standard)(3) 0 ns th(WR-CS) Chip-select signal output hold time (WR standard)(3) (note 1) ns td(BCLK-RD) RD signal output delay time th(BCLK-RD) RD signal output hold time td(BCLK-WR) WR signal output delay time th(BCLK-WR) WR signal output hold time td(DB-WR) th(WR-DB) tw(WR) 18 See Figure 24.2 18 -3 ns ns ns ns 18 ns 0 ns Data output delay time (WR standard) (note 2) ns Data output hold time (WR standard)(3) (note 1) ns WR output width (note 2) ns NOTES: 1. Values, which depend on BCLK frequency, can be obtained from the following equations. th(WR-DB) = 109 f(BCLK) × 2 - 20 [ns] th(WR-AD) = 109 f(BCLK) × 2 - 10 [ns] th(WR-CS) = 109 f(BCLK) × 2 - 10 [ns] 2. Values, which depend on BCLK frequency and external bus cycles, can be obtained from the following equations. td(DB-WR) = tw(WR) = 109 × m f(BCLK) 109 × n f(BCLK) × 2 - 20 [ns] (if external bus cycle is aφ + bφ, m = b) - 15 [ns] (if external bus cycle is aφ + bφ, n = (b × 2) - 1) 3. tc [ns] is added when recovery cycle is inserted. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 354 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V Switching Characteristics (VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.0 to 3.6 V, VSS = 0 V, Topr = -20 to 85°C unless otherwise specified) Table 24.49 Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (when accessing external memory space with multiplexed bus) Symbol Parameter Measurement Condition Standard Min. Max. 18 Unit td(BCLK-AD) Address output delay time th(BCLK-AD) Address output hold time (BCLK standard) 0 ns th(RD-AD) Address output hold time (RD standard)(5) (note 1) ns th(WR-AD) Address output hold time (WR standard)(5) (note 1) ns td(BCLK-CS) Chip-select signal output delay time th(BCLK-CS) Chip-select signal output hold time (BCLK standard) 0 ns th(RD-CS) Chip-select signal output hold time (RD standard)(5) (note 1) ns th(WR-CS) Chip-select signal output hold time (WR standard)(5) (note 1) ns td(BCLK-RD) RD signal output delay time th(BCLK-RD) RD signal output hold time td(BCLK-WR) WR signal output delay time th(BCLK-WR) WR signal output hold time td(DB-WR) th(WR-DB) td(BCLK-ALE) ALE signal output delay time (BCLK standard) th(BCLK-ALE) ALE signal output hold time (BCLK standard) td(AD-ALE) th(ALE-AD) tdz(RD-AD) Address output float start time 18 18 See Figure 24.2 -3 ns ns ns ns 18 ns 0 ns Data output delay time (WR standard) (note 2) ns Data output hold time (WR standard)(5) (note 1) ns 18 ns -2 ns ALE signal output delay time (address standard) (note 3) ns ALE signal output hold time (address standard) (note 4) ns 8 ns NOTES: 1. Values, which depend on BCLK frequency, can be obtained from the following equations. th(RD-AD) = 109 f(BCLK) × 2 - 10 [ns] th(WR-AD) = 109 f(BCLK) × 2 - 10 [ns] th(RD-CS) = 109 f(BCLK) × 2 - 10 [ns] th(WR-CS) = 109 f(BCLK) × 2 - 10 [ns] th(WR-DB) = 109 f(BCLK) × 2 - 20 [ns] 2. Values, which depend on BCLK frequency and external bus cycles, can be obtained from the following equation. td(DB-WR) = 109 × m f(BCLK) × 2 - 25 [ns] (if external bus cycle is aφ + bφ, m = (b × 2) - 1) 3. Values, which depend on BCLK frequency and external bus cycles, can be obtained from the following equation. td(AD-ALE) = 109 × n f(BCLK) × 2 - 20 [ns] (if external bus cycle is aφ + bφ, n = a) 4. Values, which depend on BCLK frequency and external bus cycles, can be obtained from the following equation. th(ALE-AD) = 109 × n f(BCLK) × 2 - 10 [ns] (if external bus cycle is aφ + bφ, n = a) 5. tc [ns] is added when recovery cycle is inserted. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 355 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1=VCC2=3.3V tc XIN input tr tf tw(H) tw(L) tc(TA) tw(TAH) TAiIN input tw(TAL) tc(UP) tw(UPH) TAiOUT input tw(UPL) TAiOUT input (counter increment/ decrement select input) In event counter mode th(TIN-UP) TAiIN input (count on falling edge) tsu(UP-TIN) TAiIN input (count on rising edge) In event counter mode with two-phase pulse tc(TA) TAiIN input tsu(TAIN-TAOUT) TAiOUT input tsu(TAIN-TAOUT) tsu(TAOUT-TAIN) tsu(TAOUT-TAIN) tc(TB) tw(TBH) TBiIN input tw(TBL) tc(AD) tw(ADL) ADTRG input tc(CK) tw(CKH) CLKi tw(CKL) th(C-Q) TXDi td(C-Q) tsu(D-C) RXDi tw(INL) INTi input tw(INH) NMI input 2 CPU clock cycles + 300 ns or more ("L" width) Figure 24.7 2 CPU clock cycles + 300 ns or more VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V Timing Diagram (1) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 356 of 385 th(C-D) Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics VCC1=VCC2=3.3V Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode BCLK RD (Separate bus) WR, WRL, WRH (Separate bus) RD (Multiplexed bus) WR, WRL, WRH (Multiplexed bus) RDY Input tsu(RDY-BCLK) th(BCLK-RDY) BCLK th(BCLK-HOLD) tsu(HOLD-BCLK) HOLD Input HLDA Output td(BCLK-HLDA) P0, P1, P2, P3, P4, P5_0 to P5_2 td(BCLK-HLDA) Hi-Z Measurement Conditions -VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.0 to 3.6 V -Input high and low voltage: VIH = 2.4 V, VIL = 0.6 V -Output high and low voltage: VOH = 1.5 V, VOL = 1.5 V Figure 24.8 VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V Timing Diagram (2) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 357 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (when accessing an external memory space) VCC1=VCC2=3.3V Read Timing (1φ + 1φ Bus Cycle) BCLK th(BCLK-CS) 0ns.min td(BCLK-CS) 18ns.max(1) CSi tcyc th(RD-CS) 0ns.min td(BCLK-AD) 18ns.max(1) th(BCLK-AD) 0ns.min ADi BHE th(RD-AD) 0ns.min td(BCLK-RD) 18ns.max RD th(BCLK-RD) -3ns.min tac1(RD-DB)(2) tac1(AD-DB)(2) DBi Hi-Z tsu(DB-BCLK) 30ns.min(1) th(RD-DB) 0ns.min NOTES: 1. Values guaranteed only when the MCU is used stand-alone. A maximum of 35 ns is guaranteed for td(BCLK-AD) + tsu(DB-BCLK). 2. Varies with operation frequency: tac1(RD-DB) = (tcyc / 2 x m - 35) ns.max (if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, m = (b x 2) + 1) tac1(AD-DB) = (tcyc x n - 35) ns.max (if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, n = a + b) Write Timing (1φ + 1φ Bus Cycle) BCLK th(BCLK-CS) 0ns.min td(BCLK-CS) 18ns.max(1) CSi tcyc th(WR-CS)(3) td(BCLK-AD) 18ns.max(1) th(BCLK-AD) 0ns.min ADi BHE td(BCLK-WR) 18ns.max th(WR-AD)(3) tw(WR)(3) WR,WRL,WRH th(BCLK-WR) 0ns.min td(DB-WR)(3) th(WR-DB)(3) DBi NOTES: 3. Varies with operation frequency: td(DB-WR) = (tcyc x m - 20) ns.min ( if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, m = b) th(WR-DB) = (tcyc / 2 - 20) ns.min th(WR-AD) = (tcyc / 2 - 10) ns.min th(WR-CS) = (tcyc / 2 - 10) ns.min tw(WR) = (tcyc / 2 x n - 15) ns.min ( if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, n = (b x 2) - 1) Figure 24.9 Measurement Conditions: - VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.0 to 3.6 V - Input high and low voltage: VIH = 1.5 V, VIL = 0.5 V - Output high and low voltage: VOH = 1.5 V, VOL = 1.5 V tcyc= VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V Timing Diagram (3) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 358 of 385 109 f(BCLK) Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 24. Electrical Characteristics Memory Expansion Mode and Microprocessor Mode (when accessing an external memory space with the multiplexed bus) VCC1=VCC2=3.3V Read Timing (2φ + 2φ Bus Cycle) BCLK td(BCLK-ALE) 18ns.max th(BCLK-ALE) -2ns.min ALE td(BCLK-CS) 18ns.max th(BCLK-CS) 0ns.min tcyc th(RD-CS)(1) CSi ADi /DBi tsu(DB-BCLK) 30ns.min th(ALE-AD)(1) td(AD-ALE)(1) Address Data input Address tdz(RD-AD) 8ns.max td(BCLK-AD) 18ns.max th(RD-DB) 0ns.min th(BCLK-AD) 0ns.min tac2(RD-DB)(1) ADi BHE th(RD-AD)(1) tac2(AD-DB)(1) td(BCLK-RD) 18ns.max RD th(BCLK-RD) -3ns.min NOTES: 1. Varies with operation frequency: td(AD-ALE) = (tcyc / 2 x n - 20) ns.min (if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, n = a) th(ALE-AD) = (tcyc / 2 x n - 10) ns.min (if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, n = a) th(RD-AD) = (tcyc / 2 - 10) ns.min, th(RD-CS) = (tcyc / 2 - 10) ns.min tac2(RD-DB) = (tcyc / 2 x m - 35) ns.max (if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, m = (b x 2) - 1) tac2(AD-DB) = (tcyc / 2 x p - 35) ns.max (if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, p = {(a + b - 1) x 2} + 1) Write Timing (2φ + 2φ Bus Cycle) BCLK td(BCLK-ALE) 18ns.max th(BCLK-ALE) -2ns.min ALE td(BCLK-CS) 18ns.max th(BCLK-CS) 0ns.min tcyc th(WR-CS)(2) CSi td(AD-ALE)(2) th(ALE-AD)(2) Address ADi /DBi Data output td(DB-WR)(2) td(BCLK-AD) 18ns.max Address th(WR-DB)(2) th(BCLK-AD) 0ns.min ADi BHE td(BCLK-WR) 18ns.max WR,WRL,WRH th(BCLK-WR) 0ns.min th(WR-AD)(2) NOTES: 1. Varies with operation frequency: td(AD-ALE) = (tcyc / 2 x n - 20) ns.min (if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, n = a) th(ALE-AD) = (tcyc / 2 x n - 10) ns.min (if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, n = a) th(WR-AD) = (tcyc / 2 - 10) ns.min, th(WR-CS) = (tcyc / 2 - 10) ns.min th(WR-DB) = (tcyc / 2 - 20) ns.min td(DB-WR) = (tcyc / 2 x m - 25) ns.min (if external bus cycle a φ + bφ, m = (b x 2) - 1) tcyc= Figure 24.10 109 f(BCLK) VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.3 V Timing Diagram (4) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 359 of 385 Measurement Conditions: - VCC1 = VCC2 = 3.0 to 3.6 V - Input high and low voltage VIH = 1.5 V, VIL = 0.5 V - Output high and low voltage VOH = 1.5 V, VOL = 1.5 V Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25. Usage Notes 25. Usage Notes 25.1 Power Supply 25.1.1 Power-on At power-on, supply voltage applied to the VCC1 must meet the SVCC standard. (Technical update: TN-M16C-116-0311) Table 25.1 Supply Voltage Power-up Slope Symbol SVCC Standard Parameter Unit Min. Typ. Max. Supply voltage power-up slope (supply voltage range: 0 V to 2.0 V) 0.05 V/ms Voltage SVCC SVCC Supply voltage power-up slope (VCC1) 2.0 V 0V Figure 25.1 SVCC Timing REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 360 of 385 Time Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25.1.2 25. Usage Notes Power Supply Ripple Stabilize supply voltage to meet the power supply standard listed in Table 25.2. Table 25.2 Power Supply Ripple Symbol Standard Parameter Min. Typ. Max. Unit f(ripple) Power supply ripple tolerable frequency (VCC1) 10 kHz Vp-p(ripple) Power supply ripple voltage fluctuation range (VCC1 = 5 V) 0.5 V (VCC1 = 3.3 V) 0.3 V Power supply ripple voltage fluctuation rate (VCC1 = 5 V) 0.3 V/ms (VCC1 = 3.3 V) 0.3 V/ms VCC(|ΔV/ΔT|) f(ripple) f(ripple) Power supply ripple tolerable frequency (VCC1) Vp-p(ripple) Power supply ripple voltage fluctuation range Figure 25.2 25.1.3 VCC1 Vp-p(ripple) Power Supply Fluctuation Timing Noise Use thick and shortest possible wiring to connect a bypass capacitor (0.1 μF or more) between VCC and VSS. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 361 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25.2 25. Usage Notes Special Function Registers (SFRs) 25.2.1 100 Pin-Package Set addresses 03CBh, 03CEh, 03CFh, 03D2h, and 03D3h to FFh after reset when using the 100-pin package. Address 03DCh must be set to 00h after reset. 25.2.2 Register Settings Table 25.3 lists registers containing write-only bits. Read-modify-write instructions cannot be used to set these registers. If these registers are set using a read-modify-write instruction, undefined values are read from the write-only bits in the register and written back to these bits. Table 25.4 lists read-modify-write instructions. When establishing new values by modifying previous ones, write the previous values into RAM as well as to the register. Change the contents of the RAM and then transfer the new values to the register. Table 25.3 Registers with Write-Only Bits Register Address Register Address WDTS register 000Eh U3TB register 032Bh to 032Ah U1BRG register 02E9h U2BRG register 0339h U1TB register 02EBh to 02EAh U2TB register 033Bh to 033Ah U4BRG register 02F9h UDF register 0344h U4TB register 02FBh to 02FAh TA0 register(1) 0347h to 0346h TA11 register 0303h to 0302h TA1 register(1) 0349h to 0348h TA21 register 0305h to 0304h TA2 register(1) 034Bh to 034Ah TA41 register 0307h to 0306h TA3 register(1) 034Dh to 034Ch DTT register 030Ch TA4 register(1) 034Fh to 034Eh ICTB2 register 030Dh U0BRG register 0369h U3BRG register 0329h U0TB register 036Bh to 036Ah NOTE: 1. In one-shot timer mode and pulse width modulation mode only. Table 25.4 Read-Modify-Write Instructions Function Mnemonic Transfer MOVDir Bit manipulation BCLR, BMCnd, BNOT, BSET, BTSTC, BTSTS Shift ROLC, RORC, ROT, SHA, SHANC, SHL, SHLNC Arithmetic ABS, ADC, ADCF, ADD, ADDX, DADC, DADD, DEC, DSBB, DSUB, EXTS, INC, MUL, MULEX, MULU, NEG, SBB, SUB, SUBX Logical AND, NOT, OR, XOR Jump ADJNZ, SBJNZ REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 362 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25.3 25. Usage Notes Processor Mode • When a port shares its pin with a bus control pin, such as address bus, data bus, CS, or RD, set its corresponding Port Pi Register (i = 0 to 15) and Port Pi Direction Register after entering single-chip mode. (Technical update: TN-M16C-49-0004) • Rewriting bits PM01 and PM00 in the PM0 register places the MCU in the corresponding processor mode regardless of CNVSS input level. When setting bits PM01 and PM00 to 01b (memory expansion mode) or 11b (microprocessor mode), do not set simultaneously with bits PM07 to PM02. First, set bits PM02, PM05 and PM04, and PM07 in the PM0 register, and also set bits PM11 and PM10, PM15 and PM14 in the PM1 register. Then, set bits PM01 and PM00. • When the MCU starts up in microprocessor mode, the internal ROM cannot be accessed. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 363 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25.4 25. Usage Notes Bus 25.4.1 HOLD Input If the HOLD input is used, set bits PD4_0 to PD4_7 in the PD4 register and bits PD5_0 to PD5_2 in the PD5 register to 0 (input mode) prior to setting bits PM01 and PM00 in the PM0 register to 01b (memory expansion mode) or to 11b (microprocessor mode) to switch from single-chip mode to memory expansion mode or microprocessor mode. (Technical update: TN-M16C-59-0008) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 364 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25.5 25. Usage Notes Clock Generation Circuits 25.5.1 Main Clock • If the main clock is selected as the CPU clock while an external clock is applied to the XIN pin, do not stop the external clock. (Technical update: TN-M16C-109-0309) • When a clock applied to the XIN pin is used for the CPU clock, do not set the CM05 bit in the CM0 register to 1 (stopped). 25.5.2 Sub Clock 25.5.2.1 To Oscillate Sub Clock To oscillate the sub clock, set the CM07 bit in the CM0 register to 0 (clock other than the sub clock) and the CM03 bit to 1 (XCIN-XOUT drive capability = high). Then, set the CM04 bit in the CM0 register to 1 (XCINXCOUT oscillation function). Once the sub clock becomes stabilized, set the CM03 bit to 0 (XCIN-XOUT drive capability = low). After the above procedure, the sub clock can be used as the CPU clock, or the count source for timer A and timer B. (Technical update: TN-16C-119A/EA) 25.5.2.2 Oscillation Parameter Matching If an oscillation circuit constant matching for the sub clock oscillation circuit has only been evaluated with the drive capability = high, the constant matching for drive capability = low must also be evaluated. Contact your oscillator manufacturer for details on the oscillation circuit constant matching. 25.5.3 Clock Dividing Ratio To change bits MCD4 to MCD0, set the PM12 bit in the PM1 register to 0 (no wait state). 25.5.4 Power Consumption Control Stabilize the main clock, sub clock, or PLL clock prior to switching the clock source for the CPU clock to one of these clocks. 25.5.4.1 Wait Mode • When entering wait mode, the instructions following the WAIT instruction are stored into the instruction queue, and the program stops. Insert at least 4 NOP instructions after the WAIT instruction. • To enter wait mode, execute the WAIT instruction while a high-level (“H”) signal is applied to the NMI pin. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 365 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25.5.4.2 25. Usage Notes Stop Mode • The MCU cannot enter stop mode if a low-level (“L”) signal is applied to the NMI pin. Apply an “H” signal to enter stop mode. • To exit stop mode by reset, apply an “L” signal to RESET pin until a main clock oscillation stabilizes. • If using the NMI interrupt to exit stop mode, use the following procedure to set the CM10 bit in the CM1 register to 1 (all clocks stopped). (Technical update: TN-16C-127A/EA) (1) Exit stop mode using the NMI interrupt. (2) Generate a dummy interrupt. (3) Set the CM10 bit to 1 (all clocks stopped). e.g., int bset #63 CM1 ; dummy interrupt ; all clocks stopped /*dummy interrupt routine*/ dummy reit • When entering stop mode, the instructions following CM10 = 1 instruction are stored into the instruction queue, and the program stops. When stop mode is exited, the instruction lined in the queue is executed before the exit interrupt routine is handled. Insert a jmp.b instruction as follows after the instruction to set the CM10 bit to 1. (Technical update: TN-16C-124A/EA) fset I bset 0, cm1 jmp.b LABEL_001 LABEL_001: nop nop nop nop mov.b #0, prcr . . . ; I flag is set to 1 ; all clocks stopped (stop mode) ; jmp.b instruction executed (no instruction between jmp.b and LABEL.) ; nop(1) ; nop(2) ; nop(3) ; nop(4) ; protection set REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 366 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25.5.4.3 25. Usage Notes Suggestions to Reduce Power Consumption The followings are suggestions to reduce power consumption when programming or designing systems. Ports: • Through current may flow into floating input pins. Set unassigned pins to input mode and connect them to VSS via a resistor (pull down), or set unassigned pins to output mode and leave them open. A/D converter: • When the A/D conversion is not performed, set the VCUT bit in the AD0CON1 register to 0 (VREF not connected). When the A/D conversion is performed, set the VCUT bit to 1 (VREF connection) and wait 1 μs or more to start the A/D conversion. D/A converter: • When the D/A conversion is not performed, set the DAiE bit (i = 0, 1) in the DACON register to 0 (output disabled) and the DAi register to 00h. Peripheral function clock stop: • When entering wait mode from main clock mode, on-chip oscillator mode, or on-chip oscillator low-power consumption mode, power consumption can be reduced by setting the CM02 bit in the CM0 register to 1 to stop peripheral function clock source (fPFC). However, fC32 does not stop by setting the CM02 bit to 1. • In low-speed mode or low-power consumption mode, do not set the CM02 bit to 1 (peripheral clock stops in wait mode) when entering wait mode. (Technical update: TN-M16C-69-0104) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 367 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25.6 25. Usage Notes Protection The PRC2 bit in the PRCR register becomes 0 (write disable) by a write to the SFR area after the PRC2 bit is set to 1 (write enable). Set a register protected by the PRC2 bit immediately after the PRC2 bit is set to 1. Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two instructions. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 368 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25.7 25. Usage Notes Interrupts 25.7.1 ISP Setting After reset, ISP is initialized to 000000h. The program may go out of control if an interrupt is acknowledged before setting a value to ISP. Therefore, ISP must be set before any interrupt request is acknowledged. Setting ISP to an even address allows interrupt sequences to be executed at a higher speed. To use the NMI interrupt, set ISP at the very beginning of the program. The NMI interrupt can be acknowledged after the first instruction has been executed after reset. 25.7.2 NMI Interrupt • The NMI interrupt cannot be disabled. Connect the NMI pin to VCC1 via a resistor (pull-up) when not in use. • The P8_5 bit in the P8 register indicates the voltage level applied to the NMI pin. Read the P8_5 bit only to determine the pin level after the NMI interrupt occurs. 25.7.3 INT Interrupt • Edge Sensitive Each “H” or “L” width of the signal applied to pins INT0 to INT5 must be 250 ns or more regardless of the CPU clock frequency. • Level Sensitive Each “H” or “L” width of the signal applied to pins INT0 to INT5 must be one CPU clock cycle + 200 ns or more. For example, each “H” or “L” width must be 234 ns or more if the CPU clock is 30 MHz. • The IR bit in the INTiIC register (i = 0 to 5) may become 1 (interrupt requested) when the polarity settings of pins INT0 to INT5 are changed. Set the IR bit to 0 (interrupt not requested) after the polarity setting is changed. Figure 25.3 shows a procedure to set the INTi interrupt source (i = 0 to 5). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 369 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25. Usage Notes < Procedure for Edge Sensitive > Start INTiIC register: bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 = 000b Interrupt disabled IFSR register: IFSRi bit Select either one edge or both edges INTiIC register: POL bit LVS bit = 0 Select polarity (Set to 0 when both edges are selected) Select edge sensitive INTiIC register: IR bit = 0 Clear the interrupt request bit INTiIC register: bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 Interrupt enabled End < Procedure for Level Sensitive > Start INTiIC register: bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 = 000b Interrupt disabled IFSR register: IFSRi bit = 0 Select one edge INTiIC register: POL bit LVS bit = 1 Select polarity Select level sensitive INTiIC register: IR bit = 0 Clear the interrupt request bit INTiIC register: bits ILVL2 to ILVL0 Interrupt enabled End Figure 25.3 Procedure to set the INTi Interrupt Source (i = 0 to 5) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 370 of 385 i = 0 to 5 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25.7.4 25. Usage Notes Changing Interrupt Control Register To change the Interrupt Control Register while an interrupt request is disabled, use the following instructions. Changing IR bit: The IR bit may not be changed to 0 (interrupt not requested) by writing, depending on which instruction is used. If this causes a problem, use MOV instruction to change the register. (Technical update: TN-M16C-85-0204) Changing any bits other than IR bit: If an interrupt request is generated while writing to the corresponding Interrupt Control Register with instructions such as MOV, the IR bit may not become 1 (interrupt requested) and the interrupt is not acknowledged. If this causes a problem, use the following instructions to write to the register: AND, OR, BCLR, BSET 25.7.5 Changing RLVL Register The DMAII bit in the RLVL register is undefined after reset. To use interrupt priority level 7 for an interrupt, set it to 0 before setting the Interrupt Control Register. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 371 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25.8 25. Usage Notes DMAC • Set the DMAC-associated registers while bits MDi1 and MDi0 (i = 0 to 3) in the channel i are set to 00b (DMA disabled). Then, set bits MDi1 and MDi0 to 01b (single transfer) or 11b (repeat transfer) at the end of the setup procedure, which enables the DMA request of the channel i to be acknowledged. • Write a 1 (requested) to the DRQ bit when setting the DMiSL register. In the M32C/80 Series, if a DMA request is generated but a receiving channel is not ready(1), a DMA transfer does not occur and the DRQ bit becomes 0. NOTE: 1. Bits MDi1 and MDi0 are set to 00b or the DCTi register is 0000h (transferred 0 time). • To start a DMA transfer using a software trigger, set bits DSR and DRQ in the DMiSL register to 1 simultaneously. e.g., OR.B #0A0h, DMiSL ; set bits DSR and DRQ to 1 simultaneously • While the DCTi register in the channel i is set to 1, do not generate a DMA request in the channel i in the timing that bits MDi1 and MDi0 in the DMDj register (j = 0, 1) corresponding to the channel i are set to 01b (single transfer) or 11b (repeat transfer). (Technical update: TN-M16C-88-0209) • Select a peripheral function used as a DMA request source after setting the DMA-associated registers. When the INT interrupt is selected as a DMA request source, do not set the DCTi register to 1. • Wait six CPU clock cycles or more by a program to enable DMA after setting the DMiSL register(2). NOTE: 2. To enable DMA means changing bits MDi1 and MDi0 in the DMDj register from 00b (DMA disabled) to 01b (single transfer) or 11b (repeat transfer). REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 372 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25.9 25. Usage Notes Timers 25.9.1 Timer A, Timer B Timers are stopped after reset. Set the TAiS (i = 0 to 4) or TBjS (j = 0 to 5) bit in the TABSR or TBSR register to 1 (count starts) after setting timer operating mode, count source, and counter value. Change the following registers and bits while the corresponding timer is stopped (the TAiS or TBjS bit is set to 0 (count stops)). • Registers TAiMR and TBjMR • UDF register • Bits TAZIE, TA0TGL, and TA0TGH in the ONSF register • TRGSR register 25.9.2 Timer A 25.9.2.1 Timer A (Timer Mode) • The TAiS bit (i = 0 to 4) in the TABSR register is set to 0 (count stops) after reset. Set the TAiS bit to 1 (count starts) after selecting timer operating mode and setting the TAi register. • The TAi register indicates a counter value while counting at any given time. However, FFFFh can be read in the reload timing. When the TAi register is set while a counter is stopped, the setting value can be read until a counter is started. 25.9.2.2 Timer A (Event Counter Mode) • The TAiS bit (i = 0 to 4) is set to 0 (count stops) after reset. Set the TAiS bit to 1 (count starts) after selecting timer operating mode and setting the TAi register. • The TAi register indicates a counter value while counting at any given time. In the reload timing, however, FFFFh can be read if the timer underflows, or 0000h if the timer overflows. When the TAi register is set while the counter is stopped, the setting value can be read until a counter is started. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 373 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25.9.2.3 25. Usage Notes Timer A (One-Shot Timer Mode) • The TAiS bit (i = 0 to 4) in the TABSR register is set to 0 (count stops) after reset. Set the TAiS bit to 1 (count starts) after selecting timer operating mode and setting the TAi register. • The following occurs when the TAiS bit in the TABSR register is set to 0 (count stops) while counting. • The counter stops counting and the contents of the reload register is reloaded. • The TAiOUT pin outputs a low-level (“L”) signal. • The IR bit in the TAiIC register becomes 1 (interrupt requested) after one CPU clock cycle. • One-shot timer is operated by an internal count source. When an external trigger is selected, a maximum of one count source clock delay occurs between the trigger input to the TAiIN pin and the one-shot timer output. • The IR bit becomes 1 when one of the following procedures are used to set timer operating mode. • When selecting one-shot timer mode after reset. • When switching from timer mode to one-shot timer mode. • When switching from event counter mode to one-shot timer mode. To use the timer Ai interrupt (IR bit), set the IR bit to 0 after one of the above setting has done. • When a retrigger occurs while counting, the contents of the reload register is reloaded after the counter decrements by one, and continues counting. To generate a retrigger while counting, wait 1 count source clock cycle or more after the last trigger generation. • When an external trigger input is used to start counting in timer A one-shot timer mode, do not provide an external retrigger input for 300 ns before a timer A counter value reaches 0000h. The external retrigger may be ignored. (Technical update: TN-16C-125A/EA) 25.9.2.4 Timer A (Pulse Width Modulation Mode) • The TAiS bit (i = 0 to 4) in the TABSR register is set to 0 (count stops) after reset. Set the TAiS bit to 1 (count starts) after selecting timer operating mode and setting the TAi register. • The IR bit becomes 1 when one of the following procedures are used to set timer operating mode. • When selecting PWM mode after reset. • When switching from timer mode to PWM mode. • When switching from event counter mode to PWM mode. To use the timer Ai interrupt (IR bit), set the IR bit to 0 after one of the above setting has done. • The following occurs when the TAiS bit is set to 0 (count stops) while PWM pulse is output. • The counter stops. • If the TAiOUT pin outputs a high-level (“H”) signal, the signal changes to “L” and the IR bit becomes 1. • If the TAiOUT pin outputs an “L” signal, its output signal and the IR bit remains unchanged. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 374 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25.9.3 25. Usage Notes Timer B 25.9.3.1 Timer B (Timer Mode, Event Counter Mode) • The TBiS bit (i = 0 to 5) in the TABSR or TBSR register is set to 0 (count stops) after reset. Set the TBiS bit to 1 (count starts) after selecting timer operating mode and setting the TBi register. Bits TB2S to TB0S are bits 7 to 5 in the TABSR register. Bits TB5S to TB3S are bits 7 to 5 in the TBSR register. • The TBi register indicates a counter value while counting at any given time. However, FFFFh can be read in the reload timing. When the TBi register is set while a counter is stopped, the setting value can be read until a counter is started. 25.9.3.2 Timer B (Pulse Period/Pulse Width Measurement Mode) • To set the MR3 bit to 0 (no overflow has occurred), wait for one or more count source cycles to write to the TBiMR register after the MR3 bit becomes 1, while the TBiS bit is set to 1. (Technical update: TN-M16C-75-0110) • Use the IR bit in the TBiIC register to detect overflow. The MR3 bit is used only to determine an interrupt request source within the interrupt routine. • When the first valid edge is input after the count starts, an undefined value is transferred to the reload register. At this time, the timer Bi interrupt request is not generated. • The counter value is undefined when the count starts. Therefore, the MR3 bit may become 1 (overflow) and causes a timer Bi interrupt request to be generated before a valid edge is input. • The IR bit may become 1 (interrupt requested) by changing bits MR1 and MR0 in the TBiMR register after the count starts. If the same value is written to bits MR1 and MR0, the IR bit is not changed. • Pulse width is repeatedly measured in pulse width measurement mode. Determine by a program whether the measurement result is high (“H”) or low (“L”). • If an overflow and a valid edge input occur simultaneously in pulse period measurement mode, an interrupt request is generated only once, which results in the valid edge not being recognized. Do not let an overflow occur. • In pulse width measurement mode, determine whether an interrupt source is a valid edge input or an overflow by reading the port level in the TBi interrupt routine. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 375 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25. Usage Notes 25.10 Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function • Do not write to the TAi or the TAi1 register (i = 1, 2, 4) in the timing that timer B2 underflows. If there is a possibility to write in this timing, read the value of the timer B2 register to verify that there is a sufficient time until timer B2 underflows, and then write to the TAi or the TAi1 register immediately. (Technical update: TN-M16C-86-0205) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 376 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25. Usage Notes 25.11 Serial Interfaces 25.11.1 Changing UiBRG Register (i = 0 to 4) Set the UiBRG register after setting bits CLK1 and CLK0 in the UiC0 register. When bits CLK1 and CLK0 are changed, set the UiBRG register again. 25.11.2 Clock Synchronous Mode 25.11.2.1 Selecting External Clock If an external clock is selected, meet the following conditions while the external clock is held “H” when the CKPOL bit in the UiC0 register (i = 0 to 4) is set to 0 (transmit data output at the falling edge and receive data input at the rising edge of the serial clock), or while the external clock is held “L” when the CKPOL bit is set to 1 (transmit data output at the rising edge and receive data input at the falling edge of the serial clock) • Set the TE bit in the UiC1 register to 1 (transmit operation enabled). • Set the RE bit in the UiC1 register to 1 (receive operation enabled). • The TI bit in the UiC1 register is 0 (data in the UiTB register). The RE bit setting is not required for a transmit-only operation. 25.11.2.2 Receive Operation • In clock synchronous mode, the serial clock is controlled by the transmit control circuit. Set the UARTiassociated registers for a transmit operation as well, even if the MCU is used only for receive operation. Dummy data is output from the TXDi pin while receiving if the TXDi pin is set to output mode. • If data is received continuously, an overrun error occurs when the RI bit in the UiC1 register is 1 (data in the UiRB register) and the seventh bit of the next data is received in the UARTi receive shift register. And the OER bit in the UiRB register becomes 1 (overrun error). In this case, a read from the UiRB register returns undefined values. If an overrun error occurs,the IR bit in the SiRIC register is not changed to 1. • The following two conditions must be satisfied to use continuous receive mode (UiRRM bit is set to 1). (1) The CKDIR bit in the UiMR register is set to 1 (external clock). (2) The RTS function is not used. To receive data continuously under the other conditions, set the UiRRM bit to 0 (continuous receive mode disabled), and write dummy data to the UiTB register every time a receive operation is completed. 25.11.3 UART Mode Set the UiERE bit in the UiC1 register after setting the UiMR register. 25.11.4 Special Mode 1 (I2C Mode) To generate the start condition, stop condition, or restart condition, set the STSPSEL bit in the USMR4 register to 0. Then, wait for a half clock cycle of the serial clock or more to change individual condition generation bit (the STAREQ bit, STPREQ bit, or RSTAREQ bit) from 0 to 1. (Technical update: TN-16C-130A/EA) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 377 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25. Usage Notes 25.12 A/D Converter • Set the ADST bit to 1 (A/D conversion starts) after setting registers AD0CON0 (ADST bit excluded), AD0CON1, AD0CON2, AD0CON3, and AD0CON4. • When the VCUT bit in the AD0CON1 register is changed from 0 (VREF not connected) to 1 (VREF connected), wait for 1 μs or more to start A/D conversion. Set the VCUT bit to 0 when A/D conversion is not used to reduce current consumption. •To prevent latch-up and malfunction due to noise and also to minimize a conversion error, insert a capacitor between the AVSS pin and each of the following pins: the AVCC pin, VREF pin, or analog input pin ANi_j (i = none, 0, 2, 15; j = 0 to 7). Insert a capacitor between the VCC pin and the VSS pin as well. Figure 25.4 shows an example of individual pin handling. MCU VCC1 VCC1 VCC1 AVCC VSS VREF C4 C1 C2 AVSS VCC2 C3 VCC2 C5 ANi VSS NOTES: 1. C1 ≥ 0.47 μF, C2 ≥ 0.47 μF, C3 ≥ 10000 pF, C4 ≥ 0.1 μF, C5 ≥ 0.1 μF (reference values) 2. Use thick and shortest possible wiring to connect capacitors. Figure 25.4 Individual Pin Handling • Set the port direction bit in the PDk register (k = 0 to 15), which corresponds to a pin used as an analog input pin, to 0 (input mode). Also, set the port direction bit in the PDk register corresponding to the ADTRG pin, to 0 (input mode.) • When the key input interrupt is used, do not select pins P10_4 to P10_7 (AN_4 to AN_7) as analog input pins. • φAD frequency must be 16 MHz or lower when VCC1 = 4.2 V to 5.5 V, or 10 MHz or lower when VCC1 = 3.0 V to 5.5 V. When the sample and hold is not activated, φAD frequency must be 250 kHz or higher. When the sample and hold is activated, φAD frequency must be 1 MHz or higher. • When A/D operating mode is changed, set bits CH2 to CH0 in the AD0CON0 register or bits SCAN1 and SCAN0 in the AD0CON1 register again to select analog input pins. • The voltage applied to AN_0 to AN_7, AN15_0 to AN15_7, ANEX0, and ANEX1 must be VCC1 or below. The voltage applied to AN0_0 to AN0_7, and AN2_0 to AN2_7 must be VCC2 or below. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 378 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25. Usage Notes • If an A/D conversion in progress is forcibly aborted by setting the ADST bit in the AD0CON0 register to 0 (A/D conversion stops), the A/D conversion result will be incorrect. The AD0j (j = 0 to 7) register which is not performing A/D conversion may also be incorrect. If the ADST bit is set to 0 during A/D conversion, do not use values obtained from any of AD0j registers. • When using DMAC operating mode in single sweep mode, repeat sweep mode 0, repeat sweep mode 1, multiport single sweep mode, or multi-port repeat sweep mode 0, do not input an external retrigger or hardware retrigger. If a retrigger is input, the sequence of A/D conversions in progress is aborted and starts over from the ANi_0 pin (i = none, 0, 2, 15). As a result, a pin and the conversion result of the pin transferred to the RAM do not correspond to each other. Do not read the AD00 register using instructions. • To abort an A/D conversion in progress by setting the ADST bit in the AD0CON0 register to 0 in single sweep mode, disable interrupts before setting the ADST bit to 0. (Technical update: TN-16C-132A/EA) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 379 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25. Usage Notes 25.13 Programmable I/O Ports • Pins P7_2 to P7_5, P8_0, and P8_1 have the forced cutoff function of the three-phase PWM output. When these ports are set in output mode (port output, timer output, three-phase PWM output, serial interface output), they are affected by the three-phase motor control timer function and the NMI pin setting. Table 25.5 shows the INVC0 register setting, NMI pin input level, and output pin states. Table 25.5 INVC0 Register Setting, NMI Pin Level, and Output Pin Status Setting Value of the INVC0 Register INV02 Bit INV03 Bit NMI Pin Input Level 0 (three-phase motor control timer function not used) − − 0 (three-phase motor control timer output disabled) − 1 (three-phase motor control timer function used) 1 (three-phase motor control timer output enabled)(1) Pin States of P7_2 to P7_5, P8_0, P8_1 (when set in output mode) Output functions selected using registers PS1, PSL1, PSC, PS2, and PSL2 High-impedance states H Output functions selected using registers PS1, PSL1, PSC, PS2, and PSL2 L High-impedance states (forcibly terminated) −: Not affected by the bit setting nor the pin state NOTE: 1. The INV03 bit becomes 0 after a low-level (“L”) signal is applied to the NMI pin. • The availability of the pull-up resistors is undefined until the internal power voltage stabilizes even if the RESET pin is held “L”. • The input threshold level varies between the input to the port and input to the peripheral functions. If the port function and peripheral function share the same pin, the level verified by the peripheral function and the level obtained by reading the Port Pi register (i = 0 to 15) may vary during the process when the voltage applied to the pin changes from “H” to “L” or from “L” to “H”. (Technical update: TN-M16C-102-0309) REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 380 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25. Usage Notes 25.14 Flash Memory 25.14.1 Operating Speed Prior to accessing registers FMR0 to FMR3 or to entering CPU rewrite mode (EW0, EW1 mode), set the CPU clock frequency to 10 MHz or lower using bits MCD4 to MCD0 in the MCD register, and also set the PM12 bit in the PM1 register to 1 (1 wait state). 25.14.2 Prohibited Instructions The following instructions cannot be used in EW0 mode because the flash memory is accessed by executing these instructions: UND, INTO, JMPS, JSRS, and BRK instructions. 25.14.3 Interrupts (EW0 Mode) • To use peripheral function interrupts, place interrupt routine programs and the relocatable vector table in the RAM area. • When an interrupt request is generated by the NMI, watchdog timer, voltage monitor interrupt, or oscillation stop detect function, registers FMR0, FMR1, and FMR3 are forcibly initialized and the erase or program operation in progress is aborted. Now that the flash memory can be accessed, the interrupt routine will be executed. • The address match interrupt is not available because the flash memory is accessed to process this interrupt. 25.14.4 Interrupts (EW1 Mode) • Do not generate a peripheral function interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer during an erase or program operation. • When an interrupt request is generated by the NMI, watchdog timer (when the PM22 bit is set to 1), voltage monitor interrupt, or oscillation stop detect function, registers FMR0, FMR1, and FMR3 are forcibly initialized and the erase or program operation in progress is aborted. Now that the flash memory can be accessed, the interrupt routine will be executed. 25.14.5 How to Access To set the FMR01 or FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register to 1, write a 1 immediately after writing a 0 to the bit. Write to the FMR0 register in 8-bit units. Do not generate an interrupt or a DMA or DMACII transfer between these two settings. Also, set these bits while a high-level (“H”) signal is applied to the NMI pin. To change the FMR01 bit from 1 to 0, enter read array mode first, and then write into address 0057h in 16-bit units. Set the eight high-order bits to 00h. 25.14.6 Rewriting User ROM Area (EW0 Mode) If the supply voltage drops while rewriting the block where a rewrite control program is stored, it may not be possible to rewrite the flash memory again, because the rewrite control program is not rewritten successfully. If this happens, use standard serial I/O mode to rewrite the block. 25.14.7 Rewriting User ROM Area (EW1 Mode) Do not rewrite a block where the rewrite control program is stored. REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 381 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group 25. Usage Notes 25.14.8 Boot Mode When starting up in boot mode, input pins may not be placed in high-impedance states until the internal supply voltage stabilizes. Use the following procedure to power up in boot mode. (1) Input an “L” signal to the RESET pin and CNVSS pin (2) Wait for td(P-R) (internal power supply stabilization time) or more after the voltage applied to the VCC1 pin rises above 3.0 V (3) Input an “L” (pull-down) to the P6_5 or an “H” (pull-up) to the P6_7 (4) Input an “L” (pull-down) to the EPM (P5_5) and an “H” (pull-up) to the CE (P5_0) (5) Input an “H” to the CNVSS pin (6) Input an “H” to the RESET pin (out of reset) 25.14.9 Writing Command and Data Write command codes and data to even addresses in the user ROM area. 25.14.10 Block Erase If an erase operation in progress is aborted due to such as the NMI interrupt, hardware reset, or supply voltage drop, the lock bit or protect bit of the block which has been erased may become 0 (locked/protected). To erase the same block again, set the FMR02 bit in the FMR0 register to 1 (lock bit disabled) and then execute the block erase command. 25.14.11 Wait Mode To enter wait mode, set the FMR01 bit in the FMR0 register to 0 (CPU rewrite mode disabled) and then execute the WAIT instruction. 25.14.12 Stop Mode To enter stop mode, use the following procedure: • Set the FMR01 bit to 0 (CPU rewrite mode disabled) before setting the CM10 bit to 1 (stop mode). • Execute the JMP.B instruction right after the instruction to set the CM10 bit to 1 (stop mode). e.g., BSET 0, CM1 ; Stop mode JMP.B L1 L1: Program after exiting stop mode 25.14.13 Low-Power Consumption Mode and On-Chip Oscillator Low-Power Consumption Mode When the CM05 bit in the CM0 register is set to 1 (main clock stopped), do not execute the following commands: • Program command • Block erase command • Lock bit program command • Read lock bit status command • Protect bit program command • Read protect bit status command REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 382 of 385 Under development Preliminary specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Appendix 1. Package Dimensions Appendix 1. Package Dimensions JEITA Package Code P-LQFP144-20x20-0.50 RENESAS Code PLQP0144KA-A Previous Code 144P6Q-A / FP-144L / FP-144LV MASS[Typ.] 1.2g HD *1 D 108 73 109 NOTE) 1. DIMENSIONS "*1" AND "*2" DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD FLASH. 2. DIMENSION "*3" DOES NOT INCLUDE TRIM OFFSET. 72 bp E c HE c1 b1 *2 Reference Symbol Terminal cross section Index mark c 36 A 1 ZD ZE 37 A2 144 D E A2 HD HE A A1 bp b1 c c1 A1 F L L1 *3 e y JEITA Package Code P-LQFP100-14x14-0.50 RENESAS Code PLQP0100KB-A bp e x y ZD ZE L L1 Detail F x Previous Code 100P6Q-A / FP-100U / FP-100UV Dimension in Millimeters Min Nom Max 19.9 20.0 20.1 19.9 20.0 20.1 1.4 21.8 22.0 22.2 21.8 22.0 22.2 1.7 0.05 0.1 0.15 0.17 0.22 0.27 0.20 0.09 0.145 0.20 0.125 0° 8° 0.5 0.08 0.10 1.25 1.25 0.35 0.5 0.65 1.0 MASS[Typ.] 0.6g HD *1 D 51 75 NOTE) 1. DIMENSIONS "*1" AND "*2" DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD FLASH. 2. DIMENSION "*3" DOES NOT INCLUDE TRIM OFFSET. 50 76 bp HE Reference Dimension in Millimeters Symbol c c1 *2 E b1 D E A2 HD HE A A1 bp b1 c c1 100 26 1 ZE Terminal cross section 25 Index mark ZD y e *3 bp A1 c A A2 F L x L1 Detail F REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 383 of 385 e x y ZD ZE L L1 Min Nom Max 13.9 14.0 14.1 13.9 14.0 14.1 1.4 15.8 16.0 16.2 15.8 16.0 16.2 1.7 0.05 0.1 0.15 0.15 0.20 0.25 0.18 0.09 0.145 0.20 0.125 8° 0° 0.5 0.08 0.08 1.0 1.0 0.35 0.5 0.65 1.0 Under development Preliminary Specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Index Index [A] AD00 to AD07 ........................................ 257 AD0CON0 .............................................. 253 AD0CON1 .............................................. 254 AD0CON2 .............................................. 255 AD0CON3 .............................................. 256 AD0CON4 .............................................. 257 AIER ....................................................... 115 IFSR ............................................... 113, 205 Interrupt Control Register (1) ................. 103 Interrupt Control Register (2) ................. 104 INVC0 ..................................................... 180 INVC1 ..................................................... 181 [L] LVDC ........................................................ 37 [C] CM0 ................................................. 67, 118 CM1 ......................................................... 68 CM2 ......................................................... 70 CPSRF ..................................................... 73 CRCD ..................................................... 274 CRCIN .................................................... 274 [M] MCD ......................................................... 69 [O] ONSF ..................................................... 153 [D] [P] DA0 ........................................................ 272 DA1 ........................................................ 272 DACON .................................................. 272 DCT0 to DCT3 ....................................... 125 DM0SL to DM3SL .................................. 122 DMA0 to DMA3 ...................................... 124 DMD0 ..................................................... 126 DMD1 ..................................................... 127 DRA0 to DRA3 ....................................... 125 DRC0 to DRC3 ...................................... 125 DS ............................................................ 44 DSA0 to DSA3 ....................................... 124 DTT ........................................................ 186 DVCR ....................................................... 38 P0 to P15 ............................................... 285 PCR ........................................................ 295 PD0 to PD15 .......................................... 284 PLC0 ........................................................ 71 PM0 .......................................................... 41 PM1 .......................................................... 42 PM2 .......................................................... 72 PRCR ....................................................... 94 PS0 ........................................................ 286 PS1 ........................................................ 286 PS2 ........................................................ 287 PS3 ........................................................ 287 PSC ........................................................ 290 PSL0 ...................................................... 288 PSL1 ...................................................... 288 PSL2 ...................................................... 289 PSL3 ...................................................... 289 PUR0 ...................................................... 291 PUR1 ...................................................... 291 PUR2 ...................................................... 292 PUR3 ...................................................... 293 PUR4 ...................................................... 294 PWCR0 .................................................... 62 PWCR1 .................................................... 63 [E] EWCR0 to EWCR3 .................................. 50 [F] FMR0 FMR1 FMR2 FMR3 FMR4 ..................................................... 301 ..................................................... 303 ..................................................... 302 ..................................................... 302 ....................................................... 74 [I] ICTB2 ..................................................... 185 IDB0 ....................................................... 187 IDB1 ....................................................... 187 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 384 of 385 [R] RLVL .............................................. 105, 134 RMAD0 to RMAD7 ................................. 115 Under development Preliminary Specification Specifications in this manual are tentative and subject to change. M32C/8B Group Index [T] TA0 to TA4 ............................................. 149 TA0MR to TA4MR .......... 145, 146, 147, 148 TA1, TA2, TA4, TA11, TA21, TA41 ......... 187 TA1MR, TA2MR, TA4MR ....................... 183 TABSR ................................... 152, 171, 188 TB0 to TB5 ............................................. 170 TB0MR to TB5MR .................. 167, 168, 169 TB2 ........................................................ 186 TB2MR ................................................... 182 TB2SC ................................................... 185 TBSR ..................................................... 171 TCSPR ............................................. 73, 144 TRGSR .......................................... 151, 184 [U] U0BRG to U4BRG ................................. 204 U0C0 to U4C0 ........................................ 203 U0C1 to U4C1 ........................................ 204 U0MR to U4MR ...................................... 198 U0RB to U4RB ....................................... 206 U0SMR to U4SMR ................................. 199 U0SMR2 to U4SMR2 ............................. 200 U0SMR3 to U4SMR3 ............................. 201 U0SMR4 to U4SMR4 ............................. 202 U0TB to U4TB ........................................ 206 UDF ........................................................ 150 [V] VRCR ....................................................... 74 [W] WDC ...................................................... 119 WDTS .................................................... 119 [X] X0R to X15R .......................................... 276 XYC ........................................................ 276 [Y] Y0R to Y15R .......................................... 276 REJ09B0450-0050 Rev.0.50 Oct 31, 2008 Page 385 of 385 REVISION HISTORY Rev. Date 0.10 May 15, 2008 0.50 Oct 31, 2008 M32C/8B Group Hardware Manual Description Page − 3, 5 17 Summary First Edition issued Overview • Table 1.2, 1.4 Specifications Current consumption added, modified • Table 1.13 Pin Functions (3/3) A/D converter AN0_0 to AN0_7, AN2_0 to AN2_7 supply voltage changed to VCC2 23 27 Special Function Registers (Suffers) • Table 4.2 Note is added to Page mode wait control register 0, 1 • Table 4.7 Address changed from “044Ch” to “034Ch” 35 Reset • Table 5.1 Note 4 changed from “P5_5(EPM)” to “EPM(P5_5)” 38 Power Supply Voltage Monitor Function • Figure 6.3 DVCR register Note 2: Vdet(F), Vdet(R) values are added 69 84 84 90 93 99 108 110 185 Clock Generation Function • Figure 9.4 MCD Register Note 2 modified • 9.5.1.3 Low-Speed Mode Text revised • 9.5.1.4 Low-Power Consumption Mode Text revised • Table 9.8 “the clock input to the CLKi pin (i = 0 to 6)” changed to “the external clock” • Figure 9.19 Note 1 text revised Interrupts • 11.5.1 Fixed Vector Table Text revised • Figure 11.8 Diagram on the right: text changed from “Stack state before...” to “Stack state after...” • Figure 11.10 “Interrupt request level determination output” changed to “Request signal used to wake-up from wait mode/stop mode” Three-Phase Motor Control Timer Function • Figure 16.7 TB2SC register Note 1 deleted Serial Interfaces 201 • Figure 17.5 DINC bit changed from “Serial input pin..” to “Serial I/O pin..” 202 • Figure 17.6 UiSMR4 register Note 5 added 218-247 • Figure 17.11 to 17.32 Flow charts: “Initial setting start” to “Start”, “Initial setting end” to “End” • Figure 17.33 (2) Text changed to “TXDi pin outputs “L” level since...” 248 263 267 A/D Converter • Table 18.8 Start condition “retrigger of external trigger is invalid” deleted • Table 18.11 Note 2 revised • 18.2.4 Text modified, added Programmable I/O Ports 281-283 • Figures 22.1 to 22.3 Figures modified 308 311 315 317 Flash Memory • 23.6.1 CPU Rewrite Mode text added • Table 23.5 Read protect bit status, 2nd bus cycle changed “BA1” to “PBA” • Figure 23.12 Note 3 and 4 added • (9) Text changed from “any even address” to “the protect bit address” “The flash memory enters...by reading a protect bit address.” added • Figure 23.14 Text changed from “any even address” to “protect bit address” C-1 REVISION HISTORY Rev. Date M32C/8B Group Hardware Manual Description Page Summary Electrical Characteristics 326-359 • Chapter added 379 381 Usage Notes • 25.12 2nd dot, text “When using DMAC...correspond to each other.” added • 25.14.1 Text modified C-2 M32C/8B Group Hardware Manual Publication Date : Rev.0.10 Rev.0.50 May 15, 2008 Oct 31, 2008 Published by : Sales Strategic Planning Div. Renesas Technology Corp. © 2008. Renesas Technology Corp., All rights reserved. Printed in Japan M32C/8B Group Hardware Manual 2-6-2, Ote-machi, Chiyoda-ku, Tokyo, 100-0004, Japan